Skip to main content

Full text of "Proceedings of the Linnean Society of New South Wales"

See other formats


a. 
eo Semon mt 
pete Roe se 
hetenneece nen 


dipedann gnc toe Panic ote 


Se pepe 


a 


THE 


PROC BE DINGS 


OF THE 


PAR EA SOCIETY 


or 


New SoutH WALES 


INDEX 
TO 
VOLUMES [LL 
(1875-1925). 


SYDNEY: 
PRINTED AND PUBLISHED FOR THE SOCIETY BY 


THE AUSTRALASIAN MEDICAL PUBLISHING CO., LTD., 
Seamer Street, Glebe, Sydney, 


and 
SOLD BY THE SOCIETY. 


1929. 
PRICE 5;- 


Agent in Hurope: 
Messrs. DuLtau & Co., 32 Old Bond Street, London, W.1. 


lil 


The preparation of this index to contributors to the first fifty volumes of the 
Society’s Proceedings was commenced in 1924 when the Society was about to 
celebrate its Jubilee. The need of some such index was apparent and it was felt 
that, in the form in which it is now published, the index would be a valuable 
guide to the Proceedings and would enable those engaged in research in Natural 
History to locate, with comparative ease, papers dealing with any particular 
subject in which they might be interested. 


The Index contains (i) an alphabetical index of the authors who have 
contributed papers to the Proceedings, with title of paper and reference to year 
and page; (ii) a subject index compiled from the titles of the papers, with 
references to author and year; (iii) an alphabetical index to exhibitors of 
specimens, etc., at the meetings of the Society; and (iv) an index to the obituary 
notices which have appeared in the Proceedings from time to time. 


For the sake of simplicity in quotation, references have been made uniformly 
to the year for which the volume of Proceedings was issued, though at least one 
part of the volume was for many years issued early in the succeeding year. In 
order that the actual date of publication of any paper may be obtained without 
difficulty a list has been prepared (pp. v-vii) showing, for each Part of the 
Proceedings, the number of pages and the date of publication. For example:— 


Etheridge, R. Junr. Note on the Bibliography of Lord Howe Island. 1889, 627, 
appeared (as seen by reference to the list, p. v) in the Proceedings for 1889, i.e., 
Vol. iv (2nd Series), Part 3, published on 3rd February, 1890. 


In the compilation of Part i, use was made of the List of Contributors to 
the First Series (Vols. i-x) of the Proceedings, published by the Society in 1887, 
as well as of incomplete manuscript lists prepared, from time to time, by the late 
J. J. Fletcher. Part ii has been almost entirely compiled by Miss G. L. Allpress. 


A. B. WALKoM, 


Secretary. 
Sydney, . 


dlst January, 1929. 


! yt 
ome mlany G5 ee COATES te apn 


BiTiat) ast Day ae itt Gt Ear 


f ay ee Phe. oat 
i ath Ti. i weap 


Rent ‘i 


‘) Birt ls 


OO ae | nt Py i 


BARR ie 
SOAS PANNE 


a ay u f i A * : i aa i : : t «! Tah ft ay } * 
Bei. § he. aa Ms . % Be ANE ee Oe 


a), 
m cD , 
; ‘ “I i 
te 
; Ps 
a r ; 
( x We 
* e ¥ ve 
f } vt 
; ; ; ¥ ah 1 
‘ , ‘ i 
i 4 al i j 
y " i ; i \ ' 
; y % Cy D 
Ct < , 
} M 1 , 
n \ ‘i 
4 
ie Z 
A . 


LIST SHOWING DATES OF PUBLICATION OF PARTS OF THE 
PROCEEDINGS FOR HACH YEAR. 


1875-76. First Series, Vol. i. Part 1, pp. 1-20, 27th April, 1875; pp. 1-96 (pp. 1-26 
reprinted), *February, 1876; Part 2, pp. 97-168, *July, 1876; Part 3, pp. 169-282, 
*Rebruary, 1877; Part 4, pp. 283-419, *March, 1877. 


1877. First Series, Vol. ii. Part 1, pp. 1-122, *July, 1877; Part 2, pp. 123-217, 
*January, 1878; Part 3, pp. 218-288, *May, 1878; Part 4, pp. 289-401, *June, 1878. 


1878. First Series, Vol. iii. Part 1, pp. 1-76, *September, 1878; Part 2, pp. 77-161, 
* December, 1878; Part 3, pp. 161-305 (month not known), 1879; Part 4, pp. 306- 
443, *May, 1879. 


1879. First Series, Vol. iv. Part 1, pp. 1-116, 16th June, 1879; Part 2, pp. 117-244, 
6th October, 1879; Part 3, pp. 245-387, lst December, 1879; Part 4, pp. 387-492, 
May, 1880. 


1880. First Series, Vol. v. Part 1, pp. 1-105, August, 1880; Part 2, pp. 106-272, 
22nd November, 1880; Part 3, pp. 272-458; February, 1881; Part 4, pp. 459-652, 
20th May, 1881. 


1881. First Series, Vol. vi. Part 1, pp. 1-170, July, 1881; Part 2, pp. 170-408, 12th 
September, 1881; Part 3, pp. 409-711, December, 1881; Part 4, pp. 712-872, 20th 
~March, 1882: 


1882. First Series, Vol. vii. Part 1, pp. 1-135, 23rd May, 1882; Part 2, pp. 135-304, 
August, 1882; Part 3, pp. 303-404, 28th October, 1882; Part 4, pp. 405-684, April, 
18838. 


1883. First Series, Vol. viii. Part 1, pp. 1-180, 19th June, 1883; Part 2, pp. 181- 
298, 17th July, 1883; Part 3, pp. 299-417, 19th October, 1883; Part 4, pp. 419-583, 
21st February, 1884. 


1884. First Series, Vol. ix. Part 1, pp. 1-181, 23rd May, 1884; Part 2, pp. 183-443, 
19th August, 1884; Part 3, pp. 445-866, 29th November, 1884; Part 4, pp. 867- 
1242, 4th March, 1885. 


1885. First Series, Vol. x. Part 1, pp. 1-126, 4th June, 1885; Part 2, pp. 127-279, 
31st July, 1885; Part 3, pp. 279-554, 21st December, 1885; Part 4, pp. 555-881, 
3rd April, 1886. 


1886. Second Series, Vol. i. Part 1, pp. 1-238, 25th May, 1886; Part 2, pp. 239-578, 
28rd August, 1886; Part 3, pp. 579-975, 17th November, 1886; Part 4, pp. 975- 
1237, 22nd February, 1887. 


1887. Second Series, Vol. ii. Part 1, pp. 1-176, 18th May, 1887; Part 2, pp. 177- 
415, 31st August, 1887; Part 3, pp. 416-626, 30th November, 1887; Part 4, pp. 
627-1113, 21st March, 1888. 


1888. Second Series, Vol. iii. Part 1, pp. 1-402, 5th June, 1888; Part 2, pp. 403-894, 
10th September, 1888; Part 3, pp. 895-1316, 7th December, 1888; Part 4, pp. 
1317-1817, 22nd March, 1889. 


1889. Second Series, Vol. iv. Part 1, pp. 1-192, 29th May, 1889; Part 2, pp. 193- 
598, 20th September, 1889; Part 3, pp. 599-1030, 3rd February, 1890; Part 4, 
pp. 1031-1339, 15th April, 1890. ; 


* Actual date of publication not known. The months given indicate the months in 
which the receipt of Parts was registered by the Librarian of the Public Library, Sydney, 
or of the Royal Society of New South Wales (see J. J. Fletcher, Proc. Linn. Soc. N.S.W., 
2nd Ser., Vol. x, 1895, pp. 533-6), 


vi. 


1890. Second Series, Vol. vy. Part 1, pp. 1-244, 16th June, 1890; Part 2, pp. 245- 
414, 29th September, 1890; Part 3, pp. 415-656, 16th December, 1890; Part 4, pp. 
657-918, 23rd March, 1891. 


1891. Second Series, Vol. vi. Part 1, pp. 1-126, 9th, September, 1891; Part 2, pp. 
127-307, 22nd December, 1891; Part 3, pp. 308-578, 23rd May, 1892; Part 4, pp. 
579-723, 10th June, 1892. 


1892. Second Series, Vol. vii. Part 1, pp. 1-174, Ist September, 1892; Part 2, pp. 
175-314, 22nd November, 1892; Part 3, pp. 315-470, 16th March, 1893; Part 4, 
pp. 471-691, 1st May, 1893. 


1893. Second Series, Vol. viii. Part 1, pp. 1-128, 28th July, 1893; Part 2, pp. 129- 
330, 12th March, 1894; Part 3, pp. 331-438, 13th April, 1894; Part 4, pp. 439-608, 
5th June, 1894. 


1894. Second Series, Vol. ix. Part 1, pp. 1-188, 4th September, 1894; Part 2, pp. 
189-392, 10th December, 1894; Part 3, pp. 393-585, 26th March, 1895; Part 4, pp. 
586-741, 28th March, 1895. 


1895. Second Series, Vol. x. Part 1, pp. 1-210, 9th September, 1895; Part 2, pp. 
211-386, 18th November, 1895; Part 3, pp. 387-518, 3lst January, 1896; Part 4, 
pp. 519-668, 29th April, 1896; Supplement to Part 3, pp. 1-48, 31st January, 1896. 


1896. Vol. xxi. Part 1, pp. 1-112, 16th July, 1896; Part 2, pp. 113-280, 23rd 
September, 1896; Part 3, pp. 281-468, 22nd December, 1896; Part 4, pp. 469-863, 
3lst May, 1897; Supplement to Part 1, pp. 49-108, 16th July, 1896. 


1897. Vol. xxii. Part 1, pp. 1-229, 17th September, 1897; Part 2, pp. 230-437, 25th 
October, 1897; Part 3, pp. 438-659, 11th February, 1898; Part 4, pp. 660-850, 4th 
June, 1898. 


1898. Vol. xxiii. Part 1, pp. 1-105, 28rd June, 1898; Part 2, pp. 106-272, 30th 
August, 1898; Part 3, pp. 273-520, 9th December, 1898; Part 4, pp. 521-803, 19th 
May, 1899. 


1899. Vol. xxiv. Part 1, pp. 1-194, 8th August, 1899; Part 2. pp. 195-345, 10th 
October, 1899; Part 3, pp. 346-521, 9th December, 1899; Part 4, pp. 522-698, 
7th April, 1900. : 


1900. Vol. xxv. Part 1, pp. 1-130, 8th August, 1900; Part 2, pp. 131-320, 25th 
September, 1900; Part 3, pp. 321-536, 22nd November, 1900; Part 4, pp. 537- 
798, 20th May, 1901. 


1901. Vol. xxvi. Part 1, pp. 1-196, 13th August, 1901; Part 2, pp. 197-343, 7th 
November, 1901; Part 3, pp. 344-472, 19th December, 1901; Part 4, pp. 473-810, 
20th May, 1902. 


1902. Vol. xxvii. Part 1, pp. 1-145, 22nd August, 1902; Part 2, pp. 146-325, 17th 
October, 1902; Part 3, pp. 326-492, 16th December, 1902; Part 4, pp. 493-724, 
9th April, 1903; Supplement to Part 3, pp. 1-90, 16th December, 1902. 


1908. Vol. xxviii. Part 1, pp. 1-275, 30th July, 1903; Part 2, pp. 276-452, 6th 
October, 1903; Part 3, pp. 453-684, 23rd December, 1903; Part 4, pp. 685-972, 
28th April, 1904. 


1904. Vol. xxix. Part 1, pp. 1-216, 10th August, 1904; Part 2, pp. 217-441, 20th 
September, 1904; Part 3, pp. 442-670, 16th December, 1904; Part 4, pp. 671-890, 
10th April, 1905. z 


1905 Wooly xxx. Part de pp aliGaa4tiy Jilly lO Obes baljte 2. Deets oa amecii tell 
September, 1905; Part 3, pp. 353-485, 20th December, 1905; Part 4, pp. 486-638, 
12th April, 1906; Supplement to Part 1, pp. 1-18, 14th July, 1905; Supplement 
to Part 4, pp. 91-163, 12th April, 1906. 


1906. Vol. xxxi. Part 1, pp. 1-176, 27th June, 1906; Part 2, pp. 177-392, 3rd 
October, 1906; Part 3, pp. 393-567, 19th November, 1906; Part 4, pp. 568-768, 
28th March, 1907. 


1907. Vol. xxxii. Part 1, pp. 1-205, 20th June, 1907; Part 2, pp. 206-430, 20th 
August, 1907; Part 3, pp. 431-626, 25th October, 1907; Part 4, pp. 627-938, 11th 
March, 1908. 


1908. Vol. xxxiii. Part 1, pp. 1-208, 11th June, 1908; Part 2, pp. 209-455, 14th 
August, 1908: Part 8, pp. 456-700, 20th November, 1908; Part 4, pp. 701-907, 
11th March, 1909. 


vil 


1909. Vol. xxxiv. Part 1, pp. 1-194, 13th July, 1909; Part 2. pp. 195-3838, 15th 
September, 1909; Part 3, pp. 384-592, 3rd December, 1909; Part 4, pp. 593-831, 
12th March, 1910. 

1910. Vol. xxxv. Part 1, pp. 1-305, 14th July, 1910; Part 2, pp. 306-520, 17th 
September, 1910; Part 3, pp. 521-685, 16th December, 1910; Part 4, pp. 686-912, 
ist March, 1911. ; 

1911. Vol. xxxvi. Part 1, pp. 1-192, 17th August, 1911; Part 2, pp. 193-422, 20th 
November, 1911; Part 3, pp. 423-608, 8th February, 1912; Part 4, pp. 609-726, 
16th May, 1912. 

1912. Vol. xxxvii. Part 1, pp. 1-234, 26th August, 1912; Part 2, pp. 235-394, 13th 
December, 1912; Part 3, pp. 395-558, 19th March, 1913; Part 4, pp. 559-766, 
22nd July, 1913. 

1913. Vol. xxxviii. Part 1, pp. 1-228, 17th September, 1913; Part 2, pp. 229-400, 
5th November, 1913; Part 3, pp. 401-568, 19th December, 1913; Part 4, pp. 569- 
802, 23rd March, 1914. 

1914. Vol. xxxix. Part 1, pp. 1-216, 17th July, 1914; Part 2, pp. 217-448, 25th 
September, 1914; Part 3, pp. 449-640, 24th November, 1914; Part 4, pp. 641-878, 
26th February, 1915. 

1915. Vol. xl. Part 1, pp. 1-208, 16th June, 1915; Part 2, pp. 209-416, 15th 
September, 1915; Part 3, pp. 417-624, 10th December, 1915; Part 4, pp. 625-834, 
23rd February, 1916. 

1916. Vol. xli. Part 1, pp. 1-192, 14th June, 1916; Part 2, pp. 193-416, 13th 
September, 1916; Part 3, pp. 417-632, 9th December, 1916; Part 4, pp. 633-905, 
4th April, 1917. 

1917. Vol. xlii. Part 1, pp. 1-219, 11th July, 1917; Part 2, pp. 220-405, 3rd October, 
1917; Part 3, pp. 406-632, 22nd December, 1917; Part 4, pp. 633-890, 3rd April, 
1918. 

1918. Vol. xliii. Part 1, pp. 1-236, 3rd July, 1918; Part 2, pp. 237-416, 13th 
September, 1918; Part 3, pp. 417-672, 18th December, 1918; Part 4, pp. 673-902, 
26th March, 1919. 

1919. Vol. xliv. Part 1, pp. 1-212, 27th June, 1919; Part 2, pp. 213-462, 2nd 
October, 1919; Part 3, pp. 463-718, 17th December, 1919; Part 4, pp. 719-912, 
15th March, 1920. 

1920. Vol. xlv. Part 1, pp. 1-184, 25th June, 1920; Part 2, pp. 185-317, 16th 
August, 1920; Part 3, pp. 318-472, 8th November, 1920; Part 4, pp. 473-653, 
7th March, 1921. 

1921. Vol. xlvi. Part 1, pp. 1-156, ist June, 1921; Part 2, pp. 157-284, 12th August, 
1921; Part 3, pp. 285-408, 2nd November, 1921; Part 4, pp. 409-536, 23rd 
December, 1921. 

1922. Vol. xlvii. Part 1, pp. i-xx, 21st April, 1922; Part 2, pp. 1-198, 16th June, 
1922; Part 3, pp. 199-390, 15th September, 1922; Part 4, pp. 391-590, 15th 
December, 1922; Part 5, pp. xxi-lxxi, 15th February, 1923. 

1923. Vol. xlviii. Part 1, pp. i-xxvii, 13th April, 1923; Part 2, pp. 1-205, 15th 
June, 1923; Part 3, pp. 206-448, 3rd October, 1923; Part 4, pp. 449-688, 14th 
December, 1923; Part 5, pp. xxix-Ixxxii, 15th February, 1924. 

1924. Vol. xlix. Part 1, pp. i-xxi, 9th April, 1924; Part 2, pp. 1-178, 2nd July, 
1924; Part 3, pp. 179-396, 24th October, 1924; Part 4, pp. 397-544, 29th December, 
1924; Part 5, pp. xxi-lxxxi, 18th February, 1925. 

1925. Vol.1. Part 1, pp. i-xxxvi, 17th April, 1925; Part 2, pp. 1-170, 1st July, 1925; 
Part 3, pp. 171-310, 15th September, 1925; Part 4, pp. 311-561, 15th December, 
1925; Part 5, pp. xxxvii-lxxxvi, 15th February, 1926. 


i. INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS IN VOLUMES 1-50 (1875-1925). 


ALEXANDER, C. P. An Undescribed Species 
of Clytocosmus Skuse. 1920, 183—New 
or little-known Species of Australian 
Tipulidae (Diptera). 1922, 581. 

ALLEYNE, H. G., and W. Mactray. The 
Ichthyology of the “Chevert” Expe- 
Gition, Part i. 1875-76, 261; Part ii. 
1875-76, 321. 

Ancry, C. F. On some new or hitherto 
little known Land Shells from New 
Guinea or adjacent Islands. 1895, 374— 
Observations on Papuan Land and 
Freshwater Shells, with Descriptions 
of new Species from New Guinea and 
Western Australia. 1897, 771. 

AwpDERSON, R. H. A Revision of the Aus- 
tralian Species of the Genus Bassia. 
S33, BULA. 

ANDREWS, EH. C. Preliminary Note on the 
Geology of the Queensland Coast, with 
References to the Geography of the 
Queensland and New South Wales 
Plateau. 1902, 146—Notes on the 
Geography of the Blue Mountains and 
Sydney District. 1903, 786—The New 
Zealand Sound (and Lake) Basins and 
the Canons of Eastern Australia in 


their bearing on the Theory of the 


Peneplain. 1906, 499—The Geographical 
Significance of Floods, with especial 
Reference to Glacial Action. 1907, 795— 
The Development of the N.O. Myrtaceae. 
1913, 529—See also SawyrER and 
ANDREWS. 

AsSHMEAD, W. H. Notes on some New 
Zealand and Australian Parasitic 
Hymenoptera, with Descriptions of 
new Genera and new Species. 1900, 327. 

AUROUSSEAU, M. Petrological Notes. No. i 
—Igneous Rocks and Tuff from the 
Carboniferous of New South Wales. 
1915, 294; No. ii—The Relations between 
some Western Australian Gneissic and 
Granite Rocks. 1916, 261—An interest- 
ing Form of Sub-surface Drainage. 
1919, 826. 

BaiLtey, F. M. A General Account of the 
Flora of Tropical Queensland. 1877, 
276—On the Ferns of Queensland. 
1878, 118—On some of the Introduced 
Plants of Queensland. 1879, 26—On a 
new Species of Fern, Asplenium 
Prenticei. 1879, 36—Medicinal Plants 
of Queensland. 1880, 1—On Queensland 
Ferns, with a Description of two new 
A 


Species. 1880, 29—On a new Species of 
Nepenthes. 1880, 185—On the Flora of 
Stradbroke Island, with a Description 
of new Species. 1881, 139. 


BarLty, F. M., and J. HE. Tenrson-Woops. 


A Census of the Flora of Brisbane. 
1879, 137—See also Woops, TENISON-, 
and BAILry. 


Baker, R. T. Some New South Wales 


Plants illustrated. No. i. Acacia 
prominens, A. Cunn. 1891, 572; No. ii. 
Tarrietia argyrodendron, Benth., with a 
note on the Organs of Reproduction. 
1892, 333; No. iii. Acacia pugioniformis, 
Wendl. 1892, 379; No. iv. Acacia 
pruinosa, A. Cunn. 1892, 666; No. v. 
Angophora subvelutina, F.v.M. 1893, 
167; No. vi. Acacia subulata, Bonpl. 
1893, 237; No. vii. Genus Notothizos. 
1894, 158; No. viii. Acacia lanigera, 
A. Cunn. 1895, 382; No. ix. 1897, 693— 
Description of a new fsopogon from 
New South Wales. 1894, 658—Two New 
Species of Prostanthera from New 
South Wales. 1896, 378—On the Botany 
of Rylstone and the Goulburn River 
District. Part i. 1896, 427—Descrip- 
tions of two new Species of Acacia 
from New South Wales. 1897, 153— 
Contributions to a Knowledge of the 
Flora of Australia. No. i. 1897, 230; 
No: ii) L899) 4372 Noe it 9005 7659) 
No. iv. 1902, 536; No. v. 1906, 711— 
On the Cinnamomums of New South 
Wales; with a Special Research on the 
Oil of C. oliveri Bail. .1897, 275— 
Descriptions of two new Species of 
Pultenaea. 1897, 438—On two _ well- 
known, but hitherto undescribed Species 
of Hucalyptus. 1898, 162—On two new 
Species of Hucalyptus. 1898, 414—On a 
supposed new Genus of the N.O. 
Myrtaceae. 1898, 767—On three new 
Species of Hucalyptus. 1899, 292—On 
an Apocynaceous plant yielding large 
edible Tubers. 1899, 385—On three new 
Species of Hucalyptus. 1899, 596— 
On two new Species of Casuarina. 
1899, 605—On a new Species of 
Angophora. 1900, 84—On some new 
Species of Hucalyptus. 1900, 303—On 
some new Species ef Hucalyptus. 1900, 
674—On Eucalyptus melanophiloia, 
F.v.M., and its cognate Species. 1902, 
225—On a new Species of Ardisia from 


2 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


New South Wales. 1902, 380—On a new 
Species of Symplocos from New South 
Wales. 1902, 594—A Revision of the 
EKucalypts of the Rylstone District. 
1903, 349—On a new Species of 
Callitris from Hastern Australia. 1903, 
839—On an undescribed Species of 
Actinotus (A. Paddisoni) from Hastern 
Australia. 1905, 225—On an undescribed 
Species of Cryptocarya (C. foetida) 
from Hastern Australia. 1905, 517—On 
two Species of Hucalyptus, undescribed 
‘or imperfectly known, from Hastern 
Australia. 1906, 303—On two un- 
recorded Myrtaceous Plants from New 
South Wales. 1912, 585—Descriptions 
of three new Species of Myrtaceae. 
1913, 597. 


Batt, W. M. On some new and rare 
Hydroida in the Australian Museum 
Collection. 1888, 745. 


Bancrort, T. L. Preliminary Notes on 
the Pharmacology of some new poison- 
ous Plants. 1889, 1061—Note on Bac- 
terial Diseases of the Roots of the 
Leguminosae. 1893, 51—On the Habit 
and Use of Nardoo (Marsilea drum- 
mondii, A. Br.) together with some 
Observations on the Influence of Water- 
plants in retarding Evaporation. 1893, 
215—Note on Bungwall (Blechnum 
serrulatum, Rich.), an Aboriginal Food. 
1894, 25. 


Barwick, A. C. The Botany of the 


“Clears” and “Basalt Masses”; County - 


of Hunter, N. S. Wales. 1903, 932. 


BEDDOME, C. #H. Note on Cypraea 
angustata, Gray, var. subcarnea, Ancey. 
1896, 467—Description of a new Species 
of Pupina from Queensland. 1896, 814 
—Description of a new Species of Shell. 
1897, 123—Notes on Species of Cypraea 
inhabiting the Shores of Tasmania. 
1897, 564. 


Bett, F. J. Notes on a Collection of 
Echinodermata from Australia. 1884, 
496. 


Bennett, K. H. Notes on the habits of 
the Black-breasted Buzzard, Gypoic- 
tinia melanosternon, Gould. 1881, 146— 
On the Breeding-Place of Platalea 
flavipes and Ardea pacifica. 1882, 324— 
On Myoporum platycarpum, a Resin- 
producing Tree of the Interior of New 
South Wales. 1882, 349—On the Habits 
of the Mallee Hen, Leipoa ocellata. 
1883, 193—Notes on the method of 
obtaining Water from Eucalyptus Roots 
as practised by the Natives of the 
Country between the Lachlan and 
Darling Rivers. 1883, 213—Notes on 
the Habits, etc. of Birds breeding in the 


Interior of New South Wales. 1885, 162 
—Remarks on the Decay of certain 
Species of Hucalypti. 1885, 453—Note 
on the mode of Nidification of a Species 
of Pachycephala, supposed to be P. 
Gilbertii, from the Interior of New 
South Wales. 1887, 103—Notes on a 
Species of Rat (Mus tompsonii, Ram- 
say), now infesting the western Portion 
of N.S.W. 1887, 447—Note on the 
Breeding of the Glossy Ibis, Falcinellus 
igneus (Ibis falcinellus, Linn.). 1889, 
1059. 


Benson, W. N. The Geology of New- 


bridge, near Bathurst, N.S.W. 1907, 523 
—The Geology and Petrology of the 
Great Serpentine Belt of New South 
Wales. Parti. 1913, 491; Part ii. The 
Geology of the Nundle District. 1913, 
569; Part iii. Petrology. 1913, 662; 
Part iv. The Dolerites, Spilites and 
Keratophyres of the Nundle District. 
1915, 121; Part v. The Geology of the 
Tamworth District. 1915, 540; Part vi. 
A General Account of the Geology and 
Physiography of the Western Slopes of 
New England. 1917, 223, 250; Appendix 
to Part vi. The Attunga District. 1917, 
693; Part vii. See Benson, W. N., and 
F. CHAPMAN; Part viii. The Extension 
of the Great Serpentine Belt from the 
Nundle District to the Coast. 1918, 593; 
Part ix. See Benson, W. N., W. S. 
Dun and W. R. Browne—Petrological 
Notes on various New South Wales 
Rocks, 1914, 447. 


Benson, W. N., and F. CHapman. The 


Geology and Petrology of the Great 
Serpentine Belt of New South Wales. 
Part vii. The Geology of the Loom- 
berah District and a portion of the 
Goonoo Goonoo Hstate. 1918, 320, 363. 
(With two Palaeontological Appendices 
by F. Chapman. 1918, 385.) 


Benson, W. N., W. S. Dun and W. R. 


Browne. The Geology and Petrology of 
the Great Serpentine Belt of New South 
Wales. Part ix. The Geology, Palaeon- 
tology and Petrography of the Curra- 
bubula District, with notes on adjacent 
regions. Section A—General Geology 
(W. N. Benson). 1920, 285; Section B 
—Palaeontology (W. S. Dun and W. N. 
Benson). Appendix by F. Chapman. 
1920, 337; Section C—Petrography (W. 
R. Browne). 1920, 405. 


BERTRAND, E. G. Description d’un Hechan- 


tillon de Kerosene Shale de Megalong 
Valley, N. S. Wales. 1900, 637. 


Bezzi, M. MFissicorn Tachinidae, with 


description of new forms from Aus- 
tralia and South America. 1923, 647— 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 3 


On the Tachinid Genus E£Huthera 
(Diptera), with Description of New 
Species from Australia, Africa and 
South America. 1925, 275. 

BLAcKBuRN, T. Notes on the Hemiptera 
of the Hawaiian Islands. 1888, 343— 


Notes on Australian Coleoptera with . 


Descriptions of new Species. 1888, 805; 
Part ii. 1888, 1387; Part iii. 1889, 445; 
Part iv. 1889, 707; Part v. 1889, 1247; 
Part vi. 1890, 147; Part vii. 1890, 303; 
Part viii. 1890, 553; Part ix. 1890, 775; 
Payer, os, IG, 2iy@e Ieee. Sei, nse, Was 
Part xii. 1892, 283; Part xiii. 1893, 185; 
Part xiv. 1893, 245; Part xv. 1894, 85— 
Revision of the Genus Heteronyz, with 
Descriptions of new Species. Part i. 
TSE, Ueeals Ieee ih; Ist, eis Jeena abhi, 
TSO) ASS iene Thy, IUKSOS (ASR Jenne Av 
1889, 1217—Revision of the Genera 
Colpochila (including Haplonycha), 
Sericesthis and their Allies, with 
Descriptions of new Species. Part 
j. 1890, 517—Revision of the Australian 
Amarygmides, Part i. The Genus Chal- 
copterus. 1892, 411; Part ii. The Genus 
Chalcopterus contd., and Amarygmus. 
1893, 53—Revision of the Genus Parop- 
SiS. even i, IUIOG, Geis Ieee an, Ise)z, 
1662 Larkin. W898 e2ls- sPart aver 1898; 
656; Part v. 1899, 482; Part vi. 1901, 
159—A Revision of the Australian 
Species of Bolboceras, with Descriptions 
of New Species. 1904, 481. 

Buiatr, K. G. Notes on the Australian 
Genus Cestrinus Hr. (fam. Tenebrion- 
idae) and some Allied Genera. 1919, 529. 

BLaKELy, W. F. On a new Species of 
Acacia. 1917, 441—The Loranthaceae 
Ol: ASIANA, Ieee nm, UA ke lee yAe al, 
G22, 1992 Teenie tii, WA Bole lee wee Thy, 
UO28, WeaOs Tevet. wy, mNOeAE Wee JERE Aye 
1925, 1—Contributions to our Know- 
ledge of the Flora of New South Wales. 
1925, 383. 

BovuLENGER, G. A.—Description of a new 
Genus of Cystignathoid Frogs from New 
South Wales. 1890, 593—Description 
of a new Tree-frog from New South 
Wales. 1892, 403—On a new Typhlops 
previously confounded with Typhlops 
unguirostris Peters. 1894, 718. 

BrapvLeEy, H. H. B. The Araneides of the 
“Chevert” Hxpedition. Part i. 1875- 
76, 137; Part ii, 1877, 115—On some new 
Forms of Arachnidae. 1875-76, 220—On 
a new Genus of Arachnidae. 1875-76, 
240. 

BrAziER, J. Descriptions of fourteen new 
Species of Shells from Australia and 
the Solomon Islands. 1875-76, 1— 
Descriptions of eight Species of Aus- 
tralian and Tasmanian Land and Fresh- 


water Shells. 1875-76, 17—Descriptions 
of two new Species of Australian Land 
Shells. 1875-76, 97—Descriptions of 
thirty-five new Species of Land Shells 
from New Guinea, Australia and Islands 
in Torres Straits, collected during the 
“Chevert” Expedition. 1875-76, 98— 
List of Land Shells collected during the 
“Chevert” Hxpedition. 1875-76, 117— 
Description of a new Pupina collected 
during the “Chevert’” Expedition. 1875- 
76, 136—A List of the Pleurotomidae 
collected during the ‘“Chevert” Expe- 
dition, with the Description of the new 
Species. 1875-76, 151—List of Marine 
Shells, With Descriptions of the new 
Species, collected during the “Chevert”’ 
Expedition. Part i. 1875-76, 169; Part 
li. 1875-76, 199; Part iti. 1875-76, 224: 
Part iv. 1875-76, 249; Part v. 1875-76, 
Aes Ieee Ail, ISHS; Balals ieee Vabl. 
1875-76, 362; Part viii. 1877, 1; Part ix. 
USI, 20s IPareig ox, iS, ile Ipewer sai, 
US ie 4455 lear xa, Ime, DHS Ieee sci. 
IRS, TESS eB aah, alS77/, IPAS Ie ae oay 
Us‘, és Jesse sal, US, Bose Ieee 
xvii. 1878, 155—Notes on Laevicardium 
Beechet. 1875-76, 306—Description of a 
new Murex collected at Port Darwin, 
by Mr. W. Bednall. 1877, 6—Descrip- 
tion of three new Species of Shells from 
Australia and New Guinea. 1877, 25— 
Description of two new Species of Helix 
from New Guinea and the Louisiade 
Islands. 1877, 120—Notes and Remarks 
on Mollusca recently found in Port 
Jackson and New Caledonia. 1877, 369 
—Description of seven new Species of 
Terrestrial and Marine Shells from 
Australia. 1878, 77—Description of a 
new Species of Vivipara. 1878, 221— 
Synonymy of, and Remarks upon, Port 
Jackson, New Caledonian, and other 
Shells, with their Distribution. 1879, 
388—List of Land Shells found on 
Thursday I., with Descriptions of the 
new Species. 1879, 392—List of Brachi- 
opoda or Lamp Shells found in Port 
Jackson and on the Coast of New South 
Wales. 1879, 399—Tropical Mollusca 
recently dredged at Port Jackson Heads. 
1879, 428—Note on Oniscia ponderosa, 
with its Locality. 1879, 431—Notes on 
a new Variety of Bulimus caledonicus. 
1880, 190—Notes on Shells from the 
Solomon Islands and Australia. 1880, 
444—_Notes on recent Mollusca found in 
Port Jackson and on the Coast of New 
South Wales and other Localities, with 
their Synonyms. 1880, 481—List of 
Species of Porcellana or Cypraea found 
in Moreton Bay, Queensland. 1880, 496 
—Remarks on some recently  re- 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


described Australian Shells. 1880, 630 
—Remarks on Megapodius Brazieri. 
1881, 150—Note on a Specimen of mal- 
formed Cypraea. 1881, 202—Synonymy 
of, and Remarks upon, two Australian 
Species of Melania. 1881, 551—Descrip- 
tion of a new Bulimus from New 
Caledonia. 1881, 586—Remarks on some 
Fluviatile Shells of New South Wales. 
1882, 88—A List of Cypraeidae found on 
the Victorian Coast, collected by Mr. J. 
F. Bailey. 1882, 117—Note on Bulimus 
gunni. 1882, 12i—Habitat of Cypraea 
citrina of Gray. 1882, 322—Synonymy 
of Australian and Polynesian Land and 
Marine Mollusca. 1883, 224—Localities 
of some Species of recent Polynesian 
Mollusea. 1883, 294—Critical List of 
Mollusca from the North-West Coast 
of Australia. 1884, 793—Synonymy of 
some Land Mollusca from Papua or New 
Guinea. 1884, 804—List of some recent 
Shells found in layers of Clay on the 
Maclay Coast, New Guinea. 1884, 988 
—Synonymy of, and Remarks upon, the 
Specific Names and Authorities of four 
Species of Australian Marine Shells, 
originally described by Dr. John 
Edward Gray in 1825 and 1827. 1885, 
85—Description of a new Species of 
Onchidium. 1885, 729—New Species of 
Land and Freshwater Mollusca from 
Maclay Coast and Triton Bay, New 
Guinea, collected by Baron Maclay. 
1885, 841—Notes on the Distribution of 
Ceratella fusca Gray. 1886, 575—Report 
on a small Zoological Collection from 
Norfolk Island. iii. Mollusca. 1887, 
993—Mollusca trawled off Merimbula, 
New South Wales. 1889, 747—Descrip- 
tion of a new Cone from Mauritius. 
1891, 276—On the Synonymy of Heliz 
(Hadra) gulosa, Gould. 1891, 321— 
Synonymy of and Remarks on old- 
described Australian Mollusca, with 
Notes on their Distribution. 1893, 107 
—On a new Murex from South Aus- 
tralia. 1893, 179—Note en additional 
localities for Astele subcarinata, Sw. 
1893, 303—Distribution of little-known 
Mollusca from Polynesia and Australia, 
‘with their Synonyms. 1893, 430—On a 
Patella said to have been found on the 
Kermadec Islands. 1894, 183—On the 
Correct Habitat of Patella kermade- 
censis, Pilsbry. 1894, 566—On Trochus 
adamsi from Port Jackson, and new 
Varieties of Bulimus miltocheilus Reeve 
from the Solomon Islands. 1894, 567— 
On some Australian and Tasmanian 
Mollusca, with their synonyms. 1894, 
691—A British Bivalve Molluse (Cryp- 
todon flexuosus, Mont.) found in Aus- 


tralia and Tasmania, with its Distri- 
bution. 1894, 725—Rossiteria, a new 
Subgenus of the Family Trochidae. 
1894, 728—New Species of Cone from 
the Solomon Islands. 1895, 471—A new 
Genus and three new Species of 
Mollusca from New South Wales, New 
Hebrides and Western Australia. 1896, 
345—New Marine Shells from the Solo- 
mon Islands and Australia. 1897, 779— 
Four new Species of Mollusca from Vic- 
toria. 1898, 271—New Marine and 
Land Mollusca from Fiji, Ceylon and 
Queensland (Title). 1898, 379—See 
also Tare and Brazier; HENN and 
BRAZIER. 

BREAKWELL, Hl. <A Study of the Leaf 
Anatomy of some native Species of the 
Genus Andropogon (N.O. Gramineae). 
1914, 385—The Anatomical Structure of 
some Xerophitic Native Grasses. 1915, 
42. 

BRENNAN, SARAH O. On the reproductive 
System of Digaster (Didymogaster) 
sylvaticus, Fletch. 1899, 691. 

BREWSTER, AGNES A. Observations on the 
Pollination of Darwinia fascicularis 
Rudge (N.O. Myrtaceae). 1915, 758. 

Briecs, HE. A. Hydroids from New South 
Wales. 1915, 196. 

BRITTLEBANK, C. C. The Life-history of 
Loranthus exocarpi, Behr. 1908, 650. 

BROELEMANN, H. W. Description of a new 
Species of Myriapoda. 1915, 683. 

Broom, R. On a new Fossil Mammal 
allied to Hypsiprymnus but resembling 
in some Points the Plagiaulacidae 
(Title). 1895, 373—On the Homology 
of the Palatine Process of the Mam- 
malian Premaxillary. 1895, 477—On 
some Developments of the Mammalian 
Prenasal Cartilage. 1895, 555—On a 
small Fossil Marsupial with large 
grooved Premolars. 1895, 563—On a 
small Fossil Marsupial allied to 
Petaurus. 1895, 568—On the Organ of 
Jacobson in an Australian Bat (Mini- 
opterus). 1895, 571—Note on the Period 
of Gestation in Hchidna. 1895, 576— 
Observations on the Relations of the 
Organ of Jacobson in the Horse. 1896, 

_9—Report on a Bone Breccia Deposit 
near the Wombeyan Caves, N.S.W., with 
Descriptions of some new Species of 
Marsupiais. 1896, 48—On the Compara- 
tive Anatomy of the Organ of Jacob- 
son in Marsupials. 1896, 591—On the 
Lizards of the Chillagoe District, N. 
Queensland. 1897, 639—On the Affini- 
ties and Habits of Thylacoleo. 1898, 
57—A Contribution to the Development 
of the Common Phalanger. 1898, 705— 
Note on an Hechidna with eight cervical 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 5 


Vertebrae. 1900, 7383—On the Ossifica- 
tion of the Vertebrae in the Wombat 
and other Marsupials.. 1900, 735—On 
the Mammalian and Reptilian Vomer- 
ine Bones. 1902, 545—Observations on 
the Development of the Marsupial 
Skull. 1909, 195—On the Affinities of 
Caenolestes (Marsupialia). 1911, 315. 

BrotHervus, V. F. Descriptions of some 
new Species of Australian, Tasmanian, 
and New Zealand Mosses. vi. 1916, 
Hla 

BROTHERUS, V. F., and W. W. Watts. The 
Mosses of the Yarrangobilly Caves 
District, N.S.W. 1912, 363—The Mosses 
of Lord Howe Island. 1915, 363—The 
Mosses of North Queensland. 1918, 544. 

BrovueH, P. Preliminary Note on the 
embryo sac of Styphelia longifolia (R. 
Br.). 1923, 674—Studies in the Epacri- 
daceae. i. The life-history of Styphelia 
longifolia (R. Br.). 1924, 162. 

Brouce, PJ, Mebuckim, and ASE Ke 
PeTrig. An ecological study of the flora 
of Mount Wilson. Part i. The vegeta- 
tion of the basalt. 1924, 475. 

Brown, Ipa A. Notes on the Occurrence 
of Glendonites and Glacial Erratics in 
Upper Marine Beds at Ulladulla, N.S.W. 
1925, 25—Geology of the Milton District, 
N.S.W. 1925, 448. 

Browne, W. R. See Benson, Dun and 
BROWNE; also OSBORNE and BROWNE. 
BurRRELL, H. Burrowing Habits of Orni- 

thorhynchus. 1925, 167. 


CAMBAGE, R. H. Notes on the Botany of 
the Interior of New South Wales. Part 
i. From the Darling River at Bourke 
LOmCobaiyn 9005 59 Lark ee Tom 
Cobar to the Bogan River above Nyn- 
wena, UOOO, YAMS Jebnee ii, alXiil, alee 
Part iv. From Mount Hope to Parkes. 


1901, 317; Part v. From Parkes to 
Marsden. 1901, 685; Part vi. From 
Marsden to Narrandera. 1902, 186; 
Part vii. From Forbes to Bathurst. 
1902, 561—Notes on the Native Flora of 
New South Wales. Part i. Tumba- 
rumba and Tumut Districts. 1904, 685; 


Part ii. Western Slopes of New England. 
1904, 781; Part iii. Orange to Dubbo and 
Gilgandra. 1905, 203; Part iv. The Occur- 
rence of Casuarina stricta Ait. on the 
Narrabeen Shales. 1905, 376; Part v. 
Bowral to the Wombeyan Caves. 1906, 
432; Part vi. Deepwater to Torrington 
and Hmmaville. 1908, 45; Part vii. Hast- 
ern Monaro. 1909, 310; Part viii. Cam- 
den to Burragorang and Mount Werong. 
1911, 541; Supplementary Lists to Part 
Viii. Camden to Burragorang and 
Mount Werong. 1912, 617; Part ix. 
Barraba to Nandewar Mountains and 


Boggabri. 1912, 622; Part x. The 
Federal Capital Territory. 1918, 673— 
Description of a new Species of 
Hucalyptus from the Monaro District, 
N.S.W. 1909, 336—Presidential Address, 
25th March, 1925. 1925, i. 

CAMERON, P. On a collection of Parasitic 
Hymenoptera (chiefly bred) made by 
Mr. W. W. Froggatt, F.L.S., in New 
South Wales, with Descriptions of New 
Genera and Species. Parti. 1911, 333; 
iSeyeie mi, WSLS BGS leer mm, GIA, ILA 
—On Parasitic Hymenoptera from the 
Solomon Islands, collected by Mr. W. 
W. Froggatt, F.L.S. 1911, 349—Descrip- 
tions of two new Species of JIchneu- 


monidae from the Island of Aru. 
NOW2 207. 

CAMFIELD, J. H. See MaimpEn and Cam- 
FIELD. 


CARNE, W. M. Note on the Occurrence of a 
Limestone-flora at Grose Vale. 1910, 
849—See also Musson and CARNE. 

CARRINGTON, B., and W. H. Pearson. List 
of Hepaticae collected by Mr. Thomas 
Whitelegge in New South Wales, 1884- 
HehSsie LOS: 

Carter, H. J. Descriptions of new Species 
of Australian Coleoptera. 1905, 177— 
Notes on the Genus Cardiothorax; with 
Descriptions of new Species of Aus- 
tralian Coleoptera. 1906, 236—Revision 
of the Australian Species of Adelium. 
1908, 257—Revision of the Genus Seiro- 
trana, together with Descriptions of 
new Species of other Australian Cole- 
optera. 1908, 392—Notes on Australian 
Coleoptera; with Descriptions of new 
Species of Tenebrionidae. 1909, 120— 
Revision of Sympetes and Helaeus; with 
Descriptions of new Species of Tene- 
brionidae (Coleoptera). 1910, 77— 
Tenebrionidae from Dorrigo (Appendix 
to Carabidae from Dorrigo, N.S.W., by 
T. G. Sloane). 1910, 843—Revision of 
Pterohelaeus (contd.) and of Saragus; 
with Descriptions of new Species of 
Australian Tenebrionidae. 1911, 179— 
Descriptions of some new Species of 
Coleoptera. 1912, 480—Notes on the 
Genus Stigmodera, with Descriptions of 
eleven new Species, and of other Bup- 
restidae. 1912, 497—Revision of Aus- 
tralian Species of the Subfamilies 
Cyphaleinae and Cnodaloninae (Tene- 
brionidae). 1913, 61—Revision of the 
Subfamily Tenebrioninae, Family Tene- 
brionidae: Australian Species; with 
Descriptions of new Species of Tene- 
brioninae and Cyphaleinae. 1914, 44— 
Descriptions of six new Species of 
Buprestidae (Coleoptera). 1915, 76— 
The Australian Strongyliinae and other 


6 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


Tenebrionidae, with Descriptions of 
new Genera and Species. 1915, 522— 
Descriptions of a new Genus, and three 
new Species of Australian Tene- 
_brionidae (Coleoptera) from Barring- 
ton Tops, N.S.W. 1916, 209—Some new 
Heteromera, and a new Stigmodera 
from Tropical Australia. 1917, 701— 
Notes on Australian Coleoptera, with 
Descriptions of new Species. 1919, 137 
—Notes on some Australian Tene- 
brionidae, with Descriptions of new 
Species; also of a new Genus and 
Species of Buprestidae. 1920, 222— 
Australian Coleoptera: Notes and new 
Species. 1921, 301; No. ii. 1922, 65; No. 
iii. 1924, 19; No. iv. 1924, 521—Revision 
of the Genera Hthon, Cisseis and their 
Allies (Buprestidae). 1923, 159—Re- 
vision of the Australian Species of 
Chrysobothris (Fam. Buprestidae), to- 
gether with Notes, and Descriptions of 
New Species of Coleoptera. 1925, 225. 


CASTELNAU, F. de. Australian Fishes. 
New or little known Species. 1877, 225 
—Notes on the Fishes of the Norman 
River. 1878, 41—On several new Aus- 
tralian (chiefly) Freshwater Fishes. 
1878, 140—On a new Ganoid Fish from 
Queensland. 1878, 164—Hssay on the 
Ichthyology of Port Jackson. 1878, 347. 


CASTELNAU, F. pE, and H. P. RaAmsay. 
Notes of a Collection of Birds from the 
Norman River, Gulf of Carpentaria, 
with Descriptions of some new Species. 
1875-76, 379. 

CHAPMAN, EF. Notes on the older Tertiary 
Foraminiferal Rocks on the West Coast 
of Santo, New Hebrides. 1905, 261— 
On the Tertiary Limestones and Fora- 


miniferal Tuffs of Malekula, New 
Hebrides. 1907, 745—See also BENSON 
and CHAPMAN. 

CHAPMAN, H. G. Contributions to our 


Knowledge of the Physiology of the 
Pancreas. 1905, 92—Note on Cerebral 
Localization in the Bandicoot (Per- 
ameles). 1906, 493—The Behaviour of 
Hyla aurea to Strychnine. 1908, 292— 
The Acidity of Milk. 1908, 436—A 
Contribution to the Study of Precipitins. 
1910, 526—Presidential Address, 27th 
March, 1918. 1918, 1—Presidential 
Address, 26th March, 1919. 1919, 1— 
See also MosELEY and CHAPMAN. 

CHAPMAN, H. G., and J. M. Prerriz. The 
Hexone Bases of Egg White. 1909, 302. 

CHASE, ELEANOR KE. A new Avian 
Trematode. 1920, 500. 

CHEEL, EH. Notes on Juncus holoschaenus, 
R. Br., and J. prismatocarpus, R. Br., 
and on certain other New South Wales 
plants. 1902, 210—Notes on the “Com- 


mon Nightshade” (Solanum nigrum 
Linn.) and some closely related Forms 
and Species that have been confused 
with it. 1917, 588—New or noteworthy 
Plants from the National Herbarium, 
Sydney. 1923, 681—Two New Species 
of Callistemon, with Notes on Certain 
Other Species. 1925, 259—See also 
CLELAND and CHEEL. 

CHEESEMAN, T. F. Note on the Correct 
Habitat of Patella (Scutellastra) ker- 
madecensis, Pilsbry. 1895, 221. 


CHILTON, C. On a marine Species of 


Philougria. 1884, 463—Notes on a few 
Australian Hdriophthalmata. 1884, 
1035—On a new tIsopodan Genus 


(family Oniscidae) from Lake Coran- 
gamite, Victeria. 1919, 723. 

CHISHOLM, EH. C. Hucalypts of the Blue 
Mountains and their -defined Areas. 
1924, 147—The Comboyne Plateau: its 
General Conformation and Flora. 1925, 
284. 

Ciapp, F. G. A Few Observations on the 
Geology and Geography of North-west 
and Desert Basins, Western Australia. 
1925, 47. 

CLELAND, J. B. Diurnal Variations in the 
Temperatures of Camels. 1909, 268— 
A Second Bird Census. 1922, 132—See 
also JOHNSTON and CLELAND. 

CLELAND, J. B., and EH. CuHrert. Records 
of Australian Fungi. No. i. 1916, 853. 


Coss, N. A. Two new Instruments for 
Biologists. 1890, 157—Oxyuris-larvae 
hatched in the Human Stomach under 
Normal Conditions. 1890, 168—Arabian 
Nematodes. 1890, 449—Anticoma: a 
Genus of free-living Marine Nematodes. 
1890, 765—Onyx and Dipeltis: new 
Nematode Genera, with a Note on 
Dorylaimus. 1891, 148—Tricoma and 
other new Nematode Genera. 1893, 389 
—Descriptions of some apparently com- 
mon Australian Nematodes found at 
Sydney or in Port Jackson (Title). 
1898, 171 — Australian Free-living 
Marine Nematodes. 1898, 383. 

COCKERELL, T. D. A. The Bees of the 
Solomon Islands. 1911, 160—Australian 
Bees. i. A new Crocisa, with a List of 
the Australian Species of the Genus. 
1912, 594—A small Collection of Bees 
from Tasmania. 1912, 596. 

CoLLins, MaArvsoriz (I. On the Leaf- 
Anatomy of Scaevola crassifolia (Good- 
eniaceae), with special Reference to the 
Epidermal Secretion. 1918, 247—Note 
on certain Variations of the Sporocyst 
in a Species of Saprolegnia. 1920, 277 
—On the Structure of the Resin- 
secreting Glands in some Australian 
Plants. 1920, 329—On the Mangrove 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 7 


and Saltmarsh Vegetation near Sydney, 
with special Reference to Cabbage Tree 
@reek, Port Hacking, 19215 3”6— 
Studies in the Vegetation of Arid and 
Semi-arid New South Wales. Part: i. 
The Plant Ecology of the Barrier 
IDNisieNCE, WGP Aes Ieewer This Anare) 
Botanical Features of the Grey Range 
and its Neighbourhood. 1924, 1. 


CoQUILLETT, D. W. Description of 
Agromyza phaseoli, a new Species of 
Leaf-mining Fly. 1899, 128—Descrip- 
tions of two new Species of Diptera 
from Western Australia. 1900, 389— 
Description of a new Fruit Fly of the 
Genus Dacus from New South Wales. 
1908, 794. 

Cotton, L. A. Metasomatic Processes in 
a Cassiterite Vein from New England. 
1909, 220—Note on the Guyra Lagoon, 
N.S.W. 1909, 233—The Tin-Deposits of 
New England, N.S.W. Part i. The His- 
more Tingha District. 1909, 733—The 
Ore-Deposits of Borah Creek, New Eng- 
land, N.S.W. 1910, 496—The Diamond 
Deposits of Copeton, New South Wales. 
1914, 803. 


Corton, L. A., and A. B. WautKom. Note 
on the Relation of the Devonian and 
Carboniferous Formations west of Tam- 
worth, N.S.W. 1912, 703. 


Cox, J. C. On the Stone Implements of 
Australia and the South Sea Islands. 
1875-76, 21—Drawings by Australian 
Aborigines. 1878, 155—On two new 
Species of Helix from the Louisiade 
Archipelago. 1879, 114—Notes on the 
Genus Cypraea. 1879, 385—Notes on 
the Moore Park Borings. 1880, 273— 
Notes on some of the Habits and Cus- 
toms of Australian Natives in Queens- 
land. 1880, 683—On the Nomenclature 
and Distribution of the Genus Pythia, 
Bolton. 1881, 587—Australian Octo- 
podidae. 1881, 773—Presidential Ad- 
dress, 25th January, 1882. 1881, 847— 
On the Edible Oysters found on the 
Australian and neighbouring Coasts. 
Part i. 1882, 122; Part ii. 1882, 555— 
Presidential Address, 31st Jan., 1883. 
1882, 675—Dimensions of some gigantic 
Land-Tortoises. 1883, 531—Contribu- 
tions to Conchology. No. i. 1887, 1061 
—Notes on two Wax Figures obtained 
from an Aboriginal Camp at Miriam 
Vale near the head of Baffle Creek, 
Rockhampton. 1888, 1223—Note on 
Cypraea venusta (Sowerby). 1889, 187 
—Descriptions of two new Species of 
Australian Mollusca. 1889, 658—Annual 
(Vice-Presidential) Address, 28th Jan- 
uary, 1891. 1890, 899—Descriptions of 
some new Species of Pulmonate Mol- 


lusca from Australia, and the Solomon 
Islands. 1891, 565—Notes on the Occur- 
rence of a Species of Plecotrema and of 
other Species of Mollusca in Port Jack- 
son. 18938, 422—Description of a new 
Species of Liparus from West Aus- 
tralia. 1899, 435. 


Com de De and AS G2) Eni ron. AS ist 


of the Birds of the Mudgee District, 
with Notes on their Habits, etc. 1889, 
395. 


CUNNINGHAM, G. H. A critical revision 


of the Australian and New Zealand 
species of the genus Secotium. 1924, 
97—Gasteromycetes of Australasia. ii. 
A Revision of the Genus Tulostoma. 
1925, 245—iii. The Genera Bovista and 
Bovistella. 1925, 367. 


CurRAN, J. M. On some Fossil Plants 


from Dubbo, N.S.W. 1884, 250—The 
Geology of Dubbo. 1885, 170—Notes on 
the Geology and Water Supply of the 
Interior of New South Wales. 1885, 
233—Note on a Leucite-Basalt from 
Central New South Wales. 1887, 974— 
Carboniferous and Silurian Fossils from 
Central New South Wales. 1888, 800 
—A Contribution to the Geology and 
Petrography of Bathurst, N.S.W. 1891, 
173—On the Hvidence (so-called) of 
Glacier Action on Mount Kosciusko 
Plateau. 1897, 796. 


Davip, T. W. EneckwortH. Note on the 


Origin of “Kerosene Shale’. 1889, 483 
—Geological Notes on (i) The Lacco- 
lites of the Junction Mine, near Man- 
durama. 1890, 421; (ii) The Occur- 
rence of Glossopteris in a remarkable 
State of Preservation in the Greta Coal- 
measures at Richmond Vale near Mait- 
land. 1890, 424; (iii) The Occurrence 
of Andesitic Lavas at the Canoblas, 
near Orange. 1890, 426—Presidential 
Address, 28th March, 1894.. 1893, 540— 
Presidential Address, 27th March, 1895. 
1895, 134—On the Occurrence of Diato- 
maceous Harth at the Warrumbungle 
Mountains, N.S.W. (Title). 1895, 548— 
Note on the Occurrence of Diatoma- 
ceous Harth at the Warrumbungle 
Mountains, New South Wales. 1896, 261 
—The Occurrence of Radiolaria in 
Palaeozoic Rocks in New South Wales. 
1896, 553—Geological Notes on Kosci- 
usko, with special Reference to Eivi- 
dences of Glacial Action. Part ii. 
1908, 657—See also Dun, RANDS and 
Daviv; ETHERIDGE and Davin; PITTMAN 
and Davyip. 


IDANady, Mb Wo 194, IR, lala, eyaol Jay Ja 


PittTMAN. Geological Notes on Kos- 
ciusko, with Special Reference to 
evidences of Glacial Action. 1901, 26. 


8 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


Davin, T. W. E., and W. Howcuin. Note 
on the Occurrence of Casts of Radio- 
laria in Pre-Cambrian (?) Rocks, 
South Australia. 1896, 571. 

DEANE, H. Presidential Address, 25th 
March, 1896. 1895, 619—Presidential 
Address, 31st March, 1897. 
Observations on the Tertiary Flora of 
Australia, with special Reference to 
EKttingshausen’s Theory of the Tertiary 
Cosmopolitan Flora. 1900, 463; Part ii. 
On the Venation of Leaves and its 
Value in the Determination of Botanical 


Affinities. 1900, 581. 
DEANE, H., and J. H. Maipen. The Grey 
Gum of the North Coast Districts 


(Hucalyptus propinqua, n. sp.). 1895, 
541—Observations on the Hucalypts of 
New South Wales. Part i. 1895, 596; 
Part ii. 1896, 798; Part iii. 1897, 704; 
Part iv. 1898, 780; Part v. 1899, 448; 
Part vi. 1899, 612; Part vii. 1900, 104; 
Part viii. 1901, 122—On a new Species 
of Eucalyptus from the Sydney District. 
1897, 561—On the White Ash of 
Southern New South Wales. 1898, 412 
—Further Notes on supposed Hybridisa- 
tion amongst Hucalypts including a 
Description of a new Species. 1901, 339. 

Denpy, A. Further Notes on the Ovi- 
parity of the larger Victorian Peripatus 
generally known as P. leuckartii. 1892, 
267—Notes on some Land Planarians 
collected by Thos. Steel, Esq., F.L.S., in 
the Blue Mis., N.S.W. 1894, 729— 
Description of Peripatus oviparus. 
1895, 195. 

De Vis, C. W. Description of three new 
Fishes of Queensland. 1882, 318— 
Description of a Species of Squill from 
Moreton Bay. 1882, 321—Descriptions 
of some new Queensland Fishes. 1882, 
367—Description of two new Birds of 
Queensland. 1882, 561—Description of 
a new Belideus from Northern Q’land. 
1882, 619—Description of two new 
Queensland Fishes. 1882, 620—On Re- 
mains of an extinct Marsupial. 18838, 
1i—On Tooth-marked Bones of extinct 
Marsupials. 1883, 187—On Brachalletes 
Paimeri, an extinct Marsupial. 1883, 
190—Notes on a lower Jaw of Palor- 
chestes Azael. 1883, 221—Descriptions 
of new Genera and Species of Aus- 
tralian Fishes. 1883, 283—Myology of 


Chlamydosaurus Kingii. 1883, 300—On 
a Fossil Calvaria. 1883, 392—On a 
Fossil Humerus. 1883, 404—Fishes 


from South Sea Islands. 1883, 445— 
On some new Batrachians from Queens- 
land. 1884, 65—New Australian Fishes 
in the Queensland Museum. Part i. 
1884, 389; Part ii. 1884, 453; Part iii. 
1884, 5387; Part iv. 1884, 685; Part v. 


1896, 821— © 


1884, 869—On certain Geckos in the 
Queensland Museum. 1886, 168—On 
new or rare Vertebrates from the Her- 
bert River, North Queensland. 1886, 
1129—A Contribution to the Herpet- 
ology of Queensland. 1887, 811—On a 
supposed new Species of Nototherium. 
1887, 1065—On an Extinct Genus of the 
Marsupials allied to Hypsiprymnodon. 
1888, 5—A Glimpse of the Post- 
Tertiary Avifauna of Queensland. 
1888, 1277—Descriptions of two Lizards 
of Genera new to Australian Herpet- 
ology. 1889, 1034—Reptiles from New 
Guinea. 1890, 497—On the Trail of an 
extinct Bird. 1891, 117—Note on an 
extinct Hagle. 1891, 123—In confirma- 
tion of the Genus Owenia so-called. 


1891, 159—Remarks on Post-Tertiary 
Phascolomyidae. 1891, 235—The In- 
eisors of Sceparnodon. 1891, 258— 


Residue of the extinct Birds of Queens- 
land as yet detected. 1891, 437—Note 
on the upper Incisor of Phascolonus. 
1893, 11—A Thylacine of the earlier 
Nototherian Period in Queensland. 
1893, 44838—A Review of the Fossil Jaws 
of the Macropodidae in the Queensland 
Museum (Abstract). 1894, 735; 1895, 
75—Description of a Flycatcher, pre- 
sumably new. 1895, 171—Description 
of a Tree Creeper, presumably new 


(Title). 1895, 536. 
Distant, W. L. Synonymical Notes on 
some recently described Australian 


Cicadidae. 1912, 600. 


Drxson, T. Storte. Note upon the Bark 
of a reputed Ecbolic Plant from New 
Caledonia. 1882, 114—Presidential 
Address, 30th March, 1904. 1904, 1— 
Presidential Address, 29th March, 1905. 
1905, 2. 

Dopp, A. P. Two New Hymenoptera of 
the Superfamily Proctotrypidae from 
Australia. 1920, 443. 


Donat, et SHurRAT. Sur Quelques Simili- 
tudes des Langues et des Coutumes des 
Indigénes de Funafuti (Ellice Group) 
et des Indigénes de Iles de la Société, 
de l’Archipel des Tuamotu, etc. 1903, 
926. 

Dun, W. S. Note on the Occurrence of 
Sponge remains in the Lower Silurian 
of New South Wales. 1897, 436— 
Presidential Address, 25th March, 1914. 
1914, i1—Presidential Address, 31st 
March, 1915. 1915, 1—See also BENson, 
Duw and BRowNE; MITCHELL and Dun. . 


Dun, W. S., W. H. Ranps, and T. W. EH. 
Davin. Note on the Occurrence of 
Diatoms, Radiolaria and Infusoria in 
the Rolling Downs Formation (Lower 
Cretaceous), Queensland. 1901, 299. 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 9 


Durrant, J. H. Description of a new 
Species of Tortricidae. 1891, 17. 


Epwarps, H. Notes on the Habits and 
earlier Stages of Cryptophasa uni- 
punctata, Don. 1890, 300. 


ENGELHARDT, B. G. Notes on the Occur- 
rence of Stilbite in the Hruptive Rocks 
of Jamberoo, N.S.W. 1891, 5. 


ETHERIDGE, R., Junr. Description of 
Fish-Remains from the “Rolling Downs 
Formation” of Northern Queensland. 
1888, 156—On additional Evidence of 
the Genus Jchthyosaurus in the Meso- 
zoic Rocks (“Rolling Downs Forma- 
tion”) of North Hastern Australia. 
1888, 405—On additional Evidence of 
the Occurrence of Plesiosaurus in the 
Mesozoic Rocks of Queensland. 1888, 
410—Additions to the Fossil Flora of 
Hastern Australia. 1888, 1300—Re- 
marks on Fossils of Permo-Carbonifer- 
ous Age, from North-Western Australia, 
in the Macleay Museum. 1889, 199— 
Note on the Fructification of Phlebop- 


teris alethopteroides, Etheridge, fil. 
from the Lower Mesozoic Beds of 
Queensland. 1889, 625—-Note on the 


Bibliography of Lord Howe Island. 
1889, 627—On the further Structure of 
Conularia inornata, Dana, and Hyo- 
lithes lanceolatus, Morris sp. (= Theca 
lanceolata, Morris). 1889, 751—Note 
on the Structure of Annularia australis, 
Feistmantel, 1890, 47—Note on Aus- 
tralian Aboriginal Stone Weapons and 
Implements. No. i. 1890, 251; Nos. ii-iv. 
1890, 289; Nos. v-ix. 1890, 367; Nos. x- 
oy, IOI, Fle WGK, samierants ASOil, asey7s 
Nos. xXviii-xx. 1893, 295—Has Man a 
Geological History in Australia? 1890, 
259—A large Hquisetum from the 
Hawkesbury Sandstone. 1890, 445—On 
a Form of Womerah or ‘“Throwing- 
stick” presumed to be undescribed. 
1891, 699—A second undescribed Form 
ot Womerah from Northern Australia. 
1892, 170—Note on Queensland Creta- 
ceous Crustacea. 1892, 305—On Leaia 
Mitchelli, Eth. fil., from the Upper Coal 
Measures of the Newcastle District. 
1892, 307—Modifications of the Billetta 
or Gnalealing Womerah. 1892, 399— 
Three additional Types of Womerah or 
Throwing-Stick. 1893, 300—On an 
Aboriginal Implement, believed to be 
undescribed, and supposed to be a Hoe. 
1894, 109—On three highly ornate 
Boomerangs from the Bulloo River, 
N.S.W. 1894, 193—On five interesting 
Shields from Northern Queensland, 
with an Hnumeration of the figured 
Types of Australian Shields. 1894, 506 


—Additional Notes on the Palaeon- 
tology of Queensland. Part i. Palaeo- 
zoic. 1894, 518—The Kuditcha Shoes 
of Central Australia. 1894, 544— 
Descriptions of further highly ornate 
Boomerangs from New South Wales and 
Queensland. 1896, 14—Two ornate 
Boomerangs from North Queensland. 
1897, 260—Further Carved Boomerangs, 
and two Varieties of the Langeel from 
North Queensland. 1898, 701—The 
Spear-Becket or ‘“Doigtier’ of New 
Caledonia, the New Hebrides and other 


Pacific Islands. 1899, 271—The 
“Widow's Cap” of the Australian 
Aborigines. 1899, 333—Method of sus- 


pending the Palu, or so-called “Shark- 
hooks” as deduced from a Model. 1899, 
424—-The Tanna Spear-becket. 1899, 
427. 

ETHERIDGE, R., Jr., and T. W. H. Davip. On 
the Mode of Attachment of the Leaves 
or Fronds to the Caudex in Glossop- 
teris: with Remarks on the Relation of 
the Genus to its Allies, with a Note on 
its Stratigraphical Distribution in Aus- 
tralasia. 1894, 228. 

ETHERIDGE, R., Junr., and J. MITCHELL. 
On the identity of Bronteus Partschi de 
Koninck (non Barrande) from the 
Upper Silurian Rocks of N.S.W. 1890, 
501—The Silurian Trilobites of N.S.W., 
with references to those of other parts 
of Australia. Part i. 1891, 311; Part ii. 
The Genera Proetus and Cyphaspis. 
1893, 169; Part iii. The Phacopidae. 
1895, 486; Partiv. The Odontopleuridae. 
1896, 694; Part v. The Hncrinuridae. 
1915, 646; Part vi. The Calymeneidae, 
Cheiruridae, Harpeidae, Bronteidae, 
etc., with an Appendix. 1917, 480. 

Eyer, J. R. A Comparison of the Male 
Genitalia of the Palaeosetidae with 
those of Other Lepidoptera Homoneura. 
LOZ5e 26M. 

Eyer, J. R., and A. J. Turner. The Aus- 
tralian Species of Oncopera (Hepial- 
idae, Lepidoptera). 1925, 272. 


FarquuHar, H. On the Hchinoderm Fauna 
of New Zealand. 1898, 300—Descrip- 
tion of a new Ophiuran. 1899, 187. 


Fereuson, H. W. The Amycteridae of the 
“Voyage de |’Astrolabe’, 1835. 1911, 141 
—Revision of the Amycteridae. Part i. 
Genus Psalidura. 1909, 524; Part ii. 
Talaurinus. 1912, 83; 1913, 340; Part 
iii. Notonophes, Macramycterus, and 
genera allied to Talaurinus. 1914, 217; 
Part iv. Sclerorinus (Section i). 1915, 
685; (Section 11). 291!5, 759; Part v. 
Molochtus and Cubicorrhynchus. 1916, 
422; Part vi. Acantholophus. 1921, 19: 


10 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


Part vii. Hyborrhynchus and allied 
genera. 1921, 393; Part viii. The 
EHuomides. 1923, 381—Description of a 
New Species of Mycetophilidae (Dip- 
tera) with Luminous Larvae. 1925, 
487. 

Frrauson, H. W., and MARGUERITE HENRY. 
Tabanidae from Camden Haven 
District, New South Waies, with 
Descriptions of new Species. 1919, 828. 


Frereuson, H. W., and G. F. Hinz. Notes on 
Australian Tabanidae. 1920, 460; Part 
ii. 1922) 245. 

FirzcEraALtp, R. D., Junr. Notes on the 
Nidification of Sphecotheres mazillaris, 
Lath., and of Campephaga leucomelaena 
(V. & H.) with Descriptions of their 
Hegs. 1887, 970. 

FITZGERALD, W. V. Notes on some 
hitherto unrecorded Species of Plants 
indigenous in the State of Western 
Australia. 1902, 241—Descriptions of 
some New Species of West Australian 
Plants. 1903, 104. 

FLetcuer, J. J. On the existence after 
Parturition of a Direct Communica- 
tion between the median vaginal Cul- 
de-sac so-called, and the Urogenital 
Canal in certain Species of Kangaroos. 
1881, 796—On some points in the 
anatomy of the urogenital Organs in 
Females of certain Species of Kan- 
garoos. Part i. 1882, 640; Part ii. 1883, 
6—Note on a  Viviparous Lizard 
(Hinulia elegans). 1883, 215—Cata- 
logue of Papers and Works relating to 
the Mammalian Orders Marsupialia and 
Monotremata. 1884, 809—Notes on Aus- 
tralian Harthworms. Part i. 1886, 523; 
iPeee whl, IGG, O439 Ieee ii, ISI, Bas 
IEEE Thy, USS, GOlS Ieee ww, IlSSe, aWszils 
Part vi. 1889, 987—Remarks on an I[n- 
troduced Species of Land-Planarian 
apparently Bipalium Kewense, Moseley. 
1887, 244—Communication of a list of 
the Plants collected in N.W. Australia 
by Mr. Froggatt. 1888, 1256—Observa- 
tions on the Oviposition and Habits of 
certain Australian Batrachians. 1889, 
357—Additional Notes on Peripatus 
leuckarti. 1890, 469—Contributions to 
a more exact knowledge of the Geo- 
graphical Distribution of Australian 
Batrachia. No. i. 1890, 667; No. ii. 
1891, 263; No. iii. 1892, 7; No. iv. 1893, 
524; No. v, 1897, 660—Description of a 
supposed new Cystignathoid Frog. 
1891, 275—A viviparous Australian 
Peripatus (P. leuckartii, Sang.). 1892, 
179—Description of a new Cystig- 
nathoid Frog from New South Wales. 
1893, 229—Description of a new Cystig- 
nathoid Frog from New South Wales. 


1893, 522—On the Specific Identity of 
the Australian Peripatus usually sup- 
posed to be P. leuckarti, Sanger. 1895, 
172—On the Dates of Publication of the 
early Volumes of the Society’s Pro- 
ceedings. 1895, 5383—Hucalypts and 
Loranths in the Relations of Host and 
Parasite; and as Food Plants (Title 
only). 1896, 381—Contributions to a 
Knowledge of the Fauna of British 
New Guinea. Oligochaeta. 1898, 369— 
Illustrations of Polycotyledony in the 
Genus Persoonia, with some Reference 
to Nuytsia (N.O.0. Proteaceae; Loran- 


thaceae). 1908, 867—On a ease of 
Natural Hybridism in the Genus 
Grevillea (N.O. Proteaceae) (Title). 
1913, 449—Presidential Address, 31st 


March, 1920. 1920, 1—The Society’s 
Heritage from the Macleays. Address 
by the President, at the Special General 
Meeting, 14th June, 1920. 1920, 567— 
Presidential Address, 30th March, 1921. 
@)aals a. 

Fuercuer, J. J.. and A. G. HAMILTON. 
Notes on Australian Land-Planarians, 
with Descriptions of some new Species. 
Part i. 1887, 349. 

FLETCHER, J. J.. and C. T. Musson. On 
certain .Shoot-bearing Tumours of 
Eucalypts and Angophoras; and their 
modifying Influence on the Natural 
Growth-habit of the Plants. 1918, 191. 


Frynn, T. T. Contributions to a Know- 
ledge of the Anatomy and Development 
of the Marsupialia. INOFN 1s The 
Genitalia of Sarcophilus satanicus (Q). 
1910, 873—The Phylogenetic Signifi- 
cance of the Marsupial Allantoplacenta. 
O22 Ale 

ForsytH, W. Contribution to a Know- 
ledge of the Mosses of New South 
Wales. 1899, 674—Some Records of 
New South Wales Mosses (Title Only). 
1902, 369. 

Froceatt, J. L. A Study of the External 
Breathing-Apparatus of the Larvae of 
some Muscoid Flies. 1918, 658. 

Froaeatt, W. W. Notes on the Natives 
of West Kimberley, N. W. Australia. 
1888, 651—Notes on the Life-History of 
certain Saw-flies (Genus Perga), with 
Description of a new Species. 1890, 
283—Descriptions of a new Genus and 
two new Species of Tenthredinidae. 
1890, 487—Note on the Life-history of 
Pterygophorus cinctus Klug. 1890, 654 
—Catalogue of the described Hymen- 
optera of Australia. Part i. 1890, 689; 
Part ii. 1892, 205—Notes on a small 
Collection of Hymenoptera from Narra- 
bri, N.S.W. 1891, 183—Notes on Aus- 
tralian Cynipidae, with Descriptions of 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. ila 


several new Species. 1892, 152—Gall- 
making Buprestids. 1892, 323—Notes on 
the Family Brachyscelidae, with some 
account of their Parasites, and Descrip- 
tions of New Species. Part i. 1892, 353; 
Part ii. 1893, 209; Part ii. 1893, 335; 
Part iv. 1895, 201; Part v, 1898, 370 
On the Life-Histories of Australian 
Coleone, Ieee i, Ise, Avg leeieeE tH. 
1894, 113; Part iii. 1895, 325—Note on 
the Occurrence of the I[cerya aegyptia- 
cum, Dougl. in New South Wales. 1893, 
534—On the Nests and Habits of Aus- 
tralian Vespidae and Larridae. 1894, 
27—Description of a new Mite belong- 
ing to the Genus Heteropus, found in 
Wasps’ Nests. 1894, 259—Wood Moths: 
with some Account of their Life- 
Histories, chiefly compiled from the 
Notes of Mr. R. Thornton of Wallsend, 
N.S. W. 1894, 375—Australian Ter- 
mitidae Part i. 1895, 415; Part ii. 1896, 
SO Part ii 1897, 721——Notes’ om 
Cicadas, 1895, 526—The Hntomology of 
Grass-Trees (Xanthorrhoea). 1896, 74 
—On the Bag-Shelters of Lepidopterous 
Larvae of the Genus Veara. 1896, 258 
—A new Genus and Species of Saw-fly. 
1899, 130—Australian Psyllidae. Part i. 
1900, 250; Part ii. 1901, 242; Part iii. 
1903, 315—Notes on Australian Neurop- 
tera and their Life-Histories. 1902, 358 
—Notes on the Genus Psychopsis, New- 
man, with Descriptions of new Species. 
1903, 453—Studies in Australian Thy- 
sanoptera; the Genus Jdolothrips, Halli- 
day. 1904, 54—Notes on WNeuwroptera 
and Descriptions of new Species. 1904, 
671—Notes on the Hymenopterous 
Genus Megalyra Westw., with Descrip- 
tions of new Species. LIOG 399 
Description of a New Tick belonging 
to the Family Argasidae. 1906, 408— 
The Entomological Fauna of Nauru 
Island, of the Ocean Island Group. 
1910, 407—Notes on Fruit-Flies (Try- 
petidae) with Descriptions of new 
Species. 1910, 862—Description of a 
new Lac-Coccid (Genus Tachardia) 
from New South Wales. 1911, 154— 
Presidential Address, 27th March, 1912. 
1912, 1—Presidential Address, 26th 
March, 1913. 1913, 1—Notes on a Col- 
lection of Australian and other Myria- 
poda. 1915, 681—Notes on Australian 
Saw-flies (Tenthredinidae). 1918, 668 
—-A new Species of Wax Scale (Cero- 
plastes murrayi) from New Guinea. 
1919, 439—Description of a new Phasma 
belonging to the Genus Hztatosoma. 
1922, 344—Notes on Australian Coc- 
cidae with Description of New Species. 


1925, 378—See also Gopinc and 
FROGGATT. 

Frost, C., and A. H. S. Lucas. On a new 
Skink Lizard from Tasmania. 1893, 


227—See also Lucas and Frost. 

Fry, D. B. Description of Aphantophryne, 
a new Batrachian Genus from New 
Guinea: with Comparative Notes on the 
Pectoral Musculature. 1916, 770. 


GittiaTT, H. A. Some Remarks on the 
Action of Tannin on Infusoria. 1883, 
383. 

Ginitiges, C. D. On the Seasonal Distribu- 
tion of some Queensland Species of 
Arcella Ehrenberg (Rhizopoda). 1918, 
BAU 

Gopparp, HE. J. Contribution to our Know- 
ledge of Australian Hirudinea. Part i. 
1908, 320; Part ii. 1908, 854; Part iii. 
1909, 467; Part iv. With a Note on a 
Parasitic Endoproctous Polyzoon. 1909, 
721; Part v. Leech-Metamerism. 1910, 
51; Part vi. The Distribution of the 
Hirudinea, with Special Reference to 
Australian Forms, and remarks on 
their Affinities, together with Reflec- 
tions on Zoogeography. 1910, 69—Con- 
tribution to a further Knowledge of 
Australian Oligochaeta. Part i. Descrip- 
tions of two Species of a new Genus 
of Phreodrilidae. 1908, 768; Part ii. 
Description of a Tasmanian Phreo- 
drilid. 1908, 845—Australian Fresh- 
water Polyzoa. Part i. 1909, 487. 

Gopparp, E. J.. and H. I. Jensen. Contri- 
bution to a Knowledge of Australian 
Foraminifera. Part ii. 1907, 291. 

Gopine, F. W. A preliminary Study of 
the Membracidae described from Aus- 
tralia and Tasmania. 1898, 85—A 
Monograph of the Australian Mem- 
bracidae. 1903, 2. 

Gopine, F. W., and W. W. FROGGATT. 
Monograph of the Australian Cicadidae. 
1904, 561. 

GRANT, F. HE. Crustacea dredged off Port 
Jackson in Deep Water. 1905, 312. 

GRANT, EF. E., and A. R. McCuLtocH. On 
a Collection of Crustacea from the Port 
Curtis District, Queensland. 1906, 2— 
Decapod Crustacea from Norfolk Island. 
1907, 151. 

GREEN, EH. H. On some new Species of 
Coccidae from Australia, collected by 
W. W. Froggatt, F.L.S. 1900, 559— 
Notes on Australian Coccidae, ex Coll. 
W. W. Froggatt, with Descriptions of 
new Species. No. i. 1904, 462. 

GREENWOOD, W. See VEITCH and GREEN- 
Woop. 

Grey, EH. C. The Fatty Acids of Brain 
Lipoids. Part i. 1910, 295—Contribu- 


12 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


tion to our Knowledge of the Chemistry 
of Blood. No. i. Globin Sulphate and 
Globin from Ox-blood. 1911, 307. 

Grice, F. J. T. See PHILLIPPS and Grice. 

GROUVELLE, A. Description d’une nouvelle 
espece d’Ozylaemus (Coleoptera: Coly- 
diidae). 1907, 835. 

Guppy, H. B. Note on the Cocoanut-eating 
Habit of the Birgus in the Solomon 
Group. 1882, 661—Suggestions as to 
the Mode of Formation of Barrier Reefs 
in Bougainville Straits, Solomon Group. 
1884, 949. 

GurRNEY, W. B. Mite of genus Hriophyes 
associated with Malformation of Leaves 
of Hucalyptus stricta. 1924, 395. 


Hatz, H. M. Two new Hemiptera from 
New South Wales. 1924, 461—The De- 
velopment of Two Australian Sponge- 
Crabs. 1925, 405. 

Hatt, H. C. The Hucalypts of Parra- 
matta, with the Description of a new 
Species. 1912, 561—The Evolution of 
the Hucalypts in Relation to the Coty- 
ledons and Seedlings. 1914, 473—On 
a new Species or Form of Eucalyptus. 
1918, 747. 

Hatz, R. Description of a new Pardalote, 
its Nest and Eggs, from Victoria 
(Title only). 1899, 282—Note on the 
Occurrence in Victoria of a Phase of 
the Subspecies Pardalotus assimilis 
Ramsay. 1899, 472. 

Hatz, T. S. On the Occurrence of Mono- 
graptus in New South Wales. 1902, 654. 

HaLuican, G. H. Sand-Movement on the 
New South Wales Coast. 1906, 619. 


HALLMANN, EH. F. A Revision of the Mon- 
axonid Sponges described as new in 
Lendenfeld’s “Catalogue of the Sponges 
in the Australian Museum”. Part i. 
UGii4h Zosie ieeyee, whi, Weill Syave Jens mil 
1914, 398—A Revision of the Genera 
with Microscleres included, or pro- 
visionally included, in the Family 
Axinellidae; with Descriptions of some 
Australian Species (Porifera). Part i. 
UShlG, Gass leevee a, wilh, 2s Ieee it, 
1916, 634—On the Genera EHchinazxia 
and Rhabdosigma (Porifera). 1917, 391 
—New Genera of Monaxonid Sponges 
related to the genus Clathria. 1919, 
mone 

Haminton, A. A. A new Species of Lepi- 
dosperma (N.O. Cyperaceae) from the 
Port Jackson District; with some mis- 
cellaneous Botanical Notes. 1910, 411 
—A new Species of Hriochloa from the 
Hawkesbury River. 1912, 709—Topo- 
graphical and Ecological Notes on the 
Flora of the Blue Mountains. 1915, 386 
—The Instability of Leaf-Morphology 


in its Relation to Taxonomic Botany. 
1916, 152—Notes on the Genus 
Lepidium (N.O. Cruciferae) from the 
National Herbarium, Sydney. 1917, 
445—An Ecological Study of the Salt- 
marsh Vegetation in the Port Jackson 
District. 1919. 463—Notes from the 
Botanic Gardens, Sydney. 1920, 260. 


Hamitton, A. G. On the Fertilisation of 
Goodenia hederacea, Sm. 1885, 157— 
List of the Orchideae of the Mudgee 
District. 1886, 865—A List of the In- 
digenous Plants of the Mudgee District. 
1887, 259—On the Fertilisation of 
Clerodendron tomentosum, R. Br., and 
Candollea (Stylidium) serrulata, Labill. 
1894, 15—Notes on the Methods of Fer- 


tilisation. of the Goodeniaceae. Part i. 
1894, 201; Part ii. 1895, 361—Note on 
Pittosporum undulatum, Andr. 1894, 


5838—On apparently undescribed Struc- 
tures in the Leaves of Certain Plants 
(Title). 1895, 617—On Domatia in cer- 
tain Australian and other Plants. 1896, 
758—On the Fertilisation of Hupomatia 
laurina, R. Br. 1897, 48—Notes on the 
Fertilisation of some Australian and 
other Plants. 1898, 759—On the Flora 
of Mt. Wilson. 1899, 346—Notes on 
Byblis gigantea, Lindl. (N.O. Droser- 
aceae). 1903, 680—Notes on the West 
Australian Pitcher-Plant (Cephalotus 
follicularis, Lapbill.). 1904, 386—The 
Xerophilous Characters of Hakea dacty- 
loides, Cav. (N.O. Proteaceae). 1914, 
152—Presidential Address, 29th March, 
1916. 1916, 1—Presidential Address, 28th 
March, 1917. 1917, 1—See also Cox and 
HAMILTON, FLETCHER and HAMILTON. 
Harpy, G. H. Descriptions of Australian 
Flies of the Family Asilidae (Diptera), 
with Synonyms and Notes. 1920, 185— 
On the male Genitalia of some Robber- 


flies belonging to the Sub-family 
Asilinae (Diptera). 1920, 250—A Re- 
vision of the Chiromyzini (Diptera). 


1920, 532—A preliminary Revision of 
some Genera belonging to the Diptera 
Brachycera of Australia. 1921, 285— 
A Revision of the Australian Chiro- 
myzini (Stratiomyiidae. Diptera). 1924, 
360—Australian Nemestrinidae (Dip- 
tera). 1924, 447—Australian Mydaidae 
(Diptera). 1925, 139—See also JoHNS- 
TON and Harpy. 

Harprer, W. R. A Description of Certain 
Objects of unknown Significance for- 
merly used by some New South Wales 
Tribes. 1898, 420—Results of an Ex- 
ploration of Aboriginal Rock-shelters at 


Port Hacking. 1899, 322—On the 
“Onvar” of Malekula, New Hebrides. 
1901, 2338. 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 13 


Harrison, L. On some Pauropoda from 
New South Wales. 1914, 615—Note on 
the Pigmentation of Frogs’ Eggs. 1921, 
370—See also JOHNSTON and HARRISON. 


Harrison, L., and Haze, C. WEEKES. On 
the Occurrence of Placentation in the 
Scinecid Lizard, Lygosoma _ entrecas- 
teauxi. 1925, 470. 

Hartman, W. D. Description of a new 
Diplomorpha. 1891, 571. 

Hasweti, W. A. On six new Species of 
Annelids belonging to the Family 
Amphinomidae. 1878, 341—On two new 
Species of Crabs of the Genus Steno- 
rhynchus. 1878, 408—Notes on the 
Anatomy of Birds. i. The Brachial 
Plexus of Birds. 1878, 409; Notes on 
the Anatomy of Birds. ii. The Lumbar 
and Sacral Plexuses of Nerves. iii. The 
Myological Characters of the Colum- 
bidae. 1879, 303—On the Australian 
Species of Penoeus in the Macleay 
Museum, Sydney. 1879, 38—Contribu- 
tions to a Monograph of the Australian 
Leucosiidae. 1879, 44—On Australian 
Amphipoda. 1879, 245—Note on the 
Phyllosoma Stage of Ibacus Peronii, 
Leach. 1879, 280—On some additional 
new Genera and Species of Amphipo- 
dous Crustaceans. 1879, 319—On the 
Cyclostomatous Polyzoa of Port Jack- 
son and Neighbourhood. 1879, 350— 
Note supplementary to a Paper on the 
Australian Leucosiidae. 1879, 403—On 
the Australian Brachyura Oxyrhyncha. 
1879, 431—On some Polyzoa from the 
Queensland Coast. 1880, 33—On some 
new Amphipods from Australia and 
Tasmania. 1880, 97—On some new Aus- 
tralian Marine Isopoda. Part i. 1880, 
470; Part ii. 1881, 181—Note on the 
Occurrence on the Coast of New South 
Wales of the Genus Mesenteripora, BI. 
(Polyzoa Cyclostomata). 1881, 199— 
On some new Australian Brachyura. 
1881, 540—Description of a new Species 
of Apseudes. 1881, 748—Description of 
some new Species of Australian 
Decapoda. 1881, 750—On the structure 
of the Paired Fins of Ceratodus, with 
Remarks on the general Theory of the 
Vertebrate Limb. 1882, 2—Note on the 
Anatomy of two rare Genera of 
Pigeons. 1882, 115—-On Australian 
Fresh-water Sponges. 1882, 208—Note 
on the Brain of the Tiger Shark 
(Galeocerdo rayneri). 1882, 210—A 
Monograph of the Australian Aphro- 
ditea. 1882, 250—Note on some Points 
in the Anatomy of the Pigeons referred 
to by Dr. Hans Gadow in a recent 
Paper on the Anatomy of Pterocles. 
1882, 397—Preliminary Note on an Aus- 


tralian Species of Phoronis (Gephyrea 
“Tubicola’). 1882, 606—Note on a 
curious Instance of Symbiosis. 1882, 
608—Note on the Segmental Organs of 
Aphrodita. 1882, 610—On some new 
Australian Tubicolous Annelids. 1882, 
633—On the brain of Grey’s Whale 
(Kogia greyi). 1883, 4837—Studies on 
the Hlasmobranch Skeleton. 1884, 71— 
Note on the Claspers of Heptanchus. 
1884, 381—The Marine Annelides of the 
Order Serpulea. Some Observations on 
their Anatomy, with the Characteristics 
of the Australian Species. 1884, 649— 
On a new Crustacean found inhabiting 
the Tubes of Vermilia (Serpulidae). 
1884, 676—Note on the young of the 
Saw-Fish Shark (Pristiophorus  cir- 
ratus). 1884, 680—Revision of the Aus- 
tralian Laemodipoda. 1884, 993—A 
Revision of the Australian Isopoda. 
1884, 1001—On a new Instance of 
Symbiosis. 1884, 1019—On the Pycno- 
gonida of the Australian Coast, with 
Descriptions of new Species. 1884, 
1021—Notes on the Australian Amphi- 
poda. 1885, 95—-Jottings from the Bio- 
logical Laboratory of Sydney Univer- 
sity. No. i. On a Destructive Parasite 
of the Rock Oyster. 1885, 273; No. 2. 
On some Recent Histological Methods, 
and their Adaptation to the Teaching 
of Practical Histology. 1885, 276; No. 
3. Minute Structure of Polynoe. 1885, 
278: No. 4. An Australian Species of 
Bonellia. 1885, 331; No. 5. “Aquatic 
Respiration” in Fresh-water Turtles. 
1885, 331; No. 6. On the Myology of 
the Flying Phalanger. 1886, 176; No. 
7. Cutting Sections of Delicate Vege- 
table Structures. 1886, 489; No. 8. 
“Vocal Organs” of the Cicada. 1886, 
489; No. 9. Notes on 7mesipteris and 
Psilotum. 1887, 1025; No. 10. On the 
Embryology of Vermilia caespitosa and 
Eupomatus elegans. 1887, 1052; No. 11. 
On Sacculina infesting Australian 
Crabs. UGGS,  Al@alile  Iw@, wz Om 
Method of Preparing Blastoderms of 
the Fowl. 1888, 1712; No. 13. Note on 
Urolophus testaceus. 1888, 1713; No. 
14. On a remarkable Flat-worm para- 
sitic in the Golden Frog. 1890, 661; 
No. 15. On a simple Method of Sub- 
stituting strong Alcohol for a watery 
Solution in the Preparation of Speci- 
mens. 1891, 4833; No. 16. Note on the 
Occurrence of a Flagellate Infusorian 
as an Intra-cellular Parasite. 1892, 
197; No. 17. Three Zoological Novel- 
ties: i. The Occurrence of a second 
Species of Phoronis in Port Jackson. 
1892, 340; ii. An Alloiocoele Turbel- 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


larian inhabiting the underground 
waters of Canterbury, New Zealand. 
1892, 341; iii. A new Genus of the 
Temnocephaleae. 1892, 342; No. 18. 
Note on certain Points in the Arrange- 
ment and Structure of the Tentacu- 
liferous Lobes in Nautilus pompilius. 
1895, 544—Observations on some Aus- 
tralian Polychaeta. Part i. 1885, 733— 
Observations on the early Stages in the 
Development of the Emu (Dromaeus 
novae-hollandiae). 1887, 576—On 
simple striated muscle Fibres. 1888, 
1704—Observations on the Chlorae- 
midae, with special Reference to cer- 
tain Australian Forms. 1891, 329— 
Presidential Address, 27th January, 
1892. 1891, 706—A Monograph of the 
Temnocephaleae, Part i (Title). 1892, 
19—Presidential Address, 29th March, 
1893. 1892, 668—On the Development 
of Heterodontus (Cestracion) phillipi. 
Part i. 1897, 96—On Didymorchis, a 
Rhabdocoele’ Turbellarian inhabiting 
the Branchial Cavities of New Zealand 
Crayfishes. 1900, 424—Supplement to 
a “Monograph of the Temnocephaleae’”’. 
1900, 430—On a Gyrocotyle from 
Chimaera ogilbyi, and on Gyrocotyle 
in General. 1902, 48—On two Remark- 
able Sporocysts occurring in Mytilus 
latus, on the Coast of New Zealand. 
1902, 497—Australian Syllidae, HEusyl- 
lidae and Autolytidae. 1920, 90—On 
Astacocroton, a new type of Acarid. 
1922, 329—Critical Notes on the Temno- 
cephaloidea. 1924, 509. 


lias, Wo A. @inGl J, 12, Jeti, Om 


Polycercus: a proliferating Cystic Para- 
site of the Earthworms. 1893, 365. 


Havitanp, H: Occasional Notes on the 


Inflorescence and Habits of Plants in- 
digenous in the immediate neighbour- 


hood of Sydney. No. 1. 1882, 392; 
IN@, B WS82, GilBs WoO, 3 WSse, wsA¢ 
INOn) 4a S83 2898 INO. ba diesen 42a: 
No. 6. 1884, 67; No. 7. 1884, 449: 


No. 8. 1884, 1171; No. 9. 1885, 459— 
Some Remarks on the Fertilization of 
the Genus Goodenia. 1885, 237—On a 
Microscopic Fungus parasitic upon the 
Cucurbitaceae. 1886, 173—Flowering 
Seasons of Australian Plants. No. i. 
1886, 1049; No. ii. 1886, 1103; No. iii. 
IS7, IOHS INO, why, IUSs7, WsHe ING, Ww 
1887, 185; No. vi. 1887, 348; No. vii. 
1887, 565; No. viii. 1888, 267. 


Havitannp, F. EH. Notes on the Indigen- 


ous Plants in the Cobar District, N.S.W. 
1911, 507; No. ii. 1913, 639—The Pollin- 
ation of Goodenia cycloptera, R. Br. 
(N.O. Goodeniaceae). 1914, 851. 


Hepiey, C. On the Structure and System- 


atic Position of Cystopelta. 1890, 44— 
On the Anatomy of some Tasmanian 
Land Snails. 1891, 19—The Land 
Molluscan Fauna of British New 
Guinea. 1891, 67; Anatomical Supple- 
ment. 1891, 685; Second Supplement. 
1894, 384—-Observations on the Charo- 
pidae. Part i. 1892, 157—On the Genus 
Perrieria. 1892, 311—The Range of 
Placostylus; a Study in Ancient 
Geography. 1892, 335—Schizoglossa; 
a new Genus of Carnivorous Snails. 
1892, 3887—On Parmacochlea fischeri, 
Smith (Title). 1892, 410—Description 
of Caecum amputatum, an undescribed 
Molluse from Sydney Harbour. 18938, 
504—On the Australasian Gundlachia. 
1893, 505—Description of Calliostoma 
purpureocinctum, a new Marine Aus- 
tralian Shell. 1894, 35—On some Naked 
Australian Marine Mollusca. Part i. 
1894, 126—Some Conchological Notes. 
1894, 464—Notes on Australian Ship- 
Worms. 1894, 501—Stray Notes on 
Papuan Ethnology. 1895, 613; Part ii. 
1897, 288—Further Notes on Austral- 
asian Shipworms. 1898, 91—Descrip- 
tions of new Mollusca, chiefly from 
New Caledonia. 1898, 97—Contribu- 
tions to a Knowledge of the Fauna of 
British New Guinea. Mollusca. 1898, 
369—Note on Liotia lodderae from 
Balmoral Beach, near Sydney. 1898, 
802—A Zoogeographic scheme for the 
Mid-Pacific. 1899, 391—Description of 
a new Genus Austrosarepta and 
Notes on other Mollusca from New 
South Wales. 1899, 429—Studies on 
Australian Mollusca. Part i. 1900, 
SUS IEEE Thi, 1900, 495; Part iii. 
UGOO, Waals Ieee ih, Udit, 1G leer Ww, 
UOiL, OOS leewric wal, W902, We Ieee wil, 
1902, 596; Part viii. 1904, 182; Part ix. 
ISOH, HAS Jee se, UMS, 44s Ieee Sxl, 
19113, 258; Part xii. 1914, 6953 Part xiii. 
1916, 680; Part xiv, 1923, 301—The 
Effect of the Bassian Isthmus upon the 
existing Marine Fauna: A Study in 
ancient Geography. 1903, 876—The 
Mollusca of the Mast Head Reef, Cap- 
ricorn Group, Queensland. Part i. 
1906, 453; Part ii. 1907, 476—Mollusca 
from the Hope Islands, North Queens- 
land. 1909, 420—Presidential Address, 
30th March, 1910. 1910, 1—Presidential 
Address, 29th March, 1911. 1911, 1— 
On some Land Shells collected in 
Queensland, by Mr. Sidney W. Jackson. 
1912, 253—The Bondi Anticline. 1914, 
316. 


HeEpLEY, C., and A. F. Bassetr Hurtu. The 


Polyplacophora of Lord Howe and 
Norfolk Islands. 1912, 271. 


AN 
INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. cay 


Hepiey, C., and C. T. Musson. Descrip- 
tion of a new Marine Shell. 1891, 247 
—On a Collection of Land and Fresh- 


water Shells from Queensland. 1891, 
Ball. 
Heptey, C., and H. Sutmr. Reference 


List of the Land and Freshwater 
Mollusca of New Zealand. 1892, 618. 
HEDLEY, C., and A. Wittey. Description 
of a new Species of Astralium from 

New Britain. 1896, 107. 

Hextms, R. On the recently observed Evi- 
dences of an extensive Glacier Action 
at Mt. Kosciusko Plateau. 1893, 349— 
Anthropological Notes. 1895, 387—See 
also Davip, HrEtms and PirrM an. 

Henn, A. U., and J. Brazizr. List of 
Mollusca found at Green Point, Wat- 
son’s Bay, Sydney: with a few Re- 
marks upon some of the most interest- 
ing Species, and Descriptions of the 
New Species. 1894, 165. 

Henry, Marcurrite. A Monograph of 
the Freshwater Entomostraca of New 
South Wales. Parti. Cladocera. 1922, 
26; Part ii. Copepoda. 1922, 551; Part 
iii. Ostracoda. 1923, 267; Part iv. Phyl- 
lopoda. 1924, 120—Entomostraca col- 
lected in the vicinity of Auckland, 
New Zealand. 1924, 313—Notes on 
breeding EHEntomostraca from dried 


Mud and their Habits in Aquaria. 
1924, 319—See also FrrGuson and 
HENRY. 


Hiern, W. P. On a new Species and a 
new Variety of Diospyros. 1921, 211. 

Hitt, G. F. Northern Territory Ter- 
Mmitidae. Part i. 1915, 83—Some Notes 
on the Bionomics of the Buffalo-Fly 
(Lyperosia exigua de Meijere). 1916, 
763—Australian Stratiomyidae (Dip- 
tera), with Description of new Species. 
1919, 450—Notes on Some Diptera 
found in Association with Termites. 
1921, 216—Coptotermes raffrayi Was- 
man (Fam. Termitidae). 1921, 263— 
New and Rare Australian Termites, 
with Notes on their Biology. 1921, 433 
—Descriptions and Biology of some 
North Australian Termites. 
—A new Australian Termite. 1922, 275 
—A new Species of Mordellistena (Cole- 
optera, Mordellidae) parasitic on Ter- 
mites. 1922, 346—New Termites from 
Central and South-east Australia. 1923, 
40—See also Ferguson and Hitt. 

Hitt, J. P. Note on an abnormal con- 
nection of the Renal-Portals in a young 
male Frog (Limnodynastes peronii). 
1893, 222—Preliminary Note on a 
Balanoglossus from the Coast of New 
South Wales. 1893, 324—Note on the 
Presence of vestigial Muellerian Ducts 


1922, 142 


see 
bein | L peat oy 
\- A \ ae 4 Doe 
\ pe . : , hs ay 
pruase<O7 45 
SF; / Ke is a 
a 5 oe 


in a full-grown male Lizard (Amphibo- 
lurus muricatus). 1893, 325—A Con- 
tribution to a further Knowledge of the 
Cystic Cestodes. 1894, 49—On a new 
Species of Hnteropneusta trom the 
Coast of New South Wales (Abstract). 
1894, 736—On a new Species of Enter- 
opneusta (Ptychodera australiensis) 
from the Coast of New South Wales. 
1895, 1—On a Fiddler (Trygonorhina 
fasciaia) with abnormal Pectoral Fins. 
1895, 206—Preliminary Note on the 
Occurrence of Placental Connection in 
Perameles obesula; and on the Foetal 
Membranes of certain Macropods. 1895, 
578—Contributions to the Morphology 
and Development of the Female Uro- 
genital Organs in the Marsupialia. i. 
On the Female Urogenital Organs of 
Perameles with an Account of the 
Phenomena of Parturition. 1899, 42; ii- 
v. 1900, 519—See also HAasSweELL and 
Hix. 

Hint, J. P., and C. J. Martin. On a Platy- 
pus Hmbryo from the Intra-uterine Egg 
(Abstract). 1894, 738—On a Platypus 
Embryo from the Intra-uterine Egg. 
1895, 43. 

Hopson, J. 
1879, 243. 

HowcHin, W.—See Davin and HowcuHin. 

Hutu, A. F. Basset. The Birds of Lord 
Howe and Norfolk Islands. 1909, 636— 
Description of a fossil Lorica (Mol- 
lusca: Polyplacophora) from North 
Western Tasmania, 1910, 654—Further 
Notes on the Birds of Lord Howe and 
Norfolk Islands, 1910, 783—On a 
Collection of fossil Polyplacophora 
from North-Western Tasmania, with 
Descriptions of three new Species. 1914, 
855—Presidential Address, 26th March, 
1924. 1924, i—See also Hepiey and 
ISIE, 

Hurton, F. W. On an apparently new 
Species of Penguin from Campbell 
Island. 1878, 334—On a Species of 
Cormorant from Campbell Island. 1879, 
356—Note on  Fossarina  petterdi, 
Brazier. 1882, 66—List of the Fresh- 
water Shells of New Zealand. 1882, 67 
—Revision of the recent Rhipidoglos- 
sate and Docoglossate Mollusca of New 
Zealand. 1884, 354—Revision of the 
recent lLamellibranchiata of New 
Zealand. 1884, 512—Revision of the 
Marine Taenioglossate and Ptenoglos- 
sate Mollusca of New Zealand. 1884, 
932—Revision of the Toxoglossate 
Mollusca of New Zealand. 1885, 115— 
On the supposed Glacial Epoch in Aus- 
tralia. 1885, 334—The Mollusea of the 
Pareora and Oamaru Systems of N.Z. 


Notes on Cypraea guttata. 


16 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


1886, 205—Notes on some Australian 
Tertiary Fossils. 1886, 481—On a Tri- 
lobite from Reefton, New Zealand, new 
to Australasia. 1887, 257—Notes on the 
Mueller Glacier, New Zealand. 1888, 
429—Postseript to Notes on the Mueller 
Glacier, N.Z. 1888, 1259—On the Plio- 
cene Mollusca of New Zealand (Title). 
1892, 327—On Dinornis (7?) queens- 
landiae. 1893, 7—Theoretical Hxplana- 
tions of the Distribution of Southern 
Faunas. 1896, 36—Three new Generic 
Names for Mollusca. 1904, 461. 


IrREDALE, T. An Additional Note on the 
Birds of Lord Howe and Norfolk 
Islands. 1910, 773—Results from Roy 
Bell’s Molluscan collections. 1924, 179. 


JANSON, O. E. Descriptions of two new 
Species of Australian Cetoniidae. 1889, 
127. 

JENKINS, C. On the Geology of Yass Plains. 
Pewee i, iS, 2hle lene, imi, ILSw3, Alo? 
Part iii. 1879, 404. 

JENNINGS, J. Notes on two Papuan 
Throwing Sticks. 1896, 793. 


JENSEN, H. I. The Geology of the Glass 
House Mountains and District. 1903, 842 
—Contributions to a Knowledge of Aus- 
tralian Foraminifera. Part i. 1904, 810 
—Geology of the Volcanic Area of the 
East Moreton and Wide Bay Districts, 
Queensland. 1906, 73—Preliminary 
Note on the Geological History of the 
Warrumbungle Mountains. 1906, 228— 
The Geology of Samoa, and the Erup- 
tions in Savaii. 1906, 641—The Geology 
of the Warrumbungle Mountains. 1907, 
557—-Note on a Glaucophane Schist 
from the Conandale Range, Queensland. 
1907, 701—Chemical Note on a recent 
Lava from Savaii. 1907, 706—The 
Geology of the Nandewar Mountains. 
1907, 842—The Distribution, Origin and 
Relationships of Alkaline Rocks. 1908, 
491—The Alkaline Petrographical Pro- 
vince of Hastern Australia. 1908, 589 
—Notes on the Geology of the Mt. 
Flinders and  Fassifern Districts, 
Queensland. 1909, 67—Notes on some 
recent Work on the Rocks of Samoa. 
1909, 694—The Variable Character of 
Vegetation on Basalt Soils. 1909, 713— 
Some Notes on the Permo-Carboniferous 


and overlying Systems in Central 
Queensland. 1923, 153—See also 
GoppARD and JENSEN; SUSSMILCH and 
JENSEN. 


JOHNSTON, S. J. Contributions to a know- 
ledge of Australian Entozoa. No. i. On 
a new species of Distomum from the 
Platypus. 1901, 334; No. ii. On a new 


Species of Distomum from the Saw- 
fish Shark, Pristiophorus cirratus, Lath. 
1902, 326; No. iii. On some Species of 
Holostomidae from Australian Birds. 
1904, 108—On some Trematode Para- 
sites of Australian Frogs. 1912, 285— 
On some Trematode Parasites of Mar- 
supials and of a Monotreme. 1912, 727 
—On Moreauia mirabilis, gen. et sp. 
nov., a remarkable Trematode parasitic 
in Ornithorhynchus. 1915, 278. 


JOHNSTON, T. H. On some Haemo- 


gregarines from Australian Reptiles. 
1909, 400—The Entozoa of Monotremata 


and Australian Marsupialia. No. i. 
1909, 514; No. ii. 1911, 47—Notes on 
some Parasitic Protozoa. 1909, 501— 


The Haematozoa of Australian Reptilia. 
No. i. 1910, 677; No. ii. 1911, 479—New 
Species of Avian Cestodes. 1911, 58— 
An Australian Caryophyllaeid Cestode. 
1924, 339. 

JoHNSToN, T. H., and G. H. Harpy. A 
Revision of the Australian Diptera be- 
longing to the Genus Sarcophaga. 1923, 
94. 

JOHNSTON, T. H., and L. Harrison. Notes 
on some Mallophagan Generic Names. 
eno ByAle 

JOHNSTON, T. H., and O. W. Tires. Pseu- 
dobonellia, a new Hchiuroid genus 
from the Great Barrier Reef. 1919, 213 
—New Gyrodactyloid Trematodes from 
Australian Fishes, together with a Re- 
classification of the Superfamily Gyro- 
dactyloidea. 1922, 83. 


KALCHBRENNER, C. Definitions of some 
new Australian Fungi. 1882, 104— 
Fungi aliquot Australiae Orientalis. 
1882, 563—New Species of Agaricus dis- 
covered in West Australia. 1882, 638— 
Description of two new Fungi. 1883, 
175. 

Karny, H. H. A remarkable new Gall- 
thrips from Australia. 1922, 266—See 
also VAN LEEUWEN and Karwny. 

Katz, ©. Notes on the Bacteriological 
Hxamination of Water from the Sydney 
Supply. No. i. 1886, 907; No. ii. 1886, 
1205; No. iii. 1887, 151; No. iv. 1887, 
329—On a Remarkable Bacterium 
(Streptococcus) from Wheat-Ensilage. 
1886, 925—On an Improved Method 
of Cultivating Micro-Organisms on 
Potatoes. 1887, 187—Bacteriological 
Observations made at the Little Bay 
Coast Hospital. 1887, 2083—Preliminary 
Remarks on Phosphorescent Bacteria 
from Sea-Water. 1887, 331—General 
Remarks on Protective Inoculation for 
Bovine Pleuro-Pneumonia. 1887, 423— 
On Micro-organisms in Tissues of Dis- 


LAMBERT, 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. i 


eased Horses. 1887, 567—Further RKe- 
marks on Phosphorescent Bacteria. 
1887, 627—Notes on the Bacterio- 
scopical Examination of Ice supplied in 
Sydney. 1888, 256—Note on the Nature 
of the Venom of Australian Snakes. 
1888, 400—Some Experiments with the 
“Cattanach Disinfectant and  Deo- 
dorant’’, as compared with the ordinary 
Carbolic Powder. 1888, 727—Remarks 
on some phosphorescent beef-fat ex- 
hibited by Mr. Whitelegge. 1888, 892— 
Bacteriological Notes: (1) Note on the 
Bacillus of Leprosy. 1889, 325; (2) on 
“Air-gas” for Bacteriological Work. 
1889, 328—Experimental Researches 
with the Microbes of Chicken-Cholera. 
1889, 513. 


Kenyon, Acnes F. On the Occurrence of 


Callosities in Cypraea other than Cy. 
bicallosa and Cy. rhinocerus; and on 
the Occurrence of a Sulcus in Trivia. 
1896, 26—Note on Cypraea caput-anguis, 
Philippi. 1896, 584—Descriptions of 
two new Species of Cypraea from 
Western Australia. 1897, 145. 


KESTEVEN, H. L. The Systematic Position 


of Purpura tritoniformis of Blainville. 
1901, 533—The Protoconchs of certain 
Port Jackson Gasteropoda. 1901, 709— 
A Note on two Species of Astralium 
from Port Jackson. 1902, 2—Notes on 
Prosobranchiata. No. i. Lotorium. 
1902, 443; No. ii. Littorinacea. 1902, 
620; No. iii. The Neanic Shell of Melo 
diadema, Lamk., and the Definition of 
the Nepionic Stage in the Gasteropod 
Molluse. 1903, 448; No. iv. The onto- 
genetic stages 
Gasteropod Protoconch. 1905, 325— 
Notes on various Species of Rissoa 
(Mollusca). 1906, 426—Studies on 
Tunicata. No. i. 1909, 276—The Con- 
stitution of the Gastropod Protoconch: 
its value as a Taxonomic Feature, and 
the Significance of some of its Forms. 
1912, 49—A new Endoparasitic Cope- 
pod: Morphology and Development. 
1912, 673—The Venom of the Fish, 
Notesthes robusta. 1914, 91—The 
Origin of Yolk in the Ova of an Endo- 
parasitic Copepod. 1918, 136. 


KIRCHENPAUER, —. A Record of Localities 


of some New South Wales Zoophytes. 
1884, 534. 


KirKALpy, G. W. Memoir on a few Heter- 
opterous Hemiptera from Eastern Aus- 
tralia. 1907, 768—A Catalogue of the 
Hemiptera of Fiji. 1908, 345. 


Cx [Ae See SHIRLEY and 
LAMBERT. 


B 


represented by the - 


Lawson, A. ANSTRUTHER. The Life- 


history of Microcachrys  tetragona 
(Hook.). 1923, 177—The Life-history 
of Pherosphaera. 1923, 499. 


Lea, A. M. Descriptions of new Species 


of Bostrychidae. 1893, 317. Descrip- 
tions of new Species of Australian 
Coleoptera. 1894, 589; Part ii. 1895, 
224: Part ili. 1896, 284; Part iv. 1897, 
584: Part’v. 1898, 521; Part vi. 1901, 
481; Part vii. 1904, 60; Part viii. 1906, 
195; Part ix. 1911, 426; Part x. 1914, 
650; Part xi. 1915, 490; Part xii, 1916, 
720; Part xiii. 1917, 545; Part xiv. 1918, 
Tally Part exave OG eai(3 bin aia xavslenl 9) 2.05 
Bias Ieeietey sali, WOR, els lee sayaln, 
1925, 414—Revision of the Australian 
Curculionidae belonging to the Sub- 
family Oryptorhynchides. Part i. 1897, 
449; Part ii. 1898, 178; Part iii. 1899, 
200; Part iv. 1899, 522; Part v. 1902, 
408; Part vi. 1903, 643; Part vii. 1905, 
235; Part viii. 1907, 400; Part ix. 1908, 
(Oils IPavee xe, MOOG, HORe Teeyet xy ae, 
602; Part xii. 1913, 451—Descriptions 
of two new blind Weevils from 
Western Australia and Tasmania. 
1900, 391—Notes to accompany Figures 
of Boisduval’s Types of six Species of 
Australian Curculionidae, based upon 
Observations and Sketches by M. P. 
Lesne. 1900, 537—Descriptions of new 
Species of Lomatera (Coleoptera: 
Searabaeidae, Subfamily Cetonides). 
1906, 561—Australian and Tasmanian 
Pselaphidae (Coleoptera). 1910, 691— 
On Australian Anthicidae (Coleoptera). 
1922, 471—On some Australian Galeru- 
cides (Coleoptera, Chrysomelidae) . 
1923, 519—On some Australian Scara- 
baeidae (Coleoptera). 1924, 283. 


LENDENFELD, R. von. A Monograph of the 


Australian Sponges. Part i. 1884, 121; 
Part ii. 1884, 310; Part iii. 1884, 1083; 
Part iv. 1885, 3; Part v. 1885, 282; 
Part vi. 1885, 481—The Scyphome- 
dusae of the Southern Hemisphere. 
Part i. Introduction. 1884, 155; Part 
li. 1884, 242; Part iii. 1884, 259—The 
Australian Hydromedusae. Part i. 
1884, 206; Part ii. 1884, 345; Part iii. 
1884, 401; Part iv. 1884, 467; Part v. 
1884, 581—On the Preservation of 
tender Marine Animals. 1884, 256— 
Note on the Development of the 
Versuridae. 1884, 307—The Geo- 
graphical Distribution of the Aus- 
tralian Scyphomedusae. 1884, 421— 
The Digestion of Sponges effected by 
Ectoderm or Entoderm? 1884, 434— 
The EHruption in the Straits’ Settle- 
ments and the Hvening Glow. 1884, 
439—On the Occurrence of Flesh- 


18 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


Spicules in Sponges. 1884, 493—Note Lower, O. B. Descriptions of new 


on the Slimy Coatings of certain Species of Australian Lepidoptera, with 
Boltenias in Port Jackson. 1884, 495— Notes on Synonymy. 1897, 10—New 
Muscular Tissues in Hydroid Polypes. « Australian Lepidoptera. 1897, 263— 
1884, 635—Notes on the Fibres of cer- New Australian Lepidoptera: with a 
tain Australian Hircinidae. 1884, 641 Note on Deilephila livornica Hsp. 1898, 
—Note on the Eyes of Deep-Sea Fishes. 42—Descriptions of new Australian 
1884, 699—The Time of the Glacial Lepidoptera. 1899, 83; 1900, 29; 1900, 
Period in New Zealand. 1884, 806— 403; 1901, 639; 1915, 474. 

The Homocoela hitherto described Lucas, A. H. 8. On the Formation of a 
from Australia, and the new Family Mackerel Sky. 1894, 551—Contribu- 
Homodermidae. 1884, 896—Addenda to tions to a Knowledge of the Fauna of 
the Australian Hydromedusae. No. i. British New Guinea. Lacertilia and 
1884, 908; No. ii. 1884, 984; No. iii. Batrachia. 1898, 357—Presidential 
1885, 477; No. iv. 1885, 679—Local Address, 25th March, 1908. 1908, 1— 
Colour varieties of Scyphomedusae. Presidential Address, 31st March, 1909. 
1884, 925—The Metamorphosis of 1309) sl Lhe Gasess present ys inmschie 
Bolina Chuni, n. sp. 1884, 929—Notes Floats (Vesicles) of certain Marine 
on a Beroid of Port Jackson. 1884, 968 Algae. 1911, 626—Supplementary List 
—The Histology and Nervous System of the Marine Algae of Australia. 1912, 
of the Calcareous Sponges. 1884, 977— 157—Notes on Australian Marine Algae. 
Note on the Flight of Insects. 1884, i. 1913, 49; ii. Description of Four new 
986—The Method of Section-cutting Species. 1919, 174—Notes from the 
with some Improvements. 1885. 23— Botanic Gardens, Sydney: Partheno- 
Amoeba parasitica: a new Protozoan genesis in Aquatic Phanerogams. 1916, 
infesting Sheep. 1885, 35—Meteorology 417—An Effilorescence on some New 


of Mount Kosciusko. 1885, 39—The Zealand Kelps. 1916, 676. 
Glacial Period in Australia. 1885, 44 Lucas, A. H. S., and C. Frost. Descrip- 


—On Flight. 1885, 73—The Phorio- tions of a new Species of Ablepharus 
spongiae Marshall. 1885, 81—Notes to from Victoria: with Critical Notes on 
the Australian Sponges recently de- two other Australian Lizards. 1896, 
scribed by Carter. 1885, 151—Note on 281—See also Frost and Lucas. 

a Medusa from the Tropical Pacific. [wucas, T. P. Contribution to a Know- 
1885, 241—Remarks on the Discovery ledge of the Genus Iodis. 1888, 1263— 
of Sensitive and Ganglia Cells in Description of a new Species of Jodis, 
Horny Sponges. 1885, 246-(On a with Remarks on Pielus imperialis, 
Sponge destructive to Oyster Culture Olliff. 1889, 6083—On Queensland and 
in the Clarence River. 1885, 326—) other Australian Macro-Lepidoptera, 


Note on the Glacial Period in Aus- with 


tralia. 1885, 330—Addendum to the new Species. 1889, 1065—Undescribed 
Monograph of Australian Sponges. Australian Lepidoptera from Brisbane, 
1885, 475—Studies on Sponges: i. The Queensland (Title). 1890, 282—On 


Wesoloule Or Denarella Cuwermesa | tb Queensland and other Lepidoptera, with 
Raphyrus Hixonii. A new Gigantic Descriptions of new Species (Title). 


Localities, and Descriptions of 


Sponge from Port Jackson; ili. Halme 1890, 500—On Queensland and other 
tingens. A Sponge with remarkable Australian Lepidoptera, with Descrip- 
Colouring Power; iv. Two cases of tions of new Species. 1891, 277—On 
Mimicry in Sponges. 1885, 557— twenty new Species of Australian 
Recent Changes in the Forest Flora of Lepidoptera. 1892, 249—Descriptions 
the Interior of New South Wales. 1885, of new Australian Lepidoptera, with 
721—The Australian Fresh-water Rhi- additional Localities for known Species. 
zopoda. Part i, 1885, 723—An Alga 18938, 133—New Species of Queensland 
forming a Pseudomorph of a Siliceous Lepidoptera. 1902, 246. 


Sponge. 1885, 726—Preliminary Report 
on the Histological Structure of the Mackay, W. J. See McKay, W. J. S. 
Dorsal Papillae of certain Species of Mackerras, I. M. The Nemestrinidae 


Onchidium. 1885, 730—Second Adden- Sake CE Wn ACSIA ER Ie Eon, 

ea i Ge uaa of Australian i ackmrras, I. M, and M. J. Mackerras. 

ponsges. , : The Haematozoa of Australian Marine 
L’EstrancE, W. W., and R. Greic-SMITH. Teleostei. 1925, 359. 


The “Springing” of Tins of Preserved Maocxerras, M. J. See Mackrrras and 
Fruit. 1918, 409. MACKERRAS. 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 19 


Maczuay, N. pE Mrx~touHo. Proposed Zoo- 


logical Station for Sydney. 1878, 144 
—On Macrodontism. 1878, 169—The 
Proposed Zoological Station at Sydney. 
1879, 103—A short Résumé of the 
Results of Anthropological and Ana- 
tomical Researches in Melanesia and 
Australia. 1881, 171—A Solution for 
preserving large Vertebrata for Ana- 
tomical Hxamination. 1881, 576— 
Temperature of the Rock in the Mag- 
dala Shaft, Victoria. 1881, 579—On the 
Practice of Ovariotomy by the Natives 
of the Herbert River, Queensland. 1881, 
622—Remarks about the Circumvolu- 
tions of the Cerebrum of Canis dingo. 
1881, 624—-Cranial Deformation of New- 
born Children at the Island Mabiak, 
and other islands of Torres Straits, and 
of Women of the S.E. Peninsula of 
New Guinea. 1881, 627—Remarks on 
the Skull of an Australian Aboriginal 
from the Lachlan district. 1883, 395 
—On a very Dolichocephalic Skull of 
an Australian Aboriginal. 1883, 401 
—Temperature of the Body of Echidna 
hystriz, Cuyv. 18838, 425—The “Baro- 
metro Araucano’ from the Chiloe 
Islands. 1883, 462—On a new Species 
of Kangaroo (Dorcopsis chalmersii) 
from the South-east end of New 
Guinea. 1884, 569—On a complete 
Debouchement of the Sulcus Rolando 
into the Fissura Sylvii in some brains 
of Australian Aboriginals. 1884, 578 
—Notes on the Zoology of the Maclay- 
Coast in New Guinea. (1) On a new 
Sub-genus Peramelidae: Brachymelis. 
1884, 713; (2) On a new Species of 
Macropus (M. tibol). 1885, 141—Note 
about the Temperature of the Sea-water 
along the Hastern Coast of Australia, 
observed in July, 1878 and 1883. 1884, 
887—On two new Species of Macropus 
from the South Coast of New Guinea. 
1884, 890—On Volcanic Activity on the 
Islands near the North Hast Coast of 
New Guinea, and Evidence of the 
rising of the Maclay-Coast in New 
Guinea. 1884, 963—Notes on _ the 
direction of the Hair on the Back of 
some Kangaroos. 1884, 1151—On the 
Temperature of the Body of Ornithor- 
hynchus paradozus, Bl. 1884, 1204— 
On two new Species of Dorcopsis from 
the South Coast of New Guinea. 1885, 
145—Note on the Brain of Halicore 
australis, Owen. 1885, 193—Remarks 
on the low  Blood-temperature of 
Echidna histriz. 1885, 248—List of 
Plants in use by the Natives of the 
Maclay-Coast, New Guinea. 1885, 346— 
A Second Note on “Macrodontism” of 


Mactay, N. DE 


the Melanesians. 1885, 682—Note on 
the “Kéu”’ of the Maclay-Coast, New 
Guinea. 1885, 687. 


MikLouHoO, and W. 
Macteay. Plagiostomata of the Pacific. 
Rania lSiise o0Gseantiiemeli ooo +20) 
Parton sl Soosm amor 


Mactreay, W. Notes on a new Species of 


Dendrophis from Cleveland Bay. 1875- 
76, 15—Notes on the Zoological Collec- 
tions made in Torres Straits and New 
Guinea during the Cruise of the 
“Chevert’”’, 1875-76, 36—Presidential 
Address, 31st January, 1876. 1875-76, 
88—The Coleoptera of the “Chevert”’ 
Expedition. 1875-76, 164—Notes on the 
Entomology of New Ireland. 1875-76, 
301i—Presidential Address, 22nd Janu- 
ary, 1877. 1875-76, 396—The Ophidians 
of the “Chevert’ Expedition. 1877, 33 
—The Lizards of the “Chevert” Expe- 
Giimcin, IS, GOP IEEE tn, Ist, Yo 
Note on Monacanthus Cheverti. 1877, 
69—The Batrachians of the “Chevert’ 
Expedition. 1877, 135—On some new 
Carabidae from Port Darwin. 1877, 213 
—Notes on a Collection of Snakes from 
Port Darwin. 1877, 219—The Fishes of 
Port Darwin. 1877, 344—Note on a 
Species of Therapon found in a dam 
near Warialda. 1878, 15—Descriptions 
of some new Fishes from Port Jackson, 
and King George’s Sound. 1878, 33— 
On a new Species of Hoplocephalus 
from Sutton Forest. 1878, 52—On the 
Power of Locomotion in the Tunicata. 
1878, 54—On a Species of Amphisile 
from the Palau Islands. 1878, 165— 
Notes on some Fishes from the Solomon 
Islands. 1879, 60—On the Clupeidae of 
Australia. 1879, 363—On the Mugili- 
dae of Australia. 1879, 410—Note on 
three rare Sharks found in Port Jack- 
son. 1879; 458—Note on Scomber 
antarcticus. 1879, 463—Description of a 
new Species of Galaxias from Mount 
Wilson, with Remarks on the Distribu- 
tion of the Genus. 1880, 45—On two 
hitherto undescribed Fishes well known 
in the Sydney Market. 1880, 48— 
Descriptive Catalogue of the Fishes of 
Australia. Part i. 1880, 302; Part ii. 
USO, MlOs Weve mii, wil, Ws Ieewer iy, 
1881, 202—On a Species of the Phas- 
matidae destructive to Hucalypti. 1881, 
536—Description of two new species of 
Snakes. 1881, 811—Notes on the Pleuro- 
nectidae of Port Jackson, with descrip- 
tions of two hitherto unobserved Species. 
1882, 11—The Fishes of the Palmer 
River, North Queensland. 1882, 69—On 
a Species of Galaxias found in the Aus- 
tralian Alps. 1882, 106—Note on a 


20 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


reputed Poisonous Fly of New Cale- 
donia. 1882, 202—Contribution to a 
Knowledge of the Fishes of New 
Guinea. No. i. 1882, 224; No. ii. 1882, 
351; No. iii. 1882, 585—Observations on 
an Insect injurious to the Vine. 1882, 
344—Description of two Fishes lately 
taken in or near Port Jackson. 1882, 
366—On a new and remarkable Fish of 
the Family Mugilidae from the Interior 
of New Guinea. 1883, 2—Notes on a 
Collection of Fishes from the Burdekin 
and Mary Rivers, Queensland. 1883, 
199—Contribution to a knowledge of 
the Fishes of New Guinea. No. 4. 1883, 
252—Notices of some undescribed 
Species of Coleoptera in the Brisbane 
Museum. 1883, 409—Notes on some 
Reptiles from the Herbert’ River, 
Queensland. 1883, 432—On a new 
Genus of Fishes from Port Jackson. 
1883, 439—Some Results of Trawl 
Fishing outside Port Jackson. 1883, 
457—Supplement to the Descriptive 
Catalogue of the Fishes of Australia. 
1884, 2—Notices of new Fishes. 1884, 
170—Census of Australian Snakes, with 
descriptions of two new Species. 1884, 
548—The Insects of the Maclay-Coast, 
New Guinea. 1884, 700—On a new 
Snake from the Barrier Ranges. 1885, 
61—On some Reptilia lately received 
from the Herbert River District, 
Queensland. 1885, 64—Revision of the 
Genus Lamprima of Latreille, with 
Descriptions of new Species. 1885, 129 
—Two new Australian Lucanidae. 
1885, 199—New Fishes from the Upper 
Murrumbidgee. 1885, 267—A new 
Genus of the Sub-family Lamprimides 
of Lacordaire. 1885, 473—A remark- 
able Fish from Lord Howe Island. 
1885, 718—The Insects of the Fly River, 
New Guinea—Coleoptera. 1886, 136; 
1886, 183—Miscellanea Entomologica. 
No. i. The Genus Diphucephala. 1886, 
381; No. ii. The genus Liparetrus. 1886, 
807; No. iii. The Scaritidae of New 
Hollands alls siae db eNOl sive le cihe 
Helaeides. 1887, 513; No. v. The 
Helaeides. 1887, 635—Note on Ctenodar 
Wilkinsoni, Macl. 1886, 511—Descrip- 
tion of a new Species of Hoplocephatlus. 
1886, 1111—The Insects of the Cairns 
District, Northern Queensland. Part i. 
1887, 213; Part ii. 1887, 307—On a new 
Hoplocephalus from the Gulf of Car- 
pentaria. 1887, 403—Notes on some 
Scaritidae from Queensland, with 
Descriptions of two new Species. 1887, 
972—Notes on Mr. Froggatt’s Collec- 
tions made during the year 1887, in 
the Vicinity of Derby, King’s Sound, 


MACPHERSON, J. 


Mawen, J. H. 


North-West Australia. 1887, 1017— 
Notes on some Ophidians from King’s 
Sound, North-West Australia. 1888, 
416—The Insects of King’s Sound and 
its Vicinity. Parti. 1888, 448; Part ii. 
The Lamellicornes. 1888, 897; Part iii. 
The Sternoxes. 1888, 1227—See also 
ALLEYNE and Macieay; Macrtay and 
MACLEAY. 


Ngarrabul and other 
Aboriginal Tribes. Part i. Medical 
and Surgical Practice. 1902, 637; Part 
ii. Distribution of the Tribes. 1904, 
Grinds 

Notes on some Indigen- 
ous Sago and Tobacco from New 
Guinea. 1887, 457—Some Reputed 
Medicinal Plants of New South Wales. 
(Indigenous Species only.) 1888, 355— 
Australian Indigenous Plants providing 
Human Foods and Food-adjuncts. 1888, 
481—Notes on the Geographical Distri- 
bution of some New South Wales 
Plants. 1889, 107—The Examination of 
Kinos as an Aid in the Diagnosis of 
Eucalypts. Part i. The Ruby Group. 
1889, 605; Part ii. The Gummy Group. 
1889, 1277; Part iii. The Turbid Group. 
1891, 389—Spinifex Resin. 1889, 639 
—On Cedar Gum (Cedrela australis 
F.v.M.). 1889, 1047—Notes on Aus- 
tralian Economic Botany. No. i. 1890, 
273; No. ii. 1891, 133—On Grass-tree 
Gum. 1890, 429—On the Occurrence of 
a Gum in Echinocarpus (Sloanea) aus- 
tralis, Benth. 1891, 140—Angophora 
Kino. 1891, 253—On two undescribed 
HExudations from the Leguminosae. 
1891, 679—On Panax Gum. 1892, 35 
—Notes on Plants collected on a Trip 
to the Don Dorrigo Forest Reserve 
(Title). 1894, 463—A Giant Acacia 
from the Brunswick River. 1895, 337— 
Notes on a Trip to Mount Seaview, 
Upper Hastings River. 1898, 20— 
Observations on the Vegetation of Lord 
Howe Island. 1898, 112—Some further 
Observations on the vegetation of Lord 
Howe Island. 1899, 381—A new variety 
of Dendrobium undulatum from the 
Solomon Islands. 1899, 652—Descrip- 
tion of a new Species of Acacia. 1901, 
12—On one of the so-called Honey- 
suckles of Lord Howe Island. 1901, 
156—On Eucalyptus pulverulenta, Sims. 
1901, 547—On Hucalyptus Stuartiana, 
F.v.M. 1901, 556—On JHucalyptus 
Gunnii, Hook. f. 1901, 561—Presi- 
dential Address, 26th March, 1902. 1901, 
740—On Eucalyptus Baueriana, 
Schauer. 1902, 214—On Eucalyptus 
calycogona, Turez. 1902, 220—On a 
new Cryptocarya from Lord Howe 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 21 


Island, together with Notes on other 
Plants from that Island. 1902, 347— 
On Lucalyptus bicolor, A. Cunn. 1902, 
516—On Eucalyptus polyanthemos, 
Schauer. 1902, 527—Presidential Ad- 
dress, 25th March, 1903. 1902, 683— 
The Flora of Norfolk Island. Part i. 
1903, 692—The Variability of Hucalyp- 
tus under Cultivation. Part i. 1903, 
887—On four new Species of Hucalyp- 
tus. 1904, 469—The Botany of Funa- 
futi, Ellice Group. 1904, 589—Miscel- 
laneous Notes (chiefly Taxonomic) on 
Eucalyptus. i. 1904, 751; ii. 1905, 502 
—On a new Species of Hucalyptus from 
Northern New South Wales. 1905, 336 
—Further “Notes on Hybridisation in 
the Genus Hucalyptus. 1905, 492—The 
Botany of Howell (Bora Creek): A Tin- 
Granite Flora. 1906, 63—Further Notes 
on the Botany of Lord Howe Island 
(Fifth Paper). 1914, 377—On Brachy- 
chiton populneo-acerifolius, F.v.M., the 
Crimson-flowered Kurrajong. 1916, 180 
—On a HKucalypt Hybrid (£. calophylila 
x E. ficifolia). 1916, 185—Notes on the 
Colouration of the Young Foliage of 
Hucalyptus. 1919, 761—A Few Notes 
on the Botany of Lord Howe Island 
(Sixth Paper). 1920, 564—See also 
DEANE and MAmEn. 


Mammen, J. H., and R. T. Baker. Botan- 
ical Notes from the Technological 
Museum, Sydney. No. i. 1893, 309; No. 
ii. 1894, 456; No. iii. 1894, 722; No. iv. 
1895, 512—Description of a new Species 
of Acacia. 1893, 515—Description of a 
new Croton from New South Wales. 
1894, 160—Description of an apparently 
new Acacia from New South Wales. 


1894, 163—Description of a new 
Species of Acacia from New South 
Wales. 1895, 385—On a new Species 


of Hlaeocarpus from Northern New 
South Wales. 1895, 469—Descriptions 
of some new Species of Plants from 


New South Wales. 1895, 582. 
Mamen, J. H., and EH. Betcue. On a 
new Species of Macadamia, together 


with Notes on two Plants new to the 
Colony. 1896, 624—-Notes from the 
Botanic Gardens, Sydney No. 1. 1897, 
446; No. 2. 1898, 11: No. 3. 1898, 772: 
No. 4. 1899, 148; No. 5. 1899, 640; No. 


@, 1900, Oils INO; 7 wd, 7s Wo; 8. 
1902, 55; No. 9. 1903, 904; No. 10. 
OA ed eNO} dt. 1905, 35455 No: 12! 
HOG ial No: 13. 1908) 304; No. a4: 


1909, 357; No. 15. On a Plant, in Fruit, 
doubtfully referred to Cymodocea. 1909, 
5855; No. 16: 1910, 788: No. 17. 1912, 
244; No. 18. 1913, 242—Descriptions of 
three new Species of Australian Plants. 


1897, 150—Descriptions of four new 
Species of New South Wales Plants. 
1898, 15—Notes on Sterculia (Brachy- 
chiton) laurida and discolor. 1898, 159 
—A Review of the New South Wales 
Species of Halorrhagaceae as described 
in Prof. A. K. Schindler’s Monograph 
(1905); with the Description of a new 


Species. 1906, 393. 

Maren, J. H., and R. H. Campacr. Notes 
on the EHucalypts of the Blue 
Mountains. 1905, 190. 

Maen, J. H., and J. H. CAmrretp. Notes 


on some Port Jackson Plants. 1898, 264. 
MatiocH, J. R. Notes on Australian Dip- 


tera, with descriptions. 1923, 601; No. 
li. 1924, 138; No. iii. 1924, 329; No. iv. 
IGReE BYESo IN@, 1 IBADs, B42 IN@, iWil 
1925, 80; No. vii. 11925, 311. 


Martin, C. J. Observations on the poison- 
ous Constituents of the Venom of the 
Australian Black Snake (Pseudechis 
porphyriacus). 1892, 319—See also 
Hint and Martin; WiLson and MARTIN. 


Martin, C. J., and F. TipSweLu. Observa- 
tions on the Femoral Gland of Orni- 
thorhynchus and its Secretion; together 
with an experimental Inquiry concern- 
ing its supposed toxic Action. 1894, 
471. 

MASKELL, W. M. On a new Australian 
Coccid. 1890, 280—On a new Species 
of Coecid on Fern-roots. 1893, 225. 

Masters, G. Zoology of the “Chevert’’. 
Ornithology. Part i. 1875-76, 44—On 
Bruchigavia longirostris, a new Species 
of Gull, from King George’s Sound. 
1877, 113—Notes on a collection of 
Birds from Port Darwin. 1877, 269— 
Catalogue of the Described Coleoptera 
of Australia. Part i. Cicindelidae and 
Carabidae. 1885, 359; Part ii. Dysti- 
cidae-Heteroceridae. 1885, 583; Part iii. 
Lucanidae and Scarabaeidae. 1886, 21; 
Part iv. Trixagidae-Oedemeridae. 1886, 
259; Part v. Curculionidae. 1886, 585; 
Part vi. Scolytidae-Cerambycidae. 1886, 
979; Part vii. Chrysomelidae-Corylo- 
phidae. 1887, 13; Supplement Part i. 
Cicindelidae and Carabidae (Title 
only. Issued separately as a Supple- 
ment to Vol. x, Part 3). 1895, 468; 
Supplement Part ii (Title only. Issued 
separately as a Supplement to the Pro- 
ceedings, 1896, Part 1). 1896, 25— 
Catalogue of the known Coleoptera of 
New Guinea, including the Islands of 
New Ireland, New Britain, Duke of 
York, Aru, Mysol, Waigiou, Salwatty, 
Key and Jobie. Part i. 1888, 271; Part 
ii. 1888, 925. 

MatHEw, G. F. Rough Notes on the 
Natural History of the Claremont 


22 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


Islands. 1885, 251—An Afternoon 
among the Butterflies of Thursday 
Island. 1885, 259. 

Mawson, D. The Geology of the New 
Hebrides. 1905, 400—The Minerals and 
Genesis of the Veins and Schlieren 
traversing the Aegirine-Syenite in the 
Bowral Quarries. 1906, 579. 

May, W. L. See Tatre and May. 


McALpPIngE, D. Meliola amphitricha Fries. 
1895, 439—Notes on Uromyces 
amygdali Cooke: a Synonym of Puc- 
cinia pruni Pers. (Prune Rust). 1895, 
440—Puccinia on Groundsel, with Tri- 
morphic Teleutospores. 1895, 461— 
Descriptions of New Australian Fungi 
No. i. 1896, 104—The Sooty Mould of 
Citrus Trees: a study in Polymorphism. 
1896, 469—Two Additions to the Fungi 
of New South Wales. 1896, 722—New 
South Wales Fungi. 1897, 36; 1897, 
698S—A new Myxomycete for New 
South Wales. 1898, 82—Fungi from 
Kerguelen Island. 1899, 117—Three 
Additions to the Fungi of New South 
Wales. 1899, 125—On a Micro-fungus 
from Mount Kosciusko, and on the first 
Record of Uncinula in Australia. 1899, 
301—Phosphorescent Fungi in Aus- 
tralia. 1900, 548—On the Australian 
Fairy-ring Puff-ball (Lycoperdon fur- 
furaceum, Schaeff.). 1900, 702—The 
“Shot-hole’” Fungi of Stone-fruit Trees 
in Australia. 1901, 221—Australian 
Fungi, new or unrecorded, Decades i-ii. 
1902, 373; Decades iii-iv. 1903, 94; 
Decades v-vi. 19038, 553; Decades vii- 
viii. 1904, 117—A new Smut in a new 
Genus of Grass. 1911, 45—The Fibro- 
vascular System of the Apple (Pome), 
and its Functions. 1911, 613—The 
Fibro-vascular System of the Pear 
(Pome). UG)LaL, 656—The Fibro- 
vascular System of the Quince Fruit 
compared with that of the Apple and 
Pear. 1912, 689. 

McCoory, H. J. Notes on the Method 
adopted by the Female of the common 
Freshwater Tortoise, Chelodina longi- 
collis, in the Excavation of the Burrows 
in which her Eggs are to be deposited. 
1887, 107. 


McCunitocH, A. R. <A Description and 
Figures of three Specimens of Mola- 
canthus from the Central Pacific Ocean. 
1912, 553—Notes on, and Descriptions 
of Australian Fishes. 1915, 259; No. 2. 
1921, 457—See also GRANT and 
McCunLiocnH. 


McKay, W. J. See McKay, W. J. S. 
McKay, W. J. S. The Inter-Coxal Lobe 


of Certain Crayfishes. 1887, 967—The 
Development and Structure of the 


Pineal Hye in Hinulia and Grammato- 
phora. 1888, 876—The Osteology and 
Myology of the Death Adder (Acan- 
thophis antarctica). 1889, 893—The 
Morphology of the Muscles of the 
Shoulder-girdle in Monotremes. 1894, 
263—See also Winson and McKay. 


McLucxkiz, J. Studies in Symbiosis. i. 


The Mycorhiza of Dipodium punctatum 
R.Br. 1922, 293; ii. The Apogeotropic 
Roots of Macrozamia spiralis and their 
Physiological Significance. 1922, 319; 
iii. Contribution to the Morphology and 
Physiology of the Root-nodules of Podo- 
carpus spinulosa and P. elata. 1923, 82; 
iv. The Root-nodules of Casuarina 
Cunninghamiana and their Physio- 
logical Significance. 1923; 194; v. A 
contribution to the physiology of 
Gastrodia sesamoides (R.Br.). 1923, 
436—A Contribution to the Parasitism 
of Notothixos incanus (Oliv.) var. sub- 
aureus. 1922, 571—Studies in Parasit- 
ism: a Contribution to the Physiology 
of the genus Cassytha. 1924, 55—See 
also BroucH, McLuckir and PETRIE. 


Merritt, HE. D. The Identity of Polypo- 


dium spinulosum Burm. f. 1919, 353. 


Meyrick, EH. On a Micro-Lepidopterous 


Insect destructive to the Potato. 1879, 
112—Descriptions of Australian Micro- 
Lepidoptera. No. i. Crambites. 1878, 
175; No. ii. Crambites (continued). 
1879, 205; No. iii. Tineina. 1880, 132; 
No. iv. Tineina (continued). 1880, 204; 
No. v. Tortricina. 1881, 410; No. vi. 
Tortricina (continued). 1881, 629; No. 
vii. Revisional. 1882, 148; No. viii. 
Oecophoridae. WS, Gls INI@, IDS, 
Oecophoridae (continued). 1883, 320; 
No. x. Oecophoridae (continued). 1883, 
469; No. xi. Oecophoridae (continued). 
1884, 721; No. xii. Oecophoridae (con- 
tinued). 1884, 1045; No. xiii. QOeco- 
phoridae (continued). 1885, 765; No. 
xiv. Oecophoridae (continued). 1887, 
929; No. xv. Oecophoridae (continued). 
1888, 1565; No. xvi. Tineidae. 1892, 
477; No. xvii. Elachistidae. 1897, 297; 
No. xviii. Gelechiadae. 1904, 255; Part 
xix. Plutellidae. 1907, 47—On some 
Lepidoptera from the Fly River. 1886, 
241—Revision of Australian Lepidop- 
(Kereel, IEEWeG i, IK, Os7es Ieee wl, IK, 
SAWS ence iin, ISS), walls Ieee my, ILSK0), 
(9s Part ve) soi d>8i——Notes)) on 
Synonymy of Australian Micro-Lepidop- 
tera. 1886, 803—Descriptions of new 
Lepidoptera. 1886, 1037—Descriptions 
of new Australian Rhopalocera. 1887, 
827—Descriptions of additional Aus- 
tralian Pyralidina. 1889, 1105—Re- 
vision of Australian Tortricina. 1910, 
139;> 1911, 224. 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 23 


Mitiineron, J. A. M. Report on a small 


Zoological Collection from Norfolk 
Island, i. Introductory Remarks, 1887, 
989. 


Miskin, W. H. Descriptions of hitherto 


undescribed Australian Lepidoptera 
(Rhopalocera). 1888, 1514—Note on 
Danais chrysippus, L., and D. petilia, 
Stoll. 1889, 119—A Revision of the 
Australian Species of Hwuploea, with 
Synonymic Notes, and Descriptions of 
new Species. 1889, 1037—A Revision 
of the Australian Genus Ogyris, with 
Description of a new Species. 1890, 23 
—Descriptions of hitherto undescribed 
Australian Lepidoptera (Rhopalocera) 
principally Lycaenidae. 1890, 29—Note 
on Danais petilia, Stoll. 1890, 142— 
On Species-making (Title). 1890, 302. 


MitrcHett, J. Notes on the Geology of 


Bowning, N.S.W. 1886, 1193—On some 
new Trilobites from Bowning, N.S.W. 
1887, 435—On a new Trilobite from 
Bowning. 1888, 397—Note on the occur- 
rence of certain Fossils in previously 
unrecorded Localities in N.S.W., with 
Remarks on the Correlation of certain 
Beds in the Newcastle and Illawarra 
Districts. 1892, 345—Note on the Fruc- 
tification of Glossopteris. 1892, 377— 
On the Occurrence of the Genus 
Palaechinus in the Upper Silurian 
Rocks of New South Wales. 1897, 258 
—The Carboniferous Trilobites of Aus- 
tralia. 1918, 437—On two new Tri- 
lobites from Bowning. 1919, 441— 
Some additional Trilobites from New 
South Wales. 1919, 850—Some new 
Brachiopods from the Middle Palaeozoic 
Rocks of New South Wales. 1920, 543 
—A new Gasteropod (fam. Huomphal- 
idae) from the Lower Marine Series of 
New South Wales. 1922, 278—Descrip- 
tions of two new Trilobites and Note 
on Griffithides convexicaudatus Mit- 
chell. 1922, 535—The Strophomenidae 
from the Fossiliferous Beds of Bown- 
ing, N.S.W. Part i. Stropheodonta. 
1923, 465—New trilobites from Bown- 
ing, with notes on EHncrinurus and 
Cordania. 1924, 46—Hleven new species 
of Aviculopecten from Carboniferous 
Rocks, Myall Lakes, N.S.W. 1924, 468 
—A further reference to the occurrence 
of Merista plebeia Sowerby in New 
South Wales. 1924, 499—A preliminary 
reference to a new _ species of 
Hlonichthys from the Lower Beds of 
the Newcastle Coal Measures. 1924, 
503—Descriptions of New Species of 
Leaia. 1925, 488—See also HrTHERIDGE 
and MrrcHeEett. 


MircHett, J., and W. S. Duwun. The 


Atrypidae of New South Wales, with 


references to those recorded from other 
States of Australia. 1920, 266. 

Mirren, W. Record of new Localities of 
Polynesian Mosses, with Descriptions 
of some hitherto undefined Species. 
1882, 98. 

MoELLENDOREF, O. F. von. On the sup- 
posed New Zealand Species of Lepto- 
poma. 1892, 385. 

MortENSEN, T. Preliminary Note on the 
remarkable, shortened Development of 
an Australian Sea-Urchin, Toxocidaris 
erythrogrammus. 1915, 203. 

Morton, A. Notes on a Cruise to the 
Solomon Islands. 1882, 59. 


Mosretry, A. H., and H. G. CHAPMAN. 
Contribution to our Knowledge of the 
Action of Rennin. 1906, 568. 


MUELLER, F. von. Notes on Plants col- 
lected by Mr. Hdw. Reader in the 
vicinity of Mount Dromedary. 1880, 
286—Two new Species of Plants from 
New South Wales. 1881, 791—Far 
Southern Localities for various Plants 
in New South Wales recorded from Mr. 
W. Bauerlen’s Collections. 1883, 467— 
Notes on Hybridism in the Genus 
Brachychiton. 1884, 379—Record of an 
undescribed Correa of New South 
Wales. 1884, 960—Record of a remark- 
able Haloragis from New South Wales. 
1885, 197—Some hitherto undescribed 
Plants of New South Wales. 1886, 1105 
—Descriptive Record of two Plants 
additional to the Flora of Australia, 
and occurring also in New South Wales. 
1887, 191—Report on a small Collection 
of Plants from the Aird River, obtained 
by Mr. Theodore Bevan during his 
recent Expedition... 1887, 419—Descrip- 
tions of two hitherto unrecorded West 
Australian Plants. 1888, 162—Note on 
the Probable Occurrence of Aldrovanda 
vesiculosa in N.S.W. 1889, 197—Notes 
on a new Species of Hucalyptus (E. 
Maideni) from Southern New South 
Wales. 1889, 1020—Descriptions of 
hitherto unrecorded Australian Plants, 
with additional Phyto-geographic Notes. 
1890, 15; 1890, 186; 1890, 250—Observa- 
tions on Plants collected during Mr. 
Joseph Bradshaw’s Expedition to the 
Prince Regent’s River. 1891, 457— 
Notes on an undescribed Acacia from 
New South Wales (Title). 1892, 327— 
Description of a new Isopogon of New 
South Wales. 1894, 151—List of Mosses 
from Tamworth, N.S.W., collected by 
Mr. Musson and named by Herr A. 
Geheeb. 1894, 361—Notes on Boronia 
floribunda Sieber. 1896, 503. 

MUELLER, F. von and J. H. MaArpeEn. 


Description of a new Hakea from 
Eastern New South Wales (Title). 1892, 


24 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


3852—Description of a new Species of 
Acacia. 1898, 13. 

Muir, F. A New Genus of Australian 
Delphacidae (Homoptera). 1920, 181— 
A New Genus of Australian Cixiidae. 
1922, 63. 

Murray, P. D. F. The Motor Nerve- 
endings of the Limb Muscles of the 
Frog (Rana temporaria) and of the 
Muscles of the Pectoral Fin of the Dog- 
fish (Squalus acanthias). 1924, 371— 
A Note on an unusual Type of Secreting 
Epithelium in the Wolffian Duct of the 
Dog-fish (Scylliorhinus canicula). 1925, 
466. 

Musson, C. T. On the naturalised Forms 
of Land and Freshwater Mollusca in 
Australia. 1890, 883—A Statistical 
Note on Variations in the Flowers of 
Anguillaria dioica, R. Br. (Abstract). 
1898, 646—See also FLETCHER and 
Musson; HeprtrEy and Musson. 


Musson, C. T., and W. M. Carne. The 
Adventitious Roots of Melaleuca linarii- 
folia, Sm. 1910, 662. 


Myers, J. G. The Australian Apple Leaf- 
hopper (T'yphlocyba australis Frogg.). 
1921, 473. 


Nortu, A. J. Notes on the Bower-Birds 
(Fam. Scenopidae) of Australia. 1886, 
1155—List of References to Authentic 
Descriptions of Australian Birds’ Eggs. 
1886, 1163—Notes on the Nests and 
EKegs of certain Australian Birds. 1887, 
405—Contributions to the Oology of the 
Austro-Malayan and Pacific Regions. 
1887, 441—Descriptions of the Hggs of 
Two Species of Australian Birds. 1887, 
554—Notes on the Nidification of 
certain Australian Birds. 1887, 985— 
Notes on the Nests and Hggs of certain 
Australian Birds. 1888, 146—Notes on 
the Nesting of Alcyone pulchra, Gould. 
1888, 269—Notes on the Nidification of 
Rhipidura preissi, Cabanis, and Malurus 
pulcherrimus, Gould. 1888, 414—A List 
of the Birds found in the County of 
Cumberland, N.S.W. 1888, 1773—Note 
pointing out that Poephila gouldiae and 
P. armitiana are merely varieties of 
P. mirabilis (Hombron and Jacquinot). 
1889, 188—Notes on a small Collection 
of Birds made by Mr. HE. H. Saunders at 
Roeburne, North-western Australia. 
1889, 10283—On the Nidification of 
Heteromyias cinereifrons, Ramsay, and 
Orthonyx spaldingi, Ramsay. 1889, 
1050—Notes on the Nidification of 
Merula vinitincta, Gld., and Ocydromus 
sylvestris, Sel. (Title). 1889, 1296— 
Notes on the Breeding of Sternula 
sinensis, Gmel., in Australia (Title). 
1889, 1296—Notes upon the Plumage of 


the Adult Males in certain Species of 
the Genus Malurus. 1890, 505—Notes 
on the Nidification of the Torres Straits 
Pigeon (Myristicivora spilorrhoa). 
1890, 880—Oological Notes: i. Notes on 
the Nesting-Place and Eggs of Halcyon 
sordidus, Gld.; ii. Notes on the 
Nesting-Place and Eggs of Cyanor- 
hamphus rayneri, G. R. Gray. 1892, 395 
—wNotes on the Red-crowned Parrakeet 
(Cyanorhamphus Cooki) of Norfolk 
Island. 1893, 517—Note on the Habitat 
of the Naked-eyed Cockatoo, Cacatua 
gymnopis, Sel. 1894, 37—Oological 
Notes. 1894, 39; 1895, 215—Descrip- 
tions of the Nests and Eggs of three 
Species of Australian Birds. 1897, 56— 
Descriptions of the Nests and Heggs of 
four Species of Australian Birds. 1898, 
380—Note on the Synonymy of Malurus 
cyaneus, and M. superbus. 1901, 632. 


Norton, J. Fructification of the Bunya. 
1881, 727—Notes on the Fructification 
of the Bunya. 1883, 176—Presidential 
Address, 28th March, 1900. 1900, 1— 
Presidential Address, 27th March, 1901. 
1900, 7638. 


O’DwyER, MarGaret H. Preliminary Re- 
port on the Nutritive Value of certain 
Australian Grasses. 1921, 239—A Note 
on Protein Precipitation in Grasses. 
1922, 513—Further Report on the 
Nutritive Value of Certain Australian 
Grasses. 1922, 516. 

Orricer, G. Notes on an aboriginal Grave 
in the Darling River District, N.S.W. 
1901, 238. 


OcitBy, J. D. Notes and Descriptions of 
some rare Port Jackson Fishes. 1885, 
119—Descriptions of new Fishes from 
Port Jackson. 1885, 225—Note on Neo- 
anthias Guentheri, Casteln. 1885, 231— 
Description of a new Diplocrepis from 
Port Jackson. 1885, 270—Descriptions 
of three new Fishes from Port Jackson. 
1885, 445—Notes on the Distribution of 
some Australian Sharks and Rays, with 
a Description of Rhinobatus Bougain- 
villei, Mill. and Henle. 1885, 463— 
Remarks on the Trachichthys of Port 
Jackson. 1885, 580—Report on a small 
Zoological Collection from Norfolk 
Island: ii. Reptiles and Fishes. 1887, 
990—Description of a new Genus and 
Species of Deep-sea Fish from Lord 
Howe Island. 1888, 1313—List of the 
Australian Palaeichthyes with Notes 
on their Synonymy and Distribution. 
Part i. 1888, 1765; Part ii. 1889, 178— 
Description of a new Snake belonging 
to the Genus Hoplocephalus. 1889, 1027 
—Descriptions of two new Skinks 
(Title). 1889, 1296—Description of a 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 25 


new Snake from the Herbert River 
District. 1890, 51—Description of a 
new Australian Snake. 1894, 261— 
Descriptions of five new Fishes from 
the Australasian Region. 1894, 367— 
Description of a new Australian Eel. 
1894, 720—On two new Genera and 
Species of Fishes from Australia: 1895, 
320—On a new Genus and Species of 
Fishes from Maroubra Bay. 1896, 23 
—On a Galaxias from Mount Kosciusko. 
1896, 62—A new Family of Australian 
Fishes. 1896, 118—Descriptions of two 
new Genera and Species of Australian 
Fishes. 1896, 136—A Monograph of the 
Australian Marsipobranchii. 1896, 388 
—On some Australian Hleotrinae. 1896, 
725—New Genera and Species of Aus- 
tralian Fishes. 1897, 62—On a Larval 
Teleost from New South Wales. 1897, 
158—Some new Genera and Species of 
Fishes. 1897, 245—Notes on the Genus 
Aphritis, C.V. 1897, 554—On a Trachyp- 
terus from New South Wales. 1897, 646 
—New Species of Australian Fishes. 
1897, 759—A Contribution to the 
Zoology of New Caledonia. 1897, 762— 
On some Australian Eleotrinae. Part 2. 
1897, 783—New Genera and Species of 
Fishes. 1898, 32—New Genera and 
Species of Fishes. 1898, 280—Contribu- 
tions to a Knowledge of the Fauna of 
British New Guinea. Ophidia and 
Pisces. 1898, 359—Additions to the 
Fauna of Lord Howe Island. 1898, 730 
—Contribution to Australian Ichthy- 
ology. 1899, 154—See also Ramsay and 
OGILBY. 


Oiirr, A. S. Notes on certain Ceylonese 
Coleoptera (Clavicornia) described by 
the late Mr. Francis Walker. 1885, 69 
—A List of the Cucujidae of Australia, 
with Notes and Descriptions of new 
Species. 1885, 203—Contributions to- 
wards a knowledge of the Coleoptera of 
Australia. No. i. New species of Cara- 
bidae; No. ii. On a new Species of 
Rhysodidae. 1885, 467; No. iii. On the 
Genus Nascio (Fam. Buprestidae). 1886, 
861; No. iv. Description of a new Genus 
and Species of Oedemeridae. 1887, 153; 
No. v. On certain Species belonging to 
unrecorded Genera. 1888, 1511; No. vi. 
New Lamellicornia and lLongicornia. 
1890, 5—A List of the Trogositidae of 
Australia, with Notes and Descriptions 
of new Species. 1885, 699—A new 
Butterfly of the Family Lycaenidae 
from the Blue Mountains. 1885, 716— 
Remarks on Australian Ptinidae and 
Descriptions of new Genera and Species. 
1885, 833—Description of a new Aphan- 
ipterous Insect from New South Wales. 
1886, 171—A Revision of the Staphy- 


linidae of Australia. Part i. 1886, 403; 
Part ii. 1886, 887; Part iii. 1887, 471— 
Notes on Zelotypia Stacyi, and an 
Account of a Variety. 1887, 467—On a 
new Butterfly of the Family Satyridae. 
1887, 976—Note on a Specimen of 
Peripatus found at Cassilis, N.S.W. 
1887, 981—Report on a small Zoological 
Collection from Norfolk Island. Insecta. 
1887, 1001—On Rhopalocera from the 
Vicinity of Mt. Bellenden-Ker, Queens- 
land. 1888, 394—On two Instances of 
Colour Variation in Butterflies. 1888, 
1250—Description of a new Moth of the 
Genus Phyllodes (P. Meyricki). 1889, 
118—On Rhopalocera from Mt. Kos- 
ciusko, New South Wales. 1889, 619— 
Pielus hyalinatus and P. imperialis. 
1889, 641—New Species of Lampyridae, 
including a notice of the Mt. Wilson 


Fire-Fly. 1889, 643—Stray Notes on 
Lepidoptera. No. i. 1890, 515; No. ii. 
189i, 27. Observations on certain un- 


described Gall-making Coccidae of the 
subfamily Brachyscelinae (Title). 1892, 
378. 


OuuirF, A., and H. Prince. On anew Pielus 
from the Blue Mountains. 1887, 1015. 


OSBORNE, G. D. The Geology and Pet- 
rography of the Clarencetown-Paterson 
lDrignenee, Ieee i, iWS2e ails IPeweAe i 
L922 FLI= Part wiih AC Study ot the 
Main Glacial Beds at Seaham. 1925, 
67; Part iv. Petrography. 1925, 112. 


OSBORNE, G. D., and W. R. Browne. Note 
on a Glacially-striated Pavement in the 
Kuttung Series of the Maitland District. 
1921, 259. 


O’SHANESY, P. A. The Botany of the 
Springsure District. 1881, 730. 


Parker, T. J., and JOSEPHINE G. RIcH. 
Observations on the Myology of 
Palinurus HEdwardsti, Hutton (Title). 


1892, 410. 

PETERSEN, P. Espen. Australian Newrop- 
uer@., Ieeyer iu, IB AIt (eine Ieee ri, Il alsy 
AOS Ieehee it, Il ANB Ieebee Tay, IG wat 


HUGS leans vy SAR, SOR. 


Perrin, A. H. K. An Ecological Study of 
the Flora of Mount Wilson. Part ii. 
The Eucalyptus Forests. 1925, 145— 
See also BroucH, McLuUcKig and PETRIE. 


PetTrig£, J. M. The Stinging Property of 
the Giant Nettle-Tree (Laportea gigas, 
Wedd.). 1906, 530—Solandrine, a new 
Midriatic Alkaloid. 1907, 789—The Role 
of Nitrogen and its Compounds in 
Plant-Metabolism. Part i. Historical. 
1908, 801; Part ii. The Non-Protein 
Nitrogen in Seeds. 1908, 835; Part iii. 
The Distribution of Nitrogen in Acacia 
Seeds. 1911, 97; Part iv. The Nitrogen 


26 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


of Ripening Seeds. 1911, 127; Part v. 
The Occurrence of Potassium Nitrate in 
Plants. 1911, 135—The Chemistry of 
Doryphora sassafras. 1912, 139—Hydro- 
eyaniec Acid in Plants. Part i. Its Dis- 
tribution in the Australian Flora. 1912, 
220; Part ii. Its Occurrence in the 
Grasses of New South Wales. 1913, 
Gazebo Ieee iil, ily, IAS IeeieE ih, “INAS 
Hydrocyanic Acid of Heterodendron— 
a fodder Plant of New South Wales. 
1920, 447—Note on the Occurrence of 
Strychnicine. 1913, 761—The Chemical 
Investigation of some Poisonous Plants 
in the N. O. Solanaceae. Part ii. 
Nicotiana suaveolens, and the Identifi- 
eation of its Alkaloid. 1916, 148; Part 
iii. The Occurrence of Nor-Hyoscya- 
mine in Solandra longiflora. 1916, 815; 
PaGieelive The Chemistry of the 
Duboisias. 1917, 118; Part v. The 
Alkaloids of Duboisia Leichhardtii 
K.y.M. 1917, 137—The Occurrence of 
Methyl Laevo-Inositol in an Australian 
Poisonous Plant. 1918, 850—The 
Chemical Examination of Macrozamia 
spiralis. 1920, 424—The active prin- 
ciple of Hrythrophloeum Laboucherii. 
1921, 333—Studies in Plant Pigments. 
i. The yellow colouring matter of the 
Acacias. 1923, 356; ii. The red pig- 
ment induced by insect injury in 
Eucalyptus stricta. 1924, 386—See also 
CHAPMAN and PETRIE. 


PHiLiieres, W. J., and KF. J. ©. Grice. The 
Salinity of Inshore Oceanic Waters of 
Australasia in relation to Fishes. 1925, 
432. 

PuinpottT, A. On a Remarkable Modifica- 
tion of the Highth Abdominal Segment 
in Lindera tessalatella, with a Descrip- 
tion of the Male and Female Genitalia. 
1925, 32—The Labial Palpi of Tvricho- 
physetis cretacea and Argyria amoen- 
atis. 925, 38a. 

PINKERTON, HTHEL C. The Percentage of 
Carbon Dioxide in Expired Alveolar 
Air. 1917, 146—The Composition of Ex- 
pired Alveolar Air. 1917, 866. 


Pittman, EH. F., and T. W. H. Davin. Note 
on the Occurrence of Lepidodendron in 
Upper Devonian Rocks at Mt. Lambie, 
near Rydal, New South Wales. 1893, 
121—See also Davin, HeEtmMs, and 
PITTMAN. 

PLAyFarr, G. I. Some new or less known 
Desmids found in New South Wales. 
1907, 160—Some Sydney Desmids. 1908, 
603—Polymorphism and Life-History in 
the Desmidiaceae (Algae: conjugatae). 
1910, 459—Plankton of the Sydney 
Water-Supply. 1912, 512—Contributions 
to a Knowledge of the Biology of the 
Richmond River, N.S.W. 1914, 98—The 


Genus Trachelomonas (Infusoria). 
1915, 1—Freshwater Algae of the Lis- 
more District; with an Appendix on 
the Algal Fungi and Schizomycetes. 
1915, 310—Oocystis and Hremosphaera 
(Algae). 1916, 107—Australian Fresh- 
water Phytoplankton (Protococcoideae). 
1916, 823—Rhizopods of Sydney and 
Lismore. 1917, 633—New and rare 
Freshwater Algae. 1918, 497—Peri- 
dineae of New South Wales. 1919, 793 
—Australian Freshwater Flagellates. 
1921, 99—Notes on Freshwater Algae. 
1923, 206. 

Prince, H. See OLiirr and PRINCE. 

RAFFRAY, A. Australian Pselaphidae. 

1900, 131. 


Rartnpow, W. J. Descriptions of some 
new Araneidae of New South Wales. 
IN@s th ASA, Zale IN©, shi, ISO, wGs INO, 
Tlie AUS, ZAIME INO, whys Issel seis INO. Ww 
UH), SES ING wily ISG, Bee IN@, will, 
ISN, (BASS ING, wal, IW W5 slats IN@, tb 
1900, 488; No. x. 1902, 484—Contribu- 
tions to a Knowledge of the Arachnidan 
Fauna of Australia. No. i. 1896, 634— 
Note on Argyrodes antipodiana. 1898, 
172—Contribution to a Knowledge of 
the Arachnidan Fauna of British New 
Guinea. 1898, 328—Contributions to a 
Knowledge of the Fauna of British New 
Guinea. Insecta and Arachnida. 1898, 
363—Contributions to a Knowledge of 
the Araneidan Fauna of Santa Cruz. 


1899, 304—Arachnida from the South 
Seas. 1901, 521. 
Ramsay, EH. P. Description of a new 


Species of Ptilotis from the Endeavour 
River, with some Remarks on the 
Natural History of the East Coast 
Range, near Rockingham Bay. 1875-76, 
9—Description of a new Species of 
Trichoglossus. 1875-76, 30—Description 
of a new Genus and Species of Rat 
Kangaroo, allied to the Genus Hypsi- 
prymnus, proposed to be called Hypsip- 
rymnodon moschatus. 1875-76, 33— 
Characters of a new Genus and Species 
of Passerine Bird from the Fiji Islands, 
proposed to be called Vitia. 1875-76, 41 
—Descriptions of new Species of Merula 
and Rhypidura. 1875-76, 43—Descrip- 
tion of a new Species of Pachycephala 
from Fiji, in the collection of W. Mac- 
leay, Hsq., F.L.S. 1875-76, 65—Descrip- 
tion of a supposed new Species of 
Pachycephala from New Britain. 1875- 
76, 66—Description of a new Species 
of the Genus Lamprolia, Finsch, from 
Fiji. 1875-76, 68—Remarks on a collec- 
tion of Birds lately received from Fiji, 
and now forming part of the Macleayan 
Collection at Elizabeth Bay; with a list 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 27 


of all the Species at present known to 
inhabit the Fiji Islands. 1875-76, 69— 
Description of a supposed new Species 
of Bat from Stanwell, near Bulli, N.S.W. 
1875-76, 8i—Description of a supposed 
new Species of Fruit Pigeon from 
Malacola, one of the New Hebrides 
Islands, S. S., proposed to be called 
Ptilinopus Corriei. NOW5-16; 133—— 
Description of a new Species of Plover 
from Nth. Australia. 1875-76, 135— 
Description of a new Species of Kan- 
garoo from New Guinea. 1875-76, 162— 
List of Australian Game Birds and 
other Species which should be protected 
by the Game Preservation Act. 1875-76, 
182—Remarks on the large Number of 
Game Birds which have of late been 
offered for sale in Sydney. 1875-76, 215 
—Note on Poephila gouldiae. 1875-76, 
281—Description of a new Species of 
Halmaturus from New Ireland. 1875- 
76, 307—Description of a new Species 
of Perameles from New Ireland. 1875- 
76, 310—Description of a supposed new 
Species of Rock-Wallaby from Palm 
Islands, on the N.E. Coast of Australia, 
proposed to be called Petrogale 
assimilis. 1875-76, 359—Notes of a 
collection of Birds from New Britain, 
New Ireland, and the Duke of York 
Islands, with some Remarks on the 
Zoology of the Group. 1875-76, 369— 
On Perameles cockerellii. 1875-76, 378 
—Notes on a Collection of Birds from 
Port Moresby with Descriptions of 
some new Species. 1875-76, 386— 
Zoology of the “Chevert’—Mammals. 
Part i. 1877, 7—Descriptions of two 
supposed new Species of Mus, and of a 
Pteropine Bat of a new Genus from the 
Duke of York Island. 1877, 15—On a 
new Species of Platycercus from the 
Interior of New South Wales. 1877, 27 
—Description of a new Species of 
Pelodryas trom New Ireland. 1877, 28 
—Note of a Species of Echidna (Tachy- 
glossus) from Port Moresby, New 
Guinea. 1877, 31—Description of a new 
Species of Gerygone. 1877, 53—Some 
further Remarks on Poéphila Gouldiae 
and P. mirabilis. 1877, 70—Descrip- 
tion of a supposed new Species of 
Acanthophis, from North Australia. 
1877, 72—Description of some new 
Species of Birds from New Britain, New 
Ireland, Duke of York Island, and the 
South Hast Coast of New Guinea. 1877, 
104—Description of some rare Hggs of 
Australian Birds and a Note on the 
Eggs of certain species of Megapodius. 
1877, 107—Note on  Macgillivray’s 
Snake, Brachysoma triste. 1877, 113— 
Notes on some Birds from Savage 


Island, Tutuila, etc., in the collection 
of the Rev. Mr. Whitmee, F.R.G.S. 
1877, 139—Tabular List of all the Aus- 
tralian Birds at present known, show- 
ing the Distribution of the Species. 
1877, 177—Description of a Species of 
Edoliosoma from New Ireland, supposed 
to be the adult of Ceblepyris schisti- 
ceps (Homb. et Jacq.). 1877, 222— 
Description of a new Species of Pachy- 
cephala from the Gulf of Carpentaria. 
1877, 224—Description of a new Species 
of Ianthaenas from the Duke of York 
Islands. 1877, 248—Descriptions of 
three supposed new Species of Birds 
from the New Hebrides. 1877, 286— 
Description of a new Species of Rhipi- 
dura, from Torres Straits (?) and of a 
new Species of Hopsaltria from the 
Rockingham Bay district, with Re- 
marks on some rare Queensland Birds. 
1877, 371—Description of a new Species 
of Ptilotis from Torres Straits. 1878, 
2—Description of a Species of Myio- 
lestes from Fiji. 1878, 12—Notes on 
“List of Australian Birds’. 1878, 38— 
Descriptions of five Species of new 
Birds from Torres Straits and New 
Guinea, etc. 1878, 72—Zoology of the 
“Chevert’. Ornithology, Part ii. 1878, 
100—On two new Species of Gerygone. 
1878, 116—Note on the Tracheae of 
certain Australian Ducks. 1878, 154— 
On the Goshawk from Port Moresby, 
Astur cruentus of Salvadori and Sharpe 
(nec Gould). 1878, 173—Contributions 
to the Zoology of New Guinea. 
J2eWeUS} TL aia. mi, ee, 2453 JERE tht 
Description of a new  Marsupial 
allied to the genus Perameles Geoff. 
1878, 402; Parts iv and v. Remarks on 
recent Collections made by Mr. Andrew 
Goldie in the south-east portion of New 
Guinea and Louisiades. 1879, 85; Part 
vi. On some new and rare Birds from 
the south-east Coast of New Guinea. 
1879, 464; Part vii. 1883, 15—Notes on 
a small Collection of Birds from the 
New Hebrides, with a Description of a 
new Species of Merula. 1878, 336— 
Description of a new Species of Rhipi- 
dura from Lora Howe’s Island. 1878, 
340—Notes on Puffinus (Nectris) car- 
neipes, Gould. 1878, 406—Notes on the 
Zoology of the Solomon Islands. Part i. 
Aves. 1879) 655 Rart i. 18381) 762 Part 
its), ASsi Vis hare ive Lss25) 6— 
Notes on some recently-described Birds 
from the Solomon Islands, with Re- 
marks on some Australian Birds men- 
tioned in Mr. R. B. Sharpe’s ‘Catalogue 
of Birds’, Vol. iv. 1879, 313—Note on 
an undetermined Species of Lalage. 
1879, 396—Description of a new Species 


28 


of Oligorus from Queensland. 1880, 93 
—Notes on Galeocerdo Rayneri, with a 
list of other Sharks taken in Port Jack- 
son. 1880, 95—On a rare Species of 
Perch from Port Jackson. 1880, 294— 
Notes on Histiophorus gladius. 1880, 
295—Description of two new Species of 
Australian Fishes. 1880, 462—Descrip- 
tion of a parasitic Syngnatus. 1880, 
494—On a new Species of Regalaecus 
from Port Jackson. 1880, 631—Descrip- 
tion of a new Labroid Fish of the 
Genus Novacula from Port Jackson. 
1881, 198—Description of a new Species 
of Hemerocetes from Port Jackson. 
1881, 575—Note on Oriolus affinis, 
Gould. 1881, 576—On the Occurrence 
of Pseudophycis breviusculus Rich., in 
Port Jackson. 1881, 717—Description 
of a new Species of Honey-eater from 
the S.E. Coast of New Guinea. 1881, 
718—Description of a supposed new 
Species of Rat from the Interior of 
New South Wales. 1881, 763—Descrip- 
tion of a new Species of Therapon from 
the Macquarie River. 1881, 831— 
Description of two new Birds from the 
Solomon Islands. 1881, 883—Note on 
the range of Pycnoptilus floccosus, 
Gould, and Pachycephala  olivacea, 
V. & H. 1881, 835—On a new Species 
of Hurystopodus. 1881, 843—On a new 
Species of Mus from the Island of Ugi, 
Solomon ‘Group. 1882, 43—Contribu- 
tions to Australian Oology. Part i. 
1882, 45; Part ii. 1882, 406—Notes on 
-the Zoology of Lord Howe’s Island. 
1882, 86—Description of the Eggs of five 
Species of Fijian Birds. 1882, 112— 
On a new Species of Gobiesox from 
Tasmania. 1882, 148—Description of 
two new Birds from the Solomon 
Islands. 1882, 299—Desecription of a 
new Species of Coris from Lord Howe’s 
Island and New South Wales. 1882, 301 
—Description of a new Species of Solea 
from Port Stephens. 1882, 406—Notes 
on Birds from the Solomon Islands. 
1882, 665—Description of some new 
Australian Fishes. 1883, 177—Descrip- 
tions of two new Species of Birds from 
the Austro-Malayan Region. 1884, 863 
—Contributions to the Zoology of New 
Guinea. Notes on Birds from Mount 
Astrolabe, with Descriptions of two new 
Species. 1885, 242—Description of a 
new Species of Collyriocincla from the 
Scrubs in the vicinity of Cairns, Queens- 
land. 1885, 244—On a new Genus and 
Species of Freshwater Tortoise from 
the Fly River, New Guinea. 1886, 158 
—List of Western Australian Birds col- 
lected by Mr. Cairn and Mr. W. H. 
Boyer-Bower, at Derby and its Vicinity, 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


with Remarks on the Species. 1886, 
1085—Note on the Hgg of the Regent- 
Bird, Sericulus melinus, Lath. 1886, 
1138—Notes on the Nesting of Pycnop- 
tilus floccosus, Gould, in New South 
Wales. 1886, . 1189—Descriptions of 
Australian Birds’ Hggs. 1886, 1141— 
Description of a new Species of 
Hapalotis (H. Boweri), from North- 
West Australia. 1886, 1153—List of 
Birds collected at Derby, North-West 
Australia, by the late T. H. Boyer- 
Bower, HEsq., with Notes. 1887, 165— 
Description of a new Species of 
Epimachus, from the Astrolabe Range, 
South-Hast New Guinea. 1887, 239— 
Description of two new Species of Mar- 
supials (Perameles and Antechinus), 
and of a new Species of Mus (M. 
Burtoni) from the neighbourhood of 
Derby, N.W.A. 1887, 551—Description 
of a new Species of Philemon from 
North-West Australia. 1887, 676— 
Description of a new Species of 
Gerygone from Lord Howe’s Island. 
1887, 677—Descriptions of the Hggs of 
three Species of Sea-Birds from Lord 
Howe’s Island. 1887, 678—Description 
of a new Species of Piezorhynchus from 
the New Hebrides Islands. 1888, 1293 
—Notes on the Fauna of the Bellenden- 
Ker Ranges. 1888, 1295—See also 
CASTELNAU and RAMSAY. 


Ramsay, EH. P., and J. D. OcinBy. Descrip- 


tions of new or rare Australian Fishes. 
1885, 575—Description of two new 
Fishes from Port Jackson. 1885, 757— 
Description of a new Goris. 1885, 851 
—Descriptions of some new Australian 
Fishes. 1886, 4—A Contribution to the - 
Knowledge of the Fish-Fauna of New 

Guinea. 1886, 8—Description of a new 
Coris from the New Hebrides. 1886, 
131—Descriptions of two new Fishes. 
1886, 474—On Specimens of the Genus 
Xiphasia, Swainson, from Port Jackson. 
1886, 582—On an undescribed Species 
of Chilodactylus from Port Jackson. 
1886, 879—On an undescribed Sciaena 
from the New South Wales Coast. 1886, 
941—Description of a new Australian 
Fish (Apogon roseigaster). 1886, 1101 
—On an undescribed Dules from New 
Guinea. 1887, 4—On an undescribed 
Shark from Port Jackson, 1887, 163— 
Notes on the Genera of Australian 
Fishes. Parti. 1887, 181—Descriptions 
of New Australian Fishes. 1887, 241; 
1887, 561—On a new Genus and Species 
of Labroid Fish from Port Jackson. 
1887, 631—Descriptions of two new 
Fishes from Port Jackson. 1887, 1021— 
Note in Correction of Certain Errors in 
Previous Papers. 1887, 1024—On the 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 29 


Genus Tetragonurus of Risso. 1888, 9 
—Description of a new Tripterygium 
from Port Jackson. 1888, 419—Descrip- 
tions of two new Australian Fishes. 
1888, 1310—Description of a new Aus- 
tralian Skink (Title). 1889, 1296. 


Ranps, W. H. See Dun, RANDS and 
DaAvip. 

RatteE, F. On Tribrachyocrinus corru- 
gatus, spec. nov. from the Carboniferous 
Sandstone of New South Wales. 1884, 
1158—On the Larvae and Larva-cases 
of some Australian Aphrophoridae. 
1884, 1164—On a Devonian Fossil allied 
to Worthenia, De Koninck, from New 
South Wales. 1885, 79—On some 
remarkable Crystals of Siderite. 1885, 
759—Note on Crioceras australe, Moore 
(?), a lower Cretaceous Fossil from 
Queensland. 1886, 133—Notes on Aus- 
tralian Fossils. (1) Note on some Tri- 
lobites new to Australia. 1886, 1065; 
(2) Second Note on Tribrachiocrinus 
corrugatus, Ratte, and on the place of 
the genus among  Palaeocrinoidea. 
1886, 1069; (3) Note on two new Fossil 
Plants from the Wianamatta Shales. 
1886, 1078—Note on some Trilobites 
new to Australia. 1887, 95—Notes on 
some Australian Fossils. (1) Sdlis- 
buria palmata, emend. from Jeanpaulia 
or Baiera palmata, Ratte. 1887, 137; 
(2) On the Muscular impression of the 
Genus Notomya (Maeonia). 1887, 139 
—Note on a Remarkable Example of 
Fracture in Kerosene Shale. 1887, 140 
—Additional Evidence on Fossil Salis- 
buriae from Australia. 1887, 159. 


ReaD, R. B. Lepidoptera having the 
Antlia terminal in a Teretron or Borer. 
1878, 150—On Doris arbutus, Angas. 
1879, 291. 

RicH, JOSEPHINE G. 
RIcuH. 

ROssITER, R. C. A List of the Cypraeidae 
found on the Coast of New Caledonia 
and Loyalty Islands. 1881, 817—New 
Variety of Ovulum depressum found at 


See PARKER and 


Lifou. 1882, 323. 
Ruerp, H. M. R. Notes on Species of 
Pterostylis. 1925, 299. 


RUTHERFORD, A. A new  Scale-Insect 
(Coccidae) affecting Sugar-Cane in New 
Guinea, with a Note by EH. Jarvis. 1916, 
215. 


Sanps, F. P. The Corpus Luteum of 
Dasyurus viverrinus, with Observations 
on the Growth and Atrophy of the 
Graffian Follicle. 1903, 364. 

SANGER, EH. B. On a Molar Tooth of 
Zeuglodon from the Tertiary Beds on 
the Murray River near Wellington, S.A. 
1880, 298. 


SAWYER, B., and HE. C. ANDREWS. Notes 
on the Caves of Fiji, with special 
Reference to Lau. 1901, 91. 


SCORTECHINI, B. Contribution to a South 
Queensland Flora. 1881, 157—Half- 
Century of Plants new to South Queens- 
land. 1882, 213—Contributions to the 
Flora of Queensland. 1883, 168—A 
Second Half-Century of Plants new to 
South Queensland. 1883, 242. 


SEEBOHM, H. Note on the Occurrence of 
the Sanderling (Calidris arenaria) in 
Borneo. 1893, 49. 

SEURAT, —. See Donat et SEURAT. 

SHARP, D. Description of a new Genus 
and Species of Coleoptera (Family 


Hispidae) from New Britain. 1903, 
924. 
SHAw, A. Hnanp. Description of new 


Australasian Blattidae, with a Note on 
the Blattid Coxa. 1922, 223—New 
Genera and Species (mostly Aus- 
tralasian) of Blattidae, with Notes, and 
some Remarks on Tepper’s Types. 
1S yAH, IAAL. 


SHEARSBY, A. J. On a new Species of 
Rhizophyllum from the Upper Silurian 
Rocks of Yass, N.S.W. 1904, 869—On 
the Occurrence of a Bed of Fossil- 
iferous Tuff and Lavas between the 
Silurian and Middle Devonian at 
Cavan, Yass, N.S.W., similar in Age 
and Character to the Snowy River 
Porphyries of Victoria. 1905, 275. 


SHIRLEY, J.. and C. A. LamsBertT. The 
Stems of Climbing Plants. 1918, 600. 


SincLarirR, S. Notes of a Visit to the 
Island of Hrromanga, New Hebrides, 
in May, 1894. 1894, 701. 


SkusE, F. A. A. Notes on a new Dip- 
terous Insect belonging to the Family 
Cecidomyidae infesting Grass; also on 
two Hymenopterous Insects parasitic 
upon the former. 1887, 1071—Diptera 
of Australia. Part i. 1888, 17; Part ii. 
The Sciaridae. 1888, 657; Part iii. The 
Mycetophilidae. 1888, 1123; Part iv. 
The Simulidae and Bibionidae. 1888, 
1363; Part v. The Culicidae. 1888, 
1717; Part vi. The Chironomidae. 
1889, 215; Part vii. The Tipulidae 
brevipalpi. 1889, 757; Part viii. The 
Tipulidae longipalpi. 1890, 53; Nem- 
atocera. Supplement i. 1890, 373; 
Nematocera. Supplement ii. 1890, 595. 
Notes on the genus Lestophonus, 
Williston, and Description of a new 


Species. 1889, 123—Description of a 
new Genus (Batrachomyia, W. S. 
Macleay, M.S.) and two Species 


of Dipterous Insects parasitic upon 
Australian Frogs. 1889, 171—Descrip- 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


tion of a luminous Dipterous Insect 
(Fam. Mycetophilidae), from New 
Zealand. 1890, 677. 


SLoANnE, T. G. A Note on the Carenides, 


with Descriptions of New Species. 
1888, 1101—A Second Note on the 
Carenides, with Descriptions of New 
Species. 1893, 448—On the Carenides 
(Fam. Carabidae). No. iii. 1897, 190— 
On the Carenides (Fam. Carabidae). 
No. iv. 1900, 361—Studies in Aus- 
tralian Entomology. No. i. Review of 
the Genus Sarticus (Carabidae). 1889, 
501; No. ii. Six new Species of Cara- 
bidae. 1889, 1288; No. iii. On Prome- 
coderus and closely allied Genera 
(Carabidae). 1890, 189; No. iv. New 
Genera and Species of Carabidae. 1890, 
641; No. v. Notes on the subfamily 
Broscini (Carabidae) with Descriptions 
of New Species. 1892, 45; No. vi. 
Description of a new Tiger-beetle from 
Queensland. 1893, 25; No. vii. New 
Genera and Species of Carabidae (in- 
eluding some Notes on previously 
described Species, and synoptic Lists 
of Genera and Species). 1894, 393; 
No. viii. Descriptions of Two New 
Tiger Beetles. 1897, 33; No. ix. New 
Species of Carabidae (with Notes on 
some previously described Species and 
synoptic Lists of Species). 1899, 553; 
No. x. Description of a New Tiger 
Beetle from Western Australia. 1900, 
632; No. xi. Description of a New 
Ground Beetle from Victoria. 1901, 
672; No. xii. New Carabidae (Pana- 
geini, Bembidiini, Pogonini, Platy- 
smatini, Platynini, Lebiini, with Re- 
visional Lists of Genera and Species, 
some Notes on Synonymy, etc.). 1903, 
566; (N.B. No paper numbered xiii). 
No. xiv. New Species of Geodephagous 
Coleoptera from Tropical Australia. 
Cicindelidae (8) and .Carabidae (5) 
(Platysmatini, Marioni, Perigonini, 
Masoreini, and Physocrotaphini). 1904, 
527; No. xv. New Genera and Species 
of Carabidae, with some Notes on 
Synonymy (Clivinini, Scaritini, Cunei- 
pectini, Trigonotomini and Lebiini). 
1907, 346; No. xvi. New Species of 
Carabidae. 1910, 378; No. xvii. New 
Genera and Species of Carabidae (Pam- 
borini, Migadopini, Broscini, Cunei- 
pectini, Nomiini, Pterostichini, Platy- 
nini, Oodini, Harpalini, and Lebiini). 
1915, 438; No. xviii. New Genera and 
Species of Carabidae. 1923, 17— 
Descriptions of two New Species of 
Carenum from West Australia, with 
Notes on the Synonymy and Distribu- 
tion of some previously described 
Species. 1891, 427—On the Australian 


Clivinides (Family Carabidae) (Re- 
vision of the Australian Species of the 
Genus Clivina with the Description of 
a New Genus, Clivinarchus). 1896, 143 
—Appendix to the Australian Clivinides 
(Fam. Carabidae). The Clivinides of 
King’s Sound and its Vicinity. 1896, 
275—On the Australian Bembidiides 
referable to the Genus Tachys, with the 
Description of a new allied Genus 
Pyrrotachys. 1896, 355—On Carabidae 
from West Australia, sent by Mr. A. M. 
Lea (with Descriptions of New Genera 
and Species, Synoptic Tables, etc.). 
1898, 444—A Revision of the Genus 
Notonomus (Family Carabidae, Sub- 
family Feronini). 1902, 252—Re- 
visional Notes on Australian Carabidae. 
Part i. Tribes Carabini, Pamborini, 
Pseudozaenini, Clivini, and the Genus 
Nebriosoma. 1904, 699; Part ii. 1905, 
103; Part iii. Tribes Oodini, Chlaeiini, 
and Sphodrini. 1910, 435; Part iv. The 
Genus Notonomus. 1913, 404; Part v. 
1914, 568; Part vi. Tribe Bembidiini. 
1921, 192—Five New Species of 
Cicindela from Tropical Australia. 1905, 
229—Australian Carabidae. Check 
List. Part i. Subfamily Carabinae 
(Issued separately as supplement to 
Proceedings, 1905, Part i)—Revision of 
the Cicindelidae (Coleoptera) of Aus- 
tralia. 1906, 309—Supplement to the 
Revision of the Cicindelidae of Aus- 
tralia. 1906, 555—Second Supplement 
to the Revision of the Cicindelidae of 
Australia. 1909, 296—Carabidae from 
Dorrigo, N.S.W. (with an Appendix: 
Tenebrionidae from Dorrigo. By H. J. 
Carter). 1910, 823—Descriptions of 
Two New Species of Cicindela from 
Western Australia. 1913, 401—Descrip- 
tion of a New Tiger-beetle from North- 
Western Australia. 1914, 565—Cara- 
bidae (Coleoptera) from the Upper 
Williams River, N.S.W. 1916, 196— 
New Australian Species of Carabidae 
belonging to the tribe Scaritini (Cole- 
optera). 1916, 597—Descriptions of 
Two New  Tiger-Beetles from the 
Northern Territory. 1917, 201; -337— 
On the Endoskeleton of the Head, the 
Anterior Coxae, and the Anterior Coxal 
Cavities in the Families Carabidae and 
Cicindelidae (Coleoptera). 1917, 339 
—Carabidae from Tropical Australia. 
(New Genera and Species, Notes and 
Synonymy, and Synoptic Tables. Tribes 
Searitini, Harpalini, Odacanthini, 
Lebiini, and Helluonini). 1917, 406— 
The Carabidae of Tasmania. 1920, 113 
—A List of the Species of Australian 
Carabidae which range beyond Aus- 
tralia and its Dependent Islands. 1920, 


SmitH, G. ELuiot. 


SmirH, H. G. 


SmirH, R. GREIc. 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 31 


320—Description of a New Tiger-Beetle 
from the Wyndham District. With 
some Notes on recent Works on Aus- 
tralian Cicindelidae. 1921, 330. 


SmitH, E. A. Note on the Subgenus 


Salinator of Hedley. 1901, 14. 

A Preliminary Com- 
munication upon the Cerebral Commis- 
sures of the Mammalia, with special 
Reference to the Monotremata and 
Marsupialia. 1894, 635. 


SmiryH, G. P. D. An Account of some 


Observations upon the Life-history of 
Phoma citricarpa McAlp.: The Cause 
of the “Black Spot” Disease in Citrus 
Fruit in New South Wales. 1918, 868 
—The Occurrence of an _ inverted 
Hymenium in Agaricus campestris. 
1918, 888. 


On the Occurrence of 
Barite (Barytes) in the Hawkesbury 
Sandstone, near Sydney. 1891, 131. 


The Tick Fever Para- 
site. 1899, 585—The Nodule Organism 
of the Leguminosae. 1899, 653—The 
Flocculation of Bacteria. 1900, 65—The 
Mechanism of Agglutination. 1900, 75 
—A new Bacillus Pathogenic to Fish. 
1900, 122—The double staining of 
Spores and Bacilli. 1900, 394—Con- 
tribution to the Bacterial Flora of the 
Sydney Water Supply. i. 1900, 436; ii. 
1900, 740; The Measurement of Bac- 
teria. 1900, 533—A Fish Disease from 
George’s River. 1900, 605—The Cloud- 
ing of White Wine. 1900, 650—Bac- 
teria and the Disintegration of Cement. 
1901, 107—Notes on Vibris denitrificans 
Sewerin. 1901, 118—The Nature of the 
Bacteroids of the Leguminous Nodule 
and the Culture of Rhizobium Legum- 
inosarum. 1901, 152—The Gum Fer- 
mentation of Sugar Cane Juice. 1901, 
589—The Deterioration of Raw and 
Refined Sugar Crystals in Bulk. 1901, 
674—The Acid Fermentation of Raw 
Sugar Crystals. 1901, 684—The Gum- 
mosis of the Sugar-Cane (Bact. vascu- 
larum, Cobb). 1902, 31—Further Re- 
marks upon the Mechanism of Ageglu- 
tination. 1902, 66—An Ascobacterium 
from the Sugar-Cane, with Notes upon 
the Nature of the Slime (Bacterium 
sacchari, n. sp.). 1902, 137—A Gum 
(Levan) Bacterium from a Saccharine 
Exudate of Eucalyptus Stuartiana 
(Bacterium eucalypti, n. sp.). 1902, 
230—The Ulcer Disease (Black Oph- 
thalmia?) of Rainbow Trout (WMicro- 
coccus pyogenes). 1902, 352—The Bac- 
terial Origin of the Gums of the 
Arabin Group. Nos. i-ii. 1902, 383; Nos. 
iii-ix. 1903, 114; No. x. The Pararabin 
Gum of Sterculia (Bact. pararabinum, 


iN,  $95))6 UGK, 419 IW@s sal “ane 
Nutrition of Bacterium acaciae. 1904, 
217—A Slime Bacterium from the 
Peach, Almond and Cedar (Bacterium 
persicae, n. sp.). 1903, 338—The Slime 
of Dematium pullulans. 1903, 826—The 
Gum and Byproducts of Bacterium 
sacchari. 1903, 834—The Loss of Colour 
in Red Wines. 1904, 213—-A Variable 
Galactan Bacterium (Bacillus Ather- 
stonei, n. sp.). 1904, 442—The Red 
String of the Sugar-Cane (Bacillus 
pseudarabinus, n. sp.). 1904, 449—A 
Yellow Race of Bacillus pseudarabinus 
from the Quince. 1904, 860—The Bac- 
terial Origin of Macrozamia Gum 
(Bacillus macrozamiae, n. sp.). 1904, 
863—On First Line of Defence against 
Microbic Attacks (Abstract). 1905, 26 
—The possible Relationship between 
Bacteria and the Gum of dHakea 
saligna (Bac. pseudarabinus, ii, n. sp.). 


1905, 136—The Origin of Natural 
Immunity towards the Putrefactive 
Bacteria. 1905, 149—The Probable 


Bacterial Origin of the Gum of Linseed 
Mucilage (Bacilli lini, i-ii, n. spp.). 
1905, 161—The Role of Agglutination in 
Immunity. 1905, 289—A  Gelatin- 
hardening Bacterium (Bacillus indu- 
rans, n. sp.). 1905, 339—The Probable 
Identity of the Opsonins with the 
Normal Agglutinins. 1905, 555—A Pleo- 
morphic Slime-Bacterium (Bacillus 
alatus, n. sp.). 1905, 570—The Forma- 
tion of Slime or Gum by Rhizobium 
leguminosarum. 1906, 264—The Struc- 
ture of Rhizobium leguminosarum. 
1906, 295—The Fixation of Nitrogen by 
Rhizobium leguminosarum. 1906, 608 
—The Fixation of Nitrogen by Azoto- 
bacter chroococcum. 1906, 616— 
Opsonisation from a Bacterial Point of 
View and Opsonic Technique. 1908, 669 
Can Opsonins be obtained directly 
from Bacteria and Yeasts? 1909, 105— 
The Coagulation of Condensed Milk. 
1909, 107—The Influence of the Dilution 
of Serum upon the Phagocytic Index. 
1909, 384—-The Slime of the Household 
Bath-Sponge. 1910, 29—The Bacterial 
Flora of Rachitic Stools. 1910, 36— 
The Permanency of the Characters of 
the Bacteria of the Bac. coli-group. 
1910, 806—Contributions to our Know- 
ledge of Soil Fertility. i. The Action 
of Wax-solvents and the Presence of 
Thermolabile Bacteriotoxins in Soil. 
1910, 808; ii. The Determination of 
Rhizobia in the Soil. 1911, 492; iii. 
Bacterial Slimes in Soil. 1911, 609; iv. 
The Agricere and Bacteriotoxins of Soil. 
USilal, Oe Ww. “Wage Aveo GE INEhE 
Solvents upon Sewage-Sick Soils. 1912, 


32 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


238; vi. The Inactivity of the Soil- 
Protozoa. 1912, 655; vii-xi. 19138, 725; 
xii. The Action of Toluene upon the 
Soil-Protozoa. 1914, 839; xiii. The 
Toxicity of Soils. 1915, 631; xiv. The 
Stimulative Action of Chloroform re- 
tained by the Soil. 1915, 724; xv. The 
Action of certain Micro-organisms upon 
the numbers of Bacteria in the Soil. 
1917, 162; xvi. The Search for Toxin- 
Producers. 1918, 142—Note on the 
Bacteriotoxic Action of Water. 1914, 
533—Note on the Destruction of 
Paraffin by Bac. prodigiosus and Soil- 
Organisms. 1914, 5388—A new Levan- 
gumforming Bacterium (Bacillus hemi- 
phloiae). 1915, 174—The Single Cell 
Cultivation of Yeast. 1917, 220—The 
Germicidal Activity of the Hucalyptus 
Oils. i. 1919, 72; ii. The Action of the 
Oils in Aqueous Dilutions. 1919, 311— 
Ropiness in Wattle Bark Infusions. 
1920, 52—The High ‘Temperature 
Organism of Fermenting Tan-bark. 
leew Tl, IGP, Gs leew ib, IGA, Ile IPewer 
iii. 1923, 475; Part iv. The effect of 
Chill. 1923, 623—-Note upon the Ex- 
traction of Acids from Cultures. 1921, 
154—The Influence of certain Colloids 
upon Fermentation. Part i. 1924, 436; 
Part ii. 1925, 341—Note upon deter- 
mining the Hydrogen-ion Concentration 
colorimetrically, in small Quantities of 
Fluids. 1924, 504—See also L’HsTrancE 
and SmirH, GREIG-. 


SmiTtTH, VERA Irwin. On the Chaetoso- 


matidae, with Descriptions of new 
Species, and a new Genus from the 
coast of New South Wales. 1917, 757— 
Studies in Life-histories of Australian 
Diptera Brachycera. Part i. Stratio- 
myiidae. No. 1. Metoponia rubriceps 
Macquart. 1920, 505; No. 2. Further 
experiments in the rearing of Meto- 
ponia rubriceps. 1921, 252; No. 3. On 
the Structure of the Mouth-parts and 
Pharynx of the larval Metoponia 
rubriceps. 1921, 425; No. 4. The Res- 
piratory System in Larva, Pupa and 
Imago of Metoponia rubriceps Mac- 
quart. 1923, 49; ii. Asilidae. No. 1. 
Catalogue of the Species of Asilidae of 
which the earlier Stages have been 
recorded. 1923, 368; No. 2. Notes on 
the Kigg-laying, Eggs and young Larvae 
of Neoaratus hercules Wied. 1923, 375 
—Nematode Parasites of the Domestic 
Pigeon (Columba livia domestica) in 
Australia. 1920, 552—Notes on Nema- 
todes of the Genus Physaloptera, with 
Special Reference to those Parasitic in 
Reptiles. Part i. 1921, 492; Part ii. A 
Review of the Physaloptera of Lizards. 
1922, 538; Parts iii and iv. The Physal- 


optera of Australian Lizards. 1922, 
232; 1922, 415—A new Nematode Para- 
site of a Lizard. 1922, 311. 

Spencer, W. B. Contributions to our 
Knowledge of Ceratodus. Part i. The 
Blood Vessels (Title). 1892, 327. 


Sreap, D. G. Contributions to a Know- 
ledge of the Australian Crustacean 
Fauna. No. i. Observations on the 
Genus Neptunus. 1898, 746; No. ii. On 
Sacculina parasitic upon Pilumnopeus 
serratifrons. 1899, 687. 

STEEL, JESSIE K. Anatomical Features of 
the Mature Sporophyte of Selaginella 
wliginosa. 19238, 287. 

STEEL, T. Observations on Peripatus. 
1896, 94—Australian Land Planarians: 
Descriptions of new Species and Notes 
on Collecting and Preserving. 1897, 
104; No. 2. 1900, 563—Land Planarians 
from Fiji, with Descriptions: of new 
Species. 1897, 120—Note on Peripatus. 
1897, 121—Contributions to a Know- 
ledge of the Fauna of British New 
Guinea, Introduction. 1898, 357— 
Tasmanian Land Planarians. Descrip- 
tions of new Species, ete. 1900, 618— 
The Chemical Properties of Bacterial 
Gum Levan. 1901, 626—Presidential 
Address, 28th March, 1906. 1905, 605— 
Presidential Address, 24th March, 1907. 
1907, 1—Notes on Variable Dioecism in 
Pittosporum undulatum, Andr. 1911, 
329—The Feeding-Tracks of JLimazx 
maximus Linn. 1915, 114—The Ex- 
ternal Parasites of the Dingo (Canis 
dingo Blum.). 1919, 983—On Water 
from the roots of the Red Mallee 
(Hucalyptus oleosa). 1919, 348—On 
dental incrustations and the so-called 
“Gold-Plating’’ of Sheep’s Teeth. 1920, 
324—Ulmite, a Constituent of Black 
Sandstone. 1921, 213—The Occurrence 
of Calcium Oxalate in the Gidgee Wattle 
(Acacia Cambagei Baker). 1921, 256— 
Chemical Notes. Botanical. 1921, 487 
—Chemical Notes. General. 1922, 441 
—On some Abnormal Sugar-canes. 
1923, 462—Observations on Helix aspera 
in Australia. 1924, 151—The nectar of 
flowers. 1924, 324. 


STEPHENS, T. Notes on the Geology of the 
North-West Coast of Tasmania from 
the River Tamar to Circular Head. 
1908, 752. 


STEPHENS, W. J. Presidential Address, 
28th January, 1878. 1877, 379; January, 
1879. 1878, 414—Notes on the Geology 
of the Western Coalfield. Part i. 1882, 
548; Part ii. 1882, 598—Notes on the 
Geology of the Southern Portion of the 
Clarence River Basin. 1883, 519—Presi- 
dential Address, 27th January, 1886. 
1885, 855—Notes on the Recent Hrup- 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 33 


tions in the Taupo Zone, New Zealand. 
1886, 513—Note on a Labyrinthodont 
Fossil from Cockatoo Island, Port Jack- 
son. 1886, 931—On the Biloela Labyrin- 
thodont. 1886, 1113—On some 
Additional Labyrinthodont Fossils from 
the Hawkesbury Sandstones of New 
South Wales (Platyceps Wilkinsonii, 
and two unnamed Specimens). 1886, 
1175—Presidential Address, 26th Jan- 
uary, 1887. 1886, 1209—On some 
additional Labyrinthodont Fossils from 
the Hawkesbury Sandstone of New 
South Wales. Second Note on Platy- 
ceps Wilkinson. 1887, 156—Presi- 
dential Address, 25th January, 1888. 
1887, 1086; 30th January, 1889. 1888, 
1781—An Attempt to Synchronise the 
Australian, South African, and Indian 
Coal Measures. Part i. The Austral- 
asian and New Zealand Formations. 
1889, 331—Presidential Address, 29th 
January, 1890. 1889, 1299. 


Srretine, J. On some Further Evidences 
of Glaciation in the Australian Alps. 
1886, 483—Notes on the Rutaceae of the 
Australian Alps. 1886, 1052. 

StssmincH, C. A., and H. I. JensmEn. The 
Geology of the Canobolas Mountains. 
1909, 157. 

Suter, H. Contributions to a Revision of 
the Tasmanian Land Mollusca (Title). 
1893, 421—Additions and Hmendations 
to the Reference List of the Land and 
Freshwater Mollusca of New Zealand. 
1893, 484—See also HepLEY and SuTER. 


Tatr, R. Descriptions of three new 
Species of Helix from South Australia. 
1877, 290—Rectification of the Nomen- 
clature of Purpura anomala, Angus. 
1880, 131—On Menke’s’ Australian 
Shells. 1881, 387—Description of a 
new Species of Australian Amplexa. 
1881, 409—On the Geographical Rela- 
tions of the Floras of Norfolk and 
Lord Howe Islands (Title). 1892, 410 
—Note on Colina Brazieri, Tryon. 
1893, 244—Note on the Tertiary Fossils 
from Hall Sound, New Guinea. 1894, 
213. 

TaTE, R., and J. Brazier. Check-List of 

' the Fresh-water Shells of Australia. 
1881, 552. 


Tath, R., and W. lL. May. A Revised 
Census of the Marine Mollusca of 
Tasmania. 1901, 344. 


Taytor, F. H. A Revision of the Culicidae 
in the Macleay Museum, Sydney. 1913, 
747—Contributions to a Knowledge of 


Australian Culicidae. No. i. 1914, 454; 
No. ii. 1915, 176; No. iii. 1916, 564; 
No. iv. 1918, 826—Australian Tab- 


Cc 


1915, 806; No. ii. 
UBL, HUBS IM©, thik 


LOIS 
9/8), 


anidae. No. i. 
746; No. iii. 
41. 

Taytor, T. G. The First Recorded Occur- 
rence of Blastoidea in New South 
Wales. 1906, 54—A Correlation of 
Contour, Climate and Coal. A Contribu- 
tion to the Physiography of New South 
Wales. 1906, 517—The Lake George 
Senkungsfeld, a study of the Evolution 
of Lakes George and Bathurst, N.S.W. 
1907, 325—See also WooLtnoucH and 
TAYLOR. 

TENISON-Woops, J. EH. 
TENISON-. 

TuHery, A. Note on the Genus Syne- 
chocera, with Description cf a New 
Species. 1923, 517. 

TIDSWELL, F. See Marrin and TIDSWELL. 


TirGs, O. W. See JOHNSTON and TIEGS. 


TILLYARD, R. J. On Dimorphism in the 
Female of Ischnura heterosticta, Burm. 
(Neuroptera: Odonata). 1905, 302—On 
the supposed Numerical Preponderance 
of the Males in Odonata. 1905, 344— 
Descriptions of three new Australian 
Species of the Genus Austrogomphus 
(Neuroptera: Odonata). 1905, 547— 
New Australian Species of the Family 
Agrionidae (Neuroptera: Odonata). 
1906, 177—Life-History of Lestes leda 
Selys (Neuroptera: Odonata). 1906, 
409—New Australian Species of the 
Family Libellulidae (Neuroptera: 
Odonata). 1906, 480—New Australian 
Species of the Family Aeschnidae 
(Neuroptera: Odonata). 1906, 722— 
On Dimorphism in the Females of 
Australian Agrionidae (Neuroptera: 
Odonata). 1907, 382—New Australian 
Species of the Family Colopterygidae 
(Neuroptera: Odonata). 1907, 394— 
On the Genus Petalura, with Descrip- 
tion of a new Species. 1907, 708—The 
Dragonflies of South-Western Australia. 
1907, 719—On a Collection of Dragon- 
flies from Central Australia, with 
Descriptions of new Species. 1907, 761 
—On the new Austrogynacantha 
(Neuroptera: Odonata) with Descrip- 
tion of Species. 1908, 423—On the 
Genus Nannodythemis, with Descrip- 
tions of new Species. 1908, 444—On 
some remarkable Australian Libellu- 
linae. Part ii. Descriptions of new 
Species. 1908, 637; Part iii. Further 
Notes on Camacinia Othello, Tillyard. 
1910, 859—On some remarkable Aus- 
tralian Corduliinae, with Descriptions 
of new Species. 1908, 737—On some 


See Woops, J. E. 


rare Australian Gomphinae, with 
Descriptions of new Species. 1909, 238 
—Studies in Life-Histories of Aus- 


tralian Odonata. i The Life History 


34 


of Petalura gigantea, Leach. 1909, 256; 
ii. Life History of Diphlebia lestoides, 
Selys. 1909, 370; iii. Notes on a new 
Species of Phyllopetalia; with Descrip- 
tions of Nymph and Imago. 1909, 697; 
iv. Further Notes on the Life-History 
of Petalura gigantea Leach. 1911, 86— 
Monograph of the Genus Synthemis 
(Neuroptera: Odonata). 1910, 312—On 
some Experiments with Dragonfly 
Larvae. 1910, 666—Further Notes on 
some rare Australian Corduliinae, with 
Descriptions of new Species. iUGlal. 
366—On the Genus Cordulephya 
(Odonata). 1911, 388—On the Genus 
Diphlebia (Odonata), with Descrip- 


tions of new Species and Life-Histories. — 


1911, 584—On some new and rare Aus- 
tralian Agrionidae. 1912, 404—On some 
Australian Anisoptera, with Descrip- 
tions of new Species. 1912, 572— 
Description and Life-History of a new 
Species of Nannophlebia. 1912, 712— 
Some Descriptions of new Forms of 
Australian Odonata. 1913, 229—Study 
of the Odonata of Tasmania in rela- 
tion to the Bassian Isthmus. 1913, 765 
—On the Study of Zoogeographical 
Regions by means of Specific Contours: 
with an Application to the Odonata of 
Australia. 1914, 21—On some Prob- 
lems concerning the Development of 
the Wing-venation of Odonata. 1914, 
163—On the Development of the Wing- 
venation in Zygopterous Dragonflies, 
with Special Reference to the Calop- 
terygidae. 1915, 212—On the Physi- 
ology of the Rectal Gills in the Larvae 
of Anisopterid Dragonflies. 1915, 422 
—Studies in Australian Neuroptera. 
IN@s ts The Wing-Venation of the 
Myrmeleonidae. UGA, '7B4bS IN], ah 
Descriptions of New Genera and 
Species of the Families Osmylidae, 
Myrmeleontidae and Ascalaphidae. 1916, 
41; No. iii. The Wing-Venation of the 
Chrysopidae. 1916, 221; No. iv. The 
Families Ithonidae, Hemerobiidae, Sisy- 
ridae, Berothidae and the New Family 
Trichomatidae, with a Discussion of 
their Characters and Relationships, and 
Descriptions of new and little-known 
Genera and Species. 1916, 269; No. v. 
The Structure of the Cubitus in the 
Wings of the Myrmeleontidae. 1918, 
116; No. vi. The Family Psychopsidae, 
with Descriptions of New Genera and 
Species. 1918, 750; No. vii. The Life- 
History of Psychopsis elegans (Guérin). 
1918, 787; No. viii. Revision of the 
Family Ithonidae, with Description of 
a New Genus and Two New Species. 
1919, 414—Further Observations on the 
Emergence of Dragonfly Larvae from 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


the Egg, with special Reference to the 
Problem of Respiration. 1916, 388— 
Further Researches upon the Problems 
of the Radial and Zygopterid Sectors 
in the Wings of Odonata, and upon the 
Formation of Bridges. 1916, 872—On 
the Morphology of the Caudal Gills of 
the Larvae of Zygopterid Dragonflies. 
Introduction, Part i. (General Mor- 
phology), and Part ii (Studies of the 
Separate Types). 1917, 31; Part iii 
(Ontogeny) and Part iv (Phylogeny). 
1917, 606—The Wing-Venation of Lepid- 
optera (Preliminary Report). 1917, 
167—Mesozoic Insects of Queensland. 
No. i. Planipennia, Trichoptera, and 
the New Order Protomecoptera. 1917, 
175; No. 2. The Fossil Dragonfly 
Aeschnidopsis (Aeschna) flindersiensis 
(Woodward) from the Rolling Downs 
(Cretaceous) Series. 1917, 676; No. 3. 
Odonata and Protodonata. 1918, 417; 
No. 4. Hemiptera Heteroptera: the 
Family Dunstaniidae. With a Note on 
the Origin of the Heteroptera. 1918, 
568; No. 5. Mecoptera, the New Order 
Paratrichoptera, and Additions to the 
Planipennia. 1919, 194; No. 6. Blat- 
toidea. 1919, 358; No. 7. Hemiptera 
Homoptera; with a Note on the Phy- 
logeny of the Suborder. 1919, 857; No. 
8. Hemiptera Homoptera (contd.). The 
Genus Mesogereon; with a Discussion 
of its Relationship with the Jurassic 
Palaeontinidae. 1921, 270; No. 9. 1922, 
447; No. 10. Summary on the Upper 
Triassic Insect Fauna of Ipswich, Q. 
(With an Appendix describing New 
Hemiptera and Planipennia). 1923, 481 
—Studies in Australian Mecoptera. No. 
i. The new Family Nannochoristidae, 
with descriptions of a new Genus and 
four new Species: and an Appendix 
descriptive of a new Genus and Species 
from New Zealand. 1917, 284; No. ii. 
The Wing-Venation of Chorista aus- 
tralis Klug. 1918, 395—On some new 
Dragonflies from Australia and Tas- 
mania (Order Odonata). 1917, 450— 
Odonata, Planipennia, and Trichoptera 
from Lord Howe and Norfolk Islands. 
1917, 529—Permian and Triassic Insects 
from New South Wales, in the Collec- 
tion of Mr. John Mitchell. 1917, 720— 
On the Affinities of two interesting 
Fossil Insects from the Upper Carbon- 
iferous of Commentry, France. 1918, 
123—A Fossil Insect-wing from the roof 
of the Coal-seam in the Sydney Harbour 
Colliery. 1918, 260—The Panorpoid 
Complex. A Study of the Phylogeny of 
the Holometabolous Insects, with 
special Reference to the. Sub-classes 
Panorpoidea and Neuropteroidea. (In- 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 35 


troduction). 1918, 265; Part 1. The 
Wing-Coupling Apparatus, with Special 
Reference to the Lepidoptera. 1918, 
286; Part 2. The Wing-Trichiation and 
its Relationship to the General Scheme 
of Venation. 1918, 626; Part 3. The 
Wing-Venation. 1919, 533; Additions 
and Corrections to Part 3. 1920, 214— 
Australian Megaloptera or Alder-flies, 
with Descriptions of new Genera and 
Species. 1918, 819—On the Morphology 
and Systematic Position of the Family 
Micropterygidae (sens. lat.). Intro- 
duction and Part i. (The Wings). 1919, 
95—Report on the Neuropteroid Insects 
of the Hot Springs Region, N.Z., in 
relation to the problem of Trout Food. 
1920, 205—Revision of the Family 
Hustheniidae (Order Perlaria). With 
Deseriptions of new Genera and 
Species. 1921, 221—A New Genus and 
Species of May-fly (Order Plectoptera) 
from Tasmania, belonging to _ the 
Family Siphluridae. 1921, 409—Two 
Fossil Insect Wings in the Collection 
of Mr. John Mitchell, from the Upper 
Permian of Newcastle, N.S.W., belong- 
ing to the Order Hemiptera. 1921, 413 
—Some new Permian Insects from Bel- 
mont, N.S.W., in the Collection of Mr. 
John Mitchell. 1922, 279—Upper Permian 
Coleoptera and a new Order from the 
Belmont Beds, New South Wales. 1924, 
429—A New Fossil Insect Wing from 
Triassic Beds near Dee Why, N.S.W. 
1925, 374—Two New Species of Silky 
Lacewings (Family Psychopsidae, 
Order Neuroptera Planipennia) from 
Australia. 1925, 387. 


TurRNER, A. J. New Genera of Species of 
Lepidoptera belonging to the Family 
Noctuidae. 1902, 77—Revision of the 
Australian Lepidoptera. 1903, 42; ii. 
1904, 832; iii. 1906, 678; iv. 1907, 631; 
Ve dla, aS “Sidi, Ilr, Stebel al, ByiZke 
1919, 258; 1919, 383; Liparidae. 1920, 
474; Hypsidae, Anthelidae. 1921, 159; 
Saturniadae, Bombycidae, Hupterotidae, 
Notodontidae. 1922, 348; Lasiocam- 
pidae. 1924, 397—New Australian 
Lepidoptera, belonging to the Family 
Noctuidae. 1909, 341—Studies in Aus- 
tralian Microlepidoptera. 1913, 174; 
1916, 333—The Lepidoptera of Ebor 
Serub, N.S.W. 1914, 546—Further 
Notes on the Lepidoptera of Ebor Scrub, 
N.S.W. 1915, 185—A Third Contribu- 
tion to a Knowledge of the Lepidop- 
terous Fauna of Ebor Scrub, N.S.W. 
1916, 249—Some Australian Moths from 
Lord Howe Island. 1922, 4389—A 
Revision of the Australian Aneras- 
trianae (Lepidoptera). 1923, 451—See 
also Eyer and TURNER. 


Turner, F. A List of Exotic Trees and 
Shrubs affected by Australian Loranths 
and Viscums. 1894, 557—Description 
of a new Australian Grass. 1898, 56— 
The Vegetation of New England, New 
South Wales. 1903, 276—Botany of the 
Darling, New South Wales. 1903, 406 
—The Botany of South-Western New 
South Wales. 1904, 132—Botany of 
North-Western New South Wales. 1905, 
32—Botany of North-Eastern New 
South Wales. 1906, 365. 

TurNeER, G. Notes upon the Formicidae 
of Mackay, Queensland. 1897, 129— 
Two new Species of Phytophagous 
Hymenoptera belonging to the families 
Oryssidae and ‘Tenthredinidae, with 
Notes on other Sawflies. 1900, 514. 

TuRNER, R. H. A Revision of the Thyn- 
nidae of Australia (Hymenoptera). 
Part i. 1907, 206; Part ii. 1908, 70— 
Revision of the Australian Species of 
the Genus Anthobosca (Hymenoptera, 
Family Scoliidae) with Descriptions of 
new Species. 1907, 514—A Revision of 
the Australian Species of the Genus 
Cerceris (Hymenoptera). 1911, 664— 
New Fossorial Hymenoptera from Aus- 
tralia and Tasmania. 1913, 608—See 
also WATERHOUSE and TURNER. 

TREBECK, P. N. On the Improvements 
effected by the Australian Climate, Soil, 
and Culture on the Merino Sheep. 1884, 
173—Mount Wilson and its Ferns. 1886, 
491. 


VAN LEEUWEN, W. D., and H. H. Karny. 
Two new Thrips-galls and their In- 
habitants, from New South Wales. 
1924, 279. 

VEITCH, R., and W. GREBNWoop. The Food 
Plants or Hosts of some Fijian Insects. 
Uspal, HOS Ieee mn, iwGwAL ae. 


Waitt, EH. R. Notes on Australian Typh- 
lopidae. 1894, 9—New or rare Fishes 
from Maroubra, N.S.W. 1894, 215— 
Observations on Dendrolagus bennet- 
tianus, De Vis. 1894, 571—Redescrip- 
tion of Aspidites ramsayi, Macleay. 
1894, 715—Note on the Range of the 
Platypus. 1896, 500—Notes on the 
breeding habits of the Red-bellied Newt 
(Molge pyrrogastra, Boie.). 1908, 66. 

WaLkKom, A. B. Note on a new Species 
of Favosites from Yass District, N.S.W. 
(Actinozoa: Zoantharia). 1911, 700— 
Stratigraphical Geology of the Permo- 
Carboniferous System in the Maitland- 
Branxton District; with some Notes 
on the Permo-Carboniferous Palaeo- 
geography in New South Wales. 1913, 
114—The Geology of the Permo- 
Carboniferous System in the Glendon- 
brook District, near Singleton, N.S.W. 


36 INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


1913, 146—Notes on some recently dis- 
covered Occurrences of the Pseudo- 
morph, Glendonite. 1913, 160—The 
Geology of the Lower Mesozoic Rocks 
of Queensland, with special Reference 
to their Distribution and Fossil Flora, 
and their Correlation with the Lower 
Mesozoic Rocks of other parts of Aus- 
tralia. 1918, 37—On a Collection of 
Jurassic Plants from Bexhill, near Lis- 
more, N.S.W. 1919, 180—On the 
Occurrence of Otozamites in Australia, 
with Descriptions of Specimens from 
Western Australia. 1921, 147—On a 
specimen of Noeggerathiopsis trom the 
Lower Coal Measures of New South 
Wales. 1921, 374—Fossil Plants from 
the Narrabeen Stage of the Hawkesbury 


Series. 1925, 214—See also Corron and 
W ALKOM. 

WarpDLAW, H. S. H. The Temperature of 
Echidna aculeata. 1915, 231—The 


Change of Composition of Alveolar Air 
after the Stoppage of Normal Breath- 
ing. 1916, 786—The Variability of 
Cows’ Milk. Part i. 1917, 815—The 
Relation between the Fat-Content and 
the EHlectrical Conductivity of Milk. 
1918, 613—Note on the Temperature of 
Echidna aculeata. 1918,  844—The 
Venous Oxygen Content and the Alka- 
line Reserve of the Blood in Pneumonic 


Influenza. 1919, 514—The Effect of 
Suspended Respiration on the Com- 
position of Alveolar Air. 1922, 545. 


WaterHOUSE, G. A. The Genus Hetero- 
nympha in New South Wales. 1897, 240 
—The Life-History of Apaustus lascivia, 
Rosenstock. 1897, 244—The Rhopalo- 
cera of Lord Howe Island. 1897, 285— 
Descriptions of new Species of Aus- 
tralian Rhopalecera. 1900, 52—Notes on 
Australian Rhopalocera: Lycaenidae. 
Part i. 1902, 331; Lycaenidae. Part ii. 
1902, 648; Lycaenidae. Part iii. Re- 
visional. 1903, 132; Part iv. 1904, 798; 
Part v. 1912, 698—On a new Species of 
Heteronympha and a new Variety of 
Tisiphone abeona, Don. 1904, 466— 
Descriptions of New Forms of Butter- 
flies from the South Pacific. 1920, 468— 
Presidential Address, 29th March, 1922. 
1922, i—Presidential Address, 28th 
March, 1923. 1923, i. 

WATERHOUSE, G. A., and R. HK. TuRNeER. 
Notes on Australian Rhopalocera- 
Lycaenidae. Part iv. 1904, 798. 

Watts, W. W. Notes on some new Mosses 
from New South Wales. 1899, 632— 
Additional Notes on the Mosses of New 
South Wales. 1901, 473—Notes on some 
New South Wales Hepatics. 1901, 633; 
1902, 493—Further Notes on Australian 
Hepatics. 1904, 558—The Sphagna of 


Australia and Tasmania. 1912, 383— 
The Ferns of Lord Howe Island. 1912, 
395—Additional Notes on the Ferns of 
Lord Howe Island. 1914, 257—Some 
Notes on the Ferns of North Queens- 
land. 1914, 756—Some Cryptogamic 
Notes, from the Botanic Gardens, 
Sydney. 1916, 377—See also BrorTHERUS 
and WATTS. 

Watts, W. W., and T. WHITELEGGE. Cata- 
logue of the described Mosses of New 
South Wales. (Title only). 1900, 59 
—Census Muscorum Australiensium. A 
classified Catalogue of the Frondose 
Mosses of Australia and Tasmania, 
collated from available Publications and 
Herbaria Records. Parti. (Title only). 
(Issued separately as a Supplement to 
Part iii, 1902, of the Proceedings). 
1902, 369; Part ii. (Supplement to 
Proceedings, 1905, Part 4). 

WEEKES, H. CiarreE. See Harrison and 
WEEKES. 

WetcH, M. B. The Occurrence of Oil 
Ducts in certain Hucalypts and Ango- 
phoras. 1921, 475—The Occurrence of 
Oil Glands in the Barks of Certain 
Hucalypts. 1922, 428—The Occurrence 
of secretory Canals in certain Myrta- 
ceous Plants. 1923, 660. 

Wuitrk, A. A Revision of the Stratio- 
myidae (Diptera) of Australia. 1916, 71. 

Wuirtr, C. T. A Revised Account of the 
Queensland Lecythidaceae. 1919, 822— 
Notes on the genus Flindersia (Family 
Rutaceae). 1921, 324—A new Conifer 
from Southern Queensland. 1923, 449. 

WHITELEGGE, T. List of the Freshwater 
Rhizopoda of N.S.W. Part i. 1886, 
497—Notes on some Australian Polyzoa. 
1887, 3837—Contributions to a Know- 
ledge of the Fauna of British New 
Guinea. Crustacea. 1898, 3868—The 
Gametophyte of Psilotum: Preliminary 
Notes. 1916, 553—See also Warts and 
W HITELEGGE. 

WHiITTtELL, H. R. On some Habits of 
Pelopoeus laetus, and a Species of 
Larrada. 1883, 29—On the Voracity of 
a Species of Heterostoma. 1883, 33. 


WILKINSON, C. S. Notes on a Collection 
of Geological specimens collected by 
William Macleay, Hsq., F.L.S., President 


of the New South Wales Linnean 
Society, Sydney, from the Coasts of 
New Guinea, Cape York, and Neigh- 


bouring Islands. 1875-76, 113—Notes on 
the Abercrombie Caves. 1879, 460— 
Notes on the occurrence of Artesian 
Wells in the Albert District, New South 
Wales. 1881, 155—Notes on some 
Customs of the Aborigines of the Albert 
District, New South Wales. 1883, 436 
—Presidential Address, 30th January, 


Woops, J. EH. TENISON-. 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 37 


1884. 1883, 535—Presidential Address, 
28th January, 1885. 1884, 1207—Note 
on some vegetable fossils from New- 
stead, near Inverell. 1886, 1123. 


WiLitEy, A. On a Rare Variation in the 


Shell of Pterocera lambis, Linn. 1896, 
110—See also HepiEY and WILLEY. 


WILLIAMS, May M. A Contribution to 


our Knowledge of the Fucaceae. 1923, 
634—Contributions to the Cytology and 
Phylogeny of the Siphonaceous Algae. 
i. The Cytology of the Gametangia of 
Codium tomentosum (Stack.). 1925, 
98—The Anatomy of Lindsaya linearis 
and Lindsaya microphylla. 1925, 391. 


Wixtson, J. T. Preliminary Note on the 


Anatomy of the ‘“Dumb-bell-shaped” 
Bone in Ornithorhynchus, with a new 
View of its Homology. 1894, 44— 
Observations upon the Anatomy and 
Relations of the ‘“Dumb-bell-shaped”’ 
Bone in Ornithorhynchus, with a new 
Theory of its Homology; and upon a 
hitherto undescribed Character of the 
Nasal Septum in the Genera Ornithor- 
hynchus and Echidna. 1894, 129— 
Description (with Figures) of a young 
Specimen of Ornithorhynchus anatinus, 
from the collection of the Australian 
Museum, Sydney. 1894, 682—Presi- 
dential Address, 30th March, 1898. 1897, 
812—Presidential Address, 29th March, 
1899. 1899, 1—On the Skeleton of the 
Snout and os carunculae of the mam- 
mary foetus of Monotremes. 1900, 58 
—On the Skeleton of the Snout of the 
Mammary Foetus of Monotremes. 1901, 
relive 


WILson, J. T., and C. J. Martin. Observa- 


tions upon the Anatomy of the Muzzle 
of Ornithorhynchus (Title). 1892, 343 
—On the peculiar rod-like Tactile 
Organs in the Integument and Mucous 
Membrane of the Muzzle of Ornithor- 
hynchus (Title). 1892, 343—Further 
Observations upon the Anatomy of the 
integumentary Structures in the Muzzle 
ot Ornithorhynchus. 1894, 660. 


WiLson, J. T., and W. J. S. McKay. On 


the Homologies of the Borders and 
Surfaces of the Scapula in Monotremes. 
1893, 30. 

Observations on 
the Genus Risella. 1875-76, 242—On 
some Australian Species of Trocho- 
cochlea. 1877, 89—On a new Species of 
Neaera. 1877, 123—On a Variety of 
Trigonia Lamarckii. 1877, 125—On a 
Tertiary Formation at New Guinea. 
1877, 125—The Echini of Australia 
(including those of the ‘“Chevert’ 
Expedition). 1877, 145; Supplemental 
Note. 1877, 342—On some Australian 
Shells described by Dr. A. Gould. 1877, 


250—On some new Marine Shells. 1877, 
262—On some Tertiary Fossils from 
New Guinea. 1877, 267—On the Extra- 
tropical Corals of Australia. 1877, 292 
—On an Australian Variety of Neritina 
pulligera, Linn. 1878, 3—On a new 
Genus of Milleporidae. 1878, 6—On a 
new Species of Psammoseris. 1878, 8 
—On a new Species of Desmophyllum 
(D. quinarium) and a young Stage of 
Cycloseris sinensis. 1878, 17—On some 
Australian Littorinidae. 1878, 55—On 
Bulimus Dufresnii. 1878, 8i—On three 
new Genera and one new Species of 
Madreporaria Corals. 1878, 92—On two 
new Species of Land Shells. 1878, 123 
—On a new Genus of Polyzoa. 1878, 126 
—On some Corals from Darnley Island. 
1878, 128—On some new Extra-tropical 
Corals. 1878, 131—On some Freshwater 
Shells from New Zealand. 1878, 135— 
On some Tertiary Fossils from Muddy 
Creek, Western Victoria. 1878, 222— 
On some Tertiary Fossils. 1879, 1— 
On some new Marine Shells. 1879, 21 
—On some Freshwater Shells from New 
Guinea. 1879, 24—On some new Marine 
Shells from Moreton Bay. 1879, 108— 
On Arauja albens, Don. 1879, 111—On 
the Relations of the Brisbane Flora. 
1879, 117—On some new Australian 
Hehini. 1879, 282—On Heteropsammia 
Michelinii, of Edwards and MHaime. 
1879, 293—On a new Species of Disti- 
chopora. 1879, 301—On some Fossils 
from Levuka, Viti. 1879, 358—On some 
Post-Tertiary Fossils from New Cale- 
donia. 1879, 360—Presidential Address, 
28th January, 1880. 1879, 471—On 
some of the littoral Marine Fauna of 
North-HKast Australia. 1880, 106—On a 
Fossiliferous Bed at the mouth of the 
Endeavour River. 1880, 187—On the 
Habits of some Australian Hchini. 1880, 
193—On a new Species of Flabellum. 
1880, 301—On a new Species of Diaseris. 
1880, 459—On a young specimen of a 
Temnopleurus. 1880, 493—Pres. Address, 
27th Jan., 1881. 1880, 638—Botanical - 
Notes on Queensland. No. i. 1882, 76; 
No. ii. The Tropics. 1882, 136; No. iii. 
IRSA, BOSS INO, i, IUSS82, SRils IN©s Ww 
1882, 565—On a new Species of Stomop- 
neustes, and a new Variety of Hipponoe 
variegata. 1882, 93—On various De- 
posits of Fossil Plants in Queensland. 
1882, 95—On a new Species of Allopora. 
1882, 207—On a Coal Plant from 
Queensland. 1882, 342—Physical Struc- 
ture and Geology of Australia. 1882, 
371—On a large Mesozoic Mytilus from 
the Barcoo. 1882, 389—On a Species of 
Brachyphyllum from Mesozoic Coal 
Beds, Ipswich, Queensland. 1882, 659— 


INDEX TO CONTRIBUTORS OF PAPERS. 


On the Fossil Flora of the Coal De- 
posits of Australia. 1883, 37—On some 
Mesozoic Fossils from Central Aus- 
tralia. 1883, 235—Report on the 
Geology and Physical Geography of the 
State of Perak. 1884, 1175—On the 
Voleano of Taal. 1887, 685—Fisheries 
of the Oriental Region. 1888, 165— 
Geographical Notes in Malaysia and 
Asia. 1888, 557—Malaysian Land and 
Freshwater Mollusca. 1888, 1003—On 
the Vegetation of Malaysia. 1889, 9. 


Woops, J. EH. TENISOoN-, and EF. M. Batrery. 


On some of the Fungi of New South 
Wales and Queensland. 1880, 50—See 
also BatLEy and Woops. 


Woopwarp, H. Note on a new Decapodous 


Crustacean (Prosopon Etheridgei, H. 
Woodw.) from the Cretaceous of 
Queensland. 1892, 301. 


Woo.tts, W. Eucalypts of the County of 


Cumberland; their Classification, Hab- 
itat, and Uses. Part i. 1880, 288; Part 
ii. 1880, 448; Part iii. 1880, 463; Part 
iv. 1880, 488; Part v. 1880, 503— 
Gesneraceae of Australia. 1881, 148— 
On the Plants of New South Wales. 
IN©@, i JUSS, HEMYS Woes mi, weil ee 
INO, wil, ISG, '7OG2 WO; wy, wsesil, alAs 
No. v. 1881, 765; No. vi. 1881, 814; No. 
vii. 1881, 838; No. viii. 1882, 71—Note 
on Palmeria of the Monimiaceae. 1881, 
745—Species of Alsophila in New South 
Wales. 1881, 745—Popular Nomen- 
clature. 1881, 770—On the Forage 
Plants indigenous in New South Wales. 


1882, 310—Species of HEucalypts first 
known in HEurope. 1882, 621—Plants 
which have become Naturalized in New 
South Wales. 1884, 185—On the 
Myrtaceae of Australia. 1884, 6438— 
The Proteaceae of Australia. 1885, 54— 
Double Flowers. 1885, 455—Note on 


Eucalyptus leucoxzylon (F.v.M.). 1886, 
859—Botanical Notes: (1) Note on 
Lindsaea trichomanoides (Dry.). 1886, 


929; (2) Note on Crowea exalata 
(F.v.M.). 1886, 929—A Glance at the 
Flora of Mount Wilson. 1887, 6— 
Lemnaceae or Duckweeds. 1888, 1247 
—Sapindaceae of Australia. 1888, 1270 
—Specimens of Plants collected at King 
George’s Sound by the Rev. R. Collie, 
F.L.S. 1889, 317—On the Genus 
Dodonaea. 1890, 763—On the Classifi- 
cation of Hucalypts. 1891, 49—Notes on 
some specimens of Plants collected at 
King George’s Sound by Mr. H. Willis. 
1892, 25—Note on Gastrodia sesamoides, 


TR, Tere, IUGR, B83. 

WooLnoucH, W. G. The Continental 
Origin -or hij) kart) i.) General 
Geology. 19038, 457; Part ii. Petro- 
graphical Descriptions of Typical 
Rocks. 1903, 500—A Contribution to 


the Geology of Viti Levu, Fiji. 1907, 
431—The General Geology of Marulan 
and Tallong, N.S.W. 1909, 782. 


WooLnouGcH, W. G., and T. G. Taytor. A 


Striking Hxample of River-Capture in 
the Coastal Districts of New South 
Wales. 1906, 546. 


ii. INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


References are to Author and year in part i of this index, thus for paper on 
Abercrombie Caves look under Wilkinson in part i for paper published in the Proceedings 


itor 163'7S), 


The letters n. g. and n. sp. are used in this index to show that the description, of new 
genera or species is indicated in the title of a paper. 


Abercrombie Caves, Wilkinson, 1879. 

Ablepharus, n. sp. (Victoria), Lucas and 
Frost, 1896. 

Aboriginal, Dolichocephalic skull, Maclay, 
1883—food, Bancroft, 1894—grave, Dar- 
ling. River District, N.S.W., Officer, 
1901—implement, believed to be un- 
described, Etheridge, 1894—Lachlan 
District, skull, Maclay, 1883—rock- 
shelters, Port Hacking, Harper, 1899— 
stone weapons and implements, 
Etheridge, 1890-1893—tribes, Ngarrabul 
and other, medical and surgical prac- 
tice and distribution, Macpherson, 1904. 

Aboriginals, debouchement of Sulcus 
Rolando into Fissura Sylvii in brains, 
Maclay, 1884. 

Aborigines, Albert District, N.S.W., 
customs, Wilkinson, 1883—drawings by, 
Cox, 1878—“Widow’s Cap”, Htheridge, 
1899. 

Acacia, apparently n. sp. (N.S.W.), 
Maiden and Baker, 1894—Brunswick 
River, Maiden, 1895—Cambagei, cal- 
cium oxalate in, Steel, T., 1921— 
lanigera, Baker, 1895—n. sp., Baker, 
1897; Blakely, 1917; Maiden, 1901; 
Maiden and Baker, 1893; Mueller and 
Maiden, 1893—n. sp. (N.S.W.), Maiden 
and Baker, 1895; Mueller, 1892— 
prominens, Baker, 1891—pruinosa, 
Baker, 1892—pugioniformis, Baker, 
1892—subulata, Baker, 1898. 

Acacias, Australian Phyllodineous, correct 
interpretation of the so-called 
phyllodes, Fletcher, 1920—yellow 
colouring matter, Petrie, J.M., 1923. 

Acantholophus, Ferguson, 1921. 

Acanthophis, supposed n. sp., North 
Australia, Ramsay, 1877—antarctica, 
osteology and myology, McKay, 1889. 

Acarid, new type, Haswell, 1922. 

Acids from cultures, extraction, Smith, 
R. G., 1921. 

Actinotus Paddisoni, n. sp., Baker, 1905. 

Adelium, Carter, 1908. 

Aeschnidae, Australian, n. sp., Tillyard, 
1906. 


Aeschnidopsis flindersiensis, Rolling 
Downs Series, Tillyard, 1917. 

Agaricus, n. sp., W. Australia, Kalch- 
brenner, 1882—campestris, occurrence 
of an inverted hymenium, Smith, 
G. PB. D., 19118. 

Agglutination, mechanism, Smith, R. G., 
1900, 1902—role of, in immunity, Smith, 
IR(Cta, UO, 

Agricere of soil, Smith, R. G., 1911. 

Agrionidae, Australian, dimorphism in 
females, Tillyard, 1907—n. sp., Tillyard, 
1906—n. sp., and rare, Tillyard, 1912. 

Agromyza phaseoli, n. sp., Coquillett, 
1899. 

Air, alveolar, change of composition after 
stoppage of normal breathing, Ward- 
law, 1916—alveolar, effect of suspended 
respiration on composition, Wardlaw, 
1922—expired alveolar, composition, 
Pinkerton, 1917—expired alveolar, per- 
centage of carbon dioxide in, Pinkerton, 
1917. 

“Air-gas” for bacteriological work, Katz, 
1889. 

Alcyone pulchra, nesting, North, 1888. 


Alder-flies, Australian, n. g. et n. sp., 
Tillyard, 1918. 

Aldrovanda vesiculosa, probable occur- 
rence in N.S.W., Mueller, 1889. 


Alga forming pseudomorph of a siliceous 
sponge, Lendenfeld, 1885. 


Algae, freshwater, Playfair, 1923—fresh- 
water, Lismore District, Playfair, 1915 
-_freshwater, n. sp., Playfair, 1918— 
marine, Australian, Lucas, A. H. S., 
1912, 1913, 1919—n. sp., Lucas, A. H. S., 
1919—marine, gases present in floats 
(vesicles), Lucas, A. H. §S., 1911— 
Siphonaceous, cytology and phylogeny, 
Williams, 1925. 

Alkaline, Petrographical Province, Hast- 
ern Australia, Jensen, 1908—rocks, dis- 
tribution, origin and _ relationships, 
Jensen, 1908. 

Alkaloid, new midriatic, Petrie, J. M., 
1907. 


40 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


Allantoplacenta, marsupial, phylogenetic 
significance, Flynn, 1922. 

Allopora, n. sp., Woods, 1882. 

Alsophila, N.S.W. species, Woolls, 1881. 

Amarygmides, Blackburn, 1892. 

Amarygmus, Blackburn, 1893. 

Amoeba parasitica, Lendenfeld, 1885. 

Amphibolurus muricatus, vestigial 
Muellerian ducts in full-grown male, 
Teh, df, IP, iWese. 

Amphinomidae, n. sp., Haswell, 1878. 


Amphipoda, Haswell, 1879—Australian, 
Haswell, 1885. 
Amphipods, n. sp., Australia and Tas- 


mania, Haswell, 1880. 
Amphisile, Palan Islands, Macleay, 1878. 
Amplexa, n. sp., Australia, Tate, 1881. 


Amycteridae, revision, Ferguson, 1909- 
1928—‘“Voyage de 1’Astrolabe”’, Fer- 
guson, 1911. 

Andesitic lavas, Canoblas near Orange, 
David, 1890. 

Andropogon, leaf anatomy, Breakwell, 
1914. 

Anerastrianae, Australian, revision, 
Turner, A. J., 1923. 

Angophora, n. sp., Baker, 1900—swub- 


velutina, Baker, 1893. 


Angophoras, and Hucalypts, oil ducts in 
certain, Welch, 1921—shoot-bearing 
tumours, Fletcher and Musson, 1918. 


Anguillaria dioica, statistical note on 
variations in flowers, Musson, 1898. 
Anisoptera, Australian, n. sp., Tillyard, 

1912. 

Annelides, marine, anatomy, with char- 
acteristics of Australian species, Has- 
well, 1884. 

Annelids, n. sp., Haswell, 1878—Tubi- 
colous, n. sp., Haswell, 1882. 


Annularia australis, structure, Htheridge, 
1890. 

Antechinus, 0. sp., Ramsay, 1887. 

Anthelidae, Turner, A. J., 1921. 

Anthicidae, Lea, 1922. 

Anthobosca, revision of Australian 
species and n..sp., Turner, R. H., 1907. 

Anthropological notes, Helms, 1895. 

Anticoma, Cobb, 1890. 

Apaustus lascivia, life-history, 
house, 1897. 

Aphantophryne, New Guinea, with notes 
on pectoral musculature, Fry, 1916. 
Aphritis, Ogilby, 1897. 
Aphrodita, segmental 

1882. 
Aphroditea, monograph, Haswell, 1882. 


Water- 


organs, Haswell, 


Aphrophoridae, larvae and larva-cases, 
Ratte, 1884. 
Apocynaceous plant, yielding edible 


tubers, Baker, 1899. 


Apogon roseigaster, Ramsay and Ogilby, 
1886. 

Apple (Pome), fibro-vascular system and 
its functions, McAlpine, 1911. 

Apseudes, n. sp., Haswell, 1881. 

“Aquatic respiration’ in freshwater 
turtles, Haswell, 1885. 

Arachnida, British New Guinea, Rain- 
bow, 1898—South Seas, Rainbow, 1901. 

Arachnidae, n. g. et n. sp., Bradley, 1875- 
76. 

Araneidae, N.S.W., n. sp., Rainbow, 1892- 
1902. 

Araneides, “Chevert” Expedition, Bradley, 
1875-1877. 

Arauja albens, Woods, 1879. 

Arcella, Queensland, seasonal distribu- 
tion, Gillies, 1918. 

Ardea pacifica, breeding-place, 
1882. 

Ardisia, 0. sp., Baker, 1902. 

Argasidae, n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1906. 

Argyria amoenalis, labial palpi, Philpott, 
1925. 

Argyrodes antipodiana, Rainbow, 1898. 


Arid and semi-arid N.S.W., vegetation, 
Collins, 1923, 1924. 

Artesian wells, Albert District, N.S.W., 
Wilkinson, 1881. 


Ascalaphidae, n. g. et n. sp., 
1916. 


Asilidae, Smith, V. I., 1923—catalogue of 
species of which earlier stages have 
been recorded, Smith, V. I., 1923— 
descriptions with synonyms and notes, 
Hardy, 1920. 

Asilinae, male genitalia, Hardy, 1920. 


Aspidites ramsayi, redescription, Waite, 
1894. 

Asplenium, n. sp., Bailey, 1879. 

Astacocroton, Haswell, 1922. 

Astele subcarinata, Brazier, 1893. 
Astralium, n. sp., New Britain, 
and Willey, 1896—Port 

Kesteven, 1902. 
Astur cruentus, Ramsay, 1878 


Atrypidae, N.S.W. and other States of 
Australia, Mitchell and Dun, 1920. 
Attunga District, Serpentine Belt, Ben- 

son, 1917. 
Austrogomphus, n. sp., Tillyard, 1905. 
Austrogynacantha, Tillyard, 1908. 
Austrosarepta, Hedley, 1899. 
Autolytidae, Australian, Haswell, 1920. 
Aves, Solomon Islands, Ramsay, 1879. 
Aviculopecten, n. sp., Myall Lakes, N.S.W.., 
Mitchell, 1924. 
Avifauna, Post-Tertiary, Queensland, De 
Vis, 1888. 
Axinellidae, 
mann, 1916. 


Bennett, 


Tillyard, 


Hedley 
Jackson, 


revision of genera, Hall- 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 41 


Azotobacter. chroococcum, fixation of 
nitrogen by, Smith, R. G., 1906. 

Bacilli, double staining, Smith, R. G., 
1900—lini, Smith, R. G., 1905. 

Bacillus, alatus, Smith, R. G., 1905— 
Atherstonii, Smith, R. G., 1905—coli 
group, permanency of characters, 
Smith, R. G., 1910—nhemiphloiae, Smith, 
R. G., 1915—indurans, Smith, R. G., 
1905—macrozamiae, Smith, R. G., 1904 
—of leprosy, Katz, 1889—prodigiosus, 
destruction of paraffin by, Smith, R. G., 
1914—pseudarabinus, Smith, R. G., 
1904, 1905—pseudarabinus, yellow race, 
from the quince, Smith, R. G., 1904. 


Bacteria, flocculation, Smith, R. G., 1900 
—-measurement, Smith, R. G., 1900— 
phosphorescent, Katz, 1887—phos- 
phorescent, from sea-water, Katz, 1887 
—putrefactive, origin of natural im- 
munity, Smith, R. G., 1905. 

Bacteriological observations made at 
Little Bay Coast Hospital, Katz, 1887. 

Bacteriotoxins, of soil, Smith, R. G., 
1911—thermolabile, in soil, presence, 
Smith, R. G., 1910. 

Bacterium, acaciae, nutrition, Smith, 
R. G., 1904—eucalypti, Smith, R. G., 
1902—gelatin-hardening, Smith, R. G., 
1905—new Levan gum-forming, Smith, 
R. G., 1915—pararabinum, Smith, R. G., 
1903—persicae, Smith, R. G., 1903— 
sacchari, Smith, R. G., 1902—sacchari, 
gum and byproducts, Smith, R. G., 
1903—variable Galactan, Smith, R. G., 
1904—vascularum, Smith, R. G., 1902. 

Baiera palmata, Ratte, 1887. 

Balanoglossus, Coast N.S.W., Hill, J. P., 
1893. 


Balmoral Beach, near Sydney, Liotia 
lodderae, Hedley, 1898. 
Bandicoot, cerebral localization, Chap- 


man, H. G., 1906. 

Barite (Barytes) in Hawkesbury Sand- 
stone, near Sydney, Smith, H. G., 1891. 

Bark, Ecbolic plant, New Caledonia, 
Dixson, 1882. 

“Barometro Araucano”, 
Maclay, 1883. 

Barrier District, plant ecology, 
1923. 

Barrier Reefs, Bougainville Straits, Solo- 
mon Group, mode of formation, Guppy, 
1884. 

“Basalt Masses”, botany, Barwick, 1903. 

Basalt soils, variable character of vege- 
tation, Jensen, 1909. 

Bassia, Anderson, 1923. 

Bassian Isthmus, effect upon existing 
marine fauna, Hedley, 1903. 

Bat, organ of Jacobson, Broom, 1895— 
Pteropine, n. g., Duke of York Island, 


Chiloe Islands, 


Collins, 


Ramsay, 1877—supposed n. sp., Stan- 
well, near Bulli, N.S.W., Ramsay, 1875- 
76. 


Bathurst, N.S.W., geology and _  petro- 
graphy, Curran, 1891. 
Batrachia, British New Guinea, Lucas, 


A. H. S., 1898—geographical distribu- 
tion, Fletcher, 1890-1897. 

Batrachians, “Chevert”’ Expedition, 
Macleay, 1877—n. sp., Queensland, De 
Vis, 1884—oviposition and habits, 
Fletcher, 1889. 

Batrachomyia, Skuse, 1889. 

Beef-fat, phosphorescent, Katz, 1888. 


Bees, Cockerell, 1912—Solomon Islands, 
Cockerell, 1911—Tasmania, Cockerell, 
1912. 


Beetle, Ground, n. sp., Victoria, Sloane, 
1901—Tiger, n. sp. Sloane, 1897; 
Northern Territory, Sloane, 1917; N.W. 
Australia, Sloane, 1914; Queensland, 
Sloane, 1893; W. Australia, Sloane, 
1900; Wyndham District, Sloane, 1921. 

Belideus, n. sp., Northern Queensland, 


De Vis, 1882. 
Bembidiides, Australian, Sloane, 1896. 
Bembidiini, Sloane, 1903, 1921. 


Beroid, Port Jackson, Lendenfeld, 1884. 


Berothidae, characters and relationships 
and new and little-known genera and 
species, Tillyard, 1916. 

Bibionidae, Skuse, 1888. : 

Biological Laboratory, Sydney University, 
jottings from, Haswell, 1885-1895. 

Bipalium Kewense, Fletcher, 1887. 

Bird, Census, second, Cleland, 1922— 
extinct, De Vis, 1891—Passerine, n. g. 
et n. sp., Fiji Islands, Ramsay, 1875-76. 

Birds, anatomy, Haswell, 1878-1879. 

Birds, Australian, Ramsay, 1879—eggs 
of two species, North, 1887—game, and 
other species which should be protected, 
Ramsay, 1875-76—“‘list of’, notes on, 
Ramsay, 1878—nests and eggs, North, 
1897-1898—rare eggs, Ramsay, 1877— 
tabular list of all at present known, 
showing distribution, Ramsay, 1877— 
brachial plexus, Haswell, 1878—breed- 
ing, N.S.W., Bennett, 1885—certain 
Australian, nests and eggs, North, 1887- 
1888—certain Australian, nidification, 
North, 1887—collected at Derby, N.W. 
Australia, Ramsay, 1887—collected at 
Roeburne, N.W. Australia, North, 1889 


—egegs, Australian, Ramsay, 1886— 
eggs, Australian, list of references to 
authentic descriptions, North, 1886— 


Fijian, eggs, Ramsay, 1882—Fiji, with 
list of all species known to inhabit 
Fiji Islands, Ramsay, 1875-76—found in 
County of Cumberland, N.S.W., North, 
1888—game, which have of late been 


42 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


offered for sale in Sydney, Ramsay, 
1875-76—Lord Howe and Norfolk 
Islands, Hull, 1909, 1910; Iredale, 1910 
—Mount Astrolabe and n. sp., Ramsay, 
1885—Mudgee District, Cox and Hamil- 
ton, 1889—n. sp., Austro-Malayan 
Region, Ramsay, 1884—n. sp., New 
Britain, New Ireland, Duke of York 
Island and S.E. Coast New Guinea, 
Ramsay, 1877—n. sp., Norman River, 
Gulf of Carpentaria, Castelnau and 
Ramsay, 1875-76—n. sp., Queensland, De 
Vis, 1882—n. sp., Solomon Islands, 
Ramsay, 1881, 1882—n. sp., S.E. Coast, 
New Guinea, Ramsay, 1879—n. sp., 
Torres Straits and New Guinea, etc., 
Ramsay, 1878—nerves, lumbar and 
sacral plexuses, Haswell, 1879—New 
Britain, New Ireland and Duke of York 
Island with remarks on zoology, 
Ramsay, 1875-76—New Hebrides, Ram- 
say, 1878—Port Darwin, Masters, 1877 
—Port Moresby, n. sp., Ramsay, 1875- 
76—Queensland, extinct, De Vis, 1891 
—rare Queensland, Ramsay, 1877—Sav- 
age Island, Tutuila, etc., Ramsay, 1877 
—sea, Lord Howe’s Island, eggs, Ram- 
say, 1887—Solomon Islands, Ramsay, 
1879, 1882—supposed n. sp., New Heb- 
rides, Ramsay, 1877—Western Austra- 
lian, collected at Derby and its vicinity, 
Ramsay, 1886. 


Birgus, Solomon Group, 
habit, Guppy, 1882. 


“Black Spot” disease in citrus fruit in 
N.S.W., cause, Smith, G. P. D., 1918. 


Blastoderms of fowl, method of pre- 
paring, Haswell, 1888. 


Blastoidea, N.S.W., first recorded occur- 
rence, Taylor, T. G., 1906. 


Blattidae, mostly Australasian, n. g. et 
nN. sp., and remarks on Tepper’s types, 
Shaw, 1925—new Australasian, with 
note on Blattid coxa, Shaw, 1922. 

Blattoidea, Tillyard, 1919. 

Blechnum serrulatum, Bancroft, 1894. 

Blood, chemistry, Grey, 1911—venous 
oxygen content and alkaline reserve, in 
pheumoniec influenza, Wardlaw, 1919. 

Blue Mountains, Eucalypts, Chisholm, 
1924—flora, Hamilton, A. A., 1915— 
land planarians, Dendy, 1894— 
Lycaenidae, n. sp., Olliff, 1885—District, 
geography, Andrews, 1903. 

Bolboceras, n. sp., Blackburn, 1904. 

Bolina Chuni, metamorphosis, Lenden- 
feld, 1884. 

Boltenias, Port Jackson, slimy coatings, 
Lendenfeld, 1884. 

Bombycidae, Turner, A. J., 1922. 

Bondi Anticline, Hedley, 1914. 


coconut-eating 


Bone breccia deposit, Wombeyan Caves, 
N.S.W., Broom, 1896. 


Bonellia, Australian species, Haswell, 
1885. : 

Boomerangs, Bulloo River, N.S.W., 
Etheridge, 1894—N.S.W., and Queens- 


land, Etheridge, 1896—North Queens- 
land, Etheridge, 1897, 1898. 


Borah Creek, New England, N.S.W., ore- 
deposits, Cotton, 1910. 

Boronia floribunda, Mueller, 1896. 

Bostrychidae, n. sp., Lea, 1893. 

Botanic Gardens, Sydney, notes from, 
Hamilton, A. A., 1920; Lucas, A. H. S., 
1916; Maiden and Betche, 1897-1913. 

Botanical and Soil Survey of N.S.W., 
need for, Cambage, 1925—notes, Maiden 


and Baker, 1893-1895; Woolls, 1886— 
notes, Queensland, Woods, 1882. 
Botany, Australian Hconomic, Maiden, 
1890-1891— Funafuti, Ellice Group, 
Maiden, 1904—Howell (Bora Creek), 
Maiden, 1906—Interior of N.S.W., 


Cambage, 1900-1902—Lord Howe Island, 
Maiden, 1914, 1920—taxonomic,  in- 
stability of leaf-morphology in relation 
to, Hamilton, A. A., 1916. 

Bovista, Cunningham, 1925. 

Bovistella, Cunningham, 1925. 

Bower-birds, Australia, North, 1886. 

Bowning, N.S.W., geology, Mitchell, 1886 
—trilobites, n. sp., Mitchell, 1887, 1888. 

Bowral Quarries, minerals and genesis of 
veins and schlieren traversing the 
Aegirine-Syenite in, Mawson, 1906. 

Brachalletes Palmeri, De Vis, 1883. 

Brachiopoda, Port Jackson and Coast of 
N.S.W., Brazier, 1879. 

Brachiopods, n. sp., Middle Palaeozoic 
Rocks, N.S.W., Mitchell, 1920. 

Brachycera, Diptera, Australian, life-his- 
tories, Smith, V. I., 1920-1923—prelim- 
inary revision of some genera, Hardy, 
1921. 

Brachychiton, hybridism, Mueller, 1884— 


populneo-acerifolius, Maiden, 1916. 
Brachymelis, Maclay, 1884. 
Brachyphyllum, Mesozoic Coal _ Beds, 


Ipswich, Queensland, Woods, 1882. 
Brachyscelidae, their parasites and n. sp., 
Froggatt, W. W., 1892-1898. 
Brachysoma triste, Ramsay, 1877. 
Brachyura, n. sp., Haswell, 
Oxyrhyncha, Haswell, 1879. 
Brain Lipoids, fatty acids, Grey, 1910. 
Bronteidae, Etheridge and Mitchell, 1917. 
Bronteus Partschi, Upper Silurian Rocks, 
N.S.W., Etheridge and Mitchell, 1890. 


US eil— 


Broscini, Sloane, 1915—n. sp., Sloane, 
1892. 
Bruchigavia longirostris, King George’s 


Sound, Masters, 1877. 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 43 


Buffalo-fly, bionomics, Hill, G. F., 1916. 

Bulimus, caledonicus, Brazier, 1880— 
Dufresnii, Woods, 1878—gunni, Brazier, 
1882—miltocheilus, Solomon Islands, 
Brazier, 1894—n. sp., New Caledonia, 
Brazier, 1881. 

Bungwall, Bancroft, 1894. 

Bunya, fructification, Norton, 1881, 1883. 

Buprestidae, Carter, 1912, 1923, 1925— 
n. g. et n. sp., Carter, 1920—n. sp., 
Carter, 1915. ; 

Buprestids, gall-making, Froggatt, W. W., 
1892. 

Butterflies, colour variation, Olliff, 1888 
—new forms, South Pacific, Water- 
house, 1920—Thursday Island, Mathew, 
1885. 

Buzzard, black-breasted, Bennett, 1881. 

Byblis gigantea, Hamilton, A. G., 1908. 

Cabbage Tree Creek, Port Hacking, man- 
grove and saltmarsh vegetation, Collins, 
1921. 

Cacatua gymnopis, habitat, North, 1894. 

Caecum amputatum, undescribed mollusc, 
Sydney Harbour, Hedley, 1893. 

Caenolestes, Broom, 1911. 

Calidris arenaria, Borneo, Seebohm, 1893. 

Calliostoma purpureocinctum, Hedley, 
1894. 

Callistemon, n. sp., Cheel, 1925. 

Callitris, n. sp., Baker, 1903. 

Calopterygidae, Tillyard, 1915. 

Calvaria, fossil, De Vis, 1883. 

Calymeneidae, Etheridge and Mitchell, 
UGA 

Camacinia Othello, Tillyard, 1910. 

Camden Haven District, N.S.W.., 
Tabanidae, n. sp., Ferguson and Henry, 
1919. 


Camels, diurnal variations in tempera- 
tures, Cleland, 1909. i 
Campephaga leucomelaena, nidification 
and description of eggs, Fitzgerald, 


IZ, IDs, diwiae, ableton 

Canals, secretory, occurrence in certain 
Myrtaceous plants, Welch, 1923. 

Candollea serrulata, fertilisation, Hamil- 
ton, A. G., 1894. 

Canis dingo, circumvolutions of cerebrum, 
Maclay, 1881—external parasites, Steel, 
1h, AIBA 

Canoblas, Mountains, geology, Sussmilch 
and Jensen, 1909—near Orange, ande- 
sitic lavas, David, 1890. 


Canons, Hastern Australia, Andrews, 
1906: 
Carabidae, Masters, 1885, 1895; Sloane, 


1889, 1890, 1896, 1897, 1900, 1902, 1904 
—Australian, Sloane, 1904-1921—Aus- 
tralian, which range beyond Australia 
and its dependent Islands, Sloane, 1920 
—Dorrigo, N.S.W., Sloane, 1910—endo- 


skeleton of head, anterior coxae and 
anterior coxal cavities, Sloane, 1917— 
n. g. et n. sp., Sloane, 1890, 1894, 1907, 
1915, 1923—n. g. et n. sp., W. Aus- 
tralia and synoptic table, Sloane, 1898 
—n. sp., Olliff, 1885; Sloane, 1889, 1892, 
1899, 1903, 1910, 1916—n. sp., Port 
Darwin, Macleay, 1877—revisional lists 
of genera and species and notes on 
synonymy, Sloane, 1903—Tasmania, 
Sloane, 1920—tropical Australia, n. g. 
et n. sp., synonymy, etc., Sloane, 1917 
—Upper Williams River, N.S.W., 
Sloane, 1916. 

Carabinae, Sloane, 1905. 

Carabini, Sloane, 1904. 

Carboniferous and Silurian fossils, Cen- 
tral N.S.W., Curran, 1888. 

Cardiothoraz, Carter, 1906. 

Carenides, Sloane, 1897, 
Sloane, 1888, 1893. 


Carenum, n. sp., W. Australia, synonymy 
and distribution of some previously 
described species, Sloane, 1891. 

Cassytha, physiology, McLuckie, 1924. 

Casuarina, Cunninghamiana, root 
nodules, McLuckie, 1923—n. sp., Baker, 
1899—stricta, on Narrabeen Shales, 
Cambage, 1905. 

“Cattanach Disinfectant and Deodorant”, 
Katz, 1888. 

Caves, Fiji, Sawyer and Andrews, 1901. 

Ceblepyris schisticeps, supposed adult, 
Ramsay, 1877. 

Cecidomyidae, n. sp., 
Skuse, 1887. 

Cedrela australis, Maiden, 1889. 

Cell, sigrificance of various parts, Has- 
well, 1893. 


Cement, bacteria 
Smith, R. G., 1901. 


Census, Muscorum Australiensium, Watts 


1900—n.  sp., 


infesting grass, 


and disintegration, 


and Whitelegge, 1902, 1905—second 
bird, Cleland, 1922. 
Central N.S.W., Carboniferous and 


Silurian fossils, Curran, 1888—leucite- 
basalt, Curran, 1887. 

Cephalotus follicularis, Hamilton, A. G., 
1904. 

Cerambycidae, Masters, 1886. 

Ceratella fusca, Brazier, 1886. 

Ceratodus, blood vessels, Spencer, 1892 
—structure of paired fins, Haswell, 
1882—-vertebrate limb, remarks on gen- 
eral theory, Haswell, 1882. 

Cerceris, revision of Australian species, 
Turner, R. H., 1911. 

Ceroplastes murrayi, n. sp., New Guinea, 
Froggatt, W. W., 1919. 

Cestode, Australian Caryophyllaeid, John- 
ston, T. H., 1924. 


44 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


Cestodes, Avian, n. sp., Johnston, T. H., 
1911—Cystic, Hill, J. P., 1894. 

Cestrinus, Blair, 1919. 

Cetoniidae, n. sp., Janson, 1889. 

Chaetosomatidae, n. gen. Coast of 
N.S.W., Smith, V. I., 1917—n. sp., 
Smith, V. I., 1917. 

Chalcopterus, Blackburn, 1892, 1893. 

Charopidae, Hedley, 1882. 

Cheiruridae, Etheridge and Mitchell, 1917. 

Chelodina longicollis, method adopted by 
female in excavation of burrows, 
McCooey, 1887. 


Chemical Notes, botanical and general, 
Steel, T., 1921-1922. 


“Chevert” Expedition, Araneides, Brad- 
ley, 1875-1877—Batrachians, Macleay, 
1877—Coleoptera, Macleay, 1875-76— 
Hehini, Woods, 1877—Ichthyology, 
Alleyne and Macleay, 1875-76—land 
shells, Brazier, 1875-76—land shells, 
nN. Sp., Brazier, 1875-76—lizards, 
Macleay, 1877—mammals, Ramsay, 
1877—marine shells, n. sp., Brazier, 
1875-1878—Ophidians, Macleay, 1877— 
Ornithology, Ramsay, 1878—Pleuro- 


tomidae, n. sp., Brazier, 1875-76— 
Pupina, mn. sp., Brazier, 1875-76— 
zoological collection made in Torres 


Straits and New Guinea, Macleay, 1875- 
76—Zoology, Ornithology, Masters, 
1875-76. 

Chicken-Cholera, experimental researches 
with microbes, Katz, 1889. 


Chillagoe District, N. Queensland, lizards, 
Broom, 1897. 


Chilodactylus, Port Jackson, Ramsay and 
Ogilby, 1886. 

Chimaera ogilbyi, 
Haswell, 1902. 

Chiromyzini, Australian, revision, Hardy, 
1924—revision, Hardy, 1920. 

Chironomidae, Skuse, 1889. 

Chlaeiini, Sloane, 1910. 


Chlamydosaurus Kingii, 
Vis, 1883. 

Chloraemidae, Haswell, 1891. 

Chloroform, retained by soil, stimulative 
action, Smith, R. G., 1915. 


Chorista australis, wing-venation, Till- 
yard, 1918. 
Chrysobothris, Carter, 1925. 
Chrysomelidae, Masters, 1887. 
Chrysopidae, wing-venation, 
1916. 
Cicada, “vocal organs’, Haswell, 1886. 
Cicadas, Froggatt, W. W., 1895. 
Cicadidae, monograph, Goding 
Froggatt, 1904—synonymical 
Distant, 1912. 


a Gyrocotyle from, 


myology, De 


Tillyard, 


and 
notes, 


Cicindela, n. sp., Tropical Australia, 
Sloane, 1905—n. sp., W. Australia, 
Sloane, 1913. 

Cicindelidae, Masters, 1885, 1895; Sloane, 
1904—Australia, revision, with supple- 
ments, Sloane, 1906, 1909—Australian, 
notes on recent works on, Sloane, 1921 
—endoskeleton of head, anterior coxae 
and anterior coxal cavities, Sloane, 
1917. 

Cinnamomum oliveri, oil of, Baker, 1897. 

Cinnamomums, Baker, 1897. 

Cisseis, Carter, 1923. 

Citrus trees, sooty mould, McAlpine, 1896. 

Civilisation, a century of, from a 
zoologist’s point of view, Froggatt, 
W. W., 1913. 

Cixiidae, n. g., Muir, 1922. 

Cladocera, Henry, 1922. 
Clarencetown-Paterson District, geology 
and petrography, Osborne, 1922-1925. 
Clathria, new genera of Monaxonid 
sponges related to, Hallmann, 1919. 

Clavicornia, Ceylonese, Olliff, 1885. 

“Clears”, botany of, Barwick, 1903. 

Clerodendron tomentosum, fertilisation, 
Hamilton, A. G., 1894. 

Climate, soil and culture, 
improvements effected by, 
sheep, Trebeck, 1884. 


Australian, 
on merino 


Clivina, revision, Australian species, 
Sloane, 1896. 

Clivinarchus, Sloane, 1896. 

Clivini, Sloane, 1904. 

Clivinides, Australian, Sloane, 1896— 


King’s Sound and its vicinity, Sloane, 
1896. 

Clivinini, Sloane, 1907. 

Clupeidae, Australia, Macleay, 1879. 

Clytocosmus, n. sp., Alexander, 1920. 

Cnodaloninae, Carter, 1913. 

Coal Measures, Australian, South African 
and Indian, attempt to synchronise, 
Stephens, W. J., 1889. 

Cobar District, N.S.W., indigenous plants, 
Haviland, F. E., 1911, 1913. 

Coccid, n. sp., Maskell, 1890—on fern- 
roots, n. sp., Maskell, 1893. 


Coccidae, gall-making, undescribed, Olliff, 
1892—n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1925; 
Green, 1900, 1904—n. sp., affecting 
sugar-cane in New Guinea, Rutherford, 
1916. 

Cockatoo, 
1894. 

Codiuwm tomentosum, cytology of game- 
tangia, Williams, 1925. 

Coleoptera, Carter, 1909; Grouvelle, 1907 
—Australia, Olliff, 1885-1890—Aus- 
tralia, catalogue of the described, 
Masters, 1885-1896—Australian, n. sp., 
Lea, 1894-1925—Ceylonese, Olliff, 1885 


naked-eyed, habitat, North, 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 45 


—‘Chevert” Expedition, Macleay, 1875- 
76—Geodephagous, n. sp., Tropical Aus- 
tralia, Sloane, 1904—life-histories, 
Froggatt, W. W., 1893-1895—New 
Guinea and nine Islands, catalogue, 
Masters, 1888—n. g. et n. sp., Barring- 
ton Tops, N.S.W., Carter, 1916—n. g. et 
n. sp., New Britain, Sharp, 1903—xn. sp., 
Blackburn, 1888-1894; Carter, 1905, 
1906, 1908, 1910, 19112, 1915, 1919, 1921, 
1922, 1924, 1925; Macleay, 1883—Upper 
Permian, and new order, Belmont Beds, 
N.S.W., Tillyard, 1924. 
Colina Brazieri, Tate, 1893. 


Collections, from S.H. portion New 
Guinea and Louisiades, Ramsay, 1879— 
Mr. Froggatt’s, made in vicinity of 
Derby, King’s Sound, N.W. Australia, 
Macleay, 1887. 

Colloids, influence of certain, upon fer- 
mentation, Smith, R. G., 1924-1925. 


Collyriocincla, n. sp., Cairns, Queensland, 
Ramsay, 1885. 


Colopterygidae, Australian, n. sp., Till- 
yard, 1907. 

Colpochila, n. sp., Blackburn, 1890. 

Columba livia domestica in Australia, 


nematode parasites, Smith, V. I., 1920. 


Columbidae, myological characters, Has- 
well, 1879. 
Colydiidae, Grouvelle, 1907. 


Comboyne Plateau, general conformation — 


and flora, Chisholm, 1925. 


“Common Nightshade’, Cheel, i917. 

Comparative anatomy, organ of Jacob- 
son, marsupials, Broom, 1896. 

Conchological notes, Hedley, 1894. 

Conchology, Cox,-1887. 

Cone, from Mauritius, n. sp., Brazier, 
1891—n. sp., Solomon Islands, Brazier, 
1895. 

Conifer, n. sp., Southern Queensland, 
\nylaniee, (C5 abe, al8)783. 

Conularia inornata, structure, Htheridge, 
1889. 

Copepod, Endoparasitic, origin of yolk in 
ova, Kesteven, 1918—n. sp., Endopara- 
sitic morphology and development, 
Kesteven, 1912. 

Copepoda, Henry, 1922. 


Copeton, N.S.W., diamond 
Cotton, 1914. 

Coptotermes raffrayi, Hill, G. F., 1921. 

Corals, Darnley Island, Woods, 187&8— 
extra-tropical, Australia, Woods, 1877 
—extra-tropical, n. sp., Woods, 1878— 
Madreporaria, n. g. et n. sp., Woods, 
1878. 

Cordania, Mitchell, 1924. 

Cordulephya, Tillyard, 1911. 


deposits, 


Corduliinae, Australian, rare and n. sp., 
Tillyard, 1911—remarkable Australian 
and n. sp., Tillyard, 1908. 

Coris, 0. sp., Ramsay and Ogilby, 1885— 
n. sp., Lord Howe’s Island and N.S.W., 
Ramsay, 1882—n. sp., New Hebrides, 
Ramsay and Ogilby, 1886. 

Cormorant, Campbell Island, 
1879. 

Correa, n. sp., N.S.W., Mueller, 1884. 

Correction of certain errors in previous 
papers, Ramsay and Ogilby, 1887. 

Corylophidae, Masters, 1887. 

Crabs, Sacculina infesting Australian, 
Haswell, 1888. 

Crambites, Meyrick, 1878-1879. 

Crayfishes, inter-coxal lobe, McKay, 1887. 

Crioceras australe, Ratte, 1886. 

Crocisa, n. sp., Cockerell, 1912. 

Croton, n. sp., N.S.W., Maiden and Baker, 
1894. 

Crowea exalata, Woolls, 1886. 

Cruise to Solomon Islands, Morton, 1882. 

Crustacea, British New Guinea, White- 
legge, 1898—Decapod, Norfolk Island, 
Grant and McCulloch, 1907—off Port 
Jackson, Grant, 1905—Port Curtis Dis- 
trict, Queensland, Grant and McCulloch, 
1906—Queensland Cretaceous, Hthe- 
ridge, 1892. 


Crustacean, Decapodous, n. sp., from the © 
Cretaceous of Queensland, Woodward, 
1892—n. sp., inhabiting tubes of Ver- 
milia, Haswell, 1884. 

Crustaceans, Amphipodous, n. g. et n. sp., 
Haswell, 1879. 

Cryptocarya, foetida, n. sp., Baker, 1905 
—n. sp., Lord Howe Island, Maiden, 
1902. 

Cryptodon flexuosus, Australia and Tas- 
mania, Brazier, 1894. 

Cryptogamic notes from Botanic Gardens, 
Sydney, Watts, 1916. 

Cryptophasa unipunctata, habits 
earlier stages, Hdwards, 1890. 

Cryptorhynchides, revision, Lea, 1897-1913. 

Ctenodax Wilkinsoni, Macleay, 1886. 

Cubicorrhynchus, Ferguson, 1916. 

Cucujidae of Australia, list with n. sp., 
Olliff, 1885. 

Cucurbitaceae, microscopic fungus para- 
sitic upon, Haviland, E., 1886. 

Culicidae, Skuse, 1888—Australian, Tay- 


Hutton, 


and 


lor, F. H., 1914-1918—in Macleay 
Museum, Sydney, revision, Taylor, 
1M, Ist, Igl33. 


Cuneipectini, Sloane, 1907, 1915. 

Curculionidae, Masters, 1886—Australian, 
revision of, belonging to subfamily 
Cryptorhynchides, Lea, 1897-1913— 
notes to accompany figures of Bois- 
duval’s types of six species, Lea, 1900. 


46 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


Currabubula District, geology, palaeon- 
tology and petrography, Benson, Dun 
and Browne, 1920. 

Cyanorhamphus, Cooki, Norfolk Island, 
North, 1893—rayneri, nesting place and 
eggs, North, 1892. 

Cycloseris sinensis, young stage, Woods, 
1878. 

Cynipidae, n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1892. 

Cyphaleinae, Carter, 1913—n. sp., Carter, 
1914. 

Cyphaspis, Etheridge and Mitchell, 1893. 

Cypraea, Cox, 1879—angustata, Beddome, 
1896—caput-anguis, Kenyon, 1896— 
citrina, Brazier, 1882—guttata, Hobson, 
1879—malformed, Brazier, 1881—More- 
ton Bay, Queensland, Brazier, 1880— 
n. sp., W. Australia, Kenyon, 1897— 
occurrence of callosities, Kenyon, 1896 


—Tasmania, Beddome, 1897—venusta, 
Cox, 1889. 

Cypraeidae, Coast of New Caledonia and 
Loyalty Islands, Rossiter, 1881—Vic- 
torian Coast, Brazier, 1882. 

Cystignathoid frogs, n. g., Boulenger, 
1890. 

Cystopelia, structure and systematic 


position, Hedley, 1890. 

Dacus, n. sp., Coquillett, 1908. 

Danais, chrysippus, Miskin, 1889—vpetilia, 
Miskin, 1889, 1890. 

Darling, The, N.S.W., botany, Turner, F., 
1903. 

Darwinia fascicularis, pollination, Brew- 
ster, 1915. 

Dasyurus viverrinus, corpus luteum, 
Sands, 1903—growth and atrophy of 
Graffian follicle, Sands, 1903. 

Death Adder, osteology and myology, 
McKay, 1889. 

Decapoda, n. sp., Haswell, 1881. 

Deformation, cranial, children at Island 
Mabiak and other islands, Torres 
Straits, and of women, New Guinea, 
Maclay, 1881. 

Deilephila lVivornica, Lower, 1898. 

Delphacidae, n. g., Muir, 1920. 

Dematium pullulans, Slime, Smith, R. G., 
19038. 

Dendrilla cavernosa, vestibule, 
feld, 1885. 


Dendrobium undulatum, new variety, 
Solomon Islands, Maiden, 1899. 

Dendrolagus bennettianus, Waite, 1894. 

Dendrophis, n. sp. Cleveland Bay, 
Macleay, 1875-76. 

Desert Basin, W. Australia, geology and 
geography, Clapp, 1925. 

Desmidiaceae, polymorphism and 
history, Playfair, 1910. 

Desmids, n. sp., N.S.W., Playfair, 1907— 
Sydney, Playfair, 1908. 


Lenden- 


life- 


Desmophyllum, n. sp., Woods, 1878— 
quinarium, Woods, 1878. 

Devonian and Carboniferous formations 
west of Tamworth, N.S.W., Cotton and 


Walkom, 1912. 


Diamond deposits, Copeton, N.S.W., 
Cotton, 1914. 

Diaseris, n. sp., Woods, 1880. 
Diatomaceous earth, Warrumbungle 
Mountains, N.S.W., David, 1895, 1896. 
Diatoms, Rolling Downs Formation, 
Queensland, Dun, Rands and David, 

1901. 
Didymorchis, inhabiting branchial 


cavities of New Zealand crayfishes, 
Haswell, 1900. 

Digaster sylwaticus, reproductive system, 
Brennan, 1899. 

Dingo, external parasites, Steel, T., 1919. 

Dinornis (?) queenslandiae, Hutton, 
1893. 

Diospyros, n. sp., and new variety, Hiern, 
P9210. 

Dipeltis, Cobb, 1891. 

Diphlebia lestoides, life-history, Tillyard, 
1909—n. sp., and life-histories, Tillyard, 
1911. 

Diphucephala, Macleay, 1886. 

Diplocrepis, n. sp., Port Jackson, Ogilby, 
1885. 

Diplomorpha, n. sp., Hartman, 1891. 


Dipodium punctatum, mycorhiza, 
McLuckie, 1922. 
Diptera, Hardy, 1920-1925—A ustralia, 


Skuse, 1888-1890—Australian, Malloch, 
1923-1925—Brachycera, Australian, life- 
histories, Smith, V. I., 1920-1923— 
Brachycera, preliminary revision of 
some genera, Hardy, 1921—found in 
association with termites, Hill, G. F., 
1921—n. sp., W. Australia, Coquillett, 
1900. 

Distichopora, n. sp., Woods, 1879. 

Distomum, n. sp., from Platypus, John- 
ston, S. J., 1901—n. sp., from Saw-fish 
Shark, Johnston, S. J., 1902. 

Dodonaea, Woolls, 1890. 


Dog-fish, muscles of pectoral fin, Murray, 
1924—unusual type of secreting epi- 
thelium in Wolffian duct, Murray, 1925. 

“Doigtier’, New Caledonia, New Hebrides 
and other Pacific Islands, Etheridge, 
1899. 

Dorcopsis, chalmersii, New Guinea, 
Maclay, 1884—n. sp., South Coast, New 
Guinea, Maclay, 1885. 

Doris arbutus, Read, 1879. 

Dorylaimus, Cobb, 1891. 


Doryphora sassafras, chemistry, Petrie, 
J. M., 1912. 
Dragonflies, Anisopterid, physiology of 


rectal gills in larvae, Tillyard, 1915— 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. : 47 


Central Australia and n. sp., Tillyard, 
1907—n. sp., Australia and Tasmania, 
Tillyard, 1917—South-western Aus- 
tralia, Tillyard, 1907—Zygopterid, 
morphology of caudal gills of larvae, 
Tillyard, 1917—Zygopterous, develop- 
ment of wing-venation, Tillyard, 1915. 

Dragonfly larvae, emergence from egg, 
with special reference to problem of 
respiration, Tillyard, 1916—some ex- 
periments with, Tillyard, 1910. 

Drainage, marginal, a study, Hedley, 
1911—-sub-surface, Aurousseau, 1919. 

Dromaeus novae-hollandiae, early stages 
in development, Haswell, 1887. 

Dubbo, N.S.W., fossil plants, 
1884—geology, Curran, 1885. 

Duboisia Leichhardtii, alkaloids, Petrie, 
Jo IMI, USI, 

Duboisias, chemistry, Petrie, J. M., 1917. 

Ducks, certain Australian, tracheae, 
Ramsay, 1878. 

Duckweeds, Woolls, 1888. 

Dules, n. sp., New Guinea, Ramsay and 
Ogilby, 1887. 

Dunstaniidae, Tillyard, 1918. 

Dysticidae, Masters, 1885. 

Hagle, extinct, De Vis, 1891. 

HKarthworms, Fletcher, 1886-1889—Poly- 
cercus, a proliferating cystic parasite 
of, Haswell and Hill, 1893. 

Hast Coast Range, near Rockingham Bay, 
natural history, Ramsay, 1875-76. 

Hast Moreton and Wide Bay Districts, 
Queensland, geology of volcanic area, 
Jensen, 1906. 


Curran, 


Hebolic plant, bark, New Caledonia, 
Dixson, 1882. 

Echidna, aculeata, temperature, Ward- 
law, 1915, 1918—histriz, low blood- 
temperature, Maclay, 1885—hystriz, 
temperature of body, Maclay, 1883— 
hitherto undescribed character of 


nasal septum, Wilson, 1894—period of 
gestation, Broom, 1895—with eight 

cervical vertebrae, Broom, 1900. 

Echinaxia, Hallmann, 1917. 

Hchini, Australia, Woods, 1877—Aus- 
tralian, habits, Woods, 1880—Austra- 
lian, n. sp., Woods, 1879—‘“‘Chevert’”’ 
Expedition, Woods, 1877. 

Echinocarpus australis, gum in, Maiden, 
1891. 

Hehinodermata, Bell, 1884. 

EHdoliosoma, New Ireland, Ramsay, 1877. 

Edriophthalmata, Chilton, 1884. 

Hel, Australian, n. sp., Ogilby, 1894. 

Hgg white, hexone bases, Chapman and 
Petrie, 1909. 

Elachistidae, Meyrick, 1897. 

Hiaeocarpus, n. sp., Northern 
Maiden and BIR, 1895. 


N.S.W., 


Elasmobranch skeleton, Haswell, 1884. 

Eleotrinae, Ogilby, 1896, 1897. 

EHlonichthys, n. sp., Newcastle 
Measures, Mitchell, 1924. 


Coal 


Elsmore-Tingha District,  tin-deposits, 
Cotton, 1909. 

Hmu, early stages in development, 
Haswell, 1887. 

Encrinuridae, Etheridge and Mitchell, 
1915. 


Encrinurus, Mitchell, 1924. 

Enteropneusta, n. sp., Coast N.S.W., Hill, 
Je Py L894 sob: 

Entomology, Australian, Sloane, 1889- 
1923—New Ireland, Macleay, 1875-76. 
Entomostraca, breeding from dried mud, 
Henry, 1924—collected in vicinity of 
Auckland, New Zealand, Henry, 1924— 
freshwater, monograph, Henry, 1922- 
1924—habits in aquaria, Henry, 1924. 

Entozoa, Johnston, S. J., 1901-1904—of 
Monotremata and Australian Mar- 
supialia, Johnston, T. H., 1909, 1911. 

EHopsaltria, n. sp., Rockingham Bay Dis- 
trict, Ramsay, 1877. 

Epacridaceae, Brough, 1924. 

Epimachus, n. sp., Astrolabe Range, S.E. 
New Guinea, Ramsay, 1887. 

Equisetum, Hawkesbury 
Htheridge, 1890. 

Eremosphaera, Playfair, 1916. 

Hriochloa, n. sp., Hawkesbury River, 
Hamilton, A. A., 1912. 

EHriophyes, associated with malformation 
of leaves of Hucalypius stricta, Gurney, 
1924. 

Hrythrophloeum Laboucherii, active prin- 
ciple, Petrie, J. M., 1921. 

Ethnology, Papuan, stray notes, Hedley, 
1895, 1897. 

Hthon, Carter, 1923. 

Ettingshausen’s theory, Tertiary Cosmo- 
politan flora, Deane, 1900. 

Hucalypt hybrid, Maiden, 1916. 


Kucalypti, decay of certain species, 
Bennett, 1885—Phasmatidae destructive 
to, Macleay, 1881. 

EKucalypts, and Angophoras, oil ducts in 
certain, Welch, 1921—and lLoranths, 
Fletcher, 1896—Blue Mountains, Chis- 
holm, 1924; Maiden and Cambage, 1905 
—classification, Woolls, 1891—County 
of Cumberland, classification, habitat 
and uses, Woolls, 1880—evolution, in 
relation to cotyledons and seedlings, 
Hall, E. C., 1914—examination of Kinos 
as an aid in diagnosis, Maiden, 1889- 
1891—n. sp., Parramatta, Hall, E. C., 
1912—N.S.W., Deane and Maiden, 1895- 
19801—oil glands in barks of certain, 
Welch, 1922—Rylstone District, Baker, 


Sandstone, 


1903—shoot-bearing tumours, Fletcher Pe 


48 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


and Musson, 1918—species first known 
in Europe, Woolls, 1882—supposed 
hybridisation, Deane and Maiden, 1901. 


Eucalyptus, Baueriana, Maiden, 1902— 
bicolor, Maiden, 1902—calycogona, 
Maiden, 1902—colouration of young 


foliage, Maiden, 1919—Gunnii, Maiden, 


1901—hybridisation, Maiden, 1905— 
leucoxylon, Woolls, 1886—Maideni, 
Southern N.S.W., Mueller, 1889— 


melanophloia, Baker, 1902—miscellane- 
ous notes (chiefly taxonomic), Maiden, 
1904-1905—n. sp., Baker, 1898, 1899, 
1900, 1906; Deane and Maiden, 1901; 
Hall, H. C., 1918; Maiden, 1904—n. sp., 
Monaro District, N.S.W., Cambage, 
1909—n. sp., Northern N.S.W., Maiden, 
1905—n. sp., Sydney District, Deane 
and Maiden, 1897—oleosa, water from 
roots, Steel, T., 1919—polyanthemos, 
Maiden, 1902—propinqua, Deane and 
Maiden, 1895—pulverulenta, Maiden, 
1901—roots, water from, Bennett, 1883 
—stricta, Hriophyes associated with 
malformation of leaves, Gurney, 1924 
—stricta, red pigment induced by in- 
sect injury, Petrie, J. M., 1924— 
Sturtiana, Maiden, 1901—Stuartiana, 
gum (levan) bacterium from a sacchar- 
ine exudate, Smith, R. G., 1902—under 
cultivation, variability, Maiden, 1903. 

Huomides, Ferguson, 1923. 

EHuploea, Australian, n. sp., revision with 
synonymiec notes, Miskin, 1889. 

Hupomatia laurina, fertilisation, Hamil- 
ton, A. G., 1897. 

EHupomatus elegans, embryology, Haswell, 
1887. 

Hupterotidae, Turner, A. J., 1922. 

Hurystopodus, n. sp., Ramsay, 1881. 

Hustheniidae, revision, with n. g. et n. sp., 
Tillyard, 1921. 

‘Husyllidae, Australian, Haswell, 1920. 

Huthera, n. sp., Australia, Africa and 
South America, Bezzi, 1925. 

Evening Glow, Lendenfeld, 1884. 

Hatatosoma, n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1922. 

Falcinellus igneus, breeding, Bennett, 
1889. 

Fat-solvents, upon sewage-sick 
action, Smith, R. G., 1912. 

Favosites, n. sp., Yass District, N.S.W., 
Walkom, 1911. 

Fauna, Arachnidan, Australia, Rainbow, 
1896—Arachnidan, British New Guinea, 
Rainbow, 1898—Araneidan, Santa Cruz, 
Rainbow, 1899—Australian Crustacean, 
Stead, 1898 - 1899 — Bellenden - Ker 
Ranges, Ramsay, 1888—British New 
Guinea, Lucas, A. H. S., 1898; Ogilby, 
1898; Rainbow, 1898; Steel, T., 1898; 
Whitelegge, 1898—British New Guinea, 


soils, 


Mollusca, Hedley, 1898—British New 
Guinea, Oligochaeta, Fletcher, 1898— 
Echinoderm, New Zealand, Farquhar, 
1898—entomological, Nauru Island of 
Ocean Island Group, Froggatt, W. W., 
1910—fish, New Guinea, Ramsay and 
Ogilby, 1886—Insect, Upper Triassic of 
Ipswich, Queensland, Tillyard, 1923— 
Land Molluscan, British New Guinea, 
Hedley, 1891, 1894—1littoral marine, 
north-east Australia, Woods, 1880— 
Lord Howe Island, Ogilby, 1898. 
Faunas, Southern, theoretical explana- 
tions of distribution, Hutton, 1896. 


Ferns, Lord Howe Island, Watts, 1912, 
1914—Mount Wilson, Trebeck, 1886— 
North Queensland, Watts, 1914— 


Queensland, Bailey, 1878—Queensland, 
n. sp., Bailey, 1880. 

Feronini, Sloane, 1902. 

Fibres, muscle, simple striated, Haswell, 
1888. 

Fiddler with abnormal pectoral fins, Hill, 
Vs Je, 1895. 

Fiji, continental origin, Woolnough, 1903 
—geology of Viti Levu, Woolnough, 
1907—petrographical descriptions of 
typical rocks, Woolnough, 1903. 

Fire-fly, Mt. Wilson, Olliff, 1889. 

Fish, Deep-sea, n. g. et n. sp., Lord Howe 
Island, Ogilby, 1888—disease from 
George’s River, Smith, R. G., 1900— 
Ganoid, Queensland, Castelnau, 1878— 
Labroid, n. sp., Port Jackson, Ramsay, 
1881—Labroid, n. g. et n. sp., Port 
Jackson, Ramsay and Ogilby, 1887— 
Lord Howe Island, Macleay, 1885—new 
Bacillus pathogenic to, Smith, R. G., 
1900. 

Fisheries of Oriental 
1888. 

Fish-remains, “Rolling Downs Forma- 
tion’, N. Queensland, Etheridge, 1888. 


Fishes, Australia, Macleay, 1880-1881, 
1884—Australian, McCulloch, 1915, 1921 
—Australian, new family, Ogilby, 1896 
—Australian, new Gyrodactyloid 
Trematodes from, Johnston and Tiegs, 
1922—Australian, notes on _ genera, 
Ramsay and Ogilby, 1887—Australian, 
n. sp., Ogilby, 1897; Ramsay, 1880, 1883; 
Ramsay and Ogilby, 1885-1888—Burde- 
kin and Mary Rivers, Queensland, 
Macleay, 1883—deep-sea, eyes, Lenden- 
feld, 1884—freshwater, chiefly Austra- 
lian, n. sp., Castelnau, 1878—new and 
rare, from Maroubra, N.S.W., Waite, 
1894—New Guinea, Macleay, 1882-1883 
—Norfolk Island, Ogilby, 1887—Norman 
River, Castelnau, 1878—n. g. et n. Sp., 
De Vis, 1883; Ogilby, 1897, 1898—n. g., 
Port Jackson, BLEKCTISEDY, 1883—n. g. et 


Region, Woods, 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 49 


n. sp., Australia, Ogilby, 1895-1897— 
n. g. et n. sp., Maroubra Bay, Ogilby, 
1896—n. sp., Castelnau, 1877; De Vis, 
1884; Macleay, 1884; Ramsay and 
Ogilby, 1886—n. sp. Australasian 
region, Ogilby, 1894—n. sp., Port Jack- 
son, Ogilby, 1885; Ramsay and Ogilby, 
1885, 1887—n. sp., Port Jackson and 
King George’s Sound, Macleay, 1878— 
n. sp., Queensland, De Vis, 1882—n. sp., 
Upper Murrumbidgee, Macleay, 1885— 
n. sp., well-known in Sydney Market, 
Macleay, 1880—Palmer River, N. Queens- 


land, Macleay, 1882—Port Darwin, 
Macleay, 1877—rare Port Jackson, 
Ogilby, 1885—salinity of inshore 


oceanic waters in relation to, Phillipps 
and Grigg, 1925—Solomon Islands, 
Macleay, 1879—South Sea Islands, De 
Vis, 1883—taken in or near Port Jack- 
son, Macleay, 1882. 

Flabellum, n. sp., Woods, 1880. 

Flagellates, Australian, freshwater, Play- 
fair, 1921. 

Flat-worm, parasitic in 
Haswell, 1890. 

Flight, Lendenfeld, 1885. 

Flindersia, White, C. T., 1921. 

Floods, geographical significance, 
Andrews, 1907. 

Flora, Australia, knowledge, Baker, 1897- 
1906—Australia, two additional plants, 
occurring also in N.S.W., Mueller, 1887 


golden frog, 


—Australian, distribution of hydro- 
cyanic acid in, Petrie, J. M., 1912— 
bacterial, of Sydney Water Supply, 
Smith, R. G., 1900—Blue Mountains, 
topographical and ecological notes, 
Hamilton, iA tA 1915—Brisbane, 
- Bailey and Tenison-Woods, 1879— 
Brisbane, relations, Woods, 1879— 


forest, interior N.S.W., recent changes, 
Lendenfeld, 1885—fossil, Coal Deposits 
of Australia, Woods, 1883—fossil, Hast- 
ern Australia, Etheridge, 1888—Mount 
Wilson, Brough, McLuckie and Petrie, 
1924: Hamilton, A. G., 1899; Woolls, 
1887—Mount Wilson, ecological study, 
Petrie, A. H. K., 1925—native, N.S.W., 
Cambage, 1904-1918—N.S.W., Blakely, 
1925—Norfolk Island, Maiden, 1903— 


Queensland, Scortechini, 1883—South 
Queensland, Scortechini, 1881—Strad- 
broke Island, n. sp., Bailey, 1881— 


Tertiary, Deane, 1900—Tropical Queens- 
land, Bailey, 1877. 

Floras, Norfolk and Lord Howe Islands, 
geographical relations, Tate, 1892. 

Florideae of Australia, revised 
Lueas, A. H. S., 1909. 

Flowers, double, Woolls, 1885—nectar, 
Steel, T., 1924. ; 
D 


list, 


Flycatcher, n. sp., De Vis, 1895. 

Foraminifera, Goddard and Jensen, 1907; 
Jensen, 1904. 

Forestry, Deane, 1896. 

Formicidae, Mackay, Queensland, Turner, 
G., 1897. 

Fossarina petterdi, Hutton, 1882. 


Fossil, Devonian, allied to Worthenia, 
N.S.W., Ratte, 1885—Labyrinthodont, 
Cockatoo Island, Port Jackson, 


Stephens, W. J., 1886—Lower Cretace- 
ous, Queensland, Ratte, 1886—plants, 
Australia, Deane, 1896—plants, Dubbo, 
N.S.W., Curran, 1884. 

Fossiliferous bed at mouth of Endeavour 
River, Woods, 1880. 


Fossils, additional Labyrinthodont from 
Hawkesbury sandstones, N.S.W., 
Stephens, W. J., 1886, 1887—Australian, 
Ratte, 1886, 1887—Levuka, Viti, Woods, 
1879—Mesozoic, Central Australia, 
Woods, 1883—occurrence in  unre- 
corded localities in N.S.W., Mitchell, 
1892—Permo-Carboniferous age, North- 
western Australia, Etheridge, 1889— 
Post-Tertiary, New Caledonia, Woods, 


1879—Tertiary, Hutton, 1886; Woods, 
1879—Tertiary, Hall Sound, New 
Guinea, Tate, 1894—Tertiary, Muddy 


Creek, Western Victoria, Woods, 1878 
—Tertiary, New Guinea, Woods, 1877 
—vegetable, Newstead, near Inverell, 
Wilkinson, 1886. 


Freshwater, Mollusca, n. sp., Maclay Coast 
and Triton Bay, New Guinea, Brazier, 
1885—shells, Australian and  Tas- 
manian, Brazier, 1875-76—shells, n. sp., 
New Guinea and W. Australia, Ancey, 
1897. 

Frog, Cystignathoid, n. 
1891, 1893. 

Frogs’ eggs, pigmentation, Harrison, 1921. 

Frogs, Trematode parasites of Australian, 
Johnston, S. J., 1912. 

Fruit-flies, n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1910. 

Fruit-fly, n. sp., N.S.W., Coquillett, 1908. 

Fucaceae, Williams, 1923. 

Fucoideae of Australia, 
Lueas, A. H. S., 1909. 


Fungi, Cleland and Cheel, 1916—algal, 


sp., Fletcher, 


revised list, 


Playfair, 1915—aliquot Australiae 
Orientalis, Kalchbrenner, 1882—Aus- 
tralian, n. sp., McAlpine, 1896, 1902- 
1904—Kerguelen Island, McAlpine, 


1899—n. sp., Kalchbrenner, 1882, 1883 
—n. sp., N.S.W., McAlpine, 1896, 1899— 
N.S.W., McAlpine, 1897, N.S.W., and 
Queensland, Woods and Bailey, 1880— 
phosphorescent, McAlpine, 1900—‘‘shot- 
hole”, of stone-fruit trees, McAlpine, 
1901. 


50 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


Fungus, microscopic, parasitic 
Cucurbitaceae, Haviland, H., 1886. 


upon 


Galaxvias, found in Australian Alps, 
Macleay, 1882—n. sp., Mount Wilson, 
and distribution, Macleay, 1880— 


Mount Kosciusko, Ogilby, 1896. 

Galeocerdo Rayneri, Ramsay, 1880—brain, 
Haswell, 1882. 

Galerucides, Lea, 1923. 

Gall-thrips, n. sp., Karny, 1922. 

Ganoid fish, Queensland, Castelnau, 1878. 

Gasteromycetes, Australasia, Cunning- 
ham, 1925. 

Gasteropod, n. sp., Lower Marine Series, 
N.S.W., Mitchell, 1922. 

Gasteropoda, Port Jackson, Protoconchs, 
Kesteven, 1901. 

Gastrodia sesamoides, 
physiology, McLuckie, 

Geckos, De Vis, 1886. 

Gelechiadae, Meyrick, 1904. 


Geographical notes in Malaysia and Asia, 
Woods, 1888. 


Geography, study 
1892, 1903. 


Geological history, Australia and New 
Zealand, David, 1894—specimens from 
coasts New Guinea, Cape York and 
neighbouring Islands, Wilkinson, 1875- 
76. 

Geology, and physical geography of State 
of Perak, Woods, 1884—and physical 
structure of Australia, Woods, 1882— 
Bowning, N.S.W., Mitchell, 1886— 
Canoblas Mountains, Sussmilch and 
Jensen, 1909—Fiji, Woolnough, 1903— 
general, Marulan and Tallong, N.S.W., 
Woolnough, 1909—New Hebrides, 
Mawson, 1905—North-west coast of Tas- 
mania, Stephens, T., 1908—southern 
portion of Clarence River Basin, 
Stephens, W. J., 18883—Viti Levu, Fiji, 
Woolnough, 1907—Western Coalfield, 
Stephens, W. J., 1882. 


Gerygone, n. sp., Ramsay, 


Woolls, 
1923. 


1892— 


in ancient, Hedley, 


US7G, Us 


n. sp., Lord Howe’s Island, Ramsay, 
1887. 
Gesneraceae, Australia, Woolls, 1881. 


Glacial, action, Kosciusko, David, 1908; 
David, Helms and Pittman, 1901— 
epoch, supposed, in Australia, Hutton, 
1885—erratics, Ulladulla, N.S.W., 
Brown, 1925—period in Australia, 
Lendenfeld, 1885—period, New JZea- 
land, Lendenfeld, 1884. 

Glaciation in Australian Alps, 
evidences, Stirling, 1886. 

Glacier action, Mount Kosciusko Plateau, 
Curran, 1897; Helms, 1893. 

Glass House Mountains and District, 
geology, Jensen, 1903. 


further 


Glendonbrook District, near Singleton, 
N.S.W., geology of Permo-Carbonifer- 
ous system, Walkom, 1913. 

Glendonite, recently discovered occur- 
rences, Walkom, 1913. 

Glendonites, Ulladulla, 
1925. 

Globin and globin sulphate from ox- 
blood, Grey, 1911. 

Glossopteris, fructification, Mitchell, 1892 
—Greta Coal Measures, Richmond Vale, 
David, 1890—mode of attachment of 
leaves or fronds to caudex, Etheridge 
and David, 1894—relation to its allies, 
Etheridge and David, 1894—stratigraphi- 
cal distribution in Australasia, 
Htheridge and David, 1894. 

Glossy Ibis, breeding, Bennett, 1889. 

Gneissic and granite rocks, W. Austra- 
lian, Aurousseau, 1916. 

Gobiesox, n. sp., Tasmania, Ramsay, 1882. 

Golden frog, flat-worm parasitic in, 
Haswell, 1890. 

Gomphinae, rare Australian, and n. sp., 
Tillyard, 1909. 

Goodenia, cycloptera, pollination, Havi- 
land, F. E., 1914—fertilisation, Havi- 
land, E., 1885—nhederacea, fertilisation, 
Hamilton, A. G., 1885. 

Goodeniaceae, methods of fertilisation, 
Hamilton, A. G., 1894-1895. 

Goonoo Goonoo Estate, geology of portion, 
Benson and Chapman, 1918. 

Goshawk, Port Moresby, Ramsay, 1878. 

Goulburn River District, botany, Baker, 
1896. 

Gramineae, Andropogon, 
Breakwell, 1914. 


Grammatophora, development and struc- 
ture of pineal eye, McKay, 1888. 

Grass, Australian, n. sp., Turner F., 1898 
—n. g., new smut in, McAlpine, 1911. 

Grass-trees, entomology, Froggatt, W. W.., 
1896. 

Grasses, certain Australian, nutritive 
value, O’Dwyer, 1921, 1922—N.S.W., 
hydrocyanic acid in, Petrie, J. M., 1913 
—protein precipitation, O’Dwyer, 1922 
—xerophitic native, anatomical struc- 
ture, Breakwell, 1915. 

Green Point, Watson’s Bay, Sydney, 
Mollusca, Henn and Brazier, 1894. 

Grevillea, natural hybridism, Fletcher, 
1913. 

Grey Gum, North Coast Districts, Deane 
and Maiden, 1895. 

Grey Range and neighbourhood, botani- 
cal features, Collins, 1924. 


N.S.W., Brown, 


leaf anatomy, 


Grifithides convexicaudatus, Mitchell, 
1922. 
Gull, n. sp. King George’s Sound, 


Masters, 1877. 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 51 


Gum, Grass-tree, Maiden 1890—Levan, 
bacterial, chemical properties, Steel, T., 
1901—Panax, Maiden, 1892. 

Gums of Arabin Group, bacterial origin, 
Smith, R. G., 1902-1904. 

Gundlachia, Australasian, Hedley, 1893. 

Guyra Lagoon, N.S.W., Cotton, 1909. 

Gypoictinia melanostemon, Bennett, 1881. 

Gyrocotyle, from Chimaera ogilbyi, and 
in general, Haswell, 1902. 

Gyrodactyloidea, reclassification, 
ston and Tiegs, 1922. 

Haematozoa of Australian Reptilia, John- 
ston, T. H., 1910-1911. 

Haemogregarines from Australian Rep- 
tiles, Johnston, T. H., 1909. 

Hakea, dactyloides, xerophilous char- 
acters, Hamilton, A. G., 1914—n. sp., 
eastern N.S.W., Mueller and Maiden, 
1892—-saligna, possible relationship 
between bacteria and gum, Smith, R. G., 
1905. 

Halcyon sordidus, nesting-place and eggs, 
North, 1892. 

Halicore australis, brain, Maclay, 1885. 

Halmaturus, n. sp., New Ireland, Ramsay, 
1875-76. 

Halme tingens, Lendenfeld, 1885. 

Haloragis, N.S.W., Mueller, 1885. 

Halorrhagaceae, review of N.S.W. species 
and n. sp., Maiden and Betche, 1906. 

Hapalotis Boweri, North-west Australia, 
Ramsay, 1886. 

Haplonycha, Blackburn, 1890. 

Harpalini, Sloane, 1915, 1917. 

Harpeidae, Etheridge and Mitchell, 1917. 

Hawkesbury River, Hriochloa, n. sp., 
Hamilton, A. A., 1912. 

Helaeides, Macleay, 1887. 

Helaeus, Carter, 1910. 

Helix, aspera in Australia, Steel, T., 1924 
—gulosa, synonymy, Brazier, 1891— 
n. sp., Louisiade Archipelago, Cox, 1879 
—n. sp., New Guinea and Louisiade 
Islands, Brazier, 1877—n. sp., South 
Australia, Tate, 1877. 

Helluonini, Sloane, 1917. 

Hemerobiidae, characters and relation- 
ships and new and little-known genera 
and species, Tillyard, 1916. 

Hemerocetes, n. sp., Port Jackson, Ram- 


John- 


say, 1881. 

Hemiptera, Tillyard, 1918, 1919, 1921— 
Fiji, catalogue, Kirkaldy, 1908— 
Hawaiian Islands, Blackburn, 1888— 
Heteropterous, Hastern Australia, 


memoir on a few, Kirkaldy, 1907—n. 
sp., Hale, 1924; Tillyard, 1923—Upper 
Permian, Newcastle, N.S.W., Tillyard, 
1921. 
Hepaticae, Carrington and Pearson, 1887. 
Hepatics, N.S.W., Watts, 1901, 1902, 1904. 


Heptanchus, claspers, Haswell, 1884. 
Herpetology, Queensland, De Vis, 1887. 
Heteroceridae, Masters, 1885. 
Heterodendron, hydrocyanic acid, Petrie, 
Vs Wile, ILOZAO. 
Heterodontus 
Haswell, 1897. 


phillipi, development, 


Heteromera, n. sp., Tropical Australia, 
Carter, 1917. 
Heteromyias cinereifrons, nidification, 


North, 1889. 

Heteronympha, n. sp., Waterhouse, 1904— 
N.S.W., Waterhouse, 1897. 

Heteronyxz, nu. sp., Blackburn, 1888-1889. 

Heteropsammia Michelinii, Woods, 1879. 

Heteroptera, with a note on origin, Till- 
yard, 1918. 

Heteropus, n. sp., found in wasps’ nests, 
Froggatt, W. W., 1894. 

Heterostoma, voracity of a 
Whittell, 1883. 

Hexone, Bases, egg white, Chapman and 
Petrie, 1909. 

Hinulia, development and structure of 
pineal eye, McKay, 1888—elegans, 
Fletcher, 1883. 

Hipponoe variegata, new variety, Woods, 
1882. 

Hircinidae, Australian, fibres, Lendenfeld, 
1884. 

Hirudinea, Goddard, 1908-1910—distribu- 
tion and zoogeography, Goddard, 1910 
—leech-metamerism, Goddard, 1910— 
parasitic Endoproctous Polyzoon, 
Goddard, 1909. 

Hispidae, n. g. 
Sharp, 1903. 

Histiophorus gladius, Ramsay, 1880. 

Histological methods, adaptation to 

« teaching of Practical Histology, 
Haswell, 1885. 

Holostomidae from Australian birds, 
Johnston, S. J., 1904. 

Homocoela, Lendenfeld, 1884. 

Homodermidae, Lendenfeld, 1884. 

Homoptera, Tillyard, 1921—Delphacidae, 


species, 


et n. sp., New Britain, 


n. g., Muir, 1920—with a note on 
phylogeny, Tillyard, 15198. 

Honey-eater, n. sp., S.E. Coast, New 
Guinea, Ramsay, 1881. 

Honeysuckles, so-called, Lord Howe 
Island; Maiden, 1901. 

Hoplocephalus, n. sp., Macleay, 1886; 
Ogilby, 1889—n. sp., Gulf of Carpen- 
taria, Macleay, 1887—n. sp., Sutton 


Forest, Macleay, 1878. 
Horse, organ of Jacobson, Broom, 1896. 
Humerus, fossil, De Vis, 1883. 
Hyborrhynchus, Ferguson, 1921. 
Hydrogen-ion concentration, determining 
colorimetrically, Smith, R. G., 1924. 
Hydroida, n. sp., Bale, 1888. 


52 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


Hydroids, Briggs, 1915. 

Hydromedusae, Australian, 
1884-1885. 

Hyla aurea, behaviour of, to strychnine, 
Chapman, H. G., 1908. 

Hymenoptera, catalogue, Froggatt, W. W., 
1890, 1892—n. sp., Dodd, 1920—Narra- 
been, N.S.W., Froggatt, W. W., 1891— 
new fossorial, Australia and Tasmania, 
Turner, R. E., 19138—parasitic, n. g. et 
n. sp., Cameron, 1911-1912—parasitic, 
n. g. et n. sp., New Zealand and Aus- 
tralian, Ashmead, 1900—parasitic, Solo- 
mon Islands, Cameron, 1911—Phyto- 
phagous, n. sp., Turner, G., 1900. 

Hyolithes lanceolatus, structure, 
ridge, 1889. 

Hypsidae, Turner, A. J., 1921. 

Hypsiprymnodon, extinct genus of mar- 


Lendenfeld, 


Ethe- 


supials allied to, De Vis, 1888— 
moschatus, Ramsay, 1875-76. 

Hypsiprymnus, fossil allied to, Broom, 
1895. 


Ianthaenas, n. sp., Duke of York Island, 
Ramsay, 1877. 
Ibacus Peronii, 
Haswell, 1879. 
Ice, supplied in Sydney, bacteriological 

examination, Katz, 1888. 


Phyllosoma stage, 


Icerya aegyptiacum, Froggatt, W. W., 
1893. 
Ichneumonidae, n. sp., Island of Aru, 


Cameron, 1912. 

Ichthyology, Australian, Ogilby, 1899— 
“Chevert” Expedition, Alleyne and 
Macleay, 1875-76 — Port Jackson, 
Castelnau, 1878. 

Ichthyosaurus, “Rolling Downs Forma- 
tion”, North-eastern Australia, HEthe- 
ridge, 1888. 

Idolothrips, Froggatt, W. W., 1904. 

Igneous rocks, Carboniferous, N.S.W., 
Aurousseau, 1915. 

Index, phagocytic, influence of dilution 
of serum upon, Smith, R. G., 1909. 

Indigénes de Funafuti (Ellice Group), 
similitudes des langues et des 
coutumes, Donat et Seurat, 1903. 

Indigénes des Iles de la Société, de 
VArchipel des Tuamotu etc., Donat et 
Seurat, 1903. 

Infusoria, action of tannin on, Gilliatt, 
1883—Rolling Downs Formation, 
Queensland, Dun, Rands and David, 
1901. 

Infusorian, Flagellate, as an intra-cellular 
parasite, Haswell, 1892. 

Insect, Aphanipterous, n. sp., N.S.W., 
Olliff, 1886—injurious to vine, Macleay, 
1882—luminous Dipterous, New Zea- 
land, Skuse, 1890—micro-lepidopterous, 
destructive to potato, Meyrick, 1879— 


new Dipterous, infesting grass, Skuse, 
1887—wing, fossil, n. sp., Triassic Beds 
near Dee Why, N.S.W., Tillyard, 1925 


—wing, fossil, roof of coal seam, 
Sydney Harbour Colliery, Tillyard, 
1918—wings, fossil, Upper Permian, 


Newcastle, N.S.W., Tillyard, 1921. 

Insecta, British New Guinea, Rainbow, 
1898—Norfolk Island, Olliff, 1887. 

Insects, Cairns District, N. Queensland, 
Macleay, 1887—Dipterous, parasitic 
upon Australian frogs, Skuse, 1889— 
Fijian, food plants or hosts, Veitch and 
Greenwood, 1921, 1924—Fly River, New 
Guinea, Coleoptera, Macleay, 1886— 
fossil, Upper Carboniferous of Com- 
mentry, France, Tillyard, 1918—Holo- 
metabolous, phylogeny, Tillyard, 1918— 
King’s Sound and Vicinity, Macleay, 
1888—Maclay Coast, New Guinea, 
Macleay, 1884—Mesozoic, Queensland 
Tillyard, 1917-1923—Neuropteroid, of 
Hot Springs Region, N.Z., report, Till- 
yard, 1920—new Hymenopterous, para- 
sitic upon Dipterous insect, Skuse, 1887 
—note on flight, Lendenfeld, 1884— 
Permian and Triassic, N.S.W., Tillyard, 
1917—Permian, n. sp., Belmont, N.S.W., 
Tillyard, 1922. 


Instruments, two new, for 
Cobb, 1890. 

Interior N.S.W., botany, Cambage, 1900- 
1902—zgeology and water supply, 
Curran, 1885. 

Iodis, Lucas, T. P., 1888—n. sp., Lucas, 
a, 12, 1sso, 

Ischnura  heterosticta, 
female, Tillyard, 1905. 


Island of Hrromanga, New Hebrides, 
notes on a visit to, Sinclair, 1894. 
Isopoda, Australian, revision, Haswell, 
1884—marine, n. sp., Haswell, 1880-1881. 
Isopodan genus, new, Lake Corangamite, 
Victoria, Chilton, 1919. 
Isopogon, n. sp., Baker, 
N.S.W., Mueller, 1894. 
Ithonidae, characters and relationships 
and new and little-known genera and 
species, Tillyard, 1916—revision and 
n. g. et n. sp., Tillyard, 1919. 
Jamberoo, N.S.W., stilbite, eruptive rocks, 
Engelhardt, 1891. 
Junction Mine, near Mandurama, laccol- 
ites, David, 1890. 

Juncus, holoschaenus, Cheel, 
prismatocarpus, Cheel, 1902. 
Kangaroo, n. sp., New Guinea, Macleay, 
1884; Ramsay, 1875-76—rat, n. g. et n. 

sp., Ramsay, 1875-76. 

Kangaroos, anatomy of urogenital organs 
in females, Fletcher, 1882-1883—direct 
communication between median vaginal 


biologists, 


dimorphism in 


1894—n. gp., 


1902— 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 53 


cul-de-sac so-called and urogenital 
canal, Fletcher, 1881—direction of hair 
on back, Maclay, 1884. 

Kelps, New Zealand, efflorescence on, 
Lueas, A. H. S., 1916. 

Kerosene shale, Megalong Valley, N.S.W., 
Bertrand, 1900. 

“Kerosene shale’, origin, David, 1889. 

“Keu”’, Maclay Coast, New Guinea, 
Maclay, 1885. 

Kino, Angophora, Maiden, 1891. 

Kinos,~as an aid in diagnosis of 
Eucalypts, Maiden, 1889-1891. 

Kogia greyi, brain, Haswell, 1883. 


Kosciusko, evidences of glacial action, 
David, 1908; David, Helms and Pitt- 
man, 1901. 

Kuditcha shoes, Central Australia, 
Etheridge, 1894. 

Kurrajong, crimson-flowered, Maiden, 
1916. 


Labyrinthodont, Biloela, Stephens, W. J., 
1886. 

Lac-coccid, n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1911. 

Lacecolites, Junction Mine near Man- 
durama, David, 1890. 

Lacertilia, British New Guinea, Lucas, 
ACHES? 1898: 

Lacewings, silky, n. sp., Tillyard, 1925. 

Laemodipoda, revision, Australian, Has- 
well, 1884. 

Laevicardium Beechei, Brazier, 1875-76. 

Lake George Senkungsfeld, Taylor, T. G., 
1907. 

Lakes George and Bathurst, evolution, 
Taylor, T. G., 1907. 


Lalage, undetermined species, Ramsay, 
1879. 
Lamellibranchiata, New Zealand, revi- 


sion, Hutton, 1884. 
Lamellicornia, new, Olliff, 1890. 


Lamellicornes, King’s Sound and vicinity, 
Macleay, 1888. 

Lamprima, revision and n. sp., Macleay, 
1885. 

Lamprimides, n. g., Macleay, 1885. 

Lamprolia, n. sp., Fiji, Ramsay, 1875-76. 

Lamp shells, Port Jackson and coast of 
N.S.W., Brazier, 1879. 

Lampyridae, n. sp., Olliff, 1889. 


Land Mollusca, Australian and Poly- 
nesian, Brazier, 1883—n. sp., Maclay 
Coast and Triton Bay, New Guinea, 
Brazier, 1885—Papua or New Guinea, 
Brazier, 1884. 

Land Planarian, 
Fletcher, 1887. 

Land Planarians, Australian, n. sp., and 
notes on collecting and preserving, 
Steel, T., 1897, 1900—Blue Mountains, 
N.S.W., Dendy, 1894—Fiji and n. sp., 


introduced species, 


Steel, T., 1897—n. sp., Fletcher and 
Hamilton, 1887—Tasmanian, n. sp., 
Steel, T., 1900. 

Land shells, Australian and Tasmanian, 
Brazier, 1875-76—‘“‘Chevert” Expedition, 
Brazier, 1875-76—collected in Queens- 
land, Hedley, 1912—n. sp., Brazier, 
1875-76—n. sp., “Chevert” Expedition, 
Brazier, 1875-76—n. sp., New Guinea, 
Ancey, 1895—n. sp., New Guinea and 
W. Australia, Ancey, 1897—n. sp., 
Thursday Island, Brazier, 1879. 

Land snails, Tasmanian, anatomy, 
Hedley, 1891. 

Land tortoises, dimensions, gigantic, Cox, 
1883. 
Langeel, 
1898. 
Laportea gigas, stinging property, Petrie, 

J. M., 1906. 
Larrada, Whittell, 1883. 


North Queensland, Etheridge, 


Larridae, nests and habits, Froggatt, 
W. W., 1894. E 

Lasiocampidae, Turner, A. J., 1924. 

Lava, Savaii, chemical note, Jensen, 
1907. 

Leaf-hopper, Australian apple, Myers, 
1921. 


Leaf-mining fly, n. sp., Coquillett, 1899. 

Leaf morphology, instability, in relation 
to taxonomic botany, Hamilton, A. A., 
1916. 

Leaia Mitchelli, Upper Coal 
Neweastle District, Etheridge, 
n. sp., Mitchell, 1925. 

Lebiini, Sloane, 1903, 1907, 1915, 1917. 

Lecythidaceae, Queensland, revised 
account, White, C. T., 1919. 

Leguminosae, bacterial diseases, roots of, 
Bancroft, 1893—nodule organism, 
Smith, R. G., 1899—two undescribed 
exudations from, Maiden, 1891. 

Leipoa ocellata, Bennett, 1883. 

Lemnaceae, Woolls, 1888. 

Lepidodendron, Mt. Lambie, near Rydal, 
N.S.W., Pittman and David, 1893. 


Lepidoptera, Olliff, 1890-1891—Australian, 


Measures, 
1892— 


n. sp., Lower, 1897-1901, 1915; Lucas, 
Ty PP 1892: Miskin, 1888 Durner; 
A. J., 1909—Australian, n. sp., with 


additional localities for known species, 
Lueas, T. P., 1893—Australian, revision, 
Meyrick, 1886-1891; Turner, A. J., 1903- 


1924—Ebor Scrub, N.S.W., Turner, 
A. J., 1914-1916—Fly River, Meyrick, 
1886—having antlia terminal in a 


Teretron or Borer, Read, 1878—Homo- 
neura, comparison of male genitalia, 
Byer, 1925—n. g., Turner, A. J., 1902 
—n. sp., Meyrick, 1886; Miskin, 1890— 
n. sp., Brisbane, Queensland, Lucas, 
T. P., 1890—n. sp., Queensland, Lucas, 


54 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


T. P., 1902—n. sp., 
other Australian, Lucas, T. P., 1890, 
1891—wing venation, preliminary re- 
port, Tillyard, 1917. 

Lepidosperma, nu. sp., Port Jackson Dis- 
trict, Hamilton, A. A., 1910. 
Lepidum, Hamilton, A. A., 1917. 
Leptopoma, supposed New 
species, Moellendorff, 1892. 
Lestes leda, life history, Tillyard, 1906. 

Lestophonus, n. sp., Skuse, 1889. 

Leucite-basalt, Central N.S.W., Curran, 
1887. 

Leucosiidae, Haswell, 1879. 

Libellulidae, Australian, n. sp., Tillyard, 
1906. 

Libellulinae, remarkable Australian and 
n. sp., Tillyard, 1908. 

Limaz maximus, feeding tracks, 
AP, ISG), 

Limestone flora, Grose Vale, Carne, 1910. 

Limestones, Tertiary, Malekula, New 
Hebrides, Chapman, F., 1907. 

Limnodynastes peronti, young male, an 
abnormal connection of renal-portals 
im, TSU, do Io, Iss. : 

Lindera tessalatella, male and female 
genitalia, Philpott, 1925—modification 
of eighth abdominal segment, Philpott, 
1925. 

Lindsaea trichomanoides, Woolls, 1886. 

Lindsaya, linearis, anatomy, Williams, 
1925—microphylla, anatomy, Williams, 
1925. 

Liotia lodderae, Balmoral Beach, near 
Sydney, Hedley, 1898. 

Lipareti us, Macleay, 1886. 

Liparidae, Turner, A. J., 1920. 

Liparus, n. sp., W. Australia, Cox, 1899. 

Littorinacea, Kesteven, 1902. 

Littorinidae, Australian, Woods, 1878. 

Lizards, Australian, critical notes, Lucas 
and Frost, 1896—“‘Chevert”’ Expedition, 


Queensland and 


Zealand 


Steel, 


Macleay, 1877—Chillagoe District, N. 
Queensland, Broom, 1897—n. g., De 
Vis, 1889. 


Lomatera, n. sp., Lea, 1906. 

Longicornia, new, Olliff, 1890. 

Loomberah District, geology, Benson and 
Chapman, 1918. 

Loranthaceae, Blakely, 1922-1925. 

Loranths, and Viscums, Australian, affect- 
ing exotic trees and shrubs, Turner, F., 
1894—Eucalypts and, Fletcher, 1896. 

Loranthus exocarpi, Brittlebank, 1908. 


Lord Howe Island, bibliography, Hthe- 
ridge, 1889. 

Lorica, fossil, North-western Tasmania, 
Hull, 1910. 


Loricates, relation of, to the country rock, 
Hull, 1924. 
Lotorium, Kesteven, 1902. 


Lower Mesozoic rocks of Queensland, 
correlation with Lower Mesozoic 
rocks of other parts of Australia, 
Walkom, 1918—distribution and fossii 
flora, Walkom, 1918—geology, Walkom, 
1918. 

Lucanidae, Masters, 1886—n. sp., Macleay, 
1885. 

Lycaenidae, Waterhouse, 1902-1912; 
Waterhouse and Turner, 1904—n. sp., 
Miskin, 1890—n. sp., Blue Mountains, 
Olliff, 1885. 

Lycoperdon furfuraceum, McAlpine, 1900. 

Lygosoma entrecasteauxi, placentation, 
Harrison and Weekes, 1925. 

Lyperosia exigua, bionomics, Hill, G. F., 
1916. 

Macadamia, nu. sp., Maiden and Betche, 
1896. 

Mackerel sky, formation, Lucas, A. H. S., 
1894. 

Maclay Coast, New Guinea, evidence of 
rising, Maclay, 1884. 

Macleays, Society’s heritage, 
1920. 

Macramycterus, Ferguson, 1914. 

Macrodontism, Maclay, 1878. 

“Macrodontism” of Melanesians, second 
note, Maclay, 1885. 


Macro-Lepidoptera, Queensland and other 
Australian, localities and n. sp., Lucas, 
WM, IP ISsg: 


Macropodidae, review of fossil jaws, De 
Vis, 1894, 1895. 


Macropods, foetal membranes, Hill, J. P., 
1895. 


Macropus, n. sp.. New Guinea, Maclay, 
1884, 1885—tibol, Maclay, 1885. 


Macrozanvia, gum, bacterial origin, 
Smith, R. G., 1904—spiralis, apogeo- 
tropic roots, McLuckie, 1922—spiralis, 
chemical examination, Petrie, J. M., 
1920. 


Maitland-Branxton District, stratigraphi- 
cal geology of Permo-Carboniferous 
system, Walkom, 1913. 


Malaysia, and Asia, geographical notes, 
Woods, 1888—vegetation, Woods, 1889. 


Mallee, hen, Bennett, 1883—red, water 
from roots, Steel, T., 1919. 


Mallophagan generic names, Johnston and 
Harrison, 1911. 

Malurus, cyaneus, and M. superbus, 
synonymy, North, 1901—plumage of 
adult males in certain species, North, 
1890—pulcherrimus, nidification, North. 
1888. 

Mammal, fossil, n. sp., Broom, 1895. 

Mammalia, cerebral commissures, Smith, 

G. E., 1894. 


Fletcher, 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 55 


Mammalian, premaxillary, homology of 
palatine process, Broom, 1895—pre- 
nasal cartilage, Broom, 1895. 


Mammals, ‘“‘Chevert” Expedition, Ramsay, 
1877. 


Man, geological history?, Etheridge, 1890. 


Mangrove and saltmarsh vegetation near 
Sydney, Collins, 1921. 


Marginal drainage, a study, Hedley, 1911. 


Marine, and land Mollusca, n. sp., Fiji, 
Ceylon and Queensland, Brazier, 1898 
—animals, preservation of tender, Len- 
denfeld, 1884—Mollusea, Australian and 
Polynesian, Brazier, 1883—shells, 
Brazier, 1885—shells, n. sp., Brazier, 
1878—shells, n. sp., “Chevert” Expedi- 
tion, Brazier, 1875-1878—shells, Solo- 
mon Islands and Australia, Brazier, 
1897. 


Marioni, Sloane, 1904. 

Marsilea drummondii, Bancroft, 1893. 

Marsipobranchii, Australian, Ogilby, 1896. 

Marsupial, extinct, remains, De Vis, 1883 
—fossil, Broom, 1895—fossil, allied to 
Petaurus, Broom, 1895—new, allied to 
Perameles, Ramsay, 1878. 


Marsupialia, anatomy and development, 
Flynn, 1910—Australian, EHEntozoa of, 
Johnston, T. H., 1909, 1911—catalogue 
of papers and works relating to, 
Fletcher, 1884—morphology and de- 
velopment of female urogenital organs, 
Tetw0l, di, IB a. Is Oaexney 


Marsupials, and a Monotreme, Trematode 
parasites of, Johnston, S. J., 1912— 
and Monotremes, recent work on, Has- 
well, 1893—comparative anatomy, 
organ of Jacobson, Broom, 1896 
extinct genus, allied to Hypsiprym- 
nodon, De Vis, 1888—extinct, tooth- 
marked bones, De Vis, 1883—n. sp., 
Broom, 1896—ossification of vertebrae, 
Broom, 1900. 

Masoreini, Sloane, 1904. 

May-fly, n. g. et n. sp., Tasmania, Tillyard, 
1921. 

Mecoptera, Tillyard, 1917-1919. 


Medicinal plants, Queensland, Bailey, 
1880. 
Medusa, Tropical Pacific, Lendenfeld, 
1885. 


Megaloptera, Australian, n. g. et n. Sp., 
Tillyard, 1918. 

Megalyra, n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1906. 

'Megapodius, Brazieri, Brazier, 1881— 
eges of certain species, Ramsay, 1877. 

Melaleuca linariifolia, adventitious roots, 
Musson and Carne, 1910. 

Melania, Brazier, 1881. 


Meliola amphitricha, McAlpine, 1895. 


Melo diadema, Neanic shell, Kesteven, 
1903. 
Membracidae, Goding, 1903—Australia 


and Tasmania, Goding, 1898. 
Merista plebeia, occurrence in N.S.W., 
Mitchell, 1924. 
Merula, n. sp., Ramsay, 1875-76, 1878— 
vinitincta, nidification, North, 1889. 
Mesenteripora, occurrence on _ Coast, 
N.S.W., Haswell, 1881. 

Mesogereon, Tillyard, 1921. 

Metasomatic processes in cassiterite vein, 
New England, Cotton, 1909. 

Metoponia rubriceps, Smith, V. I., 1920—- 
respiratory system in larva, pupa and 
imago, Smith, V. I., 1923—structure of 
mouth-parts and pharynx of larval, 
Smith, V. I., 1921—further experiments 
in rearing, Smith, V. I., 1921. 

Microbic attacks, first line of defence 
against, Smith, R. G., 1905. 
Microcachrys tetragona, life 

Lawson, 19238. 
Micrococcus pyogenes, Smith, R. G., 1902. 
Micro-fungus, Mt. Kosciusko, McAlpine, 
1899. 

Micro-Lepidoptera, Australian, Meyrick, 
1878-1907; Turner, A. J., 1913, 1916. 
Micro-organisms, in tissues of diseased 

horses, Katz, 1887—on potatoes, im- 
proved method of cultivating, Katz, 
1887—upon numbers of bacteria in soil, 

action, Smith, R. G., 1917. 
Micropterygidae, morphology and system- 

atic position, Tillyard, 1919. 
Migadopini, Sloane, 1915. 


Milk, acidity, Chapman, H. G., 1908— 
condensed, coagulation, Smith, R. G., 
1909—relation between fat-content and 
electrical conductivity, Wardlaw, 1918— 
cows’, variability, Wardlaw, 1917. 

Milleporidae, n. g., Woods, 1878. 

Milton District, N.S.W., geology, Brown, 
1925. 

Miniopterus, organ of Jacobson, Broom, 
1895. 

Miscellanea Entomologica, Macleay, 1886- 
1887. 


history, 


Molacanthus, Central Pacific Ocean, 
McCulloch, 1912. 

Molge pyrrogastra, breeding habits, 
Waite, 1908. 

Mollusc, Gasteropod, definition of 


Nepionic stage in, Kesteven, 1903— 
n. sp., Sydney Harbour, Hedley, 1893. 
Mollusea, Brazier, 1893; Hedley, 1900- 
1923—Australian and Tasmanian, 
Brazier, 1894—British New (Guinea, 
Hedley, 1898—Green Point, Watson’s 
Bay, Sydney, list of and remarks upon 
species and n. sp., Henn and Brazier, 


56 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


1894—Hope Islands, North Queens- 
land, Hedley, 1909—land, Papua or 
New Guinea, Brazier, 1884—land, Tas- 
manian, Suter, 1893—land and fresh- 
water, n. sp., Maclay Coast and Triton 
Bay, New Guinea, Brazier, 1885—land 
and freshwater, naturalised forms, 
Musson, 
New Zealand, addition and emenda- 
tions to reference list, Suter, 1893— 
land and freshwater, New Zealand, 
reference list, Hedley and Suter, 1892 
—land and marine, Australian and 
Polynesian, Brazier, 1883—Malaysian 
land and freshwater, Woods, 1888— 
marine and land, n. sp., Fiji, Ceylon 
and Queensland, Brazier, 1898—marine 
Taenioglossate and Ptenoglossate, New 
Zealand, revision, Hutton, 1884— 
marine, Tasmania, revised census, Tate 
and May, 1901—Mast Head Reef, Capri- 
corn Group, Queensland, Hedley, 1906- 
1907—Merimbula, N.S.W., Brazier, 1889 
—n. g., and notes on other, Hedley, 
1899—n. g. et n. sp., N.S.W., New Heb- 
rides and W. Australia, Brazier, 1896 
—n. sp., Cox, 1889—n. sp., chiefly from 
New Caledonia, Hedley, 1898—n. sp., 
Victoria, Brazier, 1898—naked Aus- 
tralian marine, Hedley, 1894—Norfolk 
Island, Brazier, 1887—North-west Coast 
Australia, Brazier, 1884—of Pareora 
and Oamaru Systems of New Zealand, 
Hutton, 1886—Pliocene, New Zealand, 
Hutton, 1892—Polynesia and Australia, 


Brazier, 1893—Polynesian, Brazier, 
1883—Port Jackson and Coast of 
N.S.W., and other localities, Brazier, 


1880—Port Jackson and New Caledonia, 
Brazier, 1877—Pulmonate, n. sp., Aus- 
tralia and Solomon Islands, Cox, 1891 
—Rhipidoglossate and Docoglossate, 
New Zealand, revision, Hutton, 1884— 
three new generic names, Hutton, 1904 
—Toxoglossate, New Zealand, revision, 
Hutton, 1885—Tropical, Port Jackson 
Heads, Brazier, 1879. 

Molochtus, Ferguson, 1916. 

Monacanthus Cheverti, Macleay, 1877. 

Monaro District, N.S.W., Hucalyptus, 
n. sp., Cambage, 1909. 

Monimiaceae, Woolls, 1881. 

Monograptus, Hall, T. S., 1902. 

Monotremata, catalogue of papers and 
works relating to, Fletcher, 1884— 
Entozoa of, Johnston, T. H., 1909, 1911. 

Monotremes, and Marsupials, recent work 
on, Haswell, 1893—homologies of 
borders and surfaces of scapula, Wilson 
and McKay, 1893—morphology of 
muscles of shoulder-girdle, McKay, 
1894—-skeleton of snout and os carun- 


1890—land and freshwater, 


culae of mammary foetus, Wilson, 1900 
—skeleton of snout of mammary foetus, 
Wilson, 1901. 

Moore Park Borings, Cox, 1880. 

Mount Flinders and Fassifern Districts, 

Queensland, geology, Jensen, 1909. 


Mount Kosciusko, Galaxias, Ogilby, 1896 
—meteorology, Lendenfeld, 1885— 
Rhopalocera, Olliff, 1889. 


Mount Kosciusko Plateau, glacier action, 
Curran, 1897—glacier action, evidences, 
Helms, 1893. 


Mount Seaview, Upper Hastings River, 
notes on a trip to, Maiden, 1898. 


Mount Wilson, ferns, Trebeck, 1886— 
flora, Brough, McLuckie and Petrie, 
1924; Hamilton, A. G., 1899—flora, 
ecological study, Petrie, A. H. K., 1925. 


Mordellistena, n. sp., parasitic on Ter- 
mites, Hill, G. F., 1922. 


Moreauia mirabilis, n. g. et n. Sp., para- 
sitic on Ornithorhynchus, Johnston, 
Si dog alWialis, 


Mosses, Frondose, classified catalogue, 
Australia and Tasmania, Watts and 
Whitelegge, 1902, 1905—Lord Howe 
Island, Brotherus and Watts, 1915— 
n. sp., Australian, Tasmanian and New 
Zealand, Brotherus, 1916—n. _ sp., 
N.S.W., Watts, 1899, 1901—N.S.W., 
Forsyth, 1899, 1902; Watts and White- 
legge, 1900—N. Queensland, Brotherus 


and Watts, 1918—Polynesian, new 
localities and hitherto undefined 
species, Mitten, 1882—Tamworth, 


N.S.W., Mueller, 1894—Yarrangobilly 
Caves District, N.S.W., Brotherus and 
Watts, 1912. 

Moths, Australian, Lord Howe Island, 
Turner, A. J., 1922. 


Mucilage, linseed, probable bacterial 
origin of gum, Smith, R. G., 1905. 


Mudgee District, birds, Cox and Hamil- 
ton, 1889—indigenous plants, Hamil- 
ton, A. G., 1887—Orchideae, Hamilton, 
A. G., 1886. 

Mueller Glacier, 
1888. 

Mugilidae, Australia, Macleay, 1879— 
n. sp., Interior New Guinea, Macleay, 
1883. 

Murex, n. sp., Port Darwin, Brazier, 1877 
—n. sp., S. Australia, Brazier, 1893. 
Mus, Burtoni, neighbourhood of Derby, 
N.W. Australia, Ramsay, 1887—n. sp., 
Island of Ugi, Solomon Group, Ramsay, © 
1882—tompsonii, Bennett, 1887—two 

supposed n. sp., Ramsay, 1877. 

Muscoid flies, external breathing appara- 

tus of larvae, Froggatt, J. L., 1918. 


New Zealand, Hutton, 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 57 


Mycetophilidae, Skuse, 1888—n. sp., with 
luminous larvae, Ferguson, 1925—New 
Zealand, Skuse, 1890. 

Mydaidae, Australian, Hardy, 1925. 

Myiolestes, Fiji, Ramsay, 1878. 

Myoporum platycarpum, Bennett, 1882. 


Myriapoda, Froggatt, W. W., 1915— 
n. sp., Broelemann, 1915. 
Myristicivora spilorrhoa,  nidification, 


North, 1890. 

Myrmeleontidae, n. g. et n. sp., Tillyard, 
1916—structure of cubitus in wings, 
Tillyard, 1918—wing-venation, Tillyard, 
1915. 

Myrtaceae, Andrews, 1913—Australia, 
Woolls, 1884—n. g., Baker, 1898—n. sp., 
Baker, 1913—pollination of Darwinia 
fascicularis, Brewster, 1915. 

Mytilus, large Mesozoic, from the Barcoo, 
Woods, 1882—latus, two remarkable 
sporocysts occurring in, on coast of 
New Zealand, Haswell, 1902. 


Myxomycete, N.S.W., n. sp., McAlpine, 
1898. 

Nandewar Mountains, geology, Jensen, 
1907. 


Nannochoristidae, n. g. et n. sp., Tillyard, 
1917—n. g. et n. sp., New Zealand, 
Tillyard, 1917. 

Nannodythemis, n. sp., Tillyard, 1908. 

Nannophlebia, n. sp., Tillyard, 1912. 

Nardoo, Bancroft, 1893. 

Nascio, Olliff, 1886. 


Native flora of N.S.W., Cambage, 1904- 
1918. 
Natives, Herbert River, Queensland, 


practice of ovariotomy, Macleay, 1881 
—Queensland, habits and customs, Cox, 
1880—West Kimberley, N.W. Australia, 
Froggatt, W. W., 1888. 


Natural history, Claremont Islands, 
Mathew, 1885. 
Nautilus pompilius, arrangement and 


structure of Tentaculiferous lobes, 
Haswell, 1895. 

Neaera, n. sp., Woods, 1877. 

Nebriosoma, Sloane, 1904. 

Nematocera, Skuse, 1890. 

- Nematode, genera, new, Cobb, 1891, 1893 
—parasite, n. sp., of a lizard, Smith, 
Werle. 1922: 

Nematodes, Arabian, Cobb, 1890—marine, 
free-living, Cobb, 1890, 1898—Sydney 
and Port Jackson, Cobb, 1898. 


Nemestrinidae, Australian, Hardy, 1924 
—Australasian region, Mackerras, 1925. 

Neoanthias Guentheri, Ogilby, 1885. 

Neoaratus hercules, egg-laying, eggs and 
young larvae, Smith, V. I., 1923. 

Nepenthes, n. sp., Bailey, 1880. 

Neptunus, Stead, 1898. 


Neritina pulligera, Australian variety, 
Woods, 1878. 
Nettle tree, giant, 
Petrie, J. M., 1906. 
Neuroptera, Australian, Petersen, 1914- 
1923; Tillyard, 1915-1919—1ife-histories, 
Froggatt, W. W., 1902—n. sp., Froggatt, 
W. W., 1904. 
Newbridge, near 
Benson, 1907. ; 
Neweastle and Illawarra Districts, cor- 
relation of certain beds, Mitchell, 1892. 


New England, N.S.W., geology and 
physiography, Benson, 1917—meta- 
somatic processes in cassiterite vein, 
Cotton, 1909—tin-deposits, Cotton, 1909 
—vegetation, Turner, F., 1903. 


stinging property, 


Bathurst, geology, 


N.S.W., North-eastern, botany, Turner, 
Hye. 1906—North-western, botany, 
Turner, In, 1905 — South-western, 


botany, Turner, F., 1904. 


Newt, red-bellied, breeding habits, Waite, 
1908. 

Nicotiana suaveolens, identification of its 
alkaloid, Petrie, J. M., 1916. 
Noctuidae, n. g., Turner, A. J., 

na sp, Lurner As J-, 1909: : 
Noeggerathiopsis, Lower Coal Measures, 
N.S.W., Walkom, 1921. 
Nomenclature, botanical, principles of, 
Maiden, 1903—popular, Woolls, 1881. 


Norman River, Gulf of Carpentaria— 
birds, n. sp., Castelnau and Ramsay, 
1875-76—fishes, Castelnau, 1878. 

North Coast Districts, grey gum, Deane 
and Maiden, 1895. 


North-west and Desert Basins, W. Aus- 
tralia, geology and geography, Clapp, 
1925. 

Nomiini, Sloane, 1915. 

Notesthes robusta, venom, Kesteven, 1914. 

Notodontidae, Turner, A. J., 1922. 

Notonomus, Sloane, 1902, 1913. 

Notonophes, Ferguson, 1914. 

Nototherium, n. sp., De Vis, 1887. 

Notothizos, Baker, 1894—incanus var. 
subaureus, parasitism, McLuckie, 1922. 

Novacula, n. sp., Port Jackson, Ramsay, 
1881. 

Nundle District, 
keratophyres, 
Benson, 1913 
Benson, 1918. 

Nuytsia, polycotyledony, Fletcher, 1908. 

Oceanic waters, inshore, Australasia, 
salinity, in relation to fishes, Phillipps 
and Grigg, 1925. 

Octopodidae, Cox, 1881. 

Ocydromus sylvestris, nidification, North, 
1889. 

Odacanthini, Sloane, 1917. 


1902— 


dolerites, spilites and 
Benson, 1915—geology, 
to Coast, Serpentine Belt, 


58 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


Odonata, Tillyard, 1918—Australia, Till- 
yard, 1914—Australian, life-histories, 
Tillyard, 1909, 1911—Australian, new 
forms, Tillyard, 1913—Lord Howe and 
Norfolk Islands, Tillyard, 1917—prob- 
lems concerning development of wing- 
venation, Tillyard, 1914—radial and 
zygopterid sectors in wings, and forma- 
tion of bridges, Tillyard, 1916—sup- 
.posed numerical preponderance of 
males in, Tillyard, 1905—Tasmania, in 
relation to the Bassian Isthmus, 
Tillyard, 1913. 

Odontopleuridae, Etheridge and Mitchell, 
1896. 

Oecophoridae, Meyrick, 1882-1888. 

Oedemeridae, Masters, 1886—n. g. et 
n. sp., Olliff, 1887. 


Ogyris, Australian, n. sp., revision, 
Miskin, 1890. 
Oil, ducts, occurrence in certain 


Eucalypts and Angophoras, Welch, 1921 
—glands, occurrence in barks of cer- 
tain Eucalypts, Welch, 1922. 

Oils, Hucalyptus, germicidal activity, 
Smith, R. G., 1919—Hucalyptus, in 
aqueous dilutions, action, Smith, R. G., 
1919. 

Oligochaeta, Goddard, 1908—British New 
Guinea, Fletcher, 1898. 


Oligorus, Nn. Ssp., 


1880. 
Onchidium, histological structure of 
dorsal papillae of certain species, 


Lendenfeld, 1885—n. sp., Brazier, 1885. 
Oncopera, Eyer and Turner, 1925. 
Oniscia ponderosa, Brazier, 1879. 
Oniscidae, n. g., Lake Corangamite, Vic- 
toria, Chilton, 1919. 


“Onvar”, Malekula, 
Harper, 1901. 

Onyx, Cobb, 1891. 

Oocystis, Playfair, 1916. 

Oodini, Sloane, 1910, 1915. 

Oological notes, North, 1892, 1894, 1895. 

Oology, Australian, Ramsay, 1882— 
Austro-Malayan and Pacific Regions, 
North, 1887. 


New Hebrides, 


Ophidia, British New Guinea, Ogilby, 
1898. 

Ophidians, “Chevert”’ Expedition, 
Macleay, 1877—King’s Sound, N.W. 


Australia, Macleay, 1888. 
Ophiuran, n. sp., Farquhar, 1899. 
Opsonic technique, Smith, R. G., 1908. 
Opsonins, can they be obtained directly 
from bacteria and yeasts?, Smith, R. G., 
1909—probable identity of, with the 
normal agglutinins, Smith, R. G., 1905. 
Opsonisation from a bacterial point of 
view, Smith, R. G., 1908. 


Queensland, Ramsay,: 


Orchideae, Mudgee District, 
A. G., 1886. 

Ore-deposits, Borah Creek, New England, 
N.S.W., Cotton, 1910. 

Organ of Jacobson, bat (Miniopterus), 


Hamilton, 


Broom, 1895—comparative anatomy, 
Marsupials, Broom, 1896 — horse, 
Broom, 1896. 


Origin, continental, Fiji, Woolnough, 1903. 
Oriolus affinis, Ramsay, 1881. 
Ornithology, “Chevert” 
Ramsay, 1878. 
Ornithorhynchus, anatinus, Wilson, 1894 
—anatomy of “dumb-bell-shaped’’ bone, 
Wilson, 1894—anatomy of integument- 
ary structures in muzzle, Wilson and 
Martin, 1894—anatomy of muzzle, 
Wilson and Martin, 1892—burrowing 
habits, Burrell, 1925—femoral gland 
and its secretion, Martin and Tidswell, 
1894—hitherto undescribed character 


Expedition, 


of nasal septum, Wilson, 1894— 
Moreauia mirabilis, n. g. et n. Sp., 
parasitic in, Johnston, S. J., 1915— 
paradoxrus, temperature of body, 


Maclay, 1884—peculiar rod-like tactile 
organs in integument and mucous 
membrane of muzzle, Wilson and 
Martin, 1892. 


Orthonyxz spaldingi, 
1889. 

Oryssidae, n. sp., Turner, G., 1900. 

Osmylidae, n. g. et n. sp., Tillyard, 1916. 

Ostracoda, Henry, 1923. 

Otozamites, occurrence in Australia, with 
descriptions of specimens from W. 
Australia, Walkom, 1921. 

Ovulum depressum, new variety found at 
Lifou, Rossiter, 1882. 

Owenia, De Vis, 1891. 

Oxylaemus, n. sp., Grouvelle, 1907. 

Oxyrhyncha, Brachyura, Haswell, 1879. 

Oxyuris larvae, hatched in human 
stomach, Cobb, 1890. 

Oysters, edible, Australian and neighbour- 
ing Coasts, Cox, 1882. 

Pachycephala, Gilbertii, nidification of, 
Bennett, 1887—n. sp., Fiji, Ramsay, 
1875-76—n.; sp., Gulf of Carpentaria, 
Ramsay, 1877—olivacea, range, Ram- 
say, 1881—supposed n. sp., New Britain, 
Ramsay, 1875-76. 

Palaechinus, Upper 
N.S.W., Mitchell, 1897. 

Palaeichthyes, synonymy and distribu- 
tion, Ogilby, 1888-1889. 

Palaeocrinoidea, place of genus 
brachiocrinus among, Ratte, 1886. 


nidification, North, 


Silurian rocks, 


Tri- 


Palaeogeography, Permo-Carboniferous, 
N.S.W., Walkom, 1913. 
Palaeontinidae, Jurassic, relation of 


Mesogereon with, Tillyard, 1921. 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 59 


Palaeontology, Queensland, 
Etheridge, 1894. 

Palaeosetidae, comparison of male geni- 
talia, Eyer, 1925. 

Palinurus Edwardsii, 
and Rich, 1892. 

Palmeria, Woolls, 1881. 

Palorchestes Azael, lower jaw, De Vis, 
1883. 

Palu, method of suspending, Etheridge, 
1899. 

Pamborini, Sloane, 1904, 1915. 

Panageini, Sloane, 1903. 

Pancreas, physiology, 
1905. 

Panorpoid complex, Tillyard, 1918-1920. 

Parasitism, McLuckie, 1924. 

Paratrichoptera, Tillyard, 1919. 

Pardalote, n. sp., nest and eggs, Victoria, 
IBINOL, Je, ISOs). 

Pardalotus assimilis, Victoria, Hall, R., 
1899. 

Parmacochlea fischeri, Hedley, 1892. 

Paropsis, Blackburn, 1896-1901. 

Parrakeet, red-crowned, Norfolk Island, 
North, 1893. 

Parramatta, Eucalypts, n. sp., Hall, H. C., 
1912. 
Patella, 
Cheeseman, 

Brazier, 1894. 
Pauropoda, N.S.W., Harrison, 1914. 
Pavement,  glacially-striated, Kuttung 

Series, Maitland District, Osborne and 

Browne, 1921. 


Pear (Pome), 
McAlpine, 1911. 

Pelodryas, n. sp., New Ireland, Ramsay, 
US, 

Pelopoeus laetus, habits, Whittell, 1888. 

Penguin, apparently new species, Camp- 
bell Island, Hutton, 1878. 

Penoeus, Haswell, 1879. 

Perak, geology and physical geography, 
Woods, 1884. 

Perameles, cerebral localization, Chap- 
man, H. G., 1906—cockerellii, Ramsay, 
1875-76—female urogenital organs, Hill, 
J. P., 1899—n. sp., Ramsay, 1887— 
n. sp., New Ireland, Ramsay, 1875-76 
—obesula, occurrence of placental con- 
nection, Hill, J. P., 1895. 

Peramelidae, n. subgen., Maclay, 1884. 

Perch, Port Jackson, Ramsay, 1880. 

Perga, n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1890 

Peridineae, N.S.W., Playfair, 1919. 

Perigonini, Sloane, 1904. 

Peripatus, Steel T., 1896, 1897—found at 
Cassilis, N.S.W., Olliff, 1887—leuckarti, 
Fletcher, 1890, 1892, 1895—lewckartii, 
Victorian, oviparity, Dendy, 1892— 
oviparus, Dendy, 1895. 


Palaeozoic, 


myology, Parker 


Chapman, H. G.,, 


kermadecensis, Brazier, 1894; 
1895—Kermadec. Islands, 


fibro-vascular system, 


Permo-Carboniferous 
systems, 
1923. 

Perrieria, Hedley, 1892. 

Persoonia, polycotyledony, Fletcher, 1908. 

Petalura, gigantea, life-history, Tillyard, 
1909, 1911—n. sp., Tillyard, 1907. 

Petrogale assimilis, Ramsay, 1875-76. 

Phacopidae, Etheridge and Mitchell, 1895. 

Phalanger, common, Broom, 1898—flying, 
myology, Haswell, 1886. 


and overlying 
Central Queensland, Jensen, 


Phanerogams, aquatic, parthenogenesis, 
Lucas, A. H. S., 1916. 

Phascolomyidae, Post-Tertiary, De Vis, 
1891. 


Phascolonus, upper incisor, De Vis, 1893. 

Phasma, n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1922. 

Phasmatidae, destructive to Eucalypti, 
Macleay, 1881. 

Pherosphaera, life-history, Lawson, 1923. 

Philemon, n. sp., N.W. Australia, Ramsay, 
1887. 

Philougria, marine species, Chilton, 1884. 

Phlebopteris alethopteroides, fructifica- 
tion, Lower Mesozoic beds, Queensland, 
Etheridge, 1889. 

Phomea citricarpa, Smith, G. P. D., 1918. 

Phoriospongiae, Lendenfeld, 1885. 

Phoronis, Haswell, 1882—second species 
in Port Jackson, Haswell, 1892. 

Phreodrilid, Tasmanian, Goddard, 1908. 

Phreodrilidae, n. g. et n. sp., Goddard, 
1908. 

Phyllodes Meyricki, Olliff, 1889. 

Phyllopetalia, n. sp., and description of 
nymph and imago, Tillyard, 1909. 

Phyllopoda, Henry, 1924. 

Phyllosoma stage of Ibacus 
Haswell, 1879. 

Physaloptera, Australian lizards, Smith, 
V.1., 1922—lizards, Smith, V. I., 1922 
—Nematodes, parasitic in reptiles, 
Smith, V. I., 1921-1922. 

Physical, geography and geology of State 
of Perak, Woods, 1884—structure and 
geology of Australia, Woods, 1882. 

Physics, oceanic, Steel, T., 1906—terres- 
trial, some questions on, Steel, T., 1907. 

Physiography of N.S.W., correlation of 
contour, climate and coal, Taylor, T. G., 
1906. 

Physocrotaphini, Sloane, 1904. 


Peronit, 


Phytoplankton, Australian freshwater, 
Playfair, 1916. 
Pielus, hyalinatus and P. imperialis, 


Olliff, 1889—imperialis, Lucas, T. P., 
1889—n. sp., Blue Mountains, Olliff and 
Prince, 1887. 
Piezorhynchus, Nn. sp., 
Islands, Ramsay, 1888. 
Pigeon, domestic in Australia, Nematode 
parasites, Smith, V. I., 1920—fruit, sup- 


New Hebrides 


60 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


posed n. sp., Malacola, one of New 
Hebrides Islands, Ramsay, 1875-76— 
Torres Straits, nidification, North, 1890. 

Pigeons, anatomy, Haswell, 1882— 
anatomy of two rare genera, Haswell, 
1882. 

Pilumnopeus serratifrons, Sacculina para- 
sitic upon, Stead, 1899. 

Pisces, British New Guinea, Ogilby, 1898. 

Pitcher plant, W. Australian, Hamilton, 
A. G., 1904. 

Pittosporum undulatum, Hamilton, A. G., 
1894—variable dioecism in, Steel, T., 
1911. 

Placostylus, range, Hedley, 1892. 

Plagiostomata of Pacific, Maclay and 
Macleay, 1878-1885. 

Planipennia, Tillyard, 1917, 1919—Lord 
Howe and Norfolk Islands, Tillyard, 
1917—n. sp., Tillyard, 1923. 

Plankton of Sydney Water Supply, Play- 
fair, 1912. 

Plant, coal, Queensland, Woods, 1882— 
in fruit, doubtfully referred to Cymo- 
docea, Maiden and Betche, 1909— 
metabolism, nitrogen and its com- 
pounds in, Petrie, J. M., 1908-1911— 
pigments, Petrie, J. M., 1923-1924— 
poisonous, Australian, methyl laevo- 
inositol in, Petrie, J. M., 1918. 


Plants, apparently undescribed  struc- 
tures in leaves, Hamilton, A. G., 1895 
—Australian, flowering seasons, Havi- 
land, E., 1886-1888—Australian, n. sp., 
Maiden and Betche, 1897—Australian, 
n. sp., with additional phyto-geographic 
notes, Mueller, 1890—climbing, stems, 
Shirley and Lambert, 1918—collected 
Don Dorrigo Forest Reserve, Maiden, 
1894—collected in vicinity of Mount 
Dromedary, Mueller, 1880—collected 
King George’s Sound, Woolls, 1889, 1892 
—collected Prince MRegent’s River, 


Mueller, 1891—collection from Aird 
River, Mueller, 1887—domatia in, 
Hamilton, A. G., 1896—fertilisation, 


Hamilton, A. G., 1898—forage, indigen- 
ous in N.S.W., Woolls, 1882—fossil, 
n. sp., Wianamatta shales, Ratte, 1886 
—fossil, Narrabeen Stage of Hawkes- 


bury Series, Walkom, 1925—fossil, 
Queensland, various deposits, Woods, 
1882—hydro-cyanic acid in, Petrie, 
J. M., 1912-1920—indigenous, Austra- 


lian, providing human foods and food- 
adjuncts, Maiden, 1888—indigenous, 
Cobar District, N.S.W., Haviland, F. E., 
1911, 1913—indigenous in immediate 
neighbourhood of Sydney, inflorescence 
and habits, Haviland, E., 1882-1885— 
indigenous, Mudgee District, Hamilton, 
A. G., 1887—introduced, Queensland, 


Bailey, 1879—in use by natives, Maclay 
Coast, New Guinea, Maclay, 1885— 
Jurassic, Bexhill, near Lismore, N.S.W., 
Walkom, 1919—Lord Howe Island, 
Maiden, 1902 — medicinal, -reputed 
N.S.W., Maiden, 1888—Myrtaceous, n. 
sp., Baker, 1912—Myrtaceous, secretory 
canals in certain, Welch, 1923—n. sp., 
Cheel, 1923—n. sp., N.S.W., Maiden and 
Baker, 1895; Maiden and Betche, 1898; 


Mueller, 1881, 1886—n. sp., W. Aus- 
tralia, Fitzgerald, W. V., 1902-1903; 
Mueller, 1888—N.S.W., Baker, 1891- 


1897; Cheel, 1902; Woolls, 1881-1882— 
N.S.W., far southern localities, Mueller, 
1883—N.S.W., geographical distribu- 
tion, Maiden, 1889—N.W. Australia, 
Fletcher, 1888—new to South Queens- 
land, Scortechini, 1882, 1883—poison- 
ous, nh. sp., pharmacology of, Bancroft, 
1889—Port Jackson, Maiden and Cam- 
field, 1898—potassium nitrate in, Petrie, 
J. M., 1911—two, new to the Colony, 
Maiden and Betche, 1896—which have 
become naturalized in N.S.W., Woolls, 
1884. 

Platalea flavipes, 
Bennett, 1882. 
Platyceps Wilkinsonii, 
1886, 1887. 
Platycercus, 0. 
Ramsay, 1877. 

Platynini, Sloane, 1903, 1915. 

Platypus, Distomum, n. sp., from, John- 
ston, S. J., 1901—embryo from intra- 
uterine egg, Hill and Martin, 1894, 
1895—note on range, Waite, 1896. 

Platysmatini, Sloane, 1903, 1904. 

Plecotrema, Port Jackson, Cox, 1898. 

Plesiosaurus, Mesozoic rocks, Queens- 
land, Etheridge, 1888. 

Pleuronectidae, n. g. et n. sp., Port Jack- 
son, Macleay, 1882. 

Pleuro-pneumonia, bovine, 
inoculation for, Katz, 1887. 

Pleurotomidae, n. sp., “Chevert” Expedi- 
tion, Brazier, 1875-76. 

Plover, n. sp., North Australia, Ramsay, 
1875-76. 

Plutellidae, Meyrick, 1907. 

Pneumonic influenza, venous oxygen con- 
tent and alkaline reserve of blood in, 
Wardlaw, 1919. 

Podocarpus, elata, morphology and 
physiology of root-nodules, McLuckie, 
1923 — spinulosa, morphology and 
physiology of root-nodules, McLuckie, 
1923: 

Poephila gouldiae, Ramsay, 1875-76—and 
P. mirabilis, Ramsay, 1877—armitiana 
and mirabilis, North, 1889. 

Pogonini, Sloane, 1903. 


breeding place of, 
Stephens, W. J., 


sp., interior N.S.W., 


protective 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 61 


Poisonous fly, reputed, New Caledonia, 
Macleay, 1882. 

Polycercus, a proliferating cystic para- 
site of earthworms, Haswell and Hill, 
1893. 

Polychaeta, Haswell, 1885. 

Polymorphism, McAlpine, 1896. 

Polynoe, minute structure, Haswell, 1885. 

Polypes, hydroid, muscular tissues, Len- 
denfeld, 1884. 

Polyplacophora, fossil, n. sp., North- 
western Tasmania, Hull, 1914—Lord 
Howe and Norfolk Islands, Hedley and 
shoul, ae lAe 

Polypodium spinulosum, Merrill, 1919. 

Polyzoa, Australian, Whitelegge, 1887— 
Cyclostomatous, Port Jackson and 
neighbourhood, Haswell, 1879—fresh- 
water, Goddard, 1909—n. g., Woods, 
1878—Queensland Coast, Haswell, 1880. 

Porcellana, Moreton Bay, Queensland, 
Brazier, 1880. 

Porifera, Hallmann, 1916, 1917. 

Porphyries, Snowy River, Victoria, bed 
similar in age and character to, 
Shearsby, 1905. 

Port Jackson, and neighbourhood, Cyclo- 
stomatous Polyzoa, Haswell, 1879— 
ichthyology, Castelnau, 1878—Mollusca, 
Coxe sos. 

Port Jackson District, ecological study, 
saltmarsh vegetation, Hamilton, A. A., 
1919—Lepidosperma, n. sp., Hamilton, 
Arp Aeee lO ili()s 

Precipitins, Chapman, H. G., 1910. 


Preparation of specimens, simple method 
of substituting alcohol for a watery 
solution, Haswell, 1891. 

Pristiophorus cirratus, Distomum, Nn. sp., 
from, Johnston, S. J., 1902—young, 
Haswell, 1884. 

Proceedings, Society’s, dates of publica- 
tion of early volumes, Fletcher, 1895. 

Proctotrypidae, n. sp., Dodd, 1920. 

Proetus, Etheridge and Mitchell, 1893. 

Promecoderus and allied. genera, Sloane, 
1890. 

Prosobranchiata, Kesteven, 1902-1905. 

Prosopon Etheridgei, from the Cretaceous 
of Queensland, Woodward, 1892. 

Prostanthera, n. sp., Baker, 1896. 

Proteaceae, Australia, Woolls, 1885. 

Protococcoideae, Playfair, 1916. 


Protoconch, Gasteropod, constitution, 
Kesteven, 1912—Gasteropod, ontogen- 
etic stages represented by, Kesteven, 
1905. 


Protodonata, Tillyard, 1918. 

Protomecoptera, Tillyard, 1917. 

Protoplasm, recent views on the structure 
of, Haswell, 1893. 

Protozoa, parasitic, Johnston, T. H., 1909. 


Protozoan, n. sp., infesting sheep, Lenden- 
feld, 1885. 

Prune Rust, McAlpine, 1895. 

Psalidura, Ferguson, 1909. 

Psammoseris, 1. sp., Woods, 1878. 

Pselaphidae, Australian, Raffray, 1900— 
Australian and Tasmanian, Lea, 1910. 

Pseudechis porphyriacus, poisonous con- 
stituents of venom, Martin, 1892. 

Pseudobonellia, Great Barrier Reef, John- 
ston and Tiegs, 1919. 

Pseudomorph, glendonite, recently dis- 
covered occurrences, Walkom, 1913. 
Pseudophycis breviusculus, Port Jackson, 

Ramsay, 1881. 

Pseudozaenini, Sloane, 1904. 

Psilotum, Waswell, 1887—gametophyte, 
preliminary notes, Whitelegge, 1916. 
Psychopsidae, n. g. et n. sp., Tillyard, 1918 

—n. sp., Tillyard, 1925. 

Psychopsis, elegans, life-history, Tillyard, 
1918—n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1903. 

Psyllidae, Froggatt, W. W., 1900-1903. 

Pterocera lambis, rare variations in shell, 
Willey, 1896. 

Pterohelaeus, Carter, 1911. 

Pterostichini, Sloane, 1915. 

Pterostylis, Rupp, 1925. 

Pterygophorus cinctus, Froggatt, W. W., 
1890. 

Ptilinopus Corriei, Ramsay, 1875-76. 

Ptilotis, n. sp., Endeavour River, Ramsay, 
1875-76—n. sp., Torres Straits, Ramsay, 
1878. 

Ptinidae, n. g. et n. sp., Olliff, 1885. 

Ptychodera australiensis, Coast N.S.W., 
SGU, dla 125 ISOs, 

Puccinia on Groundsel, with trimorphic 
teleutospores, McAlpine, 1895. 

Puff-ball, fairy-ring, McAlpine, 1900. 

Puffinus carneipes, Ramsay, 1878. 

Pultenaea, n. sp., Baker, 1897.  . 

Pupina, n. sp., “Chevert” Expedition, 
Brazier, 1875-76—n. sp., Queensland, 
Beddome, 1896. 

Purpura, anomala, rectification of nomen- 
clature, Tate, 1880—tritoniformis, 
systematic position, Kesteven, 1901. 

Pycnogonida, n. sp., Australian Coast, 
Haswell, 1884. 

Pycnoptilus floccosus, nesting in N.S.W., 
Ramsay, 1886—range, Ramsay, 1881. 
Pyralidina, Australian, n. g. et n. sp., 

Meyrick, 1889. 

Pyrrotachys, Sloane, 1896. 


Pythia, nomenclature and distribution, 
Coxaplseik 

Queensland Coast, geology, Andrews, 
1902. 


Quince fruit, fibro-vascular system, com- 
pared with apple and pear, McAlpine, 
1912. 


62 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


Radiolaria, casts, Pre-Cambrian rocks, S. 
Australia, David and Howchin, 1896— 
Palaeozoic rocks, N.S.W., David, 1896 
—Rolling Downs Formation, Queens- 
land, Dun, Rands and David, 1901. 

Rana temporaria, motor nerve-endings of 
limb muscles, Murray, 1924. 

Raphyrus Hixvonii, Lendenfeld, 1885. 

Rat, infesting western portion N.S.W., 
Bennett, 1887—supposed n. sp., interior 
N.S.W., Ramsay, 1881. 

Regalaecus, n. sp., Port Jackson, Ramsay, 
1880. 

Regent bird, egg, Ramsay, 1886. 

Rennin, action, Moseley and Chapman, 
1906. 


Reptiles, Haemogregarines from, John- 
ston, T. H., 1909—Herbert River, 
Queensland, Macleay, 1883—New 


Guinea, De Vis, 1890—Norfolk Island, 
Ogilby, 1887. 

Reptilia, Australian, Haematozoa of, 
Johnston, T. H., 1910, 1911—Herbert 
River District, Queensland, Macleay, 
1885. 

Researches, anthropological and anatomi- 
cal, Melanesia and Australia, résumé 
of results, Maclay, 1881. 


Resin-secreting glands, structure, Collins, 
1920. 
Rhabdosigma, Hallmann, 1917. 


Rhinobatus Bougainvillei, Ogilby, 1885. 


Rhipidura, n. sp., Lord Howe’s Island, 
Ramsay, 1878—n. sp., Torres Straits 
(?), Ramsay, 1877—preissi, nidification, 
North, 1888. 

Rhizobia, in soil, determination, Smith, 
ik, Gp, Galily 

Rhizobium leguminosarum, fixation of 
nitrogen by, Smith, R. G., 1906—forma- 
tion of slime or gum by, Smith, R. G., 
1906—nature of bacteroids of legumin- 
ous nodule and culture, Smith, R. G., 
1901—structure, Smith, R. G., 1906. 

Rhizophyllum, n. sp., Yass, N.S.W., 
Shearsby, 1904. 

Rhizopoda, Australian freshwater, Len- 
denfeld, 1885—freshwater, N.S.W., 
Whitelegge, 1886—seasonal distribu- 
tion, Arcella, Queensland, Gillies, 1918. 

Rhizopods, Sydney and Lismore, Play- 
fair, 1917. 

Rhopalocera, Australian, Waterhouse, 
1902-1912; Waterhouse and ‘Turner, 
1904—Australian, n. sp., Meyrick, 1887; 
Waterhouse, 1900—Lord Howe Island, 
Waterhouse, 1897—Mount Bellenden- 
Ker, Queensland, Olliff, 1888—Mount 
Kosciusko, N.S.W., Olliff, 1889—n. sp., 
Miskin, 1888, 1890. 

Rhypidura, n. sp., Ramsay, 1875-76. 

Rhysodidae, n. sp., Olliff, 1885. 


Richmond, River, N.S.W., biology, Play- 


fair, 1914—vale, Glossopteris in Greta 
Coal Measures, David, 1890. 

Risella, Woods, 1875-76. 

Rissoa, Kesteven, 1906. 

River capture, striking example, in 
Coastal District, N.S.W., Woolnough 
and Taylor, 1906. 

Rock, in Magdala Shaft, Victoria, tem- 
perature, Maclay, 1881—oyster, destruc- 
tive parasite, Haswell, 1885—shelters, 
aboriginal, Port Hacking, Harper, 1899. 

Rocks, N.S.W., petrological notes, 
Benson, 1914—Samoa, notes on some 
recent work, Jensen, 1909—Tertiary 
Foraminiferal, New Hebrides, Chap- 
man, F., 1905. 

Rossiteria, Brazier, 1894. 

Roy Bell’s Molluscan Collections, results, 
Iredale, 1924. 

Rutaceae of Australian Alps, 
1886. 

Rylstone District, botany, Baker, 1896— 
Hucalypts, Baker, 1903. 

Sacculina, infesting Australian crabs, 
Haswell, 1888—parasitic, on Pilwm- 
nopeus serratifrons, Stead, 1899. 

Sago and tobacco, indigenous, 
Guinea, Maiden, 1887. 

Salinator, Smith, EH. A., 1901. 

Salisburia palmata, Ratte, 1887. 

Salisburiae, fossil, Australia, additional 
evidence, Ratte, 1887. 


Saltmarsh vegetation, near Sydney, 
Collins, 1921—Port Jackson District, 
ecological study, Hamilton, A. A., 1919. 

Samoa, geology, Jensen, 1906. 

Sanderling, Borneo, Seebohm, 1893. 

Sand-movement, N.S.W. Coast, Halligan, 
1906. 

Sandstone, black, ulmite, 
of, Steel, T., 1921. 

Sapindaceae, Australia, Woolls, 1888. 

Saprolegnia, variations of sporocyst, 
Collins, 1920. 

Saragus, Carter, 1911. 

Sarcophaga, revision, 
Hardy, 1923. 

Sarcophilus satanicus, 
1910. 

Sarticus, Sloane, 1889. 

Saturniadae, Turner, A. J., 1922. 

Satyridae, n. sp., Olliff, 1887. 

Savaii, eruptions, Jensen, 1906. 

Saw-flies, Froggatt, W. W., 1890, 1918; 
Turner, G., 1900. 

Saw-fly, n. g¢. et n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 
1899. 

Scaevola crassifolia, 
Collins, 1918. E 

Seale-insect, n. sp., affecting sugar cane 
in New Guinea, Rutherford, 1916. 


Stirling, 


New 


a constituent 


Johnston and 


genitalia, Flynn, 


leaf anatomy, 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 63 


Scarabaeidae, Lea, 1924; Masters, 1886. 
Searitidae, n. sp., Queensland, Macleay, 
1887—New Holland, Macleay, 1887. 
Searitini, Sloane, 1907, 1917—n. sp., 

Sloane, 1916. 

Scenopidae, North, 1886. 

Sceparnodon, incisors, De Vis, 1891. 

Schist, Glaucophane, Conandale Range, 
Queensland, Jensen, 1907. 

Schizoglossa, Hedley, 1892. 

Schizomycetes, Playfair, 1915. 

Sciaena, n. sp., N.S.W. Coast, Ramsay 
and Ogilby, 1886. 

Sciaridae, Skuse, 1888. 

Science and government, 
Lucas, A. H. S., 1908. 

Scincid lizard, Lygosoma entrecasteauxi, 
placentation, Harrison and Weekes, 
1925. 

Sclerorinus, Ferguson, 1915. 

Scoliidae, revision of Australian species 
of Anthobosca, and n. sp., Turner, R. E., 
1907. 

Scolytidae, Masters, 1886. 

Scomber antarcticus, Macleay, 1879. 

Scylliorhinus canicula, unusual type of 
secreting epithelium in Wolffian duct, 
Murray, 1925. 

Scyphomedusae, Australian, geographical 


relations of, 


distribution, Lendenfeld, 1884—local 
colour varieties; Lendenfeld, 1884— 
Southern Hemisphere, Lendenfeld, 
1884. 

Sea, urchin, Australian, remarkable 
shortened development, Mortensen, 


1915—water, eastern coast of Australia, 
temperature, Maclay, 1884. 

Seaham, Main Glacial Beds at, Osborne, 
1925. 

Secotium, Australian and New Zealand, 
Cunningham, 1924. 


Section-cutting, method, Lendenfeld, 
1885. 
Seeds, Acacia, distribution of nitrogen, 


Petrie, J. M., 1911—non-protein nitro- 
gen in, Petrie, J. M., 1908—ripening, 
nitrogen, Petrie, J. M., 1911. 

Seirotrana, Carter, 1908. 

Selaginella uliginosa, anatomical features 
of mature sporophyte, Steel, J. K., 1923. 

Sericesthis, n. sp., Blackburn, 1890. 

Sericulus melinus, egg, Ramsay, 1886. 

Serpentine Belt, N.S.W., Benson, 1913- 
1920. 

Serpulea, marine Annelides of the order, 
Haswell, 1884. 

Shale, kerosene, fracture, Ratte, 1887. 

“Shark-hooks”’, method of suspending, 
Etheridge, 1899. 

Shark, n. sp., Port Jackson, Ramsay and 
Ogilby, 1887—Saw-fish, young, Haswell, 
1884—Tiger, brain, Haswell, 1882. 


Sharks, and rays, distribution, Ogilby, 
1885—rare, Port Jackson, Macleay, 
1879—taken in Port Jackson, Ramsay, 
1880. 

Sheep, merino, improvements effected by 
Australian climate, soil and culture on, 
Trebeck, 1884. 

Sheep’s teeth, dental incrustations and 
so-called “gold-plating’’, Steel, T., 1920. 

Shell, marine Australian, n. sp., Hedley, 
1894—marine, n. sp., Hedley and 
Musson, 1891—n. sp., Beddome, 1897. 

Shells, Brazier, 1880—Australian, Woods, 
1877—Fluviatile, N.S.W., Brazier, 1882 
—freshwater, Australia, check-list, Tate 
and Brazier, 1881—freshwater, New 
Guinea, Woods, 1879—freshwater, New 
Zealand, Hutton, 1882; Woods, 1878— 
land and _ “freshwater, Queensland, 
Hedley and Musson, 1891—Jland, n. sp., 
Woods, 1878—Maclay Coast, New 
Guinea, Brazier, 1884—marine, Brazier, 
1885—marine, n. sp., Woods, 1877, 
1879—marine, n. sp., Moreton Bay, 
Woods, 1879—Menke’s Australian, Tate, 
1881—n. sp., Australia and New Guinea, 
Brazier, 1877—n. sp., Australian and 
Solomon Islands, Brazier, 1875-76— 
Port Jackson, New Caledonian and 
other, Brazier, 1879—Solomon Islands 
and Australia, Brazier, 1880. 

Shields, Northern Queensland, Htheridge, 
1894. 

Shipworms, Australasian, Hedley, 1898— 
Australian, Hedley, 1894. 

Siderite, remarkable crystals, Ratte, 1885. 


Simulidae, Skuse, 1888. 

Siphluridae, n. g. et n. sp., Tasmania, 
Tillyard, 1921. 

Sisyridae, characters and relationships 


and new and little-known genera and 
species, Tillyard, 1916. 

Skink, Australian, n. sp., Ramsay and 
Ogilby, 1889—lizard, Tasmania, Frost 
and Lucas, 1893. 

Skinks, n. sp., Ogilby, 1889. 

Skull, marsupial, Broom, 1909. 

Slime, bacterium, from peach, almond 
and cedar, Smith, R. G., 1903—bac- 
terium, pleomorphic, Smith, R. G., 
1905—of household bath-sponge, Smith, 
IR, (Gh, Salo. 

Slimes, bacterial, in soil, Smith, R. G., - 
1911. 

Smut, n. sp., in new genus of 
McAlpine, 1911. 

Snails, carnivorous, n. g., Hedley, 1892. 

Snake, Australian black, poisonous con- 
stituents of venom, Martin, 1892— 
Australian, n. sp., Ogilby, 1894—n. sp., 
Barrier Ranges, Macleay, 1885—n. sp., 
Herbert River, Ogilby, 1890. 


grass, 


64 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


Snakes, Australian, census and n. sp., 
Macleay, 1884—A ustralian, venom, 
Katz, 1888—n. sp., Macleay, 1881—Port 
Darwin, Macleay, 1877. 

Society’s, earliest history, some new light 
on, Dixson, 1904—heritage from the 
Macleays, Fletcher, 1920. 

Soil, and botanical survey of N.S.W., need 
for, Cambage, 1925—fertility, Smith, 
R. G., 1910-1918—organisms, destruction 
of paraffin by, Smith, R. G., 1914— 
Protozoa, action of Toluene upon, 
Smith, R. G., 1914—Protozoa, inactiv- 
ity, Smith, R. G., 1912. 

Soils, toxicity, Smith, R. G., 1915. 

Solanaceae, chemical investigation of 
some poisonous plants in, Petrie, J. M., 
1916-1917. 

Solandra longiflora, nor-hyoscyamine in, 
Petrie, J. M., 1916. 

Solandrine, Petrie, J. M., 1907. 

Solanum nigrum, Cheel, 1917. 

Solea, n. sp., Port Stephens, Ramsay, 1882. 

Solomon Islands, bees, Cockerell, 1911. 

Sound Basins, New Zealand, Andrews, 


1906. 
Spear-becket, New Caledonia, New Heb- 
rides and other’ Pacific Islands, 
Htheridge, 1899—tanna, Etheridge, 
1899. 


Species-making, Miskin, 1890. 
Sphagna, Australia and Tasmania, Watts, 
1912. 


Sphecotheres mawillaris. nidification and 
description of eggs, Fitzgerald, R. D., 
Junr., 1887. 

Sphodrini, Sloane, 1910. 

Spinifex resin, Maiden, 1889. 

Sponge, Clarence River, destructive to 
oyster culture, Lendenfeld, 1885—crabs, 
development, Hale, 1925—n. sp., Port 
Jackson, Lendenfeld, 1885—remains, 
Lower Silurian, N.S.W., Dun, 1897— 
Siliceous, alga forming a pseudomorph 


of a, Lendenfeld, 1885—with remark- 
able colouring power, lLendenfeld, 
1885. 

Sponges, Lendenfeld, 1885—Australian, 


Lendenfeld, 1884-1885—Calcareous, his- 
tology and nervous system, Lendenfeld, 
1884—digestion, Lendenfeld, 1884— 
flesh-spicules in, Lendenfeld, 1884— 
freshwater, Haswell, 1882—horny, sen- 
sitive and ganglia cells, Lendenfeld, 
1885—Monaxonid, Hallmann, 1914— 
Monaxonid, n. g., Hallmann, 1919— 
two cases of mimicry, Lendenfeld, 1885. 

Spores, double staining, Smith, R. G., 
1900. 

Sporocysts, two remarkable, occurring in 
Mytilus latus, on Coast of New Zealand, 
Haswell, 19@2. 


“Springing” of tins of preserved fruit, 
L’Hstrange and Greig-Smith, 1918. 
Springsure District, botany, O’Shanesy, 
1881. 

Squalus acanthias, 
fin, Murray, 1924. 

Squill, Moreton Bay, De Vis, 1882. 

Staphylinidae, Australia, Olliff, 1886-1887. 

Stenorhynchus, n. sp., Haswell, 1878. 

Sterculia, laurida and ~°S. _ discolor, 
Maiden and Betche, 1898—pararabin 
gum, Smith, R. G., 1903. 

Sternoxes, King’s Sound and vicinity, 
Macleay, 1888. 

Sternula sinensis, breeding in Australia, 
North, 1889. 

Stigmodera, n. sp., Carter, 1912—n. sp., 
Tropical Australia, Carter, 1917. 

Stilbite, eruptive rocks, Jamberoo, N.S.W., 
Engelhardt, 1891. 

Stomopneustes, n. sp., Woods, 1882. 

Stone implements, Australia and South 
Sea Islands, Cox, 1875-76. 

Stools, rachitic, bacterial flora, 
R. G., 1910. 

Straits’ Settlements, eruption in, Lenden- 
feld, 1884. 

Stratiomyiidae, Hardy, 1924; Smith, 
V. I., 1920-1923—Australia, White, A., 
1916—n. sp., Hill, G. F., 1919. 


Streptococcus from wheat-ensilage, Katz, 
1886. 

Strongyliinae, n. g. et n. sp., Carter, 1915. 

Stropheodonta, Mitchell, 1923. 

Strophomenidae,, Bowning, N.S.W., Mit- 
chell, 1923. 

Strychnicine, Petrie, J. M., 1918. 

Strychnine, behaviour of Hyla aurea to, 
Chapman, H. G., 1908. 

Styphelia longifolia, Brough, 
embryo sac, Brough, 1923. 

Submarine slope of N.S.W., Hedley, 1910. 

Sugar-cane, an Ascobacterium from, 
Smith, R. G., 1902—gummosis, Smith, 
R. G., 1902—juice, gum fermentation, 
Smith, R. G., 1901—red string, Smith, 
R. G., 1904. 

Sugar-canes, abnormal, Steel, T., 1923. 

Sugar crystals, in bulk, deterioration of 
raw and refined, Smith, R. G., 1901— 
raw, acid fermentation, Smith, R. G., 
1901. 

Sydney District, Hucalyptus, n. sp., Deane 
and Maiden, 1897—geography, Andrews, 
1903. 

Syllidae, Australian, Haswell, 1920. 

Symbiosis, Haswell, 1882; McLuckie, 
1922-1923—new instance, Haswell, 1884. 

Sympetes, Carter, 1910. 

Symplocos, n. sp., Baker, 1902. 

Synechocera, n. sp., Thery, 1923. 

Syngnatus, parasitic, Ramsay, 1880. 


muscles of pectoral 


Smith, 


1924— 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 65 


Synthemis, Tillyard, 1910. 


Taal, voleano, Woods, 1887. 

Tabanidae, Ferguson and Hill, 1920, 1922 
—Australian, Taylor, F. H., 1915-1919 
—n. sp. Camden Haven District, 
N.S.W., Ferguson and Henry, 1919. 

Tachardia, n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1911. 

Tachinidae, Fissicorn, n. sp., Australia 
and South America, Bezzi, 1923. 

Tachyglossus, Port Moresby, New Guinea, 
Ramsay, 1877. 

Tachys. Sloane, 1896. 

Talaurinus, Ferguson, 1912-1914. 

Tamworth District, geology, Benson, 1915. 


Tamworth, N.S.W., Devonian and Car- 
boniferous formations, Cotton and 
Walkom, 1912—mosses, Mueller, 1894. 


Tan-bark, fermenting, high temperature 
organism, Smith, R. G., 1921-1923. 

Tannin, action of, on Infusoria, Gilliatt, 
1883. 

Tarrietia argyrodendron, Baker, 1892. 

Tasmania, bees, Cockerell, 1912. 

Taupo Zone, New Zealand, recent erup- 
tions, Stephens, W. J., 1886. 

Teara, bag-shelters of larvae, Froggatt, 
W. W., 1896. 

Teleost, larval, N.S.W., Ogilby, 1897. 

Teleostei, Australian marine, Haema- 
tozoa, Mackerras. and Mackerras, 1925. 


Temnocephaleae, Haswell, 1892, 1900— 
n. g., Haswell, 1892. 


Temnocephaloidea, critical 
well, 1924. 
Temnopleurus, 

1880. 

Tenebrionidae, Blair, 1919; 
—Cyphaleinae and Cnodaloninae, 
Carter, 1913—Dorrigo, Carter, 1910— 
in, 2 Ge m, 0. Cesare, Isha, so Se 
n. sp., Barrington Tops, N.S.W., Carter, 
1916—n. sp., Carter, 1909-1911, 1920. 

Tenebrioninae, Carter, 1914—n._ sp., 
Carter, 1914. 

Tenthredinidae, Froggatt, W. W., 1918— 
n. g. et n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1890— 
n. sp., Turner, G., 1900. 

Termite, n. sp., Hill, G. F., 1922. 

Termites, Diptera found in association 
with, Hill, G. F., 1921—WMordellistena, 
nN. sp., parasitic on, Hill, G. F., 1922— 
n. sp., and notes on their biology, Hill, 
G. F., 1921—n. sp., Central and South- 
east Australia, Hill, G. F., 1923—North 
Australian, descriptions and biology, 
Ist, (Ge 1M, Ue. 

Termitidae, Froggatt, W. W.. 1895-i897— 
Northern Territory, Hill, G. F., 1915. 

Terrestrial shells, n. sp., Brazier, 1878. 

Tertiary formation at New Guinea, 
Woods, 1877. 

E 


notes, Has- 
young specimen, Woods, 


Carter, 1914 


Tetragonurus, Ramsay and Ogilby, 1888. 

Therapon, found in dam near Warialda, 
Macleay, 1878—n. sp., Macquarie River, 
Ramsay, 1881. 

Thrips galls, n. sp., and their inhabitants, 
N.S.W., Van Leeuwen and Karny, 1924. 

Throwing sticks, Papuan, Jennings, 1896. 

Thylacine, earlier Nototherian period, 
Queensland, De Vis, 1893. 


Thylacoleo, Broom, 1898. 

Thynnidae, Turner, R. E., 1907, 1908. 

Thysanoptera, Froggatt, W. W., 1904. 

Tick fever parasite, Smith, R. G.,, 1899. 

Tin deposits, New England, N.S.W., 
Cotton, 1909. 

Tineidae, Meyrick, 1892. 

Tineina, Meyrick, 1880. 

Tipulidae, brevipalpi, Skuse, 1889—longi- 
palpi, Skuse, 1890—n. sp., Alexander, 
1922. 


Tisiphone, abeona, new variety, Water- 
house, 1904—breeding experiments 
with, Waterhouse, 1922, 1923. 


Tmesipteris, Haswell, 1887. 


Tortoise, freshwater, n. g. et n. sp., Fly 
River, New Guinea, Ramsay, 1886— 
freshwater, method adopted by female 
in excavation of burrows, McCooey, 
1887. 

Tortricidae, n. sp., Durrant, 1891. 

Tortricina, Meyrick, 1881—Australian, 
Meyrick, 1910, 1911. 

Toxin-producers, search for, Smith, R. G., 
1918. 


Toxocidaris erythrogrammus, remarkable 
shortened development, Mortensen, 
1915. 

Trachelomonas, Playfair, 1915. 

Trachichthys, Port Jackson, Ogilby, 1885. 

Trachypterus, N.S.W., Ogilby, 1897. 

Trawl fishing, outside Port Jackson, 
Macleay, 1883. ; 

Tree, creeper, n. sp., De Vis, 1895—frog, 
n. sp., Boulenger, 1892. 

Trees and shrubs, exotic, affected by Aus- 
tralian Loranths and Viscums, Turner, 
He Le9Ae 


Trematode, Avian, n. sp., Chase, 1920— 
parasites of Australian frogs, Johnston, 
S. J., 1912—parasites of marsupials 
and a Monotreme, Johnston, S. J., 1912. 


Trematodes, new Gyrodactyloid from 
Australian fishes, Johnston and Tiegs, 
1922. 

Tribes, N.S.W., objects of unknown 
significance used by, Harper, 1898. 

Tribrachiocrinus corrugatus, Ratte, 1886 
—Carboniferous sandstone, N.S.W., 
Ratte, 1884. 


Trichoglossus, n. sp., Ramsay, 1875-76. 


66 INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 


Trichomatidae, characters and relation- 
ships and new and little-known genera 
and species, Tillyard, 1916. 

Trichophysetis cretacea, labial 
Philpott, 1925. 

Trichoptera, Tillyard, 1917—Lord Howe 
and Norfolk Islands, Tillyard, 1917. 

Tricoma, Cobb, 1898. 

Trigonia Lamarckii, a variety of, Woods, 
1877. 

Trigonotomini, Sloane, 1907. 

Trilobite, Reefton, New Zealand, new to 
Australasia, Hutton, 1887. 


Trilobites, Carboniferous, Mitchell, 1918 
—n. sp., Mitchell, 1922—n. sp., Bowning, 
N.S.W., Mitchell, 1887, 1888, 1919, 1924 
—N.S.W., Mitchell, 1919—new to Aus- 
tralia, Ratte, 1886, 1887—Silurian, 
N.S.W., and Australia, Etheridge and 
Mitchell, 1891-1917. 

Tripterygium, mn. sp., Port 
Ramsay and Ogilby, 1888. 

Trivia, occurrence of a sulcus, Kenyon, 
1896. 

Trixagidae, Masters, 1886. 

Trochidae, Brazier, 1894. 

Trochocochlea, some Australian species, 
Woods, 1877. 

Trochus adamsi, Port Jackson, Brazier, 
1894. 

Trogositidae, list with n. sp., Olliff, 1885. 

Trout, food, Neuropteroid insects of Hot 
Springs Region, New Zealand, in rela- 
tion to problem of, Tillyard, 1920— 


palpi, 


Jackson, 


rainbow, ulcer disease, Smith, R. G., 
1902. 
Trygonorhina fasciata, with abnormal 


pectoral fins, Hill, J. P., 1895. 
Trypetidae, n. sp., Froggatt, W. W., 1910. 
Tuff and lavas, fossiliferous, Cavan, Yass, 

N.S.W., Shearsby, 1905. 

Tuffs, Foraminiferal, Malekula, New Heb- 
rides, Chapman, F., 1907. 

Tulostoma, Cunningham, 1925. 

Tumours, shoot-bearing, Hucalypts and 
Angophoras, Fletcher and Musson, 1918. 

Tunicata, Kesteven, 1909—power of loco- 
motion, Macleay, 1878. 

Turbellarian, Alloiocoele, inhabiting 
underground water of Canterbury, New 
Zealand, Haswell, 1892—Rhabdocoele, 
inhabiting branchial cavities of New 
Zealand crayfishes, Haswell, 1900. 

Turtles, freshwater, “aquatic respiration”’, 
Haswell, 1885. 

Typhlocyba australis, Myers, 1921. 

Typhlopidae, Australian, Waite, 1894. 

Typhlops, nu. sp., Boulenger, 1894. 


Ulladulla, N.S.W., glendonites and glacial 
erratics, Brown, 1925. 
Ulmite, Steel, T., 1921. 


Uncinula, first record in Australia, 
McAlpine, 1899. 

Urolophus testaceus, Haswell, 1888. 

Uromyces amygdali, McAlpine, 1895. 

Vegetable structures, delicate, cutting 
sections, Haswell, 1886. 

Vegetation, Lord Howe Island, Maiden, 
1898, 1899—Malaysia, Woods, 1889. 

Venation of leaves and its value in deter- 
mination of botanical affinities, Deane, 
1900. 

Venom, Australian snakes, Katz, 1888. 


Vermilia, caespitosa, embryology, Has- 


well, 1887—new Crustacean found in- 
habiting tubes, Haswell, 1884. 

Versuridae, development, Lendenfeld, 
1884. 


Vertebrata, solution for preserving large, 
for anatomical examination, Maclay, 
1881. 

Vertebrates, n. sp., Herbert River, N. 
Queensland, De Vis, 1886. 
Vespidae, nests and habits, 

W. W., 1894. 

Vibris denitrificans, Smith, R. G., 1901. 

Vitia, Fiji Islands, Ramsay, 1875-76. 

Vivipara, n. sp., Brazier, 1878. 

Voleanic activity, islands near N.E. 
Coast of New Guinea, Maclay, 1884. 

Voleano of Taal, Woods, 1887. 


Froggatt, 


Vomerine bones, mammalian and _ rep- 
tilian, Broom, 1902. 
Wallaby, rock, supposed hn. sp., Palm 


Island, N.E. Coast, Australia, Ramsay, 
1875-76. 

Warrumbungle Mountains, diatomaceous 
earth, David, 1895, 1896—geological 
history, Jensen, 1906—geology, Jensen, 
1907. 

Water, bacteriotoxie action, Smith, R. G., 
1914—from Eucalyptus roots, Bennett, 
1883—Sydney Supply, bacteriological 
examination, Katz, 1886-1887. 

Wattle, bark infusions, ropiness in, 
Smith, R. G., 1920—Gidgee, calcium 
oxalate in, Steel, T., 1921. 

Wax, figures, aboriginal camp, Miriam 
Vale near head of Baffle Creek, Rock- 
hampton, Cox, 1888—scale, n. sp., New 


CGutinen, IProgsain, Wa. We, I1gilg— 
solvents, in soil, action, Smith, R. G., 
1910. 


Weevils, blind, n. sp., W. Australia and 
Tasmania, Lea, 1900. 

Whale, Grey’s, brain, Haswell, 1883. 
White ash, Southern N.S.W., Deane and 
Maiden, 1898. 
“Widow’s cap’, 

Etheridge, 1899. 
Wine, white, clouding, Smith, R. G., 1900. 
Wines, red, loss of colour, Smith, R. G., 

1904. 


Australian aborigines, 


INDEX TO SUBJECTS OF PAPERS. 67 


Wombat, ossification of vertebrae, Broom, 
1900. 

Wombeyan Caves, N.S.W., bone breccia 
deposit, Broom, 1896. 

Womerah, Billetta or Gnalealing, modi- 
fications, Etheridge, 1892—Northern 
Australia, undescribed form, Etheridge, 
1892—or “Throwing-stick’’, presumed to 
be undescribed, Etheridge, 1891—or 
Throwing-stick, three additional types, 
Etheridge, 1893. 

Wood moths, Froggatt, W. W., 1894. 


Worthenia, Devonian fossil allied to, 
Ratte, 1885. 

AXanthorrhoea, entomology, Froggatt, 
W. W., 1896. 


Xiphasia, Port Jackson, Ramsay and 


Ogilby, 1886. 


Yarrangobilly Caves District, N.S.W., 
mosses, Brotherus and Watts, 1912. 
Yass Plains, geology, Jenkins, 1878-1879. 
Yeast, single cell cultivation, Smith, 

JR, Ca, aC 


Zelotypia Stacyi, Olliff, 1887. 

Zeuglodon, Murray River, near Welling- 
ton, South Australia, molar tooth, 
Sanger, 1880. 

Zoogeographic 
Hedley, 1899. 

Zoogeographical regions, study, by means 
of specific contours, Tillyard, 1914. 


scheme for wmid-Pacific, 


Zoological Collection, Norfolk Island, 
Millington, 1887; Ogilby, 1887; Olliff, 
1887. 

Zoological station, Sydney, proposed, 
Maclay, 1878, 1879. 

Zoological novelties, Haswell, 1892. 


Zoology, “Chevert’”, ornithology, Masters, 
1875-76—Lord Howe’s Island, Ramsay, 


1882—Maclay Coast, New Guinea, 
Maclay, 1884-1885—_New Caledonia, 
Ogilby, 1897—New Guinea, Ramsay, 
1878-1883, 1885—Solomon Islands, 
Ramsay, 1879-1882. 

Zoophytes, N.S.W., record of localities, 


Kirchenpauer, 1884. 


iii INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


Arranged alphabetically under names of exhibitors. 


ALKIN, Rev. See under Havitanp, EH. 

ANDERSON, C. Crystals of rhodonite from 
Broken Hill. 1908, 290—Portion of Jaw 
of Diprotodon. 1922, xxv. 

ANDERSON, J. See under STEPHENS, W. J. 

ANDREWS, H. C. Red and yellow fruits of 
the Quandong. 1914, 472. 

ANONYMOUS. Dendritic stone from Rooty 
Hill. 1875-76, 20. 

ArcHER, W. H. Remarks based on letter 
from Mr. Lloyd, concerning desira- 
bility of establishing an aquarium on 
the shores of Port Jackson. 1879, 106. 

AsHER, —. “Holy dollar” and several 
“dumps”. 1883, 281. 


Baitty, FE. M. See under Fiercuemr, J. J. 

BaiLtrty, J. F. Collection of shells and 
Hehinodermata. 1884, 508—See also 
under BRAZIER, J. 

Baker, R. T. (For H. SmirxH) Barytes 
in Hawkesbury Sandstone from Gos- 
ford. 1892, 328—Fruiting specimens of 
Acacia pubescens. 1893, 239—Note on 
new variety of Acacia decurrens. 1896, 
348—Morchella conica from Moonbi 
Plains. 1896, 503—Fossil leaf and 
fossil wood from Wyrallah, Richmond 
River. 1896, 503—Note on Hucalypts 
killed by drought. 1897, 254—(For C. E. 
FINCKH) Rare fish (Monocentris 
japonicus) from Newcastle. 1897, 441 
—Camphor and camphor oil from 
leaves of Cinnamomum oliveri. 1897, 
685—(For Rev W. W. Watts) Six Aus- 
tralian mosses, with notes by Mr. Watts. 
1899, 186—Native yam from Angledool. 
1899, 373—Casts of three fishes. 1899, 
418—Section of trunk of Hakea lorea. 
1899, 418—Note on vernacular name 
(Cut-tail) of Hucalyptus  fastigata. 
1899, 547—Fungus (Hmpusa acridii) 
from South Africa. 1899, 548— 
Aboriginal fire stick. 1900, 114—Two 
undescribed fungi from Katoomba. 
1900, 114—Model of meteorite found at 
Bugaldi. 1900, 476—Portion of old 
pump made of white ironbark found in 
excavations in Hlizabeth Street. 1900, 
542—Phosphorescent fungus (Pleurotus 
candescens). 1900, 612—Bottled fruits 
of Quandong. 1900, 697—Aboriginal 
stone axe from Tumberumba Creek. 
1901, 146—(For H. Drxson) Vanilla 
grown at Summer Hill. 1901, 632— 
Flowering and fruiting Hucalyptus 
viminalis. 1902, 238—Observations on 


collecting data regarding effects of 
drought on flora. 1902, 495—Section 
showing fructification of Blackfellows’ 
Bread (Polyporus mylittae). 1902, 592 
—Timber of fHuroschinus falcatus. 
1902, 592—Flannel flower showing fas- 
ciation of stem. 1902, 592—Woliage and 
bark of probable new Acacia. 1902, 592 
—‘“Box” seedling of Eucalyptus populi- 
folia. 1902, 592—Pherosphera TFite- 
geraldi from Blue Mountains. 1903, 312 
—Aboriginal ceremonial stone. 1903, 
362—Truffle (Mylitta lapidescens) from 
India. 1903, 884—Olearia dentata from 
Pambula. 1903, 884—Fungus (Battar- 
rea tepperiana) from Nymagee. 1903, 
884—Hdible tubers of species of Vitis 
from Tamworth. 1905, 222—Puff ball 
fungus (Podaron aegyptiacus). 1905, 
259—Specimens of a “nut’’ scratched up 
from below ground and eaten by rat 
kangaroos. 1905, 351—Loranthus pen- 
dulus on Hucalyptus hemiphloia. 1905, 
491—Photographs showing various 
stages of parasitism. 1905, 491—Vege- 
table fibre from Tickera, S.A. 1906, 
261—Branch of Hucalyptus Bridgesiana 
with normal and abnormal leaves and 
fruits. 1906, 674—Two plants, Raoulia 
eximia ana Rk. mammillaris from New 
Zealand. 1907, 630—Specimen and 
drawing of Adenochilus from Went- 
worth Falls. 1907, 838—Contribution 
to discussion on welfare of indigenous 
fauna and flora. 1908, 633—Sea balls 
from South Australia. 1909, 591— 
Timber of Hucalyptus globulus with 
wide annual rings. 1909, 591—Grey 
gum, Hucalyptus punctata, with varie- 
gated leaves. 1909, 591—(For Dr. EK. C. 
Hatt) Hucalypt seedling with three 
cotyledons. 1910, 27—Tickera-fibre and 
manufactured products. 1910, 804— 
Specimens of a fungus (Fomes) grow- 
ing on Forest Oak props in a coal-mine. 
1911, 504—Rare species of Persoonia. 
1911, 306—Remarkable bark of Mela- 
leuca bracteata. 1911, 504—Sections of 
buttress of a Fig-tree. 1912, 557—Red 
Cedar damaged by fungi; entomo- 
genous fungus. 1913, 526—Sections of 
wood and leaves of Grey Mangrove. 
1916, 492—Lantern slides of the 
Mangrove-association. 1916, 493—Sec- 
tion of trunk of California Redweod 
showing annual rings; vegetable wax 
from Beyeria. 1917, 246-247—Section 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 69 


1923, xxx—Exotic plants new for the 
State. 19238, xxxiii—Solanum elaeagni- 
folium. 1923, xxx—YXanthium spinosum 
showing hypertrophy of fruits and 
spines and prolification of spines. 1928, 
Xxxi—Asparagus officinalis, terato- 
logical specimen of, 1924, xxiv— 
EHchium italicum, Myosotis versicolor, 
Rapistrum hispanicus, R. rugosum var. 
nervosum. 1924, xxxi—Silene nocturna. 
1924, xxiv. 

BLOOMFIELD, H. Report of statements that 
half-caste natives had been seen on the 


ot log of Bastard Honeysuckle (Banksia 
latifolia). 1917, 6083—New species of 
Hucalyptus. 1921, 157—See also under 
JOHNSTON, S. J.; Maipen, J. H., and 
BAKER, R. T. 

Baker, R. T., and H. G. SmirH. Botan- 
ical specimens and chemical products 
from certain Hucalypts. 1899, 548. 

Bancrorr, T. L. See under FLETCHER, 
Ve dos WilAwaneny, di, Il 

Betty, F. J. Note on Hchinaster decanus. 
1887, 1074. 

BennNeEDrT, K. H. Nest of three eggs of 
ground graucalus. 1882, 348—Spinifex Herbert River, Queensland. 1880, 636. 
or porcupine grass. 1883, 180—Mallee Brapuiry, B., and H. G. CHapmMan. Oven 
hen with young and eggs. 1883, 180— for imbedding histological material. 


Fungus from Mossgiel. 1886, 163—See 1914, 158. 
also under Nortnu, A. J. Brazier, J. Native food from Marshall 
Benson, W. N. Fossil ferns, sections, and Islands. 1875-76, 20—Fungus (Agari- 


cus) from Loyalty Islands. 1875-76, 20 
—Six rare species of Cypraea from 
Darnley Island. 1875-76, 44—A new 


microphotos. 1915, 414. 
Betcue, EK. Series of interesting plants. 


BickFoRD, H. I. 


1900, 697—Five rare species of Hpacris. 
1900, 698—See also under Maipen, J. H.; 
MAIpEen, J. H., and HE. BEtcHeE. 
Remarks on need of 
increased efforts for protection and 
preservation of native flora and fauna 
of Western Australia. 1911, 505— 
Flowering specimen ot Christmas-Tree 
of West Australia (Nuytsia floribunda). 
1911, 634—West Australian Pitcher- 
plant. 1912, 654—West Australian 
plants (Hucalyptus, and Black Kan- 
garoo-Paw). 1913, 48, 661. 


BLAKELY, W. F. Hupatorium glandulosum 


and Crepis setosa. 1920, 318—Hybrid 
form, Boronia serrulata « B. floribunda 
and variety of B. serrulata. 1920, 404 
—Amarantus deflexus. 1921, 209— 
Calandrinia caulescens. 1921, 158— 
Centaurea picris. 1921, 503—Cheno- 
podium vulvaria. 1921, 5083—Drymaria 
filiformis. 1921, 237—Huphorbia Drum- 
mondii. 1921, 210—Helipterum uni- 
florum. 1921, 268—Kochia Georgei. 
1921, 237—Orthocarpus erianthus. 1921, 
158—O. purpurascens. 1921, 158— 
Saponaria Calabrica. 1921, 349—Silene 
noctif“iora. 1921, 349—Sisymbrium 
altissimum. 1921, 158—S. Sophio, 1921, 
503—Species of Pterostylis. 1921, 408 
—Xanthium commune. 1921, 210— 
Acacia juncifolia. 1922, xxvi—Albinism 
in Pultenaea daphnoides. 1922, xxvii— 
Cenchrus pauciflorus. 1922, xxii—Hight 
weeds from N.S.W. 1922, xxxi— 
Hrucastrum incanum. 1922, xxiii— 
Examples of homoplasy. 1922, xxiy— 
Fruiting specimens of Acacia subtili- 
nervis. 1922, xxix—Large flowering 
variety of Lasiopetalum rufum. 1922, 
xxkvlii—Painting of Loranthus alyai- 
folius. 1922, xxviii—Oarthamus den- 
tatus. 1923, xxx—Oirsium  arvense. 


Helix from Hall Sound, New Guinea. 
1875-76, 44—Hggs of a Porphyrio from 
the Loyalty Islands. 1875-76, 283—New 
species of Murex from Port Darwin. 
1875-76. 311—New species of Helix 
from New Guinea. 1877, 74—Haliotis 
canaliculata and Tellina perna from 
Port Jackson. 1877, 142—Panopoea 
australis. 1877, 378—Collection of 
sternums of fowls. 1878, 21—Shells 
from Port Moresby and a Holothuria 
from Port Jackson. 1878, 122—Rare 
shells from California. 1878, 160— 
Series of Cylindrella and of Strophia. 
1878, 305—New species of Conus and 
Mitra. 1878, 406—Specimen of obsidian. 
1878, 406—Fossil shell from Algiers. 
1879, 107—Living specimen of Spon- 
dylus from Port Jackson. 1879, 107— 
Neoera latesulcata from Sydney Heads 
and four corals from Port Jackson. 
1879, 292—Note on Limnaea from fresh 
water, near Parramatta. 1879, 292— 
Centrostephanus rodgersii. 1879, 312— 
Bulimus senilis, Cypraea bregariana 
and a new Cardium. 1879, 3856— 
Cardium fornicatus and Helix aibo- 
labris. 1879, 398—Specimens of Maga- 
sella cumingi, Megerlia pulchella, M. 
sanguinea, Terebratulina cancellata, 
Kraussia lamarckiana and Cypraea 
spidacea. 1879, 409—Oniscia pon- 
derosa and Helix thomsonti. 1879, 459 
—Voluta angasi and two _ varieties. 
1879, 463—Chione calophylla with a 
small pearl. 1879, 471—Species of 
Heliz, species of fossil Goniatites, 
Ammonites, and Rhynchonella trom 
France. 1880, 300—Voluta deliciosa 
with operculum. 1880, 300—Notes on 
Helix palmensis var. meridionalis. 
1880, 458—Large tick (Ricinus) taken 


70 


from an Hchidna. 1880, 458—Phyllo- 
theca trom Rookwood. 1880, 458— 
Specimens of Voluta musica and 
Amphiperas hordacea. 1880, 469— 
Species of Lepralia. 1880, 495—Filaria 
from imported herrings. 1880, 629— 
Species of Heliz. 1880, 637—Three 
species of Australian sea birds. 1880, 
637—Ancylus cunninghami and sup- 
posed new species of Gundalucina. 1881, 
170—Young Voluta mammilla. 1881, 
196—Helix from the Kent’s Group. 
1881, 197—Tortoise with two heads. 
1881, 408—Shells from New Caledonia 
(for Mr. Rossiter) and Western Aus- 
tralia (for Prof. Tatr). 1881, 408— 
Specimens of Amplexa, Ancylus and 
Limnaea. 1881, 539—Specimens of 
Astreopora, Dolium and Melania. 1881, 
581—Bulimus  rossiteri. 1881, 626— 
Note on Limopsis loringi. 1881, 789— 
Culaxis layardi and Helix caffra. 1881, 
790—Fine collection of specimens of 
the genus Cypraea. 1881, 836—(For 
Mr. Barttry, of Melbourne) Triton 
quoyi and Bulimus loyaltyensis. 1882, 
91—-Species of Cypraea, Corbula and 
Clausilia. 1882, 134—Partula layard, 
1882, 205—Cypraea citrina and Ovulum 
depressum. 1882, 330—New shell from 
New Guinea. 1883, 35—(For Mr. 
BaiLteEy) Bulimus acutus. 1883, 388— 
(For Mr. Barry) Voluta and Cypraea. 
1883, 442—(For Mr. Batrey) Fossil 
Bryozoa. 1883, 442—(For Mr. Batty) 
Hocene Cypraea. 1883, 464—Fossil 
land _ shell. 1884, 509—Species of 
Helicidae. 1884, 866—Trigonia con- 
taining a pearl. 1884, 1016—Specimens 
of Sepia and of Chiton. 1885, 341— 
Rare shells from New Zealand. 1885, 
449_Astreopora from Port Jackson. 
1885, 449—Minyas sp. 1885, 553—Shell 
showing splintering effect of sun’s heat. 
1885, 695—New species of Helix. 1886, 
163—Photographs of four species of 
Partula. 1886, 477—Specimens of 
Ceratella. Hydractinea, Dehitella and 
Chitena. 1886, 577—(For Mr. DEANE) 
Shells from Parramatta River. 1886, 
577—Species of Triton. 1886, 853— 
Retepora phoenicea and Meretriz 
lusoria. 1886, 974—Ceratella fusca 
from Coogee. 1887, 198—Photographs 
of Polyzoa from Green Point, Fort 


Jackson. 1887, 250—Physa gibbosa 
from Waterloo. 1888, 894—Spherical 
stone from crop of pigeon. 1888, 1096 


—Segmentina australiensis from Water- 
loo swamps. 1888, 1096—Wax figures of 
aboriginal women. 1888, 1255—Land 
shell (Subulina octona) from New 
Caledonia. 1888, 1507—Note on Murex 
corneus. 1889, 117—Cuban land shell 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


(Subulina octona). 1889, 118—(For 
Mr. R. C. Rossiter) Hggs of Megapo- 
dius layardi, from New Hebrides. 1889, 
131—Mollusea trawled off Merimbula. 
1889, 1029—Crassatella pulchra. 1889, 
1029—Native pottery from  Pelew 
Islands. 1891, 8—Cypraea tigris. 1891, 
8—Diplomorpha delatouri. 1892, 200— 
Pupa fallax. 1892, 200—Copy of “Index 
Testarum Conchiliorum” printed in 
1742. 1892, 344—Cassis nana from 
Ballina. 1892, 344—Murexr octogonus 
and M. umbilicatus. 1892, 344—Note 
on Cassis wyvillei from Solomon 
Islands. 1893, 483—Astele subcarinatus 
from Circular Head, Tasmania. 1893, 
43—Murex polypleurus and fossil M. 
octogonus. 1893, 181—Additional locali- 
ties for Astele subcarinata. 18938, 303 
—Specimens of Marginella pulchella 
from Norfolk Island. 1893, 305— 
Pumice collected at Norfolk Island. 
1893, 305—Astele multigrana from 
Spencer’s Gulf. 1893, 305—Supposed 
voleanie rock from Watson’s Bay. 
1893, 305—Wood from New Caledonia. 
1893, 328—(For Mr. T. Sree.) Abor- 
iginal stone axes. 1893, 438—Recluzia 
hargravesi from near Port Stephens. 
1893, 586—Patella pilsbryi. 1894, 187— 
Conus pulcherrimus from New Hebrides. 
1894, 187—Curved specimen of Kuphus 
arenarius. 1894, 540—Pearls taken from 
Tapes turgida, Ostrea cucullata and O. 
subtrigona. 1894, 561—Sinistral variety 
of Helix similaris and species of Mar- 
ginella and Columbella. 1894, 561— 
Stilifer tumida from Wollongong. 1894, 
561—Trochus adamsi and T. poupineli 
from New Caledonia. 1894, 5883—Three 
species of Trochus from Loyalty 
Islands. 1894, 708—Calyptraea radians 
from Chili. 1894, 708—Zoological and 
botanical specimens found at Nelson 
Bay Beach (Bronte) during southerly 
gales. 1895, 209—Ringed snake (Ver- 
micella annulata) found at Waverley. 
1895, 472—Cardium vertebratum trom 
Keppel Bay, Queensland. 1895, 472— 
Specimens of Cypraea showing calios- 
ities and of Trivia with dorsal sulcus. 
1896, 29—Specimens of Cypraea and 
Pectunculus. 1896, 584—Note on shells 
from kitchen middens at Bondi Bay. 
1896, 817—Cypraea vitellus, unusually 
coloured. 1896, 818—Clathurella water- 
housae from Vaucluse. 1896, 818— 
Hawk’s bill turtle obtained at Nelson 
Bay, Waverley. 1897, 254—Specimen of 
Planazis mollis. 1897, 254—Helix ver- 
miculata from Waverley. 1897, 441— 
(For Mrs. Kenyon) Mollusea from Vic- 
torian coast. 1897, 810—New Volute 
from Lakes Entrance, Victoria. 1897, 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


810—Monstrosity of Placostylus fib- 
ratus from New Caledonia. 1898, 76 
—Variety of Risella plana from Port 
Jackson. 1898, 76—Haliotis from Vic- 
toria. 1898, 408—Placostylus payensis 
var. gayettensis from New Caledonia. 
1898, 408—Miscellaneous collection 
from New Caledonia. 1904, 872. 

BREAKWELL, EH. A. Sections of stem 
of Apophyllum anomalum, showing 
palisade tissue. 1915, 629. 

Brewster, Miss A. A. Hriostemon lanceo- 
latus showing double flowers and de- 
terioration of stamens. 1920, 473. 

Broom, R. Bone breccia from Taralga. 


1895, 618—See also under FLETCHER, 
do: as 
BuRNELL, S. C. Spirifer disjunctus in 


pebbles from Wallerawang. 1887, 982 
—Living specimen of Pygopus lepido- 


podus. 1888, 336—Rare moth (Byleora 
sp.) with pupa case. 1888, 423—Living 
Typhlops nigrescens. 1888, 1096— 
Kitten with eight legs. 1888, 1559— 
Ceylon fire-flies. 1889, 190. 


Burns, A. N. Argynnina hobartia cyrila. 
1921, 408—Larvae, pupae and perfect 
insects of Paralucia aurifer, and Pro- 
tialmenus lithochroa. 1921, 504. 

BuRRELL, H. Photo of a marine mollusc 
Ovipositing. 1910, 805—Observations on 
Denisonia superba closing its hole after 
entering. 1925, xlv. 


CALDWELL We VEL Specimen showing 
stages in development of monotremes. 
1884, 1205. 

CAMBAGE, R. H. Photograph of group of 
Eucalyptus albens affected by snow 
storm. 1900, 611—Hucalyptus eximia. 
1902, 206—Fruiting branches of Pitto- 
sporum undulatum, which bear flowers 
with long stamens. 1902, 598—Photo- 
graph of carved aboriginal grave tree. 
1905, 222—Incrustations resembling ful- 
gurites from Barrenjoey. 1905, 350— 
Flowering branch of Hucalyptus leu- 
coxzylon from Deniliquin. 1909, 117—A 
Cowrie shell from the South Coast. 1916, 
192—See also under Maipen, J. H., and 
R. H. CAMBAGE. 

CAMPBELL, A. J. Lantern slides of Aus- 
tralian birds’ nests and eggs. 1900, 
60—see also under Ramsay, H. P. 

CARNE, J. E. Nepheline-aegirine rocks 
from Mudgee district. 1903, 313—Tin- 
and wolfram-ores from New England. 
1910, 308—Lantern-views of New 
Guinea and Java. 1913, 113—See also 
under Davin, T. W. E. 

CarNE, W. M. Branches of Aleppo pine, 
Pinus halepensis, showing heterogamy. 
1906, 497—Floral prolification in a 
species of Teasel. 1910, 805—Specimen 


Qa! UA ‘eit. 
Svzor® ade) oN 
Lad) i! Hus 
\Z \ “Z 


\e ia sh 71 
NY po 


of Bupleurum m. 1919, 820— 
Wild oat, Avena sterilis. 1922, xxx. 
CARNE, W. M., and C. T. Musson. A rare 
phyllopod crustacean (Apus sp.) from 

Richmond, N.S.W. 1911, 159. 

Carson, D. Portion of lower jaw of ex- 
tinct marsupial, Diprotodon australis. 
UBD, aly). 

Carter, Miss H. Plants from the Bar- 
rington and Bean Bean Tableland. 
1887, 982. 

Carter, H. J. Entomological novelties. 
1903, 685—Scaraphites macleayi from 
Darling Point. 1903, 685—Vegetable 
caterpillar from Peak Hill. 1903, 685— 
Two beetles taken from ants’ nests in 
N.W. Victoria. 1905, 352—-Report on 
spreading of the English fox. 1909, 114 
—Coleoptera representing a new 
Family. 1910, 27—Coleoptera of the 
genus Notonomus. 1913, 398—Six Aus- 
tralian genera of Chalcophorinae. 1920, 
521--Three closely-allied Cyphogastra. 
1920, 531—Cyrioides sex-spilota. 1920, 
531—New species of Stigmodera. 1920, 
531—New genus from Port Macquarie. 
1920, 531. 

CHAPMAN, H. G. 


Sample of pure pan- 
creatic juice. 1904, 871—Dried blood 
serum of rabbit. 1905, 392—Attention 
called to variation in reaction between 
Hyla awrea and strychnine. 1906, 362 
—Hxperiments on curdling of milk by 
action of pancreatic juice. 1906, 424— 
Graphic record of blood pressure of 
dog after intravenous injection of solan- 
drine. 1906, 674—Note on precipitum 
yielded by anti-sera interacting with 
protein. 1907, 837—Slide illustrating 
phagocytosis of tubercle bacilli. 1907, 
838—A marine algal ball from Balmoral 
Beach. 1911, 425—-Mosquito larvae in 
sea-water. 1912, 237—A rare Cephalo- 
pod, Spirula spirula. 1913, 170——Sec- 
tions of small intestine, and fundus of 
dog’s stomach. 1915, 119—Peptone pre- 
pared from proteins of egg-white. 1917, 
247—Extract of the pancreas of the 
ox, and its coagulative action on milk; 
synanthic flowers of Fuchsia. 1917, 512 
—Samples of yeast. 1918, 612—Paint- 
ings of variants of flowers of Clianthus 
Dampieri. 1921, 503. 


CHapmMAN, H. G., and B. Brapitey. Oven 
for imbedding histological material. 
1914, 158. 

CHArpMAN, H. G, and J. M. Perrrie. 
Demonstration of precipitin reaction 
with extracts of seeds. 1909, 415. 


CHEEL, EX. Form of Blechnum cartil- 
agineum from Manning River. 1900, 
60—Sterculia diversifolia and Juncus 
caespititius. 1901, 145—Seedlings of 
Juncus prismatocarpus and J. holo- 


72 


schaemus. 1902, 207—Collection of 
foliaceous lichens from north island of 
New Zealand. i902, 371—Collection of 
lichens. 1903, 687—-Three plants raised 
from seed of Callistemon lanceolatus. 
1903, 884—Two apparently different 
forms of Helichrysum bracteatum from 
near Hden. 1904, 696—Probable un- 
described species of Callistemon from 
near Bullahdelah. 1905, 577—Fresh 
specimens of Daviesia buxifolia, raised 
from seed collected at Eden. 1906, 675 
—Specimens of N.S.W. hepatics. 1906, 
675—Collection of fungi. 1907, 159— 
Coprinus comatus from lawns in 
Botanic Gardens. 1907, 475—Curious 
horse-hair fungus recorded as Maras- 
mius equi-crinis. 1907, 475—Collection 
of rare fungi from N.S.W. 1907, 839— 
Specimens illustrating habits of leaf- 
eutting bee and pollen-collecting bees. 
1908, 287—Collection of fungi. 1908, 
736—Series of fungi. 1908, 798—Fifteen 
fungi, with notes thereon. 1909, 413— 
Series of fungi. 1909, 500—Hyegro- 
metric club moss (Selaginella lepido- 
phylla). 1909, 591—Two Australian 
lichens, Parmeliopsis semiviridis and 
Heterodea Muelleri. 1909, 591—Speci- 
mens of barley affected with powdery 
mildew and a smut. 1909, 591—Potato 
leaves affected with blight. 1909, 591— 
Collection of lichens. 1909, 71i— 
Remarkable or unrecorded fungi. 1910, 
137, 433, 524, 689, 805—Timber-destroy- 
ing fungi. 1910, 308, 309—Groundsel 
infected directly from aecidiospores. 
1910, 660; teleutospores produced. 1910, 
805—Orobanche, a root-parasite. 1910, 
660—Sleeping Disease of Tomato-fruits. 
1910. 48—A flowering branch of a 
hybrid Brachychiton; a small log of 
Correa Lawrenciana. 1911, 635—(for 
Mr. Maripen) Drawings of, and a Note 
on two grasses. 1911, 634—A grass 
(Digitaria) from Parsley Bay. 1911, 
424--Hnglish primroses with phyllodic 
sepals. 1911, 505—Fungi. 1911, 606— 
Sucker branches of Peach affected with 
“Peach Leaf Curl’. 1911, 607—Remark- 
able plants; Solanaceous plants un- 
affected by potato blight, though ex- 
posed to infection. 1911, 158—Speci- 
mens of Atylosia and Stizolobium, an 
original specimen of Persoonia media. 
1911, 347-348—Specimens of West Aus- 
tralian species of Persoonia; a fresh 
flowering specimen of the West Aus- 
tralian Wax-plant; specimens of rare 
species of Persoonia. 1911, 305-306— 
Mistletoes from Burrinjuck, N.S.W.; 
Rosa turbinata, and Grevillea aspleni- 
folia var. Shepherdiana. 1912, 137— 
Fungus on River She-oak. 1912, 236— 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


Grasses (Hragrostis spp.), Kangazoo 
Grass, Darwinia taxifolia var. grandi- 
flora, pods of Stizolobium spp. 1912, 393 
—Grasses, various. 1912, 494—Sweet- 
briar infested with Rose-rust; Rust- 
smitten Grasses; Viviparous Fescue 
Grass; Kangaroo Grass showing two 
distinct forms. 1912, 592—Grasses in- 
fested with Smuts; Bulbous Meadow 
Grass. 1912, 654—(For Mr. D. G. 
STEAD) Bog-moss used for packing 
Trout-ova. 1912, 288—Grasses (Hrag- 
rostis spp.); fruit of Snake Gourd; a 
creeping NXanthium; and a hybrid 
Callistemon. 1913, 110—Fungi, includ- 
ing Rusts and Smuts. 1913, 170— 
Fungi, including Rusts. 1913, 254— 
Lichens, and Fungi. 1913, 396— 
Xerotes sp., and Tetratheca spp. 1918, 
527—Various plants. 1913, 606—Grasses. 
1913, 658—Lizard with anomalous tail. 
1914, 20—Seventy cultivated Legumes. 
1914, 160—Puff-ball. 1914, 255—Ground- 
sel attacked by Rust. 1914, 397— 
Species of Dillwynia; flowering speci- 
mens of Callistemon viminalis and of a 
hybrid. 1914, 471—Three species of 
Clover, and drawing of Eucalypt, by W. 
Swainson. 1914, 646--Leaves of Grape 
vine, Hucalyptus. Dryandra, and 
Banksia affected with a disease caused 
by Mites. 1915, 117—Various grasses 
from new localities. 1915, 207—Red 
Clover infested with Rust; Hrechthites 
from Twofold Bay; Dysphania littor- 
alis, poisonous to stock; Centaury from 
England and Australia. 1915, 290— 
Geranium and 4cacia attacked by Rust; 
Couch Grass with abnormal inflores- 
cences. 1915, 416—Geranium Rust; 
abnormal Orange. 1915, 420—Red 
Clover Rust in all stages; fresh flower- 
ing and herbarium specimens of Callis- 
temon spp.; flowers of Helichrysum 
varying in colour. 1915, 625, 626— 
Seven species or vars. of Hardenbergia. 
1915, 722—An abnormal fungus (Poly- 
saccum); remarks on a white-flowered 
Hardenbergia. 1916, 105—Seeds of 
French bean. 1916, 192—Plants of 
Callistemon raised from European seed, 
and drawings. 1916, 219—Fresh flower- 
ing specimens of two W.A. Kennedyas 
(for Mr. H. Drxson). 1916, 267—Rhodo- 
dendron Galls on Azalea. 1916, 492— 
Naturalized Evening Primroses, Roses, 
and a Composite (Hmilia). 1916, 633 
—Abnormal inflorescences of Waratah. 
1917, 440—Flowering Callistemon hy- 
brids; examples of bracteoles, in 
addition to bracts in Callistemon; an 
introduced weed, Linaria Pellisseriana. 
1917, 512—Peculiar roots of Hakea, 
Banksia, and Grevillea; seedlings of 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


Tephrosia; two forms of Oxzalis cornicu- 
lata; cut-leaved or  parsley-leaved 
bramble; Rosa bracteata: flowers of 
Styphelia tubiflora, varying in colour. 
1918, 235-236—Two forms of “Cobblers’ 
Pegs”: seeds of Soy Beans. 1918, 610- 
611—Callistemon pachyphyllus, show- 
ing delayed dehiscence of the fruits. 
1918, 712—Callistemon tlanceolatus, 
white flowering form. 1919, 191— 
Flowering specimens of giant Bamboo. 
1919, 721—Flying fox skull impaled on 
twig of Lombardy Poplar. 1919, 438 
—Living seedling plants of Triphasia 
trifoliata, Hremocitrus glauca. Poncirus 
trifoliata and Microcitrus australasica. 
1919, 356-357—Rust-fungus on common 
broad bean. 1919, 525—Fresh specimens 
of Oxalis corniculata. 1919, 525— 
Ceratopetalum gummiferum with white 
flowers. 1920, 473—Double-flowering 
peach-tree (Prunus persica var. dianthi- 
flora). 1920, 203—Erigeron Tinifolius, 
living plants of. 1920, 404—Specimens 
of wild strawberry, Fragraria indica. 
1920, 404—Kennedya rubicunda with 
greenish-white flowers. 1920, 473 
Leaf and fruits of Pisonia Brunoniana. 
1920, 180—Rare lichen from Mt. 
Kosciusko. 1920, 265—Species of 
Boronia with double flowers. 1920, 
473—Species of Boronia with white 
fiowers. 1920, 473—Two distinct forms 
of Callistemon viminalis. 1920, 221— 
Two forms of Callistemon pachyphyllus. 
1920, 221—White flowering Hriostemon 
lanceolatus and EH. Crowei. 1920, 473— 
Black Mustard. 1921, 350—Caladenia 
tesselata. 1921, 350—Collection of seeds 
of species of Coral Tree, Hrythrina spp. 
1921, 504—Colza Rape (Brassica cam- 
pestris). 1921, 350—Field Rape, 1921, 
350—Live plant of Cosmos caudatus. 
1921, 237—Lyperanthus nigricans. 1921, 
350—Pterostylis barbata. 1921, 350— 
Rai or Indian Mustard (Brassica 
junecea). 1921, 350—Rock Salad (Hruca 
sativa). 1921, 350—Fresh flowering 
specimen of Callistemon. 1922, xxviii— 


Fyésh flowering specimens of Calliste- 
tse OLY, (7 pallidus. 1922, xxix—Knot-grass 


(Polygonum aviculare) infested with 
rust fungus. 1922, xxx—Schizophyllum 
commune from Perak. 1922, xxx— 
Seedling plants of blackberry infested 
with ‘rust disease’. 1922, xxvii— 
Banksia Cunninghamii. 1923, xxxvili 
—Bertya pomaderroides. 1923, xxxvili 


—Fungus (Ganodermus lucidus var.. 


japonicus?). 1923. xxxii—Seedling 
plants of lemon-scented ironbark. 1923, 
xxxvi—Stages of development of hybrid 
Acacia (A. dealbata ~ A. Baileyana). 
1923, xxxiv—Two species of Huphorbia. 


~] 


co 


1923, xxxiii—Adder’s tongue fern. 1924, 
xxx—Fresh flowering specimens of 
Microcitrus australis. 1924, xxix— 
Myriangium montagnei. 1924, xxxi— 
Port Jackson Fig (Ficus rubiginosa). 
1924, xxvii—Sclerotium or _ so-called 
Blackfellow’s bread. 1924, xxii— 
Specimens of Mimulus moschatus. 1924, 
xxiv—Californian Straw Flower (Col- 
lomia grandifiora). 1924, xxiv—Flower- 
ing specimen of Hicksbeachia pinnati- 
folia. 1925, xlii—Seedling plants of 
Hucalyptus ficifolia and E. calophylla 
var. rosea. 1925, xl. 

CHEEL, E., and J. B. CLELAND. Fungi from 
the North Coast district. 1916, 104. 

CHERRY, R. L. See under HeEptey, C. 

CHISHOLM, E. C. Etiolated specimen of 
Arum Lily. 1925, xl—Vegetable Cater- 
jollewe, a2). sl. 

CLELAND, J. B. Collection of botanical 
specimens from Perth. 1906, 565— 
Note on resistance of Australian vegeta- 
tion to bush fires and antiquity of Aus- 
tralian aboriginal. 1907, 554—(For 

_ discussion on this note see 1907, p. 627) 

Note on twists in bark of Jarrah, 
Hucalyptus marginata. 1908, 291— 
Specimens illustrating remarks on 
Illawarra red water of cattle. 1909, 216 
—Note on record of camels perspiring. 
1909, 418—Abnormal flower of Can- 
dollea, 1910, 522—Portion of a Sand- 
pipe. 1910, 309—Mosquito-larvae from 
Mount Kosciusko; and an aboriginal 
stone axe-head from Cronulla. 1911, 
424-425—Manna from Kunzea sp. 1912, 
283—Hydatid Cysts, to show how they 
are devoured by dogs without injury. 
1912, 493—Acarids on a bull’s hide; 
Lomatia leaves for export. 1912, 591— 
Silver-fish from crop of a Turkey. 1914, 
88—Pine-cones and twigs of Hucalypt 
bitten off by White Cockatoos. 1914, 
158—Manna on leaf of EHucalypt; 
branchlet of Baeckea. 1914, 545—Root- 
lets of a EHucalypt dependent from the 
roof of a tunnel, 1915, 116—Seedling of 
Hakea. 1916, 103—Webbing of gos- 
samer-spiders. 1916, 191—Oyster-shells 
from the bank of the Namoi R. 1917, 
247—An introduced weed (Silene) 
from Thirroul. 1917, 604—Four Parts 
of Blanchard’s “Epigraphie Medicale”; 
blowflies bred from an Agaric. 1918, 
415—Ovo-testes from mullet (Mugil 
grandis). 1919, 721—See also under 
FLETCHER, J. J. 

Chics, dio 18h, @inc! 1D, reso, — lbs 
from the North Coast district. 1916, 
104. 

Cops, N. A. Simpte dissecting microscope. 
1891, 167—Two fungi (Phallus sp. and 
Cyathus sp.). 1891, 167. 


4 TINDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


CoLuic, R. Sponges from Wollongong. 
1891, 8—Gorgonia from Thursday Is. 
1891, 8. 


CoLuins, Miss M. I. Crinum sp. 1921, 
504—Specimens of Clianthus Dampieri. 
1921, 504. 


Corron, L. A. Diamonds from Copeton. 
1909, 417. 


Cox, J. C. New species of Leda. 1877, 
122—Shells of Trigonia strangei. 1877, 
122—Specimens of Aspergillum. 1877, 
122—Wood carving from Solomon 
Islands. 1878, 413—Young coco-nuts 
and dates from Port Mackay, Queens- 
land. 1879, 107—Turbinaria crater 

‘attached to Pearl oyster shell. 1879, 
116—Flower of Haemanthus tigrinus. 
1879, 116—Vegetable caterpillars from 
Kurrajong. 1879, 312—White Cypraea 
umbilicata from Tasmania; Ovulum 
gigas from Victoria. 1879, 387—Striated 
fruit of Lisbon lemon; also malformed 
navel orange. 1879, 387—Fossil teeth 
of Diprotodon. 1879, 408—Maori mask. 
1879, 409—Crustacean (Astacopsis) and 
three fish (Galaxias) from Mount 
Wilson. 1879, 471—Live specimens of 
Astacopsis from Mount Wilson, 1880, 
105—White ants’ nest with two eggs 
of large Iguana. 1880, 192—Fungus 
(Mylitta australis) used by blacks. 
1880, 192—Stone axe heads and other 
articles of aboriginal manufacture fiom 
the Cloncurry River. 1880, 637— 
Fossil seeds from Forest Diggings. 
1881, 196—-Record of Leucosia splendida 
from Tweed River. 1881, 197—Cypraea 
yrinceps from Torres Strait. 1881, 539— 
Ancient carving from Solomon Islands. 
1881, 539—Albino variety of Platycercus 
pallidiceps. 1881, 729—Account of 
hairy balls believed to be shark’s or 
ray’s castings. 1881, 790—Axes made 
from Tvridacna shell from Caroline 
Islands. 1881, 790—(¥For Mr. GILLiaTr) 
Stone axes and fossils from the Dar- 
ling. 1881, 790—EHthnological  speci- 
mens from the South Sea Islands. 
1881, 836—Bowl from.San Christoval 
Island. 1881, 846—Club from Solomon 
Group. 1882, 65—Moth of family 
Liphosidae. 1882, 91—Block of wood 
from shaft at Penrith. 1882, 134 
—Latirus strangei from Bulli. 1882, 
328—Fossil nuts and seeds from Forest 
Reefs, Orange. 1882, 328—Stone 
hatchet. 1882, 329—Oysters from Swan 
Bay near Cape Hawke. 1882, 560— 
Native torch from Duke of York 
Island. 1882, 560—Ironstone nodule 
from Liverpool Plains. 1883, 417— 
Remarkable blenny (Cristiceps) from 
Broken Bay. 1883, 417—Conus nodu- 


losus and C. abbas. 1883, 441—Rocks 
with globules of water enclosed. 1583, 
441—Cypraea lynz. 1883, 442—De- 
formed hen-eggs. 1883, 442—Silk- 
worm cocoons and gall of a Coccus. 
1883, 442—Skull of rabbit with elon- 
gate incisors. 1883, 464—Fossil En- 
crinite stems. 1883, 464—Collection of 
aboriginal implements ete., from New 
Guinea. 1883, 534—Cluster of large 
mud oysters. 1884, 508—Latiazxvis 
mawae. 1884, 682—Letter with re- 
marks on poison of Conus geographicus. 
1884, 944—Collection of fibres. 1884, 
946—Banded specimens of Helix. 1884, 
946—New species of land shell. 1884, 
946—Mushroom grown at Pott’s Point. 
1884, 1206—Dried specimen of Hrioste- 
mon . Coxii. 1884, 1206—Oysters (0. 
edulis) from Port Jackson. 1885, 75— 
Plant in which flowers had been 
succeeded by  bulbils. 1885, 76— 
Femur of Dinornis robustus. 1885, 76 
Iron-stained sandstone nodule. 1885, 
189—A large Sepia. 1885, 189 
Observations on the migrations of the 
maray. 1885, 343—Cup made of coco- 
nut. 1885, 448—Teeth and bones of 
horses from deep alluvium. 1885, 853 
—Fossils from near Maitland. 18&85, 
853—Flower and fruit of Hucalyptus 
ficifolia. 1885, 853--New Caledonia 
sling stones. 1886, 127—Native cap 
made from cobwebs. 1886, 854— 
Cypraea decipiens. 1886, 881—Helix 
koorongensis from South Australia. 
1886, 974—Fruit of Hugenia jambosa. 
1887, 144—Collection of Lepidoptera 
from Perak. 1887, 144—Cast of Latris 
hecateia. 1887, 979—Lepidoptera from 
Victoria. 1887, 979—Living specimens 
of Helix maconelli from Queensland, 
H. falconari from Richmend River. 
1887, 1075—Living specimen of Tri- 
gonia strangei from Port Jackson. 
1887, 1075—Ancylus irvinae from Tas- 
mania. 1888, 894—Tertiary fossil 
(Thylacodes decussatus). 1888, 894— 
Land and freshwater mollusea from 
near Narrabri. 1888, 1253—Carbon- 
iferous fossils from the Goulburn 
River. 1888, 1255—Record of regularity 
of appearance of green cicada near Syd- 
ney. 1888, 1508—Crustacean (Squilla 
sp.). 1888, 1559—Millstone used by 
natives near Cooper’s Creek. 1889, 188 
—Photographs of Turbo jourdani show- 
ing operculum. 1889, 189—Deformed 
Cypraea vitellus. 1889, 189—Sea snake 
(Pelamis bicolor) from Botany Bay. 
1889, 633—New Limpet (Ancylus) 
from Port Hacking. 1889, 633—Draw- 
ings of new Cypraea. 1889, 633— 
Albino specimen of Dacelo gigas. 1890, 


CuRRAN, J. M. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 75 


294—Fossil Hquisetum from North 
Shore. 1890, 294—Remarks on plague 
of mice at North Shore. 1890, 294— 
Attention called to time of appearance 
of the cicada near Sydney. 1890, 656 
—Rock lily with remarkable bud. 1891, 
125—British snail (Helix ericetorum) 
naturalized in Australia. 1891, 577— 
Specimen of Purpura textilosa from 
Brewarrina. 1892, 20—Collection of 
star-fishes, sponges and Gorgonias 
from N.W. Australia, 1892, 41—Speci- 
mens of the prawn, Palaemon ornatus, 
in Hunter River. 1892, 41—Photo- 
eraphs of angler fishes and a Siamese 
twin shark from New Zealand. 1892, 


41—Dendrobium  speciosuin showing 
budding. 1893, 43—Herring (Hlops 


SQUTUS ) . 1893, 436—Voluta mazmilla 
from Tasmania. 1893, 436—Species of 
fungi infesting caterpillars and other 
larvae. 1894, 362—Lamellibranch 
(Mactra) from White Cliffs, partly 
replaced by opal. 1894, 467—Orna- 
mented boomerang club. 1894, 467— 
Aboriginal shield from W.A. 1894, 708 
—Specimens of Chiton sinclairi, with 
a note on list of Australian Acantho- 
chitidae. 1894, 709—Living specimens 
of Terebratulina cancellata from off 
Cape Hawke. 1896, 505—Myochama 
woodsi from Derwent River, Tasmania. 
1896, 505—Specimens of Cypraea and 
Trivia. 1897, 578—Specimen of Voluta 
jednalli from Port Darwin with notes. 
1898, 648—Note on Thersites pachystila 
var. subfusco-zonata. 1898, 650—Speci- 
mens of varieties of Thersites bipartita. 
1898, 651—See also under O«aiLtBy, J. D. 
Taeniopteris associated 
with fish from Ballimore Coal Series. 
1889, 634—Dick Swift petrological 
microscope. 1890, 491—Photographs of 
geological interest from western and 
central N.S.W. 1890, 491—Microphoto- 
graphs of leucite basalt and cther 
basalts. 1890, 491—Photographs show- 
ing aboriginal carvings around grave 
mounds. 1890, 491—Stone implements 
from Western Districts. 1890, 491— 
Aboriginal skull from Bogan River 
Tribe. 1890, 491—Stalactite of metallic 
copper from Cobar. 1891, 381—Knotted 
schist from Bathurst. 1891, 703— 
Auriferous lode-stuff from Pambula. 
1891, 703—Lithographs of rock sections. 
1892, 20—Note on fossil Buprestid from 
Inverell. 1893, 181—Silurian coral 
(Heliolites) from Molong. 1893, 181— 
Trachyte from Coonabarrabran. 1894, 
467—Blue sapphire in basalt from New 
England. 1894, 467—Photographs and 
specimens illustrating geology of Mt. 
Kosciusko Plateau, with notes. 1896, 


819—See also under Frercuer, J. J.; 
Macreay, W.; STEPHENS, W. J. 


DarieEy, C. W. Shells of mud oyster from 


Rozelle Bay. 1891, 307—Voluta mag- 
nifica exhibiting superficial borings. 
1891, 307—Shells from sandspit off 
Darling Point. 1891, 7083—Photographs 
of, and remarks on, aboriginal kitchen- 
middens on the Richmond River. 1892, 
314—Rock bored by Pholas. 1896, 269 
—Sheet lead perforated by termites. 
1896, 269—Ancient boomerang from 
Darling River. 1896, 818—Particulars 
of reported occurrence of VYeredo and 
rock oyster, Gippsland Lakes. 1896, 
818. Timber of punt attacked by 
Isopod. 1900, 115. 


Davip, T. W. E. Fossils and bore cores 


from near Wallsend. 1886, 127—Basalt- 
glass (Tachylyte) from New England. 
1887, 1078—Dacite from Moss Vale. 
1887, 1083—Pitchstone from Port 
Stephens. 1887, i084—Chiastolite in 
stone hatchet, near Vegetable Creek. 
1887, 1084—(For Mr. C. S. WiLkinson) 
Intrusive basalt from Bulli. 1888, 423 
—Gabbro from Canoblas. 1888, 424— 
Remarks on occurrence of stilbite at 
Kiama. 1891, 8—(For Mr. J. H. 
Carner) Precious opal from White Cliffs. 
1891, 166—Remarks on luminous organ- 
isms in Illawarra district. 1891, 249 
—Note on occurrence of sphene in 
granite from Bathurst. 1893, 44, 126— 
Lepidodendron from Back Creek. 1893, 
126—Glossopteris leaves attached to 
stem from western coalfield. 1893, 218 
—Silurian coral (Mucophyllum) trom 
Yass district. 1894, 467—Sections of 
oolitic limestone from Manning River. 
1895, 409—Fossil algae (?) from Yass 
district. 1895, 410—Rocks from War- 
rumbungle Mts. 1895, 549—Note on 
radiolarian rock, Tamworth. 1896, 505 
Minute organisms from Rolling Downs 
formation. 1901, 311—Carboniferous 
plant (Ulodendron) from Welshman’s 
Creek, N.S.W. 1915, xx—Fossil wood 
bored by Teredo. 1921, 504—Microzoal 
limestone. 1921, 504—Paraffin wax 
from Ruthven bore, Q@. 1921, 504— 
Petrol from natural gas at Roma. 1921, 
504—Chert containing spore cases. 
1922, xxx—See also under ETHERIDGE, R., 
and D2 WwW. He DaAwap: 


IDA, “We WY5 leo IR, leben eynGl Ie It 


PirrmMaNn, Lantern views and specimens 
illustrating geology of Kosciusko 
Plateau. 1901, 74. 


Deane, H. Sandstone penetrated by bur- 


rows, probably insect. 1883, 298—Rocks 
on railway between Gunnedah and 
Narrabri. 1883, 386—Water from 


mineral spring near Ryde. 1884, 179— 
Gall. from Hucalyptus vresinifera ?. 
1884, 386—Caterpillar fungus. 1884, 
508—Two eggs, almost black, of com- 
mon duck. 1886, 974—Spider of genus 
Gastracantha. 1886, 1207—Melaleuca 
Deanei from Lane Cove. 1886, 1207— 
Fresh specimens of Prasophyllum 
Deanianum, with a note. 1887, 142— 
(For Mr. Percy WiLiiaAMs) Ferrugin- 
ous concretions in pipe-clay, Lachlan 


River. 1887, 142—Marine shells found 
in mud below Hawkesbury River 
bridge. 1888, 422—Excrescence on root 
ot Monotoca elliptica. 1888, 1096— 
Apodal lizard (Delma impar). 1888, 
1096—Fossils from Bredbo. 1888, 1096, 
1316—Kitten with double body. 1888, 


1316—Attention called to means of dis- 
tinguishing plant species by qualities 
and products generally overlooked. 
1889, 190—(For Mr. J. KF. FirzHarpince) 
Fasciation in branch of Casuarina. 
1890, 656—Ophideres saliminia from 
Casino. 1891, 249—Remarks on lumin- 
cus insects in Richmond River district. 
1891, 249—Hucalypt timbers. 1891, 576 
—Flowers of Pavonia hastata grown at 
Hunter’s Hill. 1892, 174—Zinnia show- 
ing transformation of florets into 
shoots. 1892, 174—Specimens of Iron- 
bark and Box groups of Hucalyptus. 
1892, 404—Timber of Hucalyptus leu- 
coxzylon and #. paniculata. 1892, 404— 
Lizard (Mocoa sp.) with bifurcated 
tail. 1892, 404—Plants from Broken 


Hill and Tarrawingee. 1883, 329— 
Attention drawn to introduced plant 
(Lotus hispidus) at Prospect. 1898, 


330—Botanical specimens from Tweed 
River and Hawkesbury River. 1895, 
537—Cotton-grass snake (Typhlops sp.) 
from Menindie. 1896, 113—Rare spider 
(Actinopus sp.) from Menindie. 1896, 
269—Mounted specimens of W. A. wild 
flowers. 1896, 351—Rock specimens 
from Victoria Lakes. 1896, 818—Photo- 
eraphs of fossil plants. 1897, 441— 
Fossil fruits ascribed to genus Hakea 
from New Zealand. 1898, 107—Old 
EKucalypt stump unearthed in George 
Street. 1898, 172—Plants from neigh- 
bourhood of Byrock. 1899, 135—(For 
P. HE. WititrtaAmMs) Quartzite stone axe 
from near Wileannia. 1900, 612—Con- 
tribution to discussion on welfare of 
indigenous fauna and flora. 1908, 633 
—Specimens from South Australia: 
fruiting branches of dwarf Hucalyptus 
pyriformis, seeds of three species of 
Santalaceae, large scorpions, native 
ornament. 1909, 413—Epidote from 
South Australia. 1909, 4183—Abnormal 
fruits of Cocos plumosa. 1909, 413— 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


Notice of address. on the physiography, 
geology and botany along the route of 
the proposed Transcontinental Railway 
Line between Port Augusta, S.A., and 
Kalgoorlie, W.A. 1910, 912—Lantern- 
slides illustrating the physiography and 
botany of the country along the route 
of the proposed Transcontinental Rail- 
way Line. 1910, 912—A rare Grevillea 
from the Blue Mountains. 1910, 483— 
See also under Brazimr, J. 


Dr Vis, C. W. See under Frercuer, J. J. 


Discussion on welfare of indigenous 
fauna and flora. 1908, 629. 


Drxon, J. R. L. Sections of decalcified 
lower jaw-bone of a dog prepared by the 
pyridin-silver-nitrate method. iG), 
119. 

Dixson, H. Undetermined species of 
Dendrobium from Solomon Islands. 
1894, 708—Fresh flowering specimens of 
two W. A. Kennedyas. 1916, 267—See 
also under Bakrr, R. T. 

Drxson, T. S. Preparations of bacillus 
of typhoid fever and others similar to 
it. 1882, 303—See also under FLETCHER, 
Ve dls 

Dopp, S. Remarks on the deaths of some 
animals tethered near a garden plant 
of the South African Acokanthera spec- 


tabilis. 1913, 109. 
D’OmpriAN, E. A. Chrysalides, and eggs 
of insects. 1911, 425—Seeds eaten by 


Great Black Palm Cockatoo. 1912, 493 
—Portion of plank injured by a marine 
Wood-borer. 1913, 110. 


Dun, W. S. Trilobites from the Silurian 
of England. 1896, 818—Specimen of 
Receptaculites. USVA, 441—Tawites 
medius from Bulyeroi Bore. 1897, 442 
—Protospongia in Lower Silurian 
slates. 1897, 442—Two fossil shells 
from the Narrabeen Beds. 1898, 173— 
Specimens of kerosene shale. 1900, 69. 
——Carbonate of copper from Long Reef. 
1900, 761—Plant-bearing shale from 
Sydney Harbour Colliery shaft. 1901, 
738—Species of Conularia from Ravens- 
field and Harper’s Hill. 1902, 495— 
Phialocrinus konincki from Mt. Vincent. 
1903, 361—Conularia from Clarence- 
town. 1905, 395—Lepidodendron from 
Yalwal. 1905, 577—Graptolites from 
near Tallong. 1908, 434—Glendonites 
from Gerringong. 1908, 798—Specimen 
of Lingula from Ravensfield. 1909, 216— 
(For A. B. WaLkom) Glendonites from 
the Lower Marine Series. 1912, 493 
—Photograph of reptilian footprints in 


shale. 1913, 399—Silurian Coral. 1913, 
607—Fossil dicyelic Crinoid. 1914, 545 
—Stalactite and calcified Myriapod. 
1916, 191. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. Uh 


Duncan, W. S. Collection of land and 
freshwater Mollusca from Inverell 
district. 1891, 574—Collection of Cole- 
optera from Inverell. 1893, 43. 


EpvELFELt, —. Native bag of fibre from 
Morus ? sp. 1885, 126. 

ETHERIDGE, R. Pair of Kuditcha shoes 
from Barrow Creek, Central Australia. 
1894, 562—Fossil leaves from _ Cool- 
gardie, W.A., and near Birdsville, Q. 
1897, 685—Note on musical spear from 
New ireland. 1899, 373—Wooden fish 
hooks used in the Pacific. 1899, 477— 
(For P. HE. Wirr1ams) Disc of slate 
from near Bourke. 1900, 696—Contri- 
bution to discussion on welfare of in- 
digenous fauna and flora. 1908, 632. 

PRHERIDGE, R., and TZ W. EH. Davin. 
Portions of skeleton of aboriginal found 
at Long Bay. 1888, 739—Aboriginal 
skull, with a note. 1888, 1314—Seeds 
of palm from Central Australia. 1892, 
373—Seeds of Bean tree from Central 
Australia used by aborigines for neck- 
laces. 1892, 373. 

Ewan, —. Nitrate of uranium and citrate 
of caffeine. 1882, 328—Gum resin of 
Hucalyptus globulus. 1882, 328. 


FaIirHFUL, P. See under STEPHENS, W. J. 

FARNELL, F. Contribution to discussion 
on welfare of indigenous fauna and 
flora. 1908, 630. 

FrerGuson, HE. W. Destructive Longicorn, 
Fleas, Ticks and Mosquitoes. 1914, 545 
—Foreign  biting-flies. 1915, 116— 
Imago and larvae of muscid fly. 1920, 
265—Species of Tabanidae. 1921, 210 
—Head of fowl infested with fleas. 
Gy, o-o-ahirle 

FINCKH, C. EB. See under Baker, R. T. 

Fincku, H. E. Report of importation of 
Huropean newts and hatching of 
Japanese newt. 1908, 798. 

FITZGERALD, R. D. Drawings of fossil 
bones from Lord Howe Island. 1884, 
1206. 

FITZHARDINGE, J. F. See under DEANE, H. 

FLAVELLE, A. E. See under Hatrican, 
Se Lal 

FrLetcHer, J. J. Giant earthworm from 

Burrawang. 1883, 218—Plates of 

Dendrolagus. 1883, 218—Parasitic 

worm (filaria) from kangaroo. 1883, 

388—Giant earthworm. 1884, 681 

Young of Pseudophryne australis. 1885, 

342—Antechinus flavipes with nine 

mammary foetuses. 1886, 164—Blasto- 

dermic vesicles of kangaroos. 1886, 164 

—Foetus of Ospranter robustus. 1886, 

164—Mizophyes fasciolatus from Mt. 

Wilson, 1886, 238—Segmenting ova of 

Pseudophryne bibronii and tadpoles of 


1886, 477—(For Rev. J. 
M. Curran) Grevillea anethifolia in 
fruit, with a note. 1886, 1208—(For 
Dr. Drxson) Photographs of two fin- 
back whales (Balaenoptera) captured 
at Twotold Bay. 1886, 1208—(For Mr. 
A. G. Hamirton) Remarkable frog, un- 
determined. 1887, 175—Living speci- 
mens of Bipalium kewense. 1887, 251 
—Indigenous land planarians. 1887, 
414—-Peripatus from Gippsland, with 
note. 1887, 450—Plants from Derby, 
N.W. Australia. 1887, 557—(For Baron 
VON MUELLER) Drawing of Aldrovandra 
vesiculosa. 1887, 621—(For Mr. Dr 
Vis) Lower Jaw of Nototherium. 1887, 
1078—Plants from Derby. 1888, 335 
Flowering specimens of JVallisneria 
spiralis and Symphyonema paludosum. 
1888, 400—Collection of plants from 
Derby. 1888, 425—Collection of plants 
from Cobar. 1888, 425—Peripatus, with 
a note. 1888, 892—List of plants col- 
lected by Mr. Froggatt in N.W. Aus- 
tralia. 1888, 1256—Two new species of 
frogs. 1888, 1258—Frog previously ex- 
hibited (March, 1887) apparently Helio- 
porus albopunctatus. 1888, 1258—Letter 
from Dr. Creed calling attention to mice 
in country districts. 1888, 1508— 
Young specimens of Peripatus leuckarti. 
1888, 1508—Botanical specimens col- 
lected on excursions. 1888, 1508— 
Plants collected in Wagga _ district. 
1883, 1560—Living specimens of Peri- 
patus leuckarti from Burrawang. 1888, 
1560—Letter from Baron von Mueclle> 
re distribution of waratah. 1889, 139— 
Collection of plants from near Hay. 
1889, 1054—Collection of plants from 
Nymagee. 1889, 1055—Silene cucubalus 
and trefoil from Wagga Wagga. 1889, 
1055—Collection of plants from near 
Wagea Wagga. 1889, 1100—Collection 
of plants from King George’s Sound. 
1890, 295—Living and spirit specimens 
of Notaden Bennettii. 1890, 414 
Small worm living on  Astacopsis 
serratus. 1890, 510—Notaden Bennettii 
from Trangie. 1890, 898—Land plan- 
arian (Bipalium kewense). 1891, 44— 
Prolification in the flannel flower. 
1891, 44—Three species of frogs from 
Goangra, near Walgett. 1891, 44— 
Hyla gracilenta from the Richmond 
River. 1891, 44—(For Mr. J. H. Roszr) 
Inland species of frog (Chiroleptes 
platycephalus) from near Walgett. 1891, 
125—Terrestrial Nemertines (Geone- 
mertes sp.) trom Richmond River and 
Tasmania. 1891, 167—Male Peripatus 
leuckartii. 1891, 167—Fruits of Sechium 
edule from Queensland. 1891, 168 
Living specimens of Chiroleptes aus- 


same species. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


tralis. 1891, 168—Note on supposed ovi- 
parity of Peripatus leuckartw. 1891, 577 
—Fly (Phytomyzidae) whose larvae in- 
fest Composites. 1891, 704—Crickets 
(Gryllus  servillei) from McIntyre 
River district. 1891, 704—Collection of 
plants from Blue Mountains. 1892, 40 
—Living adult and young Peripatus. 
1892, 40—Female galls of new species 
of Brachyscelids. 1892, 667—Flannel 
flower (Actinotus helianthi), with a 
note by Dr. Woolls. 1893, 45—Flowers 
of Rhyncospermun jasminoides with 
trapped flies. 1893, 45—(For Mr. J. H. 
Rose) Two frogs from Warialda. 1893, 
126—Large undescribed frog from near 
Sydney. 1893, 126—Collection of botan- 
ical specimens obtained by Hider 
Exploring Expedition. 1893, SQs—— 
Specimens of Ruppia maritima trom 
Manly. 1893, 303—(For Mr. G. L. 
PircHEeR) Undeseribed Longicorn. 1898, 
438—Nests of wasp (Humenes latreillei) 
with specimens of wasp and of 
COhrysis sp. 1893, 438—Grevillea parvi- 
flora from various localities. 1893, 535 
—Isopogon sp. from Blue Mountains. 
1893, 536—A new species of Isopogon 
from Blue Mountains and specimens of 
IT. anemonifolius. 1894, 188—Entomos- 
traca (Lepidurus) from Tamworth and 
Dandaloo. 1894, 362—Flowers of 
Mandevilla suaveolens. 1894, 3862— 
Land Nemertine from Mt. Kosciusko 
Plateau and near Gosford. 1895, 342 
—Eneglish humble bees. 1895, 537— 
(For Mr. F. M. Battery) Collection of 
medicinal plants from Queensland. 
1896, 269—(For Dr. R. Broom) Fossil 
marsupials from bone breccia near 
Wombeyan Caves. 1896, 269—(For 
Miss Georgina Kine) Letters and 
sketches referring to Boronia  jlori- 
bunda. 1896, 584—Watercolour draw- 
ings of Australian animals by Dr. J. 
Stuart. 1896, 585—Moths from cater- 
pillars resembling Hucalyptus shoots. 
1897, 44—(For C. T. Musson) Day- 
flying moth (Agarista macleayi). 1897, 
44--Bossiaea rhombifolia infested with 
fungus. 1897, 44—Beetle (Rhopaea 
soror) from Richmond. 1897, 44— 
Viscum articulatum, parasitic on San- 
talum. 1897, 254—Hymenopterous in- 
sects from vineyard fence near Wagga. 
1897, 578—(For Mr. J. H. Rose) Longi- 
corn (Rhytiphora rosei) from Warialda. 
1898, 274—Little known frog from near 
Warialda. 1898, 274—Specimens illus- 
trating fauna of Mt. Kosciusko Plateau. 
1899, 193—Specimens of Heleioporus 
pictus from W.A. 1899, 194—F'resh- 
water crab (Hymenosoma lacustris) 
from Tasmania. 1900, 61—Peripatus 


from New Zealand. 1900, 116— 
Attencion called to two forms of ccom- 
mon Pittosporum about Sydney. 1900, 
543—Books and relics of J. W. Lewin. 
1901, 540—Some original drawings 
made during voyage of “Beagle”. 1902, 
344-_-Ms. journal of Mr. Syms Coving- 
ton. 1902, 344—Coins from collection 
of Mr. Syms Covington. 1902, 370— 
Record of stridulating Agarista (A. 
nvacleayi). 1902. 657—Charles Darwin’s 
pocket compass received from Mr. 
Syms Covington. 19038, 363—Bursarvria 
spinosa bearing species of Loranthus. 
19038, 3863—Branchlets of Hucalyptus 
punctata with noticeable quantities of 
manna from near Ryde. 1903, 686— 
Copy of “Voyages de Corneille de 
Bruyn par la Moscovie, en Perse, et aux 
Indes Orientales’” (1725). 1903, 686— 
Fresh flowering specimens of Hpacris 
impressa from Pambula. 1903, 832— 
Collection of native plants from Pam- 
bula_ district. 1903, 944—(For Mr. 
Harpine) Proliferous rose from Eliza- 
beth Bay House. 1904, 558—Male 
amenta of Bunya Bunya (Araucaria 
Bidwill) . 1904, 697—Remarks on 
whereabouts of Dr. Solander’s journal. 
1905, 223—-Remarks on Loranths. 1905, 
397—List of host plants for three 
species of Loranthus. 1905, 488— 
Specimens of Loranthus celastroides 
parasitic on various species and para- 
sitised by other Loranths. 1905, 488— 
(For Miss M. Lopper) Young of a 
species of Galaxias. 1906, 430—Male 
amenta of Bunya Bunya. 1906, 431— 
Letter from Miss Lodder re occurrence 
of small fishes (Galaxvias sp.) in damp 
earth. 1906, 497—Flowers of Welichrus 
rotatus, showing large amount of 
nectar produced. 1906. 498—Communi- 
cated opinion of Mr. Stead regarding 
Tasmanian fishes (Galaxias sp.) found 
in damp earth. 1906, 566—Typical 
examples of Hyla ewingii. 1907, 159 
—Germinating seeds and young seed- 
lings of Cassytha pubescens. 1907, 556 
—Flowers of Jasminum grandiflorum, 
showing floral prolification. 1907, 744 
—(For T. L. Bancrorr) Collection of 
Queensland mosquitoes. 1908, 288— 
Lantern slides of germinating seeds and 
young seedlings of Loranthus. 1908, 
288—Specimens of Loranthus Bidwilltt 
from Warrumbungle Mts., and from 
near Young. 1908, 291—Germinating 
seeds of Nuytsia floribunda. 1908, 344 
—Letter from J. B. Cleland re preserva- 
tion of fauna and flora in W.A. 1908, 
635—Photographs, specimens and seed- 
lings illustrating germination and 
growth stages of Atkinsonia ligustrina 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 79 


and Nuytsia floribunda. 1908, 736— 
(For J. B. Crentanp) Sections of 
branches, suckers and natural seedlings 


of Nuytsia. 1908, 800—(For H. 
W ASTENEYS ) Two pieces of wood 
cemented to branches of shrubs. 1909, 
219—Diptera bred from fruits of 


Loranthus pendulus. 1909, 419—A rare 
Grevillea from the Blue Mountains, 
probably a natural Hybrid. 1910, 433- 
434—-Angophora seedlings with anomal- 
ous cotyledons. 1910, 661—(For Mr. T. 
STEPHENS) Portion of plank destroyed 
by “dry-rot”. 1910, 311—(For W. M. 
CARNE and C. T. Musson) A rare phyllo- 
pod crustacean. 1911, 159—Specimens 
of rare species of Persoonia. 1911, 306 
—Spine-tailed Swift struck by light- 
ning. 1912, 138—Fruits of Tecoma 
radicans. 1913, 113—Cohesion of 
opposite leaves of Lantana. 1914, 89, 
162—Abnormal racemes of Poke-weed. 
1915, 421—Viscid fruits of Pisonia, 
which catch Blue Wrens. 1915, 629— 
Portrait of the late Sir R. Owen. 1916, 
220—Abnormal flowers of Grevillea 
buxifolia. 1917, 247—Reversion-shoots 
and Acacia-seedlings. 1917, 303—Three 
cerimson-flowered Callistemons. 1917, 
343—Callistemon sp. 1917, 440— 
Brachyscelid galls. 1918, 361—Plants, 
other than Eucalypts and Angophoras, 
with shoot-bearing tumours. 1918, 415 
—Melaleuca Deanei and Petrophila 
sessilis. 1918, 416—Water-storing 
Mallee-roots, and water therefrom. 1918, 
496—Grevillea buxifolia with bipistil- 
late flowers. IGA). 527—Fasciated 
phylloclades of Bossiaea scolopendria 
bearing leaves. 1919, 528—Fasciated 
fiowering branches of Phyllota phyli- 
coides. 1919, 528—Leafy galls on 
Cassinia sp., and teratological develop- 
ments on Aster ramulosa and Kennedya 
monophylla. 1919, 722—Leaf of Jaca- 
randa ovalifolia. 1920, 204—Flowering 
branches, reversion shoots and _ seed- 
lings of Acacias. 1920, 204—Specimens 
of Persoonia tlucida. 1920, 531— 
Stunted branch of Hucalyptus saligna 
with cluster of female galls. 1920, 319 
—Pod and seeds of Hrythrina indica. 
1921, 238, 269—Dwarf plant of Darwinia 
taxifolia. 1922,  xxiv—Lantern-slides 
showing germination of Loranthus. 
1922, xxvii—Remarks on Indian Bulbul 
(Otocompsa emeria). 1922, xxy— 
Reference to life of Charles Gould. 
1925, xiv. 


HEBROHER Je andaG.. ot. Musson: 
Lantern-illustrations of modification of 
plant-growth due to parasites. 1915, 
xx—Plants collected near the boundary 


between the Counties of Cumberland 
and Cook. 1915, 489. 

Frynn, T. T. Intracranial cast of whale, 
Prosqualodon davidis. 1922, xxx 
Photograph showing parturition in 
Potorus tridactylus. 1922, xxviii. 


ForsytH, W. (For Mr. J. H. MatpEn) 
Flowering specimens of three rare 
plants. 1897, 811—A rare Grevillea 


from the Blue Mountains. 

MOUCART; I. Leaf of poisonous New 
Guinea tree. 1886, 506—“Meerschaum” 
from the Nambucca River. 1887, 144. 

Fox, F. Exhibition of handling venomous 
snakes. 1909, 712. 

Frignp, N. B. Fangs and venom from 
Diamond Rattler Snake. 1921, 350— 
Freshly prepared specimen of picramic 


1910, 433. 


acid. 1922, xxviii—Analysis of stalac- 
tite. 1925, xxxix—Stalactites from 
National Park. 1925, xxxviii. 
Froaeatr, J. L. Fungus emitting iodo- 
form-like odour. 1912, 557—Fossil- 
bones from Cuddie Spring. 1914, 253 
—An undescribed parasitic chalcid 
wasp. 1916, 494—Parasitic wasp from 


pupae of Blowflies. 1917, 302—House- 


flies bred from rotten liver. 1918, 361 
—Martynia lutea, a noxious weed in 
parts of Queensland. 1920, 180. 


Froeeatr, W. W. Native weapons and 
implements from N.W. Australia. 1888, 
422—Girella tricuspidata, illustrating 
method of preparation for exhibition. 
1889, 313—-Spinifex resin as prepared by 
aborigines. 1889, 654—Hight kinds of 
galls with insects bred from them, from 
Rose Bay and Woollahra. 1889, 1053— 
Case moth (Oiketicus elongatus). 1889, 
1100—Parasitic Hymenoptera. 1889, 
1100—Collection of species of Paropsis 
from Mt. Dromedary. 1890, 11—Fig 
leaves stripped of tissue by larvae. 1890, 
141—Small moth obtained from tin of 
cayenne pepper. 1890, 244—Orange 
leaves from Thornleigh covered with 
black mildew. 1890, 296—Specimens of 
plague locust from Hay, Mulwala and 
the Wimmera. 1890, 296—Two Coccid 
galls on Hucalyptus sp. from King’s 


Sound. 1890, 413—Larvae of undeter- 
mained Saw-fly destroying Acacia 
decurrens about Melbourne. 1890, 510 


-—Note on life-history of Pterygophorus 
cinctus. 1890, 654—Grasshopper  fre- 
quenting flowers to capture bees. 1891, 
8—Hymenoptera from the Australian 
Alps. 1891, 8—Collection of insects 
from Ballarat district. 1891, 307—Rare 
Saw-fly (Peiga affinis) from Ballarat. 
1891, 307—Beetles (Aaxionichus insig- 
nis) showing protective colouration. 
1891, 381—Hymenoptera from Ballarat. 
1891, 577—Tipula from Rose Bay. 1891, 


80 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


577—Homopterous galls from Wollon- 
gong and parasitic Hymenoptera. 1891, 
577—Seales and perfect insects of 
species of Psylla. 1891, 682—Homop- 
terous galls from Yass. 1891, 682— 
Note on life-history of Dipterous insect 
(Syrphus). 1891, 704—Leaf-boring fly 
(Phytomyza sp.) bred from leaves of 


sunflower. 1891, 704—Homopterous 
galls found on Casuarina suberosa. 
1891, 704—Series illustrating life- 
history of Jalmenus evagoras. 1892, 
40—An arboreal spiny grasshopper 


from Ballina. 1892, 40—Collection of 
rare beetles from Ballina and Hllalong. 
1892, 40—Rare saw-fly (Philomastix 
glaber) and its larvae from Mt. 
Vincent. 1892, 201—Collection of Cole- 
optera from Torren’s Creek, N.Q. 1892, 
201—Male specimens of Thynnus 
brenchieyi. 1892, 201—KFemale speci- 
mens of undescribed Coelostoma. 1892, 
278—Robber-fly with a bee. 1892, 278— 
Living specimen of Gecko (Gymnodac- 
tylus miliusii) from Bendigo. 1892, 
314—Leaves of Hucalyptus obtusifolia 
attacked by Coccid. 1892, 344—Brachy- 
scelid Coccids and galls with parasites. 
1892, 373—Twig of Hucalyptus robusta 
attacked by Psyllae. 1892, 380—Spray 
of Acacia undulifolia with aborted seed 
pods, attacked by Hymenoptera. 1892, 
404—Hucalyptus longifolia covered with 


seale (Hriococcus sp.), together with 
moth whose larva destroys coccus. 
1892, 404—Small Coccinella (Rhizo- 
bius ? sp.). 1892, 404—A common 
Passalid (Aulacocyclus kawpi) from 
Bathurst. 1893, 45—Female galls on 
Hucalyptus capitellata from Sutherland. 
1893, 45—Crane-fly (Tipulidae) and 
bug (Reduviidae) showing mimetic 


markings of latter. 1893, 126—Fungoid 
growth on scales of Homopterous in- 
sect. 18938, 218—Galls of Cecidomyia 
nubitipennis on leaf stalks of Hucalyp- 
tus siderophloia. 1893, 238—Thrips 
galls on Callistemon salignus. 1893, 
303—Note on Icerya aegyptiacum. 18938, 
534—Icerya rosae from near Sydney, 
with a note. 1894, 186—Acacia stem 
attacked by Hudoxyla eucalypti. 1894, 
467—Coleoptera from Coolgardie and 
Fraser Range, W.A. 1894, 540—Fungus 
growing from mouth of shell (Helix 


poma). 1894, 740—Hoops from powder 
kegs attacked by Gracilia pygmaea. 
1895, 209—Larva of Australian silk- 


worm moth destroyed by parasitic 
Hymenoptera. 1895, 209—Pine resin 
from stems of Frenella robusta, enclos- 


ing insects. 1895, 341—Collection of 
Australian ants. 1895, 519—Beetle 
(Fam. Paussidae) from nest of ant. 


1895, 519—Collection of Sydney Cicadas. 
1895, 537—Two species of scale insects 
and parasites, with a note. 1895, 549 
—Insects frequenting four species of 
Xanthorrhoea in County of Cumber- 
land. 1896, 88—lLiving specimen of 
Moloch horridus from Kalgoorlie. 1896, 
88—Living specimens of Coelostoma 
australe. 1896, 113—Larvae of Acacia 
goat-moth attacked by fungus and 
turned into vegetable caterpillars. 1896, 
113—Larva, pupa, moth and _  bag- 
shelters of Teara contraria from Pens- 
hurst. 1896, 269—Silken-shelter of 
species of Teara from Kalgoorlie. 1896, 
269—Specimens of common species of 
Teara in N.S.W. 1896, 269—Collection 


of Australian Coccids. 1896, 382— 
Arachnid from New Hebrides. 1896, 
502—Bag-shelter of Teara from 


Quirindi. 1896, 502—(For Mr. LyEr1) 
Rare butterfly (Jalmenus myrsilus). 
1896, 502—(For Mr. Matern) MHorn- 
like galls on Eucalypt. 1896, 503— 
Queensland fruit fly and apples attacked 
by it. 1897, 124—Potatoes attacked by 
white ants. 1897, 124—Adult female of 
Monophiebus crawfordi. 1897, 161— 
Stakes covered with scars cut by 
Cicadas. 1897, 253—Scale insects and 
eggs of scale-eating moth on Hucalyptus 
twig. 1897, 810—Living specimen of 
largest Australian white ant. 1897, 810 
—Series of fruit flies from neighbour- 
hood of Sydney. 1898, 75—Apple show- 
ing discolouration from San José 
seale. 1898, 75—Stone covered with 
eggs of minute red mite. 1898, 172— 
Undetermined fungoid growth on grass. 
1898, 172—Acacia longifolia branches 
covered with indigenous scale. 1898, 
408—Collection of frog hoppers. 1898, 
408—Twig of fruit with eggs of grass- 
hopper. 1898, 437—Banksia leaves 
covered with Homopterous larvae. 
1898, 647—Collection of fruit flies of 
subfamily Trypetinae. 1899, 190— 
Cocoons of Lewin’s case moth. 1899, 
283—Termites from Borneo, Sarawak 
and Africa. 1899, 283—Plague cater- 
pillars attacked by fungoid disease. 
1899, 476—Oranges from Noumea 
affected with scale. 1899, 476—Shoe- 
horn destroyed by larvae of museum 
beetle. 1899, 549—Cocoons of un- 
described case moth. 1899, 549—New 
plague locust. 1899, 698—Woody galls 
of Brachyscelis fletcheri. 1899, 698— 
Hucalypt from Mittagong showing 
formation of manna. 1899, 698—Twelve 
species of Australian ticks. 1900, 114— 
Wheat stalks damaged by aphis. 1900, 
697—Collection of J&cerya purchasi 
from which lady-bird beetles had bred 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 81 


out. 1900, 697—Cherries from Armidale 
district attacked by Rutherglen bug. 
1900, 760—Carrot seed infested with 


small beetle. 1900, 760—Galls on 
Acacia pendula. 1901, 146—IJdolothrips 
spectrum. 1901, 214—Collection of lac- 


producing coccids of genus Zachardia. 
1901, 515—Spiny Phasmid (Hatatosoma 
tiaratum). 1901, 589—Samples of lac 
from near Bundaberg. 1901, 631—Lady- 
bird beetle, abundant on Norfolk 
Island and Bunya Pines. 1901, 738— 
Cultures of fungus used to destroy 
Chinch bug. 1901, 738—Collection of 
Coleoptera from southern Queensland 
and northern rivers, N.S.W. 1902, 74 
—Specimens and photographs of Aus- 
tralian fleas. 1902, 205—W heat 
damaged by grain weevil and grain 
moth larva. 1902, 343—Apple wood 
affected by San José scale. 1902, 343— 
Coccid (Frenchia casuarinae) from 
near Condobolin. 1902, 592—Larvae of 
pine scrub beetle from dead or dying 
Currawong bushes. 1902, 592—Lamelli- 
corn beetle (Pentodon australis), 
which had damaged maize crops. 1902, 
656—Beetle (Chiroplatys), which had 
devoured potatoes and tomatoes. 1902, 
656—Species of grasshopper from Ben- 
dithera Caves, near Moruya. 19038, 312 
—Oedaleus marmoratus and O. senegal- 
ensis. 1903, 312—Small beetle which 
had caused serious damage to coconut 
palms. 1903, 564—Nut grass (Cyperus 
rotundus) infested by scale _ insect. 
1903, 686—Parasites and hyper-parasites 
of brown olive scale. 1903, 831—Larvae 
of five species of Carabidae. 1904, 128 
—Collection of undescribed scale in- 
sects. 1904, 253—Collection of in- 
digenous and introduced Diptera. 1904, 
557—Larvae of sheep nasal or bot fly. 
1904, 871—Two undetermined grass- 
hoppers from  W.A. 1904, 871— 
Oligotoma gurneyi with webs. 1905, 
175—Pupae of common bulldog ant. 
1905, 175—Collection of Australian 
Thysanura. 1905, 259—Italian forms of 
_Japyx, Lepisma and Machilis. 1505, 
259—Collection of Japanese Cicadas. 
1905, 259—Paussid beetles, Arthropterus 
darlingensis. 1905, 259—Deformed 
branch of Eucalypt caused by fungoid 
disease. 1905, 3807—-Two species of 
Coleoptera which damaged coconut 
palms in New Hebrides. 1905, 307 
—Specimens of vine moth and 
parasite. 1905, 3851—Wheat stalks 
damaged by aphids. 1905, 487— 
-Freshwater crustacean, Lepidurus sp., 
from Hay. 1905, 487—Specimens illus- 
trating life-history of Pauropsalta 
annulata. 1905, 576—Neuropterous in- 
F 


sect, Croce attenuata from North 
Queensland. 1905, 576—Larvae of 
African “‘bont” tick. 1906, 174—Collec- 
tion of Australian fleas. 1906, 174— 
Attention called to report of mortality 
among marsupials caused by sand-flies. 
1906, 175—Gregarious Phasmids show- 
ing remarkable colouration. 1906, 261 
—Leaves of Hugenia sp., coated with 
tests of “Snow  flies’’. 1906, 427— 
Axionicus insignis from stem of damaged 
Kurrajong tree. 1906, 496—Coccid galls 


from Central Australia. 1906, 565— 
Collection of Thynnidae. 1907, 158— 
Grasshopper, Oedaleus senegalensis. 


1907, 158—Dried land snails mixed with 
seed of imported forage plants. 1907, 
393—Neuropterous insect (Chasmop- 
tera huttii) with modified hind wings. 
1908, 434—Biting and _ blood-sucking 
Diptera from the Sudan. 1908, 635— 
Series of fruit flies (Dacus spp.). 1908, 
736—Water bugs and eggs from Mexico. 
1908, 798—Water bugs imported from 
Africa into England. 1908, 798— 
Largest Lecanid scale insect, Lopho- 
coccus maximus. 1908, 798—Wingless 
females of species of Mutilla, which 
sting very sharply. 1908, 798—Life- 
history of Mexican cotton boll weevil. 
1909, 216—Larva of water beetle and 
Nematode worm found in stomach of 
trout. 1909, 216—Large land crab from 
Solomon Islands. 1909, 416—Bright 
red snail from Solomon Islands. 1909, 
416—Pigment from Soiomon Islands 
used for painting the face. 1909, 417 
—Coleoptera from Solomon Islands. 
1909, 498—Collection of MThynnidae. 
1909, 710—Coconut-Palm Beetle and 
pupae. 1910, 431—Fly injurious to 
Apple twigs; Fly parasitic upon 
Spiders; and a large Longicorn and 
its Larvae, from the Solomon Islands. 
1910, 688—Rust-galls associated with 
Mites, and other Plant-galls. 1910, 523 
—Shade-Midges, and Ants. 1910, 657 
—A large, wingless grass-hopper. 1911, 
159—Harthen egeg-cases of Scarabaeid 
Beetles. 1911, 348—Living larval stages 
of the Great Leaf-insect of Ceylon. 
1911, 635—Named Australian Biting- 
flies. 1911, 506—Specimens of the 
Kurrajong Star-psylla, and of parasitic 
Hymenoptera. 1911,  3805—Specimens 
illustrating the life-history of a weevil 
destructive to Pine-trees. 1911, 608— 
Rare West Australian Mole-cricket; two 
rare Cicadas from Bernier Island, and 
Perth, W.A. 1912, 394—Mealy Bug from 
South Australia; trapdoor nests of 
spiders. 1912, 496—Dipterous larvae 
from windpipes of Kangaroos. 1912, 560 
—Australian and Tasmanian Bees. 1912, 


82 


592—Cicada destructive to fruit and 
forest trees. 1912, 654—(For W. B. 
GuRNEY) European Lecanid Scale on 
Grape-vines. 1912, 592—Insects trapped 
by flowers of Oleander. 19138, 108—In- 
sects from the New Hebrides. 1913, 
521—Cicadidae, and Chalcid parasites 
of the Sheep Maggot-fly. 1913, 656— 
Freshwater Crustacean from the in- 
terior; Butterflies. 1914, 158—Plates 
from Gould’s “Mammals”; lLoranths 
from the interior. 1914, 395—Mountain- 
grasshoppers; branchlets of Peppermint 
Gums girdled by lLongicorn larvae. 
1914, 470—Golden Stagbeetles from 
Uralla; leaves of Waratah attacked by 
a leaf-mining larva. 1915, 210— 
Longicorn-beetle, whose larvae girdle 
Hucalypt branchlets. Sls), 417— 
Cocoons of the Blue Sawfly; Centipede 
from Brewarrina, N.S.W.; Opuntia in- 
fested with Coccus. 1915, 628—Insects 
blown out to sea, and washed up on 
Womberal beach; life-history of a 
Longicorn-beetle, and its parasites; 
Cordyceps on a beetle. 1915, 720— 
Various entomological specimens. 1916, 
191—Specimens illustrating the life- 
history of the Ribbed Case-Moth 
destructive to Sugar-Gums. 1916, 494— 
Mosquitoes from Riverina; destructive 
insects from wheat-stacks. 1917, 246 
—Brachyscelid galls. 1917, 302—Grain- 
weevils from Sydney and Melbourne. 
1917, 343—Lepidopterous galls on 
Eremophila. 1917, 439—New  Wax- 
Scale from New Guinea; perforated 
nodule from an ants’ nest. 1917, 511— 
Immature Spiny Stick-Insect; grass in- 
fested with larvae of a Cecidomyid fly. 
1918, 234—Three introduced beetles of 
economic importance. 1918, 316— 
Brachyscelid galls; a Californian 
Cynipid gall; and an undetermined 
living snake. 1918, 416—An Indian 
wood-borer introduced in the wood of 
boxes. 1918, 610—Green Tomato and 
bean bug, Nozara viridula, infested 
with eggs of Tactonid fly. 1919, 355— 
Mounted specimens of Bugong moth, 
Agrostis infusa. 1919, 819—Living 
specimen of Ironbark Beetle, Zosperosis 
george. 1919, 819—Five forms of 
Apiomorpha wileata. 1919, 819—Bag 
Shelter or Boree Moth (TVeara con- 
traria). 1920, 531—Cup Moth (Apoda 
zylomeli) on Waratah. 1920, 318— 
Series of flies from India. 1920, 472— 
Bibio imitator. 1920, 472—Tobacco 
thrips from the Tamworth District. 
1920, 180—Chalecid wasp, Dinoura 
cyanea. 11921, 423—Dinoura auri- 
ventris. 1921, 423—Foliage of satin- 
wood covered with galls. 1921, 268— 


GoppARD, HK. J. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


Frog Warble Fly. 1921, 423—Larvae 
of saw-fly, Pterygophorus analis. 1921, 
268—New aphid infesting native 
cypress. 1921, 408—Painted Shield Bug, 
with larvae and eggs. 1921, 209—Gall 
(Sphaerococcus leaii) on Belah. 1922, 
xxvi—Loranthus parasitic on Black 
Cypress Pine. 1922, xxv—Cotton boll 
moths found in Australia. 1923, xxxii 
—Figtree longicorn. 1923, xxxviii— 
Life-history of Penthea picta. 1923, 
Xxxii—Great pine weevil. 1923, xxxviii 
—Oryctes barbarosa and its larva. 
1923, xxxii—Pittosporum stem longi- 
corn. 1923, xxxviii—Puff ball fungus. 
1923, xxxii—Bostrychid beetle (Xylo- 
thrips flavipes). 1924, xxiii—Coleop- 
terous parasites and braconid wasp 
parasite. 1924, xxiii—Life-history of 
green wood moth (Charagia eximia). 
1924, xxviii—Life-history of Pin- 
hole borer (Crossotarsus armipennis). 
1924, xxix—tbLyctid beetle (Lycio- 
pholus rugicollis). 1924, xxiii—Pho- 
tograph of wasp tree, also wasps 
and nests. 1924, xxix—Beetle galls on 
Hucalyptus siderophloia. 1925, xliii— 
Drawing of life-history of Acrocercops 
plebeia. 1925, xli—Galls produced by 
Trichilogaster on Acacia. 1925, xliv— 
Insects from Pillaga Scrub. 1925, 
xxxix—Large Click Beetle. 1925, xl— 
Penthea picta. 1925, xxxviii—Scoleco- 
brotus westwoodi. 1925, xxxviii— 
Specimens damaged by Huropean Fur- 
niture Beetle. 1925, xl. 


GARLAND, J. R. Photographs of weathered 


clay cliffs near Wagga Wagga, 1890, 
898—Flowering specimens of Ricino- 
carpus Bowmani from Adelong. 1893, 
303—Miscellaneous fragments from 
aboriginal kitchen-midden, Pittwater. 
1895, 209—Hpacris purpurascens with 
double flowers. 1899, 547—White 
variety of Boronia ledifolia. 1900, 542. 


GILL, Rev. J. W. See under MacieEay, W. 
GinLiatT, H. A. 


Stone axes and fossils 
from Darling River. 1881, 790—Creta- 
ceous fossils from Mount Brown. 1883, 
218—Salt from Holy-Box Well. 1883, 
443—Vegetable matter incrusted with 
lime. 1884, 508—Stone implement. 
1884, 946—See also under Cox, J. C. 
Freshwater crustaceans 
and freshwater leeches from Tasmania 
and N.S.W. 1908, 287—Methods of 
collecting Tardigrada and _  Rotifera. 
1909, 219—Infusorian (Spirostoma sp.) 
from freshwater aquarium. 1909, 411. 
—Marine leech (Branchellion sp.) 
from neck of turtle. 1909, 411—Minute 
structures occurring on neck of 
Pontobdella. 1909, 411. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 83 


Grant, R. Apparatus for filling tubes 
with calf-lymph. 1913, 518. 

Grey, E. C. Fatty acids obtained from 
human brain. 1909, 500. 

GrirFin, J. G. Samples of gravel used as 
ballast on Deniliquin and Moama rail- 
way. 1883, 398—Native stone weapons. 
1883, 442—Fossil oyster shells. 1884, 
1015. 

Gurney, W. B. Stridulating moth (Heco- 
tesia fenestrata). 1902, 657—Living 
specimens of EHztatosoma tiaratum. 
1903, 361—Insects from Coolabah. 
1905, 576—Specimens illustrating the 
life-history of an indigenous parasite 
of Fruit-flies. 1911, 304—EKuropean 
Lecanid Scale on Grape-vines. 1912, 
592. 


Haut, E. C. Collection of flowering car- 
nations. 1909, 712—Eucalypt seedling 
with anomalous cotyledons. 1910, 27 
—Seedlings with anomalous cotyledons. 
1910, 138—Hybrid Acacia seedling. 
1910, 310—Abnormal flower of Anemone 
coronaria. 1912, 557—Hybrid Freesias. 
1914, 472. 

HALLIGAN, G. 4H. (ioe jie, AW Pade 
FLAVELLE) Recently hatched Echidna. 
1897, 577—Amphipods. 1914, 162. 


Hamirton, A. A. Specimens of four in- 
teresting plants: 1900, 213—Botanical 
specimens of interest. 1901, 310—In- 
teresting plants from new localities. 
1901, 471—Persoonia angulata, Un- 
cinia tenella and Carez gracilis. 1902, 
73—Bipinnate form of Pteris falcata. 
1905, 394—Two-flowered specimens of 
Adenochilus Nortoni from Lawson. 
1908, 286—Persoonia angulata from 
Blue Mountains. 1908, 286—Waratah 
with uncommon foliage. 1908, 286— 
Pterostylis grandiflora from Katoomba. 
1908, 4385—Baeckea crenulata from 
Blue Mountains. 1908, 435—Pas- 
palum brevifolium from Cook’s River. 
1908, 435—Hibbertia sericea and 
Cassinia quinquefaria from Port Jack- 
son district. 1909, 118S—A rare Grevillea 
from the Blue Mountains. 1910, 433— 
Plants from unrecorded Localities. 1910, 
688—Two grasses. 1911, 347—Unre- 
corded plants collected at Douglas Park, 
N.S.W. 1911, 88—A new grass from 
the Hawkesbury River; three species 
of Hrigeron. 1912, 495—Caltrops weed; 
a variable grass (Panicuwin crusgalli) ; 
drawing of the tubers of Hupomatia 
Bennetti; specimens of two species of 
Pimelea. 1912, 558—Three interesting 
plants (Medicago hispida, var. inermis, 
Acacia obtusata, Cotula reptans). 1912, 
591—Two unrecorded introduced 
plants; a rare Leucopogon. 1913, 110 


—Two unrecorded introduced plants; 
Boerhaavia diffusa. 1913, 170—Two 
introduced plants; Chenopodium trian- 
gulare. 1913, 254—“Hottentot Fig’; 
variable leaves of Senecio. 1913, 396— 
Plants exemplifying teratology. 1913, 
605—Teratological and variable plants, 
examples of leaf-variation, new hab- 
itats. 1914, 88, 159, 254, 324, 396, 470, 
543, 647—Dimorphic foliage of Acacias. 
1914, 648—New records. 1914, 159, 649 
—Teratological and xerophytic plants, 
examples of leaf-variation. 1915, 117, 
208, 288, 414, 417, 486, 627, 720— 
Dimorphic foliage of Callitris. 1915, 
118—Plants from Woronora River. 
1915, 627—Remarks on the distribution 
of Acacia trinervata and Persoonia 
oblongata. 1915, 628—Teratological or 
variable plants. 1916, 193, 218, 267, 
492—Specimens of an introduced Tet- 
ragonia. 1917, 247—Plants from Egypt 
and Palestine, collected by Mr. W. M. 
Carne. 1917, 512—Irregular phyllo- 
taxy, petaloid heterotaxy and _ fron- 
descent prolification in Rosa. 1919, 
720—Potato showing adventitious 
tubers in axils of stem leaves. 1919, 
356—Increased bulb production in the 
“Snow-flake’’. gOS 356—Specimens 
showing synanthy and syncarpy. 1919, 
820—Specimens of Synaphea. 1919, 
257—Specimens showing fasciation and 
spiral torsion. 1919, 526—Vivipary in 
Cucurbita Pepo, Citrus medica var. 


limonum, Tagetes patula, and Im- 
patiens balsamina. 1919, 192—Aroids 
illustrating Chromatism, Virescence 


and Multiplication of spathes. 1920, 
204—Seed of Butia yatay which had 
produced twin seedlings. 1920, 319— 
Seeds of Cladium jamaicense and 
Carex pumila immersed for five years. 
IO2R, SOSA 


Hamitton, A. G. Large caterpillar in- 


fested with parasitic mites. 1892, 41 
—Photographs of fossil tree trunk at 
Mt. Kembla. 1892, 344—Casyapa beata 
and Heteronympha mirifica from Illa- 
warra. 1894, 43—Note on Pittosporum 
undulatum. 1894, 583—Specimen of 
Phascologale’ minutissima from Mt. 
Kembla. 1894, 740—West Australian 
Pitcher plant, Cephalotus follicularis. 
1904, 460—Calcareous concretion re- 
sembling obsidianite. 1905, 175— 
Thalloid hepatic. 1905, 395—Riccia 
growing on damp soil. 1905, 395— 
Phylloglossum Drummondii from W.A. 
1905, 395—Boronia Barkeriana from 
near Willoughby. 1905, 395—Host 
plants of Loranthus at Mt. Kembla. 
1905, 490—Lorarths and other hosts. 
1905, 491—Vegetable fibre from beach 


84 INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


near Albany, W.A. 1906, 362—Flowers 
from waratah head showing abnormal- 
ities. 1907, 630—Germinating seeds and 
young seedlings of Loranthus exocarpt. 
1908, 288—Worm cast from Willoughby. 
1909, 118—Branchlet of Casuarina 
growing on sand hill at Corrimal. 1909, 
119—Photograph of the large Green 


Hrog. 1912, 591—Teratological ex- 
ample of Arum Lily. 1913, 606— 
“Vegetable caterpillars”. 1916, 268— 


Drawing of an undetermined Orchid. 
1916, 493—See also under FLETCHER, 
Io dle 

Hamiyn-Harris, R. Remarks on fall of 
voleanic dust at Barbados. 1903, 362. 

Harpine, —. See under FiercHer, J. J. 

Harpy, GH. Pair of flies, Chrysomyza 
aenea. 1920, 472—Boreoides subulata. 
1921, 269—Chiromyza australis. 1921, 
269—Chiromyza fuscana. 1921, 269— 
Metoponia rubriceps. 1921, 269—Pair 
of Allognosta fuscitarsis. 1921, 269— 
Species of Husthenia. 1921, 237—Tas- 
manian ichneumon. 1921, 424—Three 
ichneumon parasites. 1921, 424. 


Harpy, N. Aboriginal shields from Vic- 


toria and Queensland. 1894, 540— 
Nerrum or strangulation cord of 
Loddon River’ tribe. 1896, 820— 


Feathered arrows from New Hebrides 
and notes thereon. 1897, 442. 

Harpy, N., and J. <A. DESPEISSIS. 
Aboriginal cloak, womerah and knife 
from Lake Muir, W.A. 1894, 741. 


Harper, W. R. Native thumb guards and 
arm guards from Malekula. 1901, 311 
—Deformed Malekulan crania. 1901, 
311—Australian ethnological specimens. 
1901, 515—Supplementary note on wrist 
euard of Malekula. 1901, 539. 

Harrison, F. J. W. Contribution to dis- 
cussion on welfare of indigenous fauna 
and flora. 1908, 631. 

Harrison, L. Egg of Pallid cuckoo taken 


at Manly. 1905, 576—Skins of the 
Oriental Cuckoo, from Broadwater, 
N.S.W. 1910, 533—Photographs of 


Yellow-breasted Robin and White- 
shafted Fantail. 1911, 347—A skin of 
the Cape Petrel, and Mallophagan 
parasites therefrom. 1911, 633—Hippo- 
boscid flies with Mallophaga, from 
birds. 1913, 108—Pauropoda Scuti- 
gerella, Land-Nemertean, Pontobdella, 
and Myriothela. 1914, 256—Living 
young of Ornithorhynchus anatinus. 
1921, 407—Irregularly conical shaped 
object. 1924, xxiii. 
Harrison, L. M. Leg bone 
which had been fractured. 
HaAswetit, W. A. Specimens of Amphi- 
oxus. 1881, 711—Female generative 
organs of Platypus. 1882, 212—Draw- 


of bullock 
1884, 1016. 


ings of earlier stages in development 
of Phoronis australis. 1882, 611— 
Announcement of arrangements made 
for supply of spawn of Ceratodus. 1882, 
674—Skeleton of Port Jackson shark. 
1883, 442—Remarks on A. G. Bourne’s 
observations on nephridia of Polynoe. 
1884, 382—Foetuses of a wallaby. 1884, 
681—Specimens of Alepas parasita. 
1885, 279—Astacopsis serratus from 
Mt. Wilson. 1886, 505—Cicada showing 
song production apparatus. 1886, 505— 
Preparations iilustrating embryology 
of birds. 1887, 621—Adaptation of 
microscope for use in museum cases. 
1892, 313—See also under Herpiey, C. 


HAVILAND, HH. (For Rev. Mr. ALKIN) 
Sphaeria parasitic on caterpillar. 1886, 
163—Hthulia conyzoides from  Rich- 
mond River district, with a note by 
Baron von Mueller. 1887, 141—Maize 
from Camden, destroyed by fungus. 
1887, 196. 

Havitanp, FE. EK. A Mulga-ball from the 
intestine of a sheep; and an egg of the 
Mallee-hen. 1911, 634. 


Hay, J. Spike of flowers of Orchid 
(Cymbidium  Loweanum - eburneum). 
1900, 697. 

Haynes, A. J. Living Moloch horridus 
from Coolgardie. 1897, 161. 

Hector, J. Plates of fossil flora of New 
Zealand. 1877, 266. 


HepLtEy, C. Specimens of Vaginula 
leydigi and V. hedleyi from Brisbane. 
1890, 897—Nests of Trapdoor spider. 
1891, 44—Note on ova of Helicarion 
robustus. 1891, 248—(For Mr. WHItE- 
LEGGE) Species of Glauwcus frequently 
washed ashore. 1891, 576—Living 
specimens of Panda atomata. 1892, 
200—Living specimens of AHelicarion 
from Scone. 1892, 200—Cystopelta 
petterdi from Mt. Wilson. 1892, 200— 
Helicarion thomsoni from Geographe 
Bay. 1892, 200—(For Mr. RatnBow) 
Spider of family Hpeiridae. 1892, 278 
—Remarks on transference of Pupa 
anodonta to genus Heterocyclus. 1892, 
373—Nautilus pompilius found stranded 
at Curl Curl. 1893, 239—Shell of 
Unio angasi from stomach of cod. 1893, 
536—Land shell (Flammulina rosacea) 
from Blackheath. 1894, 43—Oysters 
from Vaucluse destroyed by boring 
molluse, with a note. 1894, 185—Note 
on snail found in throat of Rallus 
pectoralis. 1894, 361—Conchological 
notes. 1894, 464—Remarks on species 
of Calliostoma described by J. Brazier. 
1894, 5883—Valve of Cardium flavum 
from Port Jackson. 1895, 409—Atten- 
tion called to specimens of Fiona 
marina collected at Maroubra Bay. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 85 


1896, 28—Specimens of Firoloides des- 
maresti. 1896, 28—(For Mr. J. 
JENNINGS) Living Strombus luhuanus 
from Vaucluse. 1896, 88—Pleuro- 
branchea luniceps from Maroubra Bay. 
1896, 816—Monodonta zeus from W.A. 
1896, 817—Cancellaria granosa from 
stomach of schnapper. 1897, 442— 
Fully developed specimen of Gund- 
lachia. 1898, 75—Photographs of 
gigantic fish-hook. 1898, 75—Note on 
South Sea Island canoe cast up on 
beach near Cape Byron. 1899, 192— 
Freshwater shells from Lake Tan- 
ganyika. 1899, 547—(For Dr. T. H. 
May) Photographs of aboriginal stone 
carvings. 1900, 322—French example 
of use of three colour process. 1900, 
476—Shel! known as Ranella leucos- 
toma. 1901, 631—(For R. L. CHERRY) 
Conus capitaneus and Vewilla vexillum. 
1901, 6831—Molluseca dredged off Wollon- 
gong. 1902, 495—Polyzoa and Foram- 
inifera dredged off Cape Byron. 1902, 
657—(For Miss PARKES) Molluse 
(Strebloceras cynicollis) from Port 
Jackson. 1904, 253—Copy of Catalogue 
of Contents of Museum of James 
Petiver (1695-1703). 1904, 479—(For 
W. EF. Prerrerd) Collection of deep sea 
Mollusca, corals and MHolothuria, 
dredged east of Sydney Heads. 1905, 
101—(For Mr. Basser Hovryi) Pearl 
oyster spat found on beach pumice 
near Sydney. 1905, 351—Pelagic crus- 
tacean, Phronoma sedentaria, found at 
Maroubra. 1905, 576—(For Professor 
HASWELL) Collection of deep sea 
animals, trawled east of Sydney. 1906, 
°565—(For A. R. McCuntocH) Views 
illustrating vegetation of Lord Howe 


Island. 1908, 736—Mollusca dredged ~ 


off Cape Royds. 1909, 116—(For Mr. 
B. JARDINE) Pearl adherent to valve of 
pearl shell. 1909, 216—Rare Carrier- 
Trochus (Xenophora) from New Zea- 
land. 1909, 274—Native spoon from 
Solomcen Islands. 1909, 411—(For Mr. 
H. BurreEtL) Photo of a marine Molluse 
Ovipositing. 1910, 805—Japanese post- 
cards, and bonbons resembling shells. 
1913, 255—A copy of Waterhouse and 
Lyell’s “Australian Rhopalocera’”’. 1914, 
323—Japanese conchological  illustra- 
tions. 1915, 207—Photograph of the 
cenotaph in memory of Major and Mrs. 
Innes, in the old church at Port Mac- 
quarie. 1918, 236—Photographs of 
pearl shells. 1923, xxxiv. 


Hetms, R. Reference to discovery of 


Peripatus at high altitudes. 1889, 598— 
Remarks on evidence of glacier action 
at Mt. Kosciusko. 1893, 327—Glacier 
polished rock from Snowy Mountains. 


1893, 328—Spider (Dicrostichus gp.) 
with nest and egg-bags. 1901, 476—See 
also under Davin, T.. W. E., R. Hetmus 
and H. EF. Pirrman. 

HENDERSON, P. E. Collection of minerals. 
1884, 443. 

Henn, A. U. (For Mrs. G. J. Water- 
HOUSE) Collection of Cypraeidae from 
Port Jackson. 1895, 520—Cypraea 
vitellus and Micromelo guamensis from 
Botany Heads. 1895, 520—Collection 
of Mollusca (Fam. Rissoidae) from Port 
Jackson. 1896, 500—Mollusca from 
Long Bay and Middle Harbour. 1896, 
500. 

Hitt, J. P. Balanoglossus. 1893, 329— 
Undetermined species of Cristiceps with 
developing young. 1900, 761—Drawings 
illustrating development of marsupials. 
1900, 761—Egg shells of eggs of Echidna 
and Platypus. 1900, 761—Land Nemer- 
tean from Barrington River scrubs. 
1905, 487. 

Hinpe, B. H. Letter respecting poisonous 
effects of bite inflicted by Conus geo- 
graphicus. 1884, 944. 

Hirst, G. D. Centipede (Heterostoma) 
from Herbert River. 1885, 76. 


Hogsson, J. Entomological specimens from 
Solomon Islands. 1879, 463—Butter- 
flies taken at considerable distance 
from the coast. 1880, 286—Mineral 
specimens from Solomon Islands. 1880, 
495—New species of Bulimus. 1881, 
790. 

Hutu, A. F. B. Eggs of silver gull (Larus 
novae-hollandiae ) from Montague 
Island. 1908, 286—Hegg of white tern 
laid on branch of white wood tree, 
Norfolk Island. 1908, 800—Skin and 
egg of white-faced storm petrel and eggs 
of little penguin from Tom Thumb 
Island. 1909, 589—Bird-skins and eggs 
from Lord Howe and the Kermadec 
Islands. 1910, 522—Bird-skins and 
eggs from the islands off Port Stephens. 
1910, 687—Bird-skins from Lord Howe 
Island. 1910, 804—Littler’s “Handbook 
of the Birds of Tasmania’’, etc., 1910, 
138—Hegg and nestlings of the White- 
winged Petrel, from Cabbage Tree 
Island. 1911, 82—(For Mr. L. 
Harrison) Skin of the Cape Petrel, and 
Mallophagan parasites therefrom. 1911, 
633—Skin and HEgg of Allied Petrel; 
eggs of Fleshy-footed Petrel. 1912, 48 
—Nest and eggs of two Lord Howe 
Island birds. 1918, 657—Wilson’s 
Storm-Petrel caught at sea; section of 
stem of Callicoma bored by a beetle. 
1915, 116—Fluttering Petrel. 1916, 103 
—Collection of Land and Freshwater 
Mollusks collected in France. 1918, 235 
—Note on mortality amongst Puffinus 


86 INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


tenuirostris. 1919, 721—Chitons and 
land shells from coast of Great Aus- 
tralian Bight and Recherche Archi- 
pelago. 1922, xxiv—Handbook No. 1 of 
Royal Zoological Society of N.S.W., 
1922, xxiii—Abnormal Loricates. 1925, 
xxxix, xliii—Series of colour variations 
of Rhyssoplax discolor. 1925, xliii— 
See also under Hepiey, C. 

Hunter, J. G. An enormous Antarctic 
Pyenogonid. 1913, 113. 

Hurst, G. Egg of Scythrops 
hollandiae. 1884, 1169—EHEggs from 
swamp at Newington. 1886, 882— 
Sphenaeacus gramineus with nest and 
eggs from Newington. 1886, 1061— 
Egg of cuckoo from nest of Malurus 
cyaneus with note. 1888, 421. 

Hurton, F. W. Postscript to “Notes on 
the Mueller Glacier, N.Z.’’, 1888, 1259. 


Hynes, Miss S. Motion urging more 
adequate protection of the native flora. 
1914, 90—Botanical diagrams for use 
in schools; and a badge for field- 
botanists. 1911, 156—Fruits and a draw- 
ing of Hernandia bivalvis; coloured 
illustrations of native plants. 1913, 48 
—Coccoloba platyclada showing xero- 
phytic characters. 1913, 520—Double 
flowers of Wahlenbergia gracilis, and 
painting. 1915, 629—White-flowered 
var. of Hpacris longifiora; fasciated 
Antirrhinum; synanthic flowers of 
Digitalis; spikes of Callistemon linearis 
var., with flowers of different colours. 
1917, 512—Water colour drawing of 
undetermined Phalloid fungus. 1919, 
40—Water colour paintings of Dictyo- 
phora (Phalloideae). 1919, 192—Con- 


nOvae- 


eretion. 1920, 404—Monstera deliciosa. 
1921, 158. 
Jacoss, HE. G. Epacris purpurascens 


showing double flowers. 1920, 404. 
JARDINE, B. See under Hepiey, C. 
JENKINS, C. Drawings of Trilobites. 

1878, 40—Palaeozoic fossils from 

between Cobar and Wilcannia. 1882, 

674. : 
JENKINS, R. J. H. Flaked aboriginal stone- 

axe, from Woy Woy. 1913, 525. 
JENNINGS, J. See under HeEpiey, C. 
JENSEN, H. I. Microscope section of coal 

from Neweastle. ‘1903, 832—Slides of 

Foraminifera and glauconite from Den- 

mark. 1903, 832—Glaucophane schist 

from Mt. Mee, Q. 1905, 396—Raised 

beach shells from Point Arkwright, Q. 

1905, 3897—Water from sulphuretted 

hydrogen spring at Point Arkwright. 

1905, 397—Lava from Samoa and 

Tonga. 1906, 676—Shells from raised 

beach at Lautoka. 1906, 676— 

Lantern slides of active volcano in 


Savaii. 1906, 676—Kava root (Piper 
methysticum) from South Sea Islands. 
1907, 188—Photographs and petrological 
specimens from Warrumbungle Mts. 
1907, 556—See also under TaAytor, T. G. 
JoHNsStToN, S. J. Marine Annelid (Palalo 
viridis). 1899, 477—Collection of 
lizards from Lizard Island. 1901, 214— 
(For R. T. Baker) Supposed new 
species of Actinotus. 1904, 460. 
JoHnston, T. H. Record of occurrence 
of nine species of Hntozoa in N.S.W. 
1909, 117—New records of Entozoa 
from N.S.W. 1909, 217—Series of 
Entozoa from N.S.W. 1909, 412— 
Potatoes showing various diseased con- 
ditions. 1909, 417—Galls due _ to 
Nematode worms. 1909, 417—Series of 
Entozoa mainly from rats and mice. 
1909, 417—Note on reported occurrence 
of Sarcosporidia in Australian animals. 
1909, 418—Series of EHEntozoa from 
N.S.W. 1909, 590—Series of Entozoa 
from the Barracouta. 1909, 710— 
Entozoa, remarkable or unrecorded. 
1910, 28, 309, 432, 523, 659, 804—Plants 
injuriously affected by Gall-Mites. 1910, 
136—Potato-tubers destroyed by an 
Agaric. 1910, 310—Tomato-fruit affected 
by Irish Blight. 1910, 48—Australian 


Entozoa. 1911, 157—Fungus-smitten 
plants. 1911, 83. 

KanGaroo. ~ Discussion of meaning of 
name. 1890, 510. 


Katz, O. Bacteria in sterilized nutrient 
gelatin. 1886, 854—Bacteria from 
Sydney water. 1886, 1207—Bacillus 
(Micrococcus prodigiosus). 1886, 1207 
—Cultures of pathogenic and sapro- 
phytic bacteria. 1887, 143—Bacillus cf 
typhoid fever. 1887, 197—Bacillus of 
leprosy. 1887, 198—Cultures of phos- 
phorescent bacteria. 1887, 414—Ham 
with nodules of carbonate of lime. 1887, 
556—Cultures of pigment-producing 
micrococcus. 1887, 621—Cultures of 
phosphorescent bacteria. 1887, 680— 
Note on lung of cow suffering from 
pleuro-pneumonia. 1887, 979—Bacillus 
of fowl cholera. 1888, 336—Note on 


venom of Australian snakes. 1888, 400 
—New thermostat. 1888, 1315—Draw- 
ings of leprosy bacilli. 1889, 390— 


Pamphlet illustrating gas-making appa- 
ratus. 1889, 390—Drawings and cul- 
tures of chicken cholera microbe. 1889, 
598. 


Kenyon, Mrs. Varietal forms of Cypraea. 


1896, 269—Note on Cypraea caput- 
anguis. 1896, 584—Specimens of Conus 
rutilus and _ varieties. 1896, 818— 


Conus anemone showing small pearl. 
1897, 161—Species of Cypraea exhibiting 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 87 


peculiarities. 1897, 161—See also under 
BRAZIER, J. 

KersHaw, W. Remarks on the abundance 
of a Noctuid moth, Agrotis spina. 1889, 
1053. 

KESTEVEN, H. L. Specimens of Rissoidae 
from Sandgate, Q. 1902, 206—Record 
of Asaphis contraria in Sydney Har- 
bour. 1903, 98—(For W. J. RArInsow) 
Ogyris idino and O. barnardi. 1903, 
314—Notes on some N.S.W. Rissoidae. 
1906, 426—Curious fungus (Aseroe 
rubra) from Mullumbimby. 1907, 159 
—Preparations of eyes of tadpole of 
species of Hyla. 1907, 839—Dissected 
specimen of Ayla aurea, containing 
smaller specimen in stomach. 1908, 286 
—Cervical cord of dog and sections of 
brain of Hyla aurea treated in various 
ways. 1909, 412. 

KING, Miss GEORGINA. 
FLETCHER, J. J. 

Kine, P. G. Specimens of Pieris teutonia. 
1882, 674. 

KinenHorn, J. R. Drawing of Pletholax 


See under 


gracilis. 1925, xxxviii. 
KLAATSCHE, —. Lantern views illustrat- 
ing travels amongst aborigines in 


North Australia. 

Kynepon, E. B. Marsh plants from 
Waterloo. 1883, 197—Fossil fruit from 
near Bathurst. .1885, 760—Plant re- 
mains from Mt. Piddington. 1887, 144 
—Concretion from stomach of whale. 
1887, 144. 


1906, 676. 


Lamont, Rev. J. Presentation of old 
prints of Australian plants to the 
Society. 1914, 157. 


Laseron, C. F. Graptolites from near 
Cooma. 1909, 118—Probable new genus 
of fossil Pelecypod from Shoalhaven 
River. 1909, 118—Conularia laevigata 
showing aperture. 1909, 590—Permo- 
Carboniferous fossils. 1910, 308. 

Layarp, H. L. See under Mactray, W. 


Lesa, A. M. Insects which inhabit ant 
and Termite nests. 1893, 438—Cole- 
optera from Forest Reefs. 1893, 534— 
Tick unusually abundant at Manly. 
1894, 708—Cypraea mauritiana trom 
Long Bay. 1894, 708—Coconut moth 
(Levuana iridescens). 1924, xxvii. 


LENDENFELD, R. von. New species of 
Haliphysema. 1884, 866—Bolina chuni 
at different stages and Neis cordigera. 
1884, 1016—Granite from Australian 
Alps. 1885, 124—Cypress pine (fFrenela 
robusta) affected by larva of Diadozus. 
1885, 124—Dipnyes found at Bondi. 
1885, 187—Remarks on discovery of 
sensitive ganglia cells in horny 
sponges. 1885, 246—Photographs of 
glacier-polished rocks. 1885, 553. 


Le Sourr, A. S. Photographs of a 
gelded Wallaroo, and of Carpet Snakes. 
1910, 524—The skin of a very dark 


specimen of the Vulpine Phalanger 
from West Australia. 1911, 425— 
Abnormal elephant’s tusk. 1916, 632— 


Live specimen of Moloch horridus. 
1921, 210—lLive specimen of Conilurus 


conditor. 1922, xxv—Two new rock 

wallabies. 1924, xxviii. ; 
LITTLEJOHN, —. Gastrotokeus biaculeatus 

from Torres Strait. 1883, 417. 
LocKYER, —. See under WILKINSON, C. S. 


Lopprr, Miss M. See under Fietcuer, J. J. 


Lucas, A. H. S. Tasmanian lizard. 1893, 
238—Pseudophryne semi - marmorata 
from Victoria. 1893, 238—Fossil piants 
from Joadja Creek. 1893, 238—Two 
small fishes from Central Australia. 
1894, 361—Typhlops from Victoria and 
Queensland. 1894, 540—Honey ants 
and lizards from Central Australia. 
1895, 472—Specimens of Hgernia from 
Coolgardie. 1895, 472—Fossil fish in 
Wianamatta shale from Marrickville. 
1896, 88—HExtreme fasciation in Flannel 
Flower and Calycothrix tetragona. 
1897, 810—Casuarina glauca infested 
with Hriococcus turgipes. 1897, 810— 
Remarks on Brachylophus. 1899, 285 
—(For Mr. G. THorntTon) Collection of 
New Zealand Cordyceps. 1899, 285— 
Wattles flowering at Gordon. 1908, 
629—Sea balls from Port Stephens. 
1909, 498—Mounted marine algae. 1913, 
109. 

LYELL, G. See under Frocearr, W. W. 


MacDonaLp, J. See under Macrimay, W. 


MACDONNELL, S. Diatomaceous earth from 
Beechworth, Victoria. 1886, 577—Saw 


of species of Pristis. 1887, 412— 
Rotifers (Megalotrocha sp.). 1888, 
1096—Letter asking for Australian 
Oribatidae. 1888, 1560—Mounted speci- 
mens of Baetis from Adelong. 1890, 
140. 


Portion of a cobra (Calo- 
1880, 


Mackay, P. 
bates) from Parramatta River. 
285. 


MACKELLAR, —. Portions of liver and 
lungs of sheep with hydatid cysts. 
1883, 280. 

Mackinnon, H. Six parasitic Fungi. 
1912, 592—Micro-fungi; Plantago lance- 
olata in a teratological condition. 1913, 
657. 

MacLaurin, C. Vegetable caterpillar 
from New Zealand. 1900, 213. 


Maclaurin, N. Remarks on occasion of 
his unveiling portrait of Prof. W. J. 
Stephens, painted and presented by 
Miss Stephens. 1913, 256. 


88 


Macray, N. dE MikLouHo. 
Melanesian natives illustrating lacro- 
dontism. 1878, 305—Anthropological 
drawings and photographs. 1881, 196-— 
Drawings of brain of Hchidna and mar- 
supials. 1881, 196—Photographs and 
drawings of brain of dingo. 1881, 626 
—Sketches showing deformation of 
heads of children and drawings of 
natives in New Guinea. 1881, 711— 
Specimens of marine life. 1883, 296— 
Sketch of new species of Heterodontus. 
1883, 416—Shells and dried clay. 1884, 
1016—Remarks on low blood tempera- 
ture in Hchidna. 1885, 248—Fragment 
of jet from New Guinea. 1885, 853. 


Macieay, W. Two species of Tiaris. 1877, 


122—Lithographs of fishes. 1878, 40— 
Painting of Monacanthus granulosus. 
1878, 40—Drawing of a Medusa abun- 
dant in Port Jackson. 1878, 76— 
Argonauta argv from Port Jackson. 
1878, 76—Drawings of Trilobites 
from Yass. 1878, 76—Coloured draw- 
ings of an Aplysia and of Mona- 
canthus from Fort Jackson. 1878, 76 
—Am~phisile komis and Vivipara 
allisoni. 1878, 305—Coral from Green’s 
Point, Watson’s Bay. 1878, 340— 
Heterodontus galeatus. 1879, 292— 
Note on Heterodontus galeatus. 1879, 
311—Notes on Fijian fossils, contained 
in letter from A. Boyd. 1879, 397— 
Silurian and Devonian fossils from 
Yass district. 1879, 409—Notes on three 
sharks from Port Jackson. 1879, 458— 
Note on Scomber antarcticus. 1879, 463 
—Note on fluid for preservation of 
animal and vegetable tissues. 1880, 
284—Gorgonias and rare shells from 
the Torres Straits. 1881, 196—Large 
specimen of fungus (Mylitta australis). 
1881, 749—Novel native implements 
from Batavia River. 1881, 790—(For 
Mr. Patmer) Large Gall of a manna- 
producing Cocecus and a rare heteromer- 
ous beetle (Zopherosis georgii). 1881, 
837—(For Mr. H. L. Layarp) Samples 
of a bark used by the natives of New 
Caledonia and New Hebrides to pro- 
eure abortion. 1881, 837—Mass of 
gutta-percha from a New Caledonian 
tree. 1881, 837—Note on insects in- 
jurious to gum trees. 1881, 845— 
Peculiar fungus. 1882, 91—Chersydrus 
annulatus from Cairns. 1882, 302— 
Grape vine cuttings eaten by larva of 
weevil. 1882, 329—Orthorhinus klugti. 
1882, 348—Borer (Family Scolytidae). 
1882, 348—Horny growth from ear of 
sheep. 1883, 34—Dendrolagus dorianus. 
1883, 197—Moth and fungus upon 
which the larvae fed. 1883, 197— 
Specimen of fire opal from Queensland. 


Drawings of 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


1883, 197—Tineid moth whose larva 
was damaging vegetable gardens. 1883, 
218, 281—Foetus of Halmaturus rufi- 
collis. 18838, 218—Cast of right man- 
dible of Palorchestes azgael. 1883, 280 
-—Living Trachydosaurus asper. 1883, 
387—Strophura spinigera. 1883, 388— 
Casts of humerus of Diprotodon and ? 
Nototherium. 18838, 416—Letter from 
J. HE. Tenison-Woods. 18838, 464— 
Remarks on shark captured at Port- 
land, Victoria. 1883, 464—Remarks on 
cases of commensalism. 1883, 533— 
Siphonognathus argyrophanes. 1883, 433 
—Fossil plant from near Hunter’s Hill. 
1883, 534—(For Mr. J. MacDonatp) 
New species of Salarias. 1884, 119— 
Letter from J. EH. Tenison-Woods at 
Perak. 1884, 38883—Remarks on Chlamy- 
doselachus anguineus. 1884, 442— 
—Omissions in his Catalogue of Aus- 
tralian Fishes. 1884, 443—(For Rev. 
J. W. Gitt) Small beetle (“‘Fire-fly’’) 
from New Guinea. 1884, 443—(For Mr. 
C. S. WILKINSON) Conical stone imple- 
ment. 1884, 507—(For Mr. C. S. 
WILKINSON) Heliz-like shells. 1884, 
508—New species of Furina. 1884, 682 
—(For Rev. J. M. Curran) Lizard 
(Grallatophorus) from Dubbo. 1884, 
865—Ophiophagus elaps. 1884, 1205— 
Notes on habits of aborigines by Dr. 
Turner. 1885, 188—Freshwater fishes 
from Little and Yass Rivers. 1885, 246 
—Immature specimens of Holostoma 
alatum. 1885, 342—Aviculopecten. 1885, 
448—Branch of orange tree perforated 
by larva of longicorn beetle. 1885, 448 
—Necrodes osculans. 1885, 553—Petri- 
fied wood. 1885, 558—Species of 
Monacanthus. 1885, 761—(For Mr. 
WILKINSON) Fossil Crustacean from 
Forrest River. 1885, 761—Specimen of 
Hunice sp. 1885, 854—Caranz ciliaris. 
1886, 505—Tragoceras lepidopterus 
from Mt. Victoria. 1886, 578—Reptiles 
and fishes from Cairns district. 1886, 
882—Tertiary fossil leaves from near 
Inverell. 1886, 1123—Australian Scari- 
tidae. 1887, 1483—Hoplocephalus nigres- 
cens and HA. collaris from Mt. Wilson 
and elsewhere. 1887, 196—Grass in- 
fested by grub probably belonging 
to Cecidomyidae. 1887, 251—(For Pro- 
fessor W. J. STEPHENS) Abnormal 
lemons grown at Ryde. 1887, 251— 
Leptocephalus taenia from the China 


Sea. 1887, 414—(For Rev. J. HE. 
TENISON-Woops) Edible bird’s nests 
from the Philippines. 1887, 451— 
Stibnite from Borneo. 1887, 451—In- 


sects from Malay Peninsula. 1887, 451 
—Ascaris from. stomach of kangaroo. 
1887, 451—Brachysoma simile and 


MACPHERSON, —. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 89 


Furina teaxtilis from Port Darwin. 
1887, 556—Hoplocephalus from Cooma. 
1887, 556—Hrythrichthys nitidus from 
Tasmania. 1887, 621—Oligorus from 
Richmond River. 1887, 981—(For Rev. 
J. E. Tentson-Woops) Coal fossils from 
Borneo. 1887, 982—Fossils from near 
King’s Sound. 1888, 422—Species of 
carp from Wingecarribee River, with 
note. 1888, 1507—Two species. of 
Cyprinidae. 1888, 1559—Two new 
snakes from Queensland. 1889, 190. 

Aboriginal stone chisel 
from near Glen Innes. 1902, 74—Stone 
axe from Inverell district. 1902, 74. 


Mamwen, J. H. Shell conglomerate from 


Manly Beach. 1886, 974—Collection of 
Leguminosae from N.S.W. 1887, 175— 
Specimens of 35 rarer species of 
natural orders in Vol. i of “Australian 
Flora”. 1887, 196—Nicotiana suavo- 
lens. 1887, 556—Plants from Wilcannia 
district. 1887, 681, 978, 1075—Seeds of 
Eremophila sturtii and  Clianthus 
dampierii. 1887, 1075—Graphite from 


N.S.W. 1887, 1075—Fungus (Xylos- 
troma gigantea). 1888, 335—Rare 
plants from Milparinka. 1888, 335— 


Seed capsuies of Hucalyptus pilularis. 
1888, 739—Note on synonymy of Ficus 
scabra. 1888, 1314—Stem of Alyzia 
buxifolia, supposed to have medicinal 
properties. 1888, 1315—EHnormous 
leaves of Eucalypt from Bombala. 
1889, 633—Collection of  Huropean 
plants. 1889, 1054—Samples of wheat 
showing effects of rust. 1890, 243— 
Fruit of palm from New Hebrides 
which yields a pink dye stuff. 1890, 
243—Lake cotton from Lake Coran- 
gamite. 1890, 243—Capsule of Bombaz 
malabaricum. 1890, 243—Nuts of 
Omphalea Queenslandii. 1890, 243— 
Fruit of undetermined Loranthus. 
1890, 243—Seeds of the “Coy-you’’. 
1890, 243—-Fruit of quinine (Petalo- 
stigma quadriloculare). 1890, 243— 
Three new plants from Mt. Bellenden 
Ker. 1890, 267—Seeds of Seseli 
Harveyanum from Snowy Mountains. 
1890, 267—Artificial flowers made in 
Germany. 1890, 267—Native Truffle 
(Mylitta australis) from Victoria. 1890, 
294—Stem of Xanthorrhoea arborea. 
1890, 294—Core of the caudex of 
Xanthorrhoea arborea. 1890, 413— 
Collection of mosses from Upper 
Gloucester district. 1890, 492—Manna 
of Hucalyptus Gunnii. 1890, 492— 
Gum from Panax dendroides var. 
angusta. 1890, 510—Fresh fruit of 
Citrullus colocynthis and bulb of 
Urginea indica grown at Bombay. 1890, 
680—Hymenopterous galls found on 


Acacias. 1890, 680—Collection of in- 
digenous plants. 1891, 166—Ripe fruits 
of Monstera deticiosa. 1891, 248— 
Vegetable sponge (Lujffa aegyptiaca). 
1891, 248—Abnormal maize cobs. 1891, 
248—Seeds of sugar cane from Bar- 
bados. 1891, 381—Boronia barkeriana 
from Little Sirius Cove. 1891, 682— 
Psilotum complanatum from Ballina. 
1891, 682—Micromelum pubescens from 
near Lismore. 1891, 682—Kibara 
longipes. 1891, 682—Series of Capparis 


‘nobilis from Richmond River. 1892, 41 


Billardieri. 1892, 41— 
longifolia with unusually 
long leaf. 1892, 41—Collection of 
plants of Richmond River. 1892, 200 
—(For Baron von MUELLER) Flower- 
ing and fruiting specimens of new 
Acacia. 1892, 314—Fruits and seeds 
from Bellenden Ker Range and Her- 
bert River. 1892, 344—Flowering and 
fruiting specimens of new Hakea from 
Wallsend. 1892, 373—Flowering speci- 
mens of Grevillea Barkleyiana from 
Jervis Bay. 1892, 404—New Zealand 
Composite (Raoulia mammillaris ) . 
1892, 404—Hssential oil from flowers 
of Cananga odorata. 1892, 404—Fruit- 
ing specimens of Acacia vestita. 1892, 
667—(For Dr. Bancrorr) Photograph 
of Marsilea Drummondii grown by Dr. 
Bancroft. 1893, 218. Flowering and 
fruiting specimens of Acronychia 
acidula. 1893, 238—Sections and photo- 
graphs of native bread (Mylitta aus- 
tralis). 1893, 328—(For Mr. A. J. 
SacH) Aboriginal stone implement 
shaped like dagger. 1893, 328— 
Blechnum serrulatum and stones used 
by aboriginals for pounding. 1894, 43 
—Litsaea reticulata from Lismore. 
1894, 5883—Fruits of Hicksbeachia pin- 
natifolia from Tweed River. 1894, 740 
—Native fire sticks from near Card- 
well. 1895, 209—Pearl-shell fish-hooks 
used by natives cf Hinchinbrook Island. 
1895, 209—Native shell forehead orna- 
ment. 1895, 209—Young coconut plant 
from New Hebrides. 1895, 409—Native 
drill. 1895, 409—Parasitic fungi (Phy- 
sarum cinereum and Cerebrella andro- 
pogonis). 1898, 106—Series of South 
African Proteaceae. 1898, 106—Speci- 
men of Brabejum stellatifolium from 
Cape Colony. 1898, 106—Fresh fruits 
of Cerbera odollam from New Cale- 
donia. 1898, 106—Species of Opuntia. 
1898, 273—Juice of cultivated tress of 
Cerbera manghas. 1898, 273—Note on 
New Zealand Coprosma _ cultivated 
around Sydney. 1898, 647—Pot plants 
in flower from Botanic Gardens. 1899, 


Phebalium 
Notelaea 


- 135—Photographs of inflorescence of 


91) INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


Hedyscepe canterburiana. 1899, 135— 
Four species of plants in flower. 1899, 
190—Photographs illustrating botanical 
features of Mt. Kosciusko Plateau. 
1899, 193—Pot plant of Indian Cero- 
pegia elegans. 1899, 286—Gum resin 
and fruits of Gardenia Aubreyi. 1900, 
60—Fig (?Ficus Henneana) trom 
National Park. 1900, 60—Pot plants 
of Selaginella involvens and Oncidium 
Carthaginense. 1900, 3898—Massonia 
pustulata and Tillandsia lindeni. 1900, 
476—Pot plants (Aechmea maride- 
reginae and Cypripedium hirsutissi- 
mum). 1900, 548—Pot plants (Dendro- 
bium gracilicaule var. howeanum and 
Anthurium scherzgerianum var. album). 
1900, 611—Flowering specimens of 
interesting plants. 1900, 761—Botanical 
relics of historical interest. 1901, 476 
—Photograph of obelisk in Botanic 
Gardens, to memory of Allan Cunning- 
ham. 1901, 514—Collection of plants 
from the Sahara. 1901, 514—Double 
flowered spathe of Arum Lily. 1901, 
540—EHucalyptus tereticornis from New 
Guinea. 1901, 540—(For H. BrrcuHe) 
Balanophora fungosa from Northern 
Queensland. 1901, 540—Fruiting and 
flowering Cocos yatayi. 1902, 239— 
Watercolour drawing of fruits of Ficus 
Bennettii. 1902, 239—Report of occur- 
rence of manna from Dalgety. 1902, 239 
—New species of plants from Bismarck 
Archipelago. 1902, 344—Leafless dead 
stems of Lepidium ruderale from Bre- 
warrina. 1902, 344—Dipsacus sylvestris 
torsus. 1902, 344—Antarctic plants 
collected by Hooker. 1902, 370—Type 
specimen of Hucalyptus bicolor. 1902, 
593—Drawing of type specimen oi #. 
polyanthenvos. 1902, 593—Distegia 
Ledebourti from California. 1902, 593 
—Photograph of tablet to memory of 
Richard Cunningham. 1903, 686— 
Fruits of Hucalyptus longifolia from 
Gosford. 1903, 944—Specimen of 
calvary clover. 1903, 944—Portrait 
and letter from Sir Joseph Banks. 
1903, 944—Grass (Cenchrus  calycu- 
latus) from Norfolk Island. 1904, 479 
—Additional vernacular names _ for 
Norfolk Is. plants. 1904, 479—Flower- 
ing specimens of Dracophyllum secun- 
- dum from National Park. 1904, 557— 
Loranthus on Melaleuca sp. from 
Kangaroo Is. 1904, 696—Northern 
Territory Cypress Pine (Frenela intra- 
tropica). 1904, 805—Flower of Helico- 
diceros muscivorus. 1904, 805—Collec- 
tion of Javanese plants. 1905, 222— 
Coloured drawings of Port Jackson 
plants by J. W. Lewin. 1905, 307— 
New genus of Compositae. 1905, 307— 


Acacia leptocilada, showing stem fascia- 
tion. 1905, 350—Coloured drawings of 
Hucalyptus seedlings. 1905, 350— 
Loranths of County of Cumberland. 
1905, 491—Remarks on vegetable fibre 
exhibited by Messrs. Baker and Hamil- 
ton. 1906, 425—Fruits of Davidson’s 
plum. 1906, 426—Number of plants 
usually called leafless. 1906, 426—Fibre 
of marine plant, Posidonia australis. 
1906, 497—Living plant of Myrmecodia 
beccarii. 1906, 566—(For T. Sreex) 
Boronia from French’s Forest. 1906, 
566—Two species of N.S.W. MHalor- 
rhagis. 1906, 675—Contribution to dis- 
cussion on welfare of indigenous fauna 
and flora. 1908, 632—Roots of native 
cherry showing haustoria. 1909, 216— 
A “cushion-plant” from Bolivia; Hoff- 
mann’s litho-portrait of Robert Brown. 
1910, 136—Drawing of a seedling of 
Bloodwood, with three cotyledons; A 
West Australian Hucalypt with ternate 
juvenile leaves. 1910, 523—Fruits of 
Jarrah; seedlings of Cassytha. 1910, 
431—Drawing and specimens of a 
Tasmanian saprophyte (N.O. Burman- 
niaceae). 1911, 607—Drawing of two 
Couch grasses, one previously un- 
recorded. 1911, 634—-Photographs of 
fruits of Macrozamia: a hybrid Acacia. 
1913, 109—Fruits and flowers of a rare 
EKucalypt from West Australia. 1913, 
170—Tubers of Mirabilis longiflora; 
flowering specimen of JHucalyptus 
torquata. 1915, 117—Hybrid Boronia. 
1915, 419—Crimson-flowered Kurrajong, 
and hybrid Hucalypt. 1916, 192— 
Flowering twig of Hucalyptus erythro- 
corys. 1917, 201—Linnea borealis var. 
americana. 1922, xxx—See also under 
ForsytH, W.; FRrocGarr, W. W. 


Maren, J. H., and R. T. Baker. Ptero- 
stylis barbata from near Bathurst, 1894, 
708. 


Maen, J. H., and EK. Bercue. Nephelium 
distyle and N. divaricatum. 1898, 273. 


Maen, J. H., and R. H. CamsBace. Series 
of Hucalypts of Blue Mountains. 1905, 
DIOR 


Mannine, J. N. Fossil fish from St. 
Peters. 1885, 553. 


Masters, G. Batocera wallacei from Hall 
Sound, New Guinea. 1875-76, 40— 
Geobasileus reguloides and G. chrysor- 
rhous with nests and eggs of each. 
1875-76, 361—Nest of Gerygone albogu- 
laris with eggs of its own and of a 
bronze cuckoo. 1875-76, 362—Skull of 
an aboriginal female. 1877, 30— 
Gigantic petrel captured at Sydney 
Heads. 1877, 122—Collection of spiders. 
1877, 142—Voluta turneri and V. flavi- 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 91 


cans. 1877, 288—Two crabs (Maia). 
1877, 288—Albino specimens of birds. 
1878, 14—New Zealand petrel shot near 
Sydney Heads. 1878, 21—Phyllosoma 
from Port Jackson and MJZ'rachurus 
trachurus. 1878, 413—Species of Sawl- 
oprocto meliornis and Rhipidura. 1879, 
107—Specimens of shells from Manly. 
1879, 116—New species of Serranus 
and Percis from Fiji Islands. 1879, 
244—Two heads of Malicolo chiefs 
showing lengthened skulls. 1879, 244— 
A Cirripede, Paradolepas neptuni. 1879, 
398—Note on effect of heat in the 
development of insects. 1879, 408— 
Preserved specimen of Doris. 1879, 409 
—Heterodontus philippii and H. galea- 
tus. 1879, 471—Puffinus gavius and 
Arses  telescopthalmus. 1880, 49— 
Monkey from Borneo. 1880, 49— 
Phaenorhina goliath. 1880, 105—Large 
wooden fish hook used by natives of 
Fiji. 1880, 184—Antechinus fuiiginosus 
with young. 1880, 192—EHgg of Para- 
disea raggiana. 1884, 681—Ibacus 
antarcticus from Newcastle. 1884, 865 
—Rare Australian beetles. 1884, 946— 
Native swords and club. 1885, 76— 
Xenica kershawi and Heteronympha 
digglesi. 1885, 187—Ornithoptera 
brookeana. 1885, 342—Moths from the 
eaterpillars feeding on Coccus. 1885, 
853—Chick with four legs. 1886, 127— 
Hive of bees destroyed by Achraea 
grisella. 1886, 164—Seed vessel of 
Trapa bicornis. 1886, 164—Land shells 
from Cairns. 1886, 477—Collection of 
insects from Cairns. 1886, 578— 
Phyllurus inermis. 1886, 853—Papilio 
androgeus. 1886, 853—Nyctalemon 
orontes from Cairns. 1886, 882—Heges 
of painted snipe. 1886, 882—Butter- 
flies from Cairns. 1886, 1062—Cole- 
optera from Port Douglas. 1886, 1123 
—Nest of Dicaewm hirundinaceum. 
1886, 1123—Ornithoptera victoriae from 
Solomon Islands. 1886, 1207—Collec- 
tion of entomogenous fungi with an 
explanatory note. 1887, 109—Common 
opossum (Phalangista vulpina) and 
other species. 1887, 142—Living speci- 
men of Cyclodus nigro-luteus from Mt. 
Wilson. 1887, 174—(For Mr. PrRINcE) 
Undescribed Pielus from Lawson. 1887, 
415—Platycercus eximius and IB 
pennantii, and a hybrid. 1887, 450— 
Insects from Derby. 1887, 557—Species 
of Hoplocephalus in Macleay Museum. 
1887, 978—Mammals from Derby. 1887, 
981—Danais petilia and D. chrysippus 
with a note. 1887, 1076—Collection of 
Coleoptera from Blackheath. 1895, 341 
—Collection of Coleoptera from West- 
ern Australia, 1895, 409. 


MatruHrew, G. F. Two species of Papilio 
at various stages. 1884, 946—Lepidop- 
terous insects from New Guinea. 1884, 
1206. 

May, T. H. See under HeEptry, C. 

McALPINE, OD. New species of rust, 
Puccinia loranthicola. 1905, 577. 

McCoory, —. Two notes on the burrow- 
ing habits of Chelodina longicollis. 
1887, 109—See also under STEPHENS, 
No de 

McCuttocu, A. R. Fishes, remarkable or 
unrecorded, from West Australia and 
Victoria. 1910, 307—from the Great 
Barrier Reef. 1910, 431—Port Darwin 
and West Australia. 1910, 688— 
Lantern-slides illustrating the experi- 
ences of a Naturalist during a visit to 
the New Hebrides. 1910, 887—Fishes, 
rare or unrecorded, from Manilla and 
Clifton, N.S.W., and a drawing of an 
overlooked Port Jackson fish (Schuwet- 
tea scalaripinnis Steindachner). 1911, 
82—Fishes, rare or unrecorded, from 
Murray Island. 1911, 305, 347, 423, 606 
—Fishes, rare or unrecorded, from 
Dunk and Masthead Islands. 1911, 606 
—Land-crab from Murray Island. 1912, 
136—Water Rat killed in the Botanic 
Gardens. 1912, 493—Freshwater turtle 
taken in salt water. 1913, 110—Draw- 
ings of fishes on special paper. 1913, 
396—A new publication, “The -Aus- 
tralian Zoologist”; an interesting fish, 
Jordanidia. 1914, 324—Lantern-slides 
of the Mangrove-fauna. 1916, 493— 
Collection of fishes. 1920, 203—Young 
Frost Fish, Lepidopus caudatus. 1921, 
238—See also under HepieEy, C. 

McDonnovuenH, T. Large fruits of Hndi- 
andra. 1910, 136. 


McManon, P. Section of pine log with 
stone embedded. 1881, 408—Rock 
erystal. 1884, 443—Fossil wood and 
also wood resembling cedar. 1884, 865 
—Micaceous sandstone from North 
Shore. 1885, 448. 

Meyrick, H. Potato-destroying moth. 
US'79, WG, 

Miskin, W. H. Note on Danais chry- 
sippus and D. petilia. 1889, 119—Note 
on Danais petilia. 1890, 142. 

MitcHett, J. Silurian fossils from Bow- 
ning. 1884, 1205—Silurian fossils 
from Bowning. 1886, 577—Fossil mar- 
supial teeth and bones. 1886, 577— 
Remarks referring to fossils from 
Bowning previously exhibited by him. 
1886, 1059—Note on Acidaspis. 1887, 
196—Fossils from Bowning, with notes. 
1887, 412—Remarkable concretion from 
near Bungonia. 1887, 1077—Photo- 
graphs of Trilobites from Bowning. 
1887, 1077—New species of Acidaspis. 


92 INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


1888, 150—Species of graptolites from 
Bowning beds. 1888, 150—Note record- 
ing occurrence of new Entomostraca in 
Bowning shales. 1890, 656—Note on 
fossils and remarks on correlation of 
beds in Newcastle and Illawarra dis- 


tricts. 1892, 345—Fossil plants from 
Glenlee and Bellambi. 1892, 405— 
Species of Hstheria trom Glenlee. 1892, 


405—Note on discovery of bone deposit 
near Kentucky Railway Station. 1893, 
127—Note on Hstheria in Upper Coal 
Measures of N.S.W. 18938, 239—Note on 
Lepidodendroid fossils from Stockyard 
Mt. 1893, 487—Occurrence of Ptero- 
phyllum near Campbelltown. 1893, 438— 
Note on aboriginal kitchen-midden at 
Bellambi. 1893, 536—Fossil insects 
and plants from Wianamatta Series 
near Narellan. 1895, 410—Glossopteris 
from near Lambton. 1895, 519—Fossil 
Lycopod from South Bulli. 1895, 519 
—Prints of leaves on sensitised paper. 
1897, 292—Announcement of discovery 
of fossil insect wing at Newcastle. 
1898, 437—Some rare fossil shells from 
N.S.W. 1906, 262—Fossil Hstheria with 


notes. 1909, 411—Palaeoniscid fish 
from the Newcastle Coal-Measures. 
1914, 324—Silurian and Devonian 
brachiopods from N.S.W. 1920, 473— 
Fossil insect wing. 1924, xxix— 
Hurydesma cordatum var. sacculum. 
1925, xlvi—Fossil fish. 1925, xlvi— 


Pebbles showing kernel, faulting, fold- 
ing, glacial striae, ete. 1925, xlii— 
Timber showing aboriginal toe-hold. 
1925, xlii—Valve of pelecypod (?). 1925, 
xlvi— Wing of fossil scorpion fly. 1925, 
xlvi. 


Mso6perc, E. Zoological specimens from 


North Queensland. 1913, 606. 
Mort, H. S. Unusually large emu egg. 
1899, 631—Cerithiuwm dubium and 


Typhis philippensis from Port Jackson. 
1902, 343—Hulima articulata and Pendi- 
cularia stylasteris from Long Bay. 
1903, 312—Dimya corrugata from Long 
Bay. 19038, 564—Vivipara stelomphora 
var. malleata from Japan. 1906, 674. 


Morton, A. Birds from Solomon Islands. 
1882, 65—(For Mr. Ramsay) New 
species of Solea and Coris. 1882, 212 
—(For Mr. Ramsay) Aboriginal toma- 
hawk, knives, spear head, and brushes. 
1882, 212—(For. Mr. Ramsay) Speci- 
mens of Pinna from Rarotonga. 1882, 
212—Native implements, etc., from 
New Guinea. 1883, 180—Native 
weapons, etc. 1883, 464—Native crna- 
ments from Solomon Group. 1883, 534. 

MosELEY, —.. See under Musson, C. T. 

MUELLER, Baron F. von. Note on ortho- 
graphy of name Linnaeus. 1883, 532— 


Hypoestes moschata from North Aus- 
tralia. 1891, 578—Attention called to 
restoration of genus Osteocarpum and 
merging of Babbagio as subgenus. 
1891, 682—List of mosses collected at 
Tamworth. 1894, 361—Notes on 
Boronia floribunda. 1896, 5083—See also 
under FLercHEer, J. J.; Mammen, J. H. 


MuscrRaAvE, A. Slides of Lord Howe 
Island. 1924, xxvii. : 


Musson, C. T. Note on Top-knot pigeon 
(Lopholaimus antarctica). 1889, 388— 
Note on Coleopterous insect carrying 
land snail. 1889, 388—Note on effect 
of eating pigeons which have fed on 
seeds of Huphorbia. 1889, 389—General 
zoological collection from Narrabri and 
Tamworth. 1890, 898—Permo-Carbon- 
iferous fossils from Narrabri and Tam- 
worth. 1890, 898—Specimens of Cysto- 
pelta from Ballarat. 1890, 898— 
Locusts (Pachytylus australis) from 
Inverell. 1890, 898—Pieris teutonia. 
1890, 898—(For Mr. Mosrtny) Freckled 
duck (Stietonetta naevosa). 1891, 8— 
New Zealand mosses. 1891, 44—New 
Zealand land and freshwater Mollusea. 
1891, 125—Huropean slug (Arion hor- . 


tensis) introduced from New Zealand. 
1893, 181—Peculiar slug (Cystopelta 
petterdi) from Kurrajong. 1893, 181— 


Note on trimorphie character of An- 
guillaria dioica. 1897, 578—Woody galls 
on Casuarina from Richmond. 1899, 
194—Indigenous grasses affected with 
parasitic fungi from Richmond. 1899, 
194—Flowering stalks of Acacia 
Baileyana. 1900, 762—Garden plants 
exhibiting prolification, from  Rich- 
mond.. 1902, 30—Host plants of species 
of Loranthus in Richmond district. 
1905, 489—Specimen from Coolabah 
showing Loranthus exocarpi on dif- 
ferent hosts. 1905, 490—Two forms 
of common  Black-thorn (Bursaria 
spinosa). 1907, 630—Loranthus lino- 
phyllus on two unusual hosts. 1908, 
434—See also under FretrcHer, J. J. 


Musson, C. T., and W. M. Carne. A 
rare phyllopod crustacean from Rich- 


mond, N.S.W. 1911, 159—An endo- 
phytic green alga in the root of 
Macrozamia. 1914, 326. 

IMtoSsom, ©, Ith, aingl di, di,  IMeomcssioim, 


Lantern-illustrations of modification of 
plant-growth due to parasites. 1915, 
xx— Plants collected near the boundary 
between the Counties of Cumberland 
and Cook. 1915, 489. 


Ner~tt, W. Small fishes (Galazias sp.), 
taken from bales of wool. 1889, 633. 
NicHotson, A. J. Photographs showing 
wasp-like attitudes assumed by Mic- 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 93 


rodon sp. 1925, xliv—Specimen of 
Humenid. 1925, xlv. 


Nortu, A. J. Eggs of birds. 1887, 412, 


1077—Series of birds’ eggs from 
Nepean, Philip and Norfolk Islands. 
1888, 402—Heggs of three species of 
Menura and six Bower Birds. 1888, 
1258—Note on breeding of Gouldian 
finches. 1889, 188—Attention drawn to 
number of Australian finches in Sydney 
Market. 1889, 1029—Note on hatching 
of emu egg. 1889, 1029—Skins, nest 
and eggs of birds. 1889, 1297—(For 
Mr. K. H. Bennett) EHggs of glossy 
Ibis (fl. falcinellus). 1890, 142— 
Platycercus pennantii from Norfolk 
Island. 1893, 238—Graucalus melanops 
and Ardea novae-hollandiae from Nor- 
folk Island. 1893, 238—Hges of species 
of cuckoos. 1893, 327—Egegs of Colly- 
riocincla harmonica and Cacomantis 
pallida, with a note. 18938, 4386— 
Clutches of eggs each containing egg 
of a cuckoo. 1894, 43—Attention drawn 
to rare birds in George Street Markets. 
1894, 43—Egegs of New Holland honey- 
eater (Meliornis novae-hollandiae) . 
1894, 186—Male and female of common 
shoveller (Spatula clypeata) and of 
long-tailed cuckoo (Urodynamis_tait- 
ensis), with a note. 1894, 584—Head, 
crop and gizzard of Wonga Wonga 
pigeon. 1894, 585—Series of specimens 
of Zosterops caerulescens. 1895, 472— 
Set of eggs of Turnix leucogaster from 
Central Australia. 1895, 519—Attention 
called to numerous dead specimens of 
mutton birds on beaches near Sydney. 
1895, 550—Types of new birds from 
Central Australia obtained by the 
Horn Expedition. 1896, 88—Heggs 
of Menura victoriae and Geronticus 
spinicollis. 1886, 1061—Remarks on the 
progress in Papuan ornithology. 1897, 
444—Skin of freckled duck. 1897, 444 
—Egegs of black-shouldered kite. 1897, 
445—Young black-fronted dotterel from 
Cook’s River. 1897, 577—-Nest of black- 
capped honeyeater from Belmore. 1897, 
577—Rare white-vented wood swallow, 
with nests and eggs. 1897, 686—Speci- 
mens from bower of spotted Bower- 
bird. 1897, 687—Eggs of pied honey- 
eater. 1897, 687—Attention called to 
presence of Platycercus browni from 
Darwin in Sydney bird shops. 1898, 
408—Skin of fledgling fan-tailed cuckoo 
caught at Chatswood. 1898, 647—-Type 
of Hremiornis carteri from North-west 
Australia. 1900, 610—Type of Platy- 
cercus macgillivrayi from North Queens- 
land. 1900, 610—Heegs of five species 
of Cockatoo. 1900, 610—Note on 
Motacilla cyanea. 1901, 632—Attention 


drawn to abundance of species of 
cuckoo near Sydney. 1901, 632— 


Report of migratory species of birds. 


breeding at Roseville. 1901, 739—Note 
of eggs of cuckoos, taken from nests of 
other species. 1901, 739—Record of 
Monarcha gouldi and Donacicola cas- 
taneothoraxz at Ourimbah. 1901, 739— 
Hopsaltria pulverulenta and #H. gularis 
from N. W. Australia, with notes. 
1902, 74—Skins and eggs of Sisura 
nana and Rhipidura dryas. 1902, 207 
—Note on grass finches from North 
and North-western Australia, 1902, 207 
—Chlamydodera maculata and Phile- 
mon citriogularis. 1902, 237—Nest, 
eggs and skin of Buff-sided Robin 
(Poecilodryas cerviniventris). 1902, 
343—Skins, nests and eggs of Acanthiza 
ewingi and Acanthornis magna from 
Tasmania. 1904, 58—Specimen . of 
Munia flaviprymna. 1904, 130—Grass 
finch (Poephila aurantiirostris) from 
Northern Territory. 1905, 101—Adult 
female (Cuculus intermedius). 1905, 
260—Adult male (Ptilotis plumuia). 
1905, 260—Hees of some honeyeaters 
and cuckoos. 1905, 260—Skin and eggs 
of Melithreptus albigularis. 1905, 395 
—Record of albatross at Lavender Bay. 
1905, 395—Note on nesting sites of rock 
warbler. 1905, 396—Specimen of 
Motacilla from Dawson River, Q. 1905, 
o78—Skin of adult male of Cracticus 
leucopterus. 1906, 429—Attention 
called to early breeding of several 
species of birds around Sydney. 1906, 
430—Hegs of plumed egret (Jfesophoyxr 
plumifera). 1907, 629—Bird protection 
and bird destruction in N.S.W. 1908, 
630—Hegegs of great bower bird showing 
variations in colour and markings. 
1908, 636—Hybrid adult male, Artamus 
superciliosus x A. personatus. 1908, 
735—Nest and eggs of Newton’s bower 
bird and tooth-billed bower bird, to- 
gether with skins. 1908, 799—Skins 
of yellow-collared parrakeet and For- 
ster’s shearwater. 1909, 418—Birds: 
Stone Runner from Leigh’s Creek. 
1911, 44—Petrels from Lord Howe and 
South Solitary Islands. 1911, 84—A 
small race of the Laughing Jackass 
from the Jardine River. 1911, 159— 
Plumed MBronze-wing Pigeons from 
various localities, and a Fan-tailed 
Cuckoo from Lord Howe Island. 1911, 
305—Birds and eggs from Fanning 
Island. 1913, 171, 660—Skin and eggs 
of the Antarctic and  Silvery-grey 
Petrels. 1913, 255—Black-banded Fruit- 
Pigeon from the Northern Territory. 
1913, 398—Skins of Yellow-breasted 
Robin and Superb Warbler, exemplify- 


94 


(Oyenitiny, di, 1D) 


ing climatic and individual variation. 
1913, 607—Eges of sea-birds, collected 
by the Australasian Antarctic Ex- 
pedition, 1911-14. 1915, 291—Type-sets 
of Australian birds’ eggs, and Cuckoo 
type-sets. 1915, 420, 421—Skin of 
Extinct Phillip Island Parrot, and a 
New Zealand Parrot; remarks on prob- 


able extinction of the Chestnut- 
shouldered Grass-Parrakeet. 1915, 488 
—White Nutmeg or Torres Strait 


Pigeon. 1916, 103—Australian Finches. 
1916, 195—Regent Bower-bird. 1916, 219 
—Superb Fruit Pigeon. 1916, 493—See 
also under Ocinpy, J. D. 


Norton, J. Fungoid growth from Christ- 


mas Tree. 1881, 170. Cones of Bunya 
tree. 1881, 729—Nest of Origma rubri- 
cata. 1883, 443—Tasmanite from 
Tamar River. 1884, 178—Sandstone 
perforated by Hymenopterous insect. 
1884, 681—Cones of Araucaria Cooki. 
1884, 1169—Weeping Hucalyptus with 
rose-coloured flowers. 1885, 554— 
Fossils from Black Head. 1886, 476 
—Porphyritic rock from Shoalhaven. 
1886, 476—Flowering specimens of 
Cassia Brewsteri, Hernandia bivalvis 
and Kreysigia multiflora. 1886, 1122— 
Acrophyllum venosum in flower and 
seed. 1886, 1207—Seeds of Acacia 
oxycedrus. 1886, 1207—Styphelia from 
Faulconbridge. 1886, 1207—A fungus, 
Hydnum imbricatum. 1886, 1207— 
Stemonitis fusca or ferruginea from 
Springwood. 1887, 174—Pieces of wood 
carved by black Cockatoo and by white 
ants. 1887, 412—Fungus growing on 
Syncarpia. 1887, 621—Flowering speci- 
mens of bamboo. 1887, 621—Larva of 
Melolontha infested with fungus. 1890, 
140—Remarks on letter concerning 
Pavonia hastata growing in Hyde Park. 
1890, 267—Nuts of Helicia Whelani. 
1890, 898—Root of Stenocarpus Cun- 
ninghamii with fibrous rootlets. 1892, 
328—Remarks on horse’s antipathy to 
smell of fish. 1892, 328—Note record- 
ing spider attacking ants. 1896, 819— 
Western Australian plants. 1897, 577 
—Sydney bush rat from Double Bay. 
1899, 286—Remarks on black Cock- 
atoos ringbarking Hucalypts. 1899, 286 
—Sandstone partly covered with an 
organic structure. 1900, 116—-Prolifica- 
tion of inflorescence of Nicotiana sp. 
1902, 74—See also under STEPHENS, 
Wis Je 


New Species of Platy- 
cephalus. 1885, 189—New genus of 
Blenny. 1885, 248—Branchiostoma 
bassanum. 1885, 695—Ooris rex. 1885, 
858—Specimens of Hemipimalodus 


OLIvER, W. R. B. 


Oxriirr, A. S. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


dayi. 1886, 127—Tongue of Lates cal- 
carifer partially covered with teeth. 
1886, 853—Monacanthus Maculosus. 
1886, 975—Parasitic HEntomostracon 
from the Mackerel. 1886, 975—New 
species of Apogon. 1886, 1061— 
—Coloured drawing of Girella cyanea. 
1887, 109—Rare toad, Notaden ben- 
nettii, from Cobar. 1887, 174—Brachyu- 
ropis australis from unknown locality. 
1887, 174—Solenognathus spinosissimus 


and Macquaria australasica. 1887, 196 
—Hoplocephalus  ornatus (?) and 
Pseudechis australis. 1887, 1078— 


Snake from South Solitary Island. 
1888, 337—Rare fish (Anthias cichlops) 
from Lord Howe Island. 1888, 741— 
(For Mr. NorruH) Eggs of Aplonis 
fuscus from Lord Howe Island. 1888, 
890. Note on cause of death in fishes. 
1888, 890—Deep sea fish (Chloreph- 
thalmus nigripinnis). 1888, 1096— 
Photograph of Acanthias blainvillii 
and Acanthoclinus  littoreus. 1888, 
1096—Larval form of Trachypterus. 
1888, 1258—Apogon guntheri with 
mouth crammed with ova. 1888, 1559 
—Ambassis from Parramatta River. 
1888, 1559—South Australian snake 
(Vermicella bertholdii). 1888, 1559— 
Anomalops palpebratus. 1889, 312— 
Living specimen of Phrynosoma from , 
United States. 1889, 632—Species of 
Calotes from New Guinea. 1889, 632— 
Jaws of species of Myliobatis. 1889, 632 
—Lygosoma casuarinae from Went- 
worth Falls. 1889, 1028—Young Hop- 
locephalus ornatus. 1889, 1028—Fish 
(Holocanthus tibicen) from Lord Howe 
Island. 1889, 1028—Two snakes from 
New Guinea (Brachysoma triste and 
Acanthophis sp.). 1890, 413—Note 
that there are two genera of rough- 
backed Herrings in Australian waters. 
1896, 504—Specimens of two small 
Clupeids. 1896, 584—(For Dr. Cox) 
Small sole from freshwater, Richmond 
River. 1896, 817—Young conger in 
Helmictus stage. 1897, 253—Type of 
Aethoprora perspicillata from Lord 
Howe Island. 1898, 76: 

Mollusca from the 
Kermadec Islands. 1913, 605. 


Collection of Coleoptera 
from Hcuador. 1885, 342—Cryptom- 
matus jansoni. 1885, 449—Specimens 
of Tettix australis. 1886, 163—Male 
and female of Halobates wullerstoff. 
1886, 1683—Pulex echidnae. 1887, 109 
—Alectoria superba from Mossgiel. 
1887, 250—Insects from Norfolk Island. 
1887, 412—Hpidesmia tricolor, a rare 
moth from Double Bay. 1887, 452— 
Peripatus from Cassilis, with a note. 


OSBORNE, G. D. 


PaLMeER, EH. G. W. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 95 


1887, 981—Note on abundance of 
Belostoma indicum. 1888, 150— 
Schizorrhina emilea from Cairns. 1888, 
401—Palaeotoma styphelana. 1888, 424 
—Coccus gall probably new. 1888, 425 
—Nest of social caterpillar. 1888, 741 
—Harthen cocoons of Cephalodesmius 
armiger. 1888, 1507—Phyllodes mey- 
ricki. 1888, 1780—Zopherosis georgii 
from Mt. Wilson. 1889, 120—(For 
Mr. C. S. Wiztkinson) Wasps (Polistes 
sp.). 1889, 598—Collection of insects 
from Mt. Kosciusko. 1889, 598—Collec- 
tion of Diptera from Mt. Kosciusko. 
1889, 598—Male Pielus imperidlis. 
1889, 654—Attention drawn to abund- 
ance of large Noctuid moth. 1889, 
1052—Three specimens of Atyphella 
lychmus. 1889, 1297—Epicrocis tere- 
brans from Gosford. 1890, 140—New 
species of Adela from Kangaroo Mt. 
1890, 140—Species of Synemon from 


Benalla, Victoria. 1890, 140—Scale 
insects from introduced Australian 
trees in Natal. 1890, 243—Supple- 


mentary index to Whymper’s “Travels 
amongst the Great Andes’. 1890, 267— 
Cottony-cushion or fluted scale (Icerya 


purchasi). 1891, 126—Larvae and in- 
sects of Vedalia cardinalis. 1891, 126 
—Remarks on Vedalia cardinalis 
collected at Mosman’s Bay. 1891, 166 


Larvae and females of Phylloxera 
vastatrixz. 1891, 166—Fly bred from 
larvae feeding on rust. 1891, 249— 
Dipteron parasitic on plague locust. 
1891, 249—Photographs of native gods 
at Banks Is., New Hebrides. 1892, 345 
—Collection of Brachyscelid galls. 1892, 
373—Large ear-wig (Anisolabris colos- 
sea) from Richmond and Tweed 
Rivers. 1892, 380—Sugar-cane weevil 
(Sphenophorus obscurus) from Nor- 
thern Queensland. 1893, 327—Parasitic 
fly from adult beetles (Monolepta 
rosea). 18938, 328—Species of Psylla 
from Jarrahdale, W.A. 1894, 740. 

Zygopterid stem from 
Kuttung Series in N.S.W. 1925, xl. 


OwEN, R. Letter from, containing observ- 


ations on fossil marsupials and on the 
generation of Monotremes. 1885, 125. 


Plants from Lord 
Howe’s Island: 1880, 49—Fungi col- 
lected at Burwood. 1880, 192— Abor- 
iginal stone axe head. 1880, 286— 
Aboriginal weapons and implements 
from Broad Sound. 1881, 170— 
Potatoes and potato moth. 1881, 170 
—Chinese pear with fruits from both 
autumn and spring flowering. 1881, 
170—Photographs of blacks. 1881, 197 
—Aboriginal skull. 1881, 626—Plants 


affected by a fungoid and insect pests. 
1885, 189—Two Bombycid moths. 1885, 
248—Coccinella species and Anoplog- 
nathus inustus. 1885, 695—Stone axes. 
1885, 696—Mylitta sp. from Burwood. 
1886, 505—Seed vessels of Martynia 
proboscidea. 1886, 505—Silk egg-bags 
made by spider. 1887, 174—Specimens 
of spider which made egg-bags pre- 
viously exhibited. 1887, 251—Abor- 
iginal letter sticks. 1887, 621—Carbon- 
iferous fossil from Connor’s Range, Q. 
1887, 982—Aboriginal weapons from 
Port Mackay, Q. 1887, 982—Young fish 
from Burwood. 1888, 401—Viviparous | 
lizard (Lygosoma casuarinae). 1888, 
40i1—Stone axe from Campbelltown. 
1888, 401—Native ornaments and manu- 
factures from Queensland. 1888, 423— 
Fossil shells from near St. Lawrence. 
1888, 423—Wasp’s nest. 1888, 423— 
Note on sympathy and foster parentage 
among birds. 1888, 740—Roots of 
apple tree infested with American 
blight. 1890, 296—Loranthus parasitic 
on pear tree. 1890, 510—Cultivated 
Hugenia infested with Homopterous 
insects. 1890, 510—Living insect larvae. 
1890, 680—Coccinellid and Galerucid in- 
festing Cucurbitaceae and Solanaceae. 
1890, 680—Snake (Hoplocephalus 
nigrescens) and lizard (Tiliqua gigas) 
from the Blue Mts. 1892, 20—Abor- 
iginal stone axe from Lawson. 1892, 
277—Galls on Acacia decurrens and on 
a Hucalypt. 1892, 404—Fossils from 
Mt. Wellington, Tasmania. 1892, 404— 
Specimen illustrating root grafting. 
1897, 686—Galls of Brachyscelis duplex. 
1897, 686—Aboriginal sacred _ stone. 
1897, 686—Living Hchidna from Lawson. 
1898, 107—Spider (Celaenia excavata) 
with egg-bags. 1898, 107—Abnormal 
specimens of maize. 1898, 107— 
Branches of Ulnus ringbarked by longi- 
corn larvae. 1898, 173—Undetermined 
fungus growing round EHEucalypt roots. 
1898, 173—Living Gecko and large 
snake from Blue Mts. 1898, 437—Two 
species of Xerotes, eaten down by stock. 
1898, 4837—Curiously carved boomerangs 
from Queensland. 1899, 192—Abnormal 
flowering and fruiting specimens of 
Cosmos and Zea. 1899, 192—An un- 
determined fungus. 1899, 192—Coccus 
(Pulvinaria tecta). 1899, 192—Chips 
torn from Eucalypt trunk by black 
Cockatoos. 1899, 286—Aboriginal skin- 
ning knives. 1899, 477—Seedling apple 
tree with woolly aphis on roots. 1899, 
477—Underground fungus (Mylitta 
australis). 1899, 477—Spider (Amau- 
robius). 1899, 477—Bunch of dates 
from palm growing in Bourke Street. 


96 


1899, 631—Gall of Brachyscelis duplex. 
1899, 631—Note on being bitten by 
black snake. 1900, 61—Cast skin of 
snake. 1900, 115—Hydatids in black- 
tailed wallaby. 1900, 321—Remarkable 
stone axe from Lawson. 1900, 543— 
Aboriginal grinding stone and stone 
knives from Lawson. 1900, 612—Abor- 
iginal stone axe from Lawson. 1900, 
698—Spider (Theridion bicolor). 1900, 
698—Huecalypt sapling stem eaten by 
borers. 1900, 762—Aboriginal scarf 
and head dresses. 1900, 762—Peculiar 
vine from Lawson. 1901, 515—Atten- 
tion drawn to report of shower of small 
fish. 1901, 515—Mineral specimens 
from Gladstone. 1903, 313—Aboriginal 
stone axe from Helidon, @. 1904, 253 
—Statement re laying of chestnut-eared 
finches in his aviary. 1904, 805—Par- 
ticulars of breeding habits of chestnut- 
eared finch. 1905, 352—-Young speci- 
mens of Ceratodus forsteri. 1906, 60— 
Shoots of peach tree affected by Micro- 
lepidoptera. 1906, 60—Examples of 
aboriginal chipping from North-west 
Australia. 1908, 434—F lowers of 
Crotalaria Ouwnninghamii. 1908, 434— 
Coccid galls and Coleoptera from Law- 
son. 1908, 434—See also under 
Macrtesy, W.; RAInBow, W. J.; RAMSAY, 
H. P. 


Parkes, Miss. See under HEDLEY, C. 
Preptey, P. R. Hmbryo of Hippocampus. 


1881, 626—Copper minerals from Mount 
Hope and Great Central Copper Mines. 
1883, 180—Copper' grass (possibly 
Xerotes) from Cobar. 1883, 386— 
Centriscus gracilis. 1884, 119—Fungus 
on leaves of peach trees. 1885, 126— 
Two Australian aboriginal skulls. 1886, 
577—Saw of Pristis zysron. 1892, 277 
—Aboriginal weapons from north-west 
of N.S.W. 1894, 466—Aboriginal shield 
from Narran River. 1895, 472—Living 
specimen of Moloch horridus from W.A. 
1896, 88. 


Prerriz, J. M. Samples of kerosene shale and 


oil therefrom. 1904, 872—Preparations 
of stinging hairs of giant nettle tree. 
1906, 426—Remarks on strychnine in 
bark and wood of species of Strychnos. 
1906, 497—Announcement of identifica- 
tion of new alkaloid in Solandra laevis. 
1906, 673—(For Dr. H. G. CHAPMAN) 
A marine algal ball from Balmoral 
Beach. 1911, 425—Demonstration | of 
Guignard’s new method of detecting 
hydrocyanic acid compounds in plants. 
1911, 635—An African plant (Acokan- 
thera), the milky juice of which affects 
a photographic plate. 1914, 88—See 
also under CHAPMAN, H. G., and J. 
M. PETRIE. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


Perrin, J. M., and H. G. CHapman, Photo- 
graphic plate exposed to emanation of 
dried juice of Huphorbia peplus. 1909, 
500. 

PrTrEerD, W. F. See under Hepiey, C. 


PuHituies, C. Address on rabbit exterm- 
ination. 1901, 146—Remarks on rabbit 
extermination in New Zealand. 1906, 
677. 

PincHEr, G. L. See under FLeTcHER, J. J. 

Pittman, H. F. See under Davin, T. W. 
H., R. Herms and H. F. PrrrM an. 

PRINCE, H. Argonauta nodosa and 
Cypraea aurantia. 1885, 448—Number 
of Volutes. 1885, 853—Collection of 
weod moths. 1887, 681—See also under 
MAstTERrS, G. , 


Rarnpow, W. J. New spider from Bun- 
gendore. 1892, 201—Undescribed spider 
(Nephila sp.). 1892, 328—Undescribed 
spider (Arcyina sp.) from Manly. 1892, 
405—Undetermined spider from Water- 
fall and Clarence River. 1893, 218— 
Living trap door spiders (Idiops sp.). 
1894, 362—Spider (Celaeria excavata) 
and its egg-bags. 1896, 88—Silver 
wattle (Acacia dealbata) with Hymen- 
opterous galls. 1896, 382—Spider 
(Actinopus formosus) from near Gren- 
fell. 1897, 253—Note on Argyrodes 
antipodiana. 1898, 172-—-Two_ spiders 
(Ariamnes flagellum and Leptorchestes 
striatipes). 1898, 652—(For Mr. H. G. 
W. PatmerR) Living spider (Lycosa 
godeffroyi). 1899, 1385—Silk spun by 
spiders of genus Nephala. 1899, 283— 
Living specimen of spider (Dicrostichus 
magnificus). 1899, 549—Spider (Desis 
marina) from Port Jackson. 1901, 539 
—Aquatic spider, Dolomedes facetus, 
from Duck Creek. 1909, 274—Arach- 
nida from Solomon Islands. 1909, 589 
—See also under HEDLEY, C.; KESTEVEN, 
Jel, It 

Ramsay, EH. P. Notes on Hntomostracous 
Crustacean (Lepidurus viridis). 1875- 

_ 76, 32—Specimens of parrots (Lorius 
chlorocercus, Donvicella cardinalis, 
Nasiterna pusio) from New Britain and 
adjacent islands. 1875-76, 67—Skin of 
supposed new species of Poephila from 
near Rockingham Bay. 1875-76, 197— 
Male and female specimens of Zylo- 
psyche staceyi from near Newcastle. 
1875-76, 199—Skins of birds from Auck- 
land Islands, ete. 1877, 19—New and 
rare fish from Port Jackson. 1877, 54 
—New species of Huryscaphus. 1877, 
73—Burrowing frog. 1877, 73—Species 
of Antennarius. 1877, 73—Poephila 
mirabilis. 1877, 73—Death adder (Acan- 
thophis praelongus). 1877, 73—Speci- 
mens of Poephila and of Brachysoma 


INDEX 10 EXHIBITS. 97 


triste. 1877, 122—Rare species of birds. 
1877, 377—Two species of pigeon from 
Fiji. 1878, 6—Crotons and specimens 
of Coleus, Euphorbia and Aralia filici- 
folia from Duke of York Island. 1878, 
6—Osteoglossum leichhardtii from the 
Dawson River. 1878, 11—Specimens of 
Anas gibberifrons. 1878, 40—Birds 
from New Guinea. 1878, 76—Four 
species of rifle birds. 1878, 340— 
Perameles broadbentii from Port 
Moresby and white ants (Termes) from 
near Sydney. 1878, 406—New birds 
from New Guinea. 1879, 107—Photo- 
graphs of natives of Port Darwin and 
Port Hssington. 1879, 292—New species 
of Sphaeria. 1879, 292—New species of 
Lepidurus from Hunter River. 1579, 
387—Fossil fish (Ctenodon ctenodus?). 
1879, 3887—Series of new and rare 
birds. 1879, 471—Note on Malurus 
leuconotus. 1880, 191—Note on egg of 
Eclectus polychlyrus. 1880, 191—Tooth 
of marsupial allied to Diprotodon. 
1880, 495—Specimens of Fierasfer and 
of Syngnathidae and EHleotris. 1880, 
495—Birds from Solomon Islands and 
New Guinea. 1881, 196—New species 
of Lygopus. 1881, 626—Skins of birds 


from the Solomon Islands. 1881, 837 
—Drawings of a new rat. 1882, 65— 
Egg of Victorian Lyre Bird. 1882, 65 


—Drawing of new bat. 1882, 65— 
Sketch of jaw of Thylacoleo. 1882, 65 
—Tertiary leaves and granite from 
Richmond River. 1882, 91—Fishes 
from New Hebrides, Broken Bay and 
Mount Wilson. 1882, 134—Native skull 
from Dawson River. 1882, 134—Collec- 
tion illustrating fauna of Lord Howe’s 
Island. 1882, 206—Native headdress 
from New Guinea. 1882, 206—Fruit of 
small species of coconut from Ugi, 
Solomon Group. 1882, 304—Birds from 
Solomon Islands. 1882, 304—Flint 
nodule from Solomon Islands. 1882, 
330—Seeds of supposed new species of 
Cocos. 1882, 330—EHucaiyptus said to 
be punctured by ovipositor of Cicada. 
1882, 330—Photograph of large Zeus 
australis. 1882,  330—Bracelets cut 
from large shells. 1882, 347—Horned 
lizard from America. 1882, 347—Cole- 
optera from the Dawson River. 1882, 
348—Note on seaweeds from Port Jack- 
son and adjacent coast. 1882, 402— 
Rocks from coal mines between Dubbo 
and Wellington. 1882, 560—Stone im- 
plements from Samoa. 1882, 560— 
Three species of Oligorus, new species 
of Amphisile, three species of Mus, 
shells from Queensland, Dugong oil and 
aboriginal photographs. 1882, 674— 
Birds from Solomon Islands. 1882, 674 
G 


—Native ornaments, etc., from Admir- 
alty Islands. 18838, 35—Collection of 
marine animals illustrating methods 
of mounting, ete. 1884, 254—(For Mr. 
A. CAMPBELL) Pachycephala rufogu- 
laris. 1884, 509—Halcyon diops and 
Coriphilus kuhlii. 1884, 866—Native 
throwing stone. 1884, 1015—(For Mr. 
EK. G. PAtMER) Native bees’ nest. 1884, 
1206—Fossil phalanx of Palaeorchestes 
from Wellington Caves. 1885, 75— 
Devonian fossils from Wellington. 
1885, 75—Rare birds from Queensland 
and New Guinea. 1885, 124—Portion 
of skull of new extinct marsupial. 
1885, 124—Letter from Sir Richard 
Owen. 1885, 125—New birds from New 
Guinea and some rare eggs. 1885, 188 
—New species of Retaster. 1885, 189 
—A new bat from Dawson River. 
1885, 189—Some rare semi-fossil shells 
from Muddy Creek. 1885, 189—New 
Ostracod. . 1885, 247—Fungi from Moss- 
giel. 1885, 247—Dise-shaped native 
club. 1885, 248—Large sea urchin. 
1885, 342—Albino Tui or Parson-bird 
from New Zealand. 1885, 342—Albino 
ground parrot from Warren. 1885, 342— 
Letter from Sir R. Owen re new species 
of Thylacoleo. 1885, 342—Mentura 
victoriae with nest and egg. 1885, 449 
—Boltenia australis. 1885, 553—Fossil 
bones from Wellington Caves. 1885, 
761—Albino bat from Jamaica. 1886, 
127—Seed vessel of Adansonia digitata. 
1886, 505—Photographs of skeleton, 
Megaceros hibernicus. 1886, 853— 
Stone axes. 1886, 853—Rare birds from 
Derby, N. W. Australia. 1886, 881— 
New species of Monacanthus. 1886, 
1059—Notes on eggs of Ptilinorhyncus 
violaceus and Rhynchaea australis. 
1886, 1059—Supposed new species of 
birds from Derby. 1886, 1122—New 
species of Hapalotis. 1886, 1122— 
Matured fruits of Ficus stipulata. 
1886, 1122—Fossil remains of gigantic 
Echidna. 1886, 1122—Remarks on fer- 
tilization of Ficus macrophylla. 1886, 
1122—Higegs of birds illustrating paper 
by Mr. North. 1886, 1207—Kegegs of 
Puffinus  brevicaudis. 1886, 1207— 
Heliz-shaped case of insect from Japan. 
1886, 1207—Collection of rare birds. 
1887, 110—Collection of insects from 
New England. 1887, 141—Ege of top- 
knot pigeon. 1887, 174—Stone hatchets 
of aborigines of Lachlan district. 1887, 
174—F lint flakes used by aborigines of 
Tasmania. 1887, 174—Shale with 
Rhacopteris from Stroud. 1887, 174— 
Aspidiotes ramsayi, Dendrophis  sp., 
and Hoplocephalus from Louth. i887, 
196—Bird of Paradise and Paradi- 


98 INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


sornis rudolphi. 1887, 250—Amblyor- 
nis subalaris and Charmosyna jose- 
phinae from New Guinea. 1887, 250— 


Birds from New Guinea and near 
Sydney. 1887, 451—Dendritic gold 
from Lucknow Mine. 1887, 979— 


Echinaster decanus from Port Jackson. 
1887, 1075—Four species of Phalangista 
from Bellenden Ker. 1887, .1075— 
Birds from Bellenden Ker. 1887, 1075 
—Live specimen of Nardoa gilberti. 
1889, 188—Peripatus from Mt. Kos- 
ciusko. 1889, 632—Three species of 
white Cockatoo. 1889, 632—Skin of 
small Phalanger (Pseudochirus). 1889, 
632—New species of Belideus. 1889, 
1030—New species of Pseudochirus. 
1889, 1030—Dendrolagus lumholtzt 
from North Queensland. 1889, 1052— 
Rare Bird of Paradise from New 
Guinea. 1889, 1052—Bower Bird and 
young. 1889, 1052—Sericornis guwttu- 
ralis and young. 1889, 1052—See also 
under Morton, A.; STEPHENS, W. J. 

RatTE, F. Notes on the Tuena Gold 
Reefs. 18838, 179—Fossils from New 
Caledonia. 1884, 681—Calcareous shells 
of insects. 1884, 682—Devonian fish 
and other fossils. 1885, 123—Drawings 
of Crioceras and Sanguinolites. 1885, 
124—Explanatory note on references to 
figures omitted from his paper on 
Worthenia. 1885, 3483—Gold specimens 
from New Caledonia and Ballarat. 
1886, 1123—Diabase porphyry polished. 
1886, 1123—Kerosene shale showing 
mode of fracture. 1887, 142. 

ReaD, R. B. Particulars in reference to 
aquaria. 1879, 116—Proboscis of 
Macrosilia cluentius. 1879, 398—Note 
on use of Australian coal by foreign 
ships. 1889, 389—Frigate or Boatswain 
Bird from Lord Howe Island. 1889, 
654. 

Ronwu, H. 8S. Serranus cylindricus from 
New Hebrides. 1888, 1316—Carved 
shield probably from Fiji. 1888, 1316 
—Carved wooden club from New 
Zealand. 1888, 1507—Four embryos 
of Crocodilus porosus from Queensland. 


1889, 131—Stem of undetermined 
creeper from Clarence River. 1889, 131 
—Hegyptian mummy hand. 1889, 390 


—Mounted specimens of English plants. 
1889, 598—Jaw of death adder with 
supplementary tooth. 1889, 1297. 
Rost, J. H. See under Frercuer, J. J. 
RossitTER, R. C. See under Brazinr, J. 
RorHery, F. M. Contribution to discus- 
sion on welfare of indigenous fauna 
and flora. 1908, 631. 
RorTHscHiLp, N. C. Letter from (as rep- 
resentative of the Society for the Pro- 
motion of Nature-Reserves) calling 


attention to the aims and objects of 
the Society. 1914, 157. 


Sacu, A. J. See under Maipen, J. H. 

SCHUETTE, —. Plaster cast of vertebrate 
fossil. 18838, 298. 

SECRETARY, the. Photograph of Aus- 
tralian native from near the Balonne. 
1877, 217—Gall from an Acacia. 1880, 
300—Nidus of large spider. 1880, 300. 


SELKIRK, H. Fossil shells from Harpur’s 
Hill. 1881, 789—Fossil leaf from Bega. 
1881, 790—Tibia of Diprotodon. 1881, 
790—Dried ferns of New South Wales. 
1881, 790—Stone axe from Kurrajong. 
1882, 134. 

Srnciair, S. Watch found in stomach of 
shark. 1888, 739—Diamond drill cores 
from New York. 1888, 894—Native 
dresses, weapons and implements from 
Hrromanga. 1894, 708. 

Sxussg, F. A. A. Diptera from Berowra. 
1887, 978—Pupa and imago of Ortho- 
prosopa nigra. 1888, 423—Tineid bred 


from seed capsules of Phyllanthus. 
1889, 131—Minute Hymenopterous 
parasite. 1889, 131—Grass kept dry 
twelve months and still containing 


living larva, Lasioptera vastatriz. 1889, 
189—Tineid bred from staghorn fern. 
1889, 312—Plant from Samoa. 1889, 
312—Brachyscelis duplex from Blue 
Mountains. 1889, 3812—Drawing of 
imago and wing of Dipterous fly, phos- 
phorescent in iarval condition. 1889, 
312—New species of Cecidomyia with 
galls and insects bred from them. 
1889, 654—Minute Dipterous fly (Phyto- 


myza). 1889, 1030—Adults and pupa- 
eases of Tachina sp. 1889, 1052— 
Specimens of Icerya purchasi. 1889, 
1052—Galls of Cecidomyidae. 1889, 
1052—Specimens of Diptera. 1889, 
1100—Semnotes imperatoria and S. 
ducalis from near Sydney. 1890, 11— 


Leptotarsus sp., from Blue Mountains. 
1890, 11—Specimens of plant bug 
(Family Capsidae) from vineyards and 
orchards in N.S.W. and Victoria. 1890, 
141—Diptera from Dunoon. 1890, 267 
—Hristalis tenax and Gastrophilus equi 
from New Zealand. 1890, 268—Gall of 


Brachyscelis munita on Eucalyptus 
robusta. 1890, 268—Specimens of 
Mylitaspis pomorum from Goulburn. 


1890, 294—Coelostoma. australe and 
parasitic flies. 1890, 294—Batrachomyia 
of which the larval state is parasitic 
on frogs. 1890, 655—Galls of Oéeci- 
domyia frauenfeldi. 1890, 680—Atten- 
tion drawn to article on _ insects 
injurious to drugs. 1891, 125— 
Remarks on habitat of Phalacrognathus 
muelleri. 1892, 20—See also under 
Waits, H. R. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 99 


SLoane, T. G. Collection of Carenides. 
1889, 654—Summary of views on geo- 1925, xli. 
graphical range of Cicindelidae. 1909, SmirHers, W. H. Native copper from 
275. near Townsville. 1886, 505. 

SmitH, H. G. Crude Hudesmol from §mirHurst, H. Betelnut and implements 
Hucalyptus camphora. 1902, 238— and weapons from New Guinea. 1886, 


Mydaid fly larva, Diochlistus gracilis. 


SmitH, Miss V. I. 


Section of trunk of Orites excelsa, with 
cavity coated with aluminium suc- 
cinate. 1903, 885—See also under 
BAKER, R. T.; Baker, R. T., and H. G. 
SMITH. 


SmirH, R. Greic. Two samples of butter 


prepared under different conditions. 
1899, 418—Attention called to experi- 
ments on Bacillus pyocyaneus. 1899, 
477—Samples of cloudy wine and cul- 
tures of acetic acid forming bacterium. 
1900, 698—Bacteriological apparatus 
and appliances. 1901, 516—Life history 
and characteristics of Bacterium vascu- 
larum. 1902, 74—Culture of Penicil- 
lium glaucum. 1902, 207—Cultures of 
Bacterium eucalypti. 1902, 238—Note 
on prevalence of gummosis in sugar 
cane. 1902, 238—Microscopic prepara- 
tions of diseased rainbow trout. 1902, 
370—Salmon affected with Saprolegnia 
ferax. 1902, 495—Slime produced by 
Bacterium sacchari. 1903, 362—Cul- 
tures and products obtained while in- 
vestigating Sterculia gum. 1903, 564 
—Cork from wine bottle damaged by 
insect larvae. 1903, 564—Record of 
occurrence of Bacterium eucalypti in 
manna of Hucalyptus punctata. 1903, 
831—Ginger beer plant consisting of a 
microbe and a _ yeast. 1904, 253— 
Preparations of blood smears of tick 
and other fevers. 1904, 479—Three bush 
mice with skin disease. 1904, 805— 
Undetermined Bacterium on saccharose- 
bean-agar. 1906, 175—Dry gum of 
Rhizobium leguminosarum. 1906, 361 
—Résumé of bacteriological institutions 
visited abroad. 1907, 744—Schizosac- 
. charomyces isolated from molasses. 
1908, 286—Culture of slime-forming 
Bacterium, forming on _ household 
sponge. 1908, 290—Condensed milk 
which had become jellified. 1908, 629 
—Cultures of two bacteria related to 
Colon bacillus. 1909, 591—Household 
sponges infected with slime-forming 
bacteria. 1909, 592—Apples affected 
with Bitter Pit. 1911, 158—Painted 
wood sown with conidia of Dematia 
and Cladosporium. 1923, xxxiv. 


Common bag moth 
(Metura elongata); its method of pro- 
gression on vertical pane of glass. 
1920, 318—Parasitic nematodes from a 
chicken and a goat. 1922, xxx—Species 
of Diptera bred in captivity or reared 
from larvae or pupae. 1923, xxx— 


577—Shale with fossil ferns from Walls- 
end. 1886, 974—Ironstone nodule. 
1886, 974—Fossil Polyzoa. 1886, 974— 
Antique green porphyry. 1886, 1207— 
Bones of gigantic kangaroo from Gul- 
gong. 1887, 109—Two corals -(Favo- 
sites gothlandica and Isastraea) from 
Gulgong. 1887, 109—Crystalline petri- 
faction formed in four years. 1887, 
1075. 


STEAD, D. G. Hydatina physis and spiral 


ribbon of eggs. 1898, 274—--Crustacean 
(Philyra pisum) from Japan. 1898, 
408—Hawkesbury sandstone tunnelled 
by insects. 1899, 285—Basalt from 
Kiama and silicified wood from Wollon- 
gong. 1899, 374—Hawkesbury sand- 
stone tunnelled by termites. 1899, 418 
—Remarks on finding common bronze- 
wing pigeon 500 miles from land. 
1899, 418—Carpenter bee (Lestis 
aeratus), boring in young Hucalypt. 
1899, 476—Port Jackson Crustaceans. 
1899, 549—Phasmid from New Heb- 
rides. 1899, 631—Crustacean (Ibacus 
peronii) from Port Jackson. 1899, 631 
—Crustacean (Pilumnopeus  serrati- 
frons) and undetermined Nematode 
from stomach of Jew fish. 1899, 697— 
Ant and piece of quartz which it had 
lifted. 1900, 115—Pelagic Crustacean 
(Galathea sp.). 1900, 321—Living 
specimen of Murrumbidgee crayfish. 
1900, 321—Photograph showing atmos- 
pheric erosion at Bondi. 1900, 321— 
Mounted preparations of Crustaceans. 
1900, 3898—Specimen of Stink Fish 
(Callionymus curvicornis). 1900, 476 
—Undetermined snake. 1900, 476— 
Preparation of fruit of Barringtonia 
cupania. 1900, 542—Land crab (Cardi- 
soma sp.) from New Hebrides. 1900, 
610—Remains of freshwater crayfishes 
from stomach of Murray Cod. 1900, 
610—Attention called to large numbers 
of Palinurus Edwardsii for sale in 
Sydney. 1900, 610—Preparation of 
coral collected at Shark Island. 1901, 
213—Aboriginal relics from Port Hack- 
ing. 1901, 2183—Hardwood pile bored 
by Teredo. 1901, 514—Ova of large 
Australian crayfish. 1901, 514—Speci- 
men of Octopus pictus. 1901, 515— 
Two deformed Malekulan skulls. 1901, 
631—Wood showing junction of host 
and mistletoe. 1901, 631—Crab from 
New Hebrides. 1901, 631—Two species 
of Orthoptera from Sydney. 1901, 631 


100 


—Megalops stage of a crab. 1901, 631 
—Crustacean (Rhynchocinetes typus). 
1901, 631—Sand eel from Cowan Bay. 
1901, 738—Two species of locusts and 
two geckos from New Hebrides. 1901, 
738—Specimens of Ceratothoa, a Crus- 
tacean parasite. 1901, 738—Larvae of 
Agarista glycine. 1901, 738—“Doctor” 
or “Surgeon” fish from Port Jackson. 
1902, 205—Flute mouth (fistularia 
serrata) from Port Jackson. 1902, 205 
—Photographs of large biack bream 
(Chrysophrys australis). 1902, 370— 
English lobster (Homarus vulgaris) 
which reached Australia alive. 1902, 
495—Remarks on large shoal of 
“salmon” (Arripis salar) i «IEE 
Hacking. 1902, 656—Glass rope sponge 
(Hyalomena mirabilis) from Japan. 
1903, 831—Copepod (Sphyrion laevi- 
gatunm). 1903, 884—Barnacle attached 
to skin of whale. 1903, 944—Crus- 
tacean (Cyamus ceti) from a whale, 
with notes. 1903, 944—Octopus pictus 
with batch of eggs. 1904, -128—Fish 
preserved in formalin with exposed 
surface covered with mould. 1904, 128 
Cocoon of Antheraea eucalypti, with 
parasitic flies. 1904, 557—Mention of 
variations in Australian fishes. 1904, 
805—Scorpaenoid fish (Glyptauchen 
panduratus) from Port Jackson. 1905, 
486—Centropercis nudivittis from Ter- 
rigal. 1905, 486—Amia _ roseigaster, 
with ova. 1905, 486—Two species of 
mullet, Mugil waigiensis and M. dus- 
sumieri. 1906, 60—Fishes recorded for 
first time from N.S.W. 1906, 174— 
Common freshwater perch of eastern 
N.S.W. 1906, 261—Mature intra- 
uterine foetus cof Little Saw-shark. 
1906, 425—Chela-. of mangrove crab, 
malformed. 1906, 425—Species of 
Syngnathid pive-fishes. 1906, 428— 
Species of fish new to fauna of N.S.W. 
1906, 496—Cheilodactylus  spectabilis 
from N.S.W. 1906, 565—Immature 
specimen of Trachinotus sp. 1906, 565 
—Embryos of little “gummy” shark. 
1906, 565—Record of occurrence at 
Port Hacking of Ceratium furca. 1906, 
565—Record of occurrence of “Govern- 
ment bream” at Coff’s Harbour. 1906, 
673—Rare Syngnathid pipe-fish from 
Bellinger River. 1906, 673—Young 
example of skipper garfish. 1906, 673 
—Record of large shoal of great 
tunnies. 1907, 392—Record of Chlamy- 
doselachus in N.S.W. 1907, 554—Beaked 
salmon (Gonorhynchus gonorhynchus). 
1907, 744—Deformed claw of mangrove 
crab. 1907, 88388—Record of occurrence 
of sword fish (Xiphias gladius) in 
N.S.W. waters. 1908, 797—Photographs 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


of sun fish (Mola mola). 1908, 797— 
Living example of Osphromenus tri- 
chopterus. 1908, 797—Particulars of 
unidentified marine animal near 
Manning River. 1909, 114—Small 
freshwater perch from artesian well at 
Corella. 1909, 116—‘“‘Moorish idol’, 
Zanclus cornutus, from Botany Bay. 
1909, 274—Common drill or boring 
whelk. 1909, 411—Tests of South 
American Hchinoderm, Hncope emar- 
ginata. 1909, 411—Living specimen of 
striated serpent-head fish from Singa- 
pore, 1909, 416—Brittle star from 
Coogee Beach. 1909, 416—Undeter- 
mined marine worms from aquarium. 
1909, 416—Fan-tailed variety of com- 
mon golden carp from Japan. 1909, 
498—Amphibious fish, Anabas scandens, 
from Singapore. 1909, 498—Amphib- 
ious, imported Freshwater Hels. 1910, 
27—Hstuary and Freshwater Perches. 
1910, 657—Jaws of large Sunfish. 1910, 
304—Records of additions to the Fish- 
fauna; blood-red Conglomerate from 
the Barwon River. 1910, 307—Water- 
beetle from the Dry Bogan. 1910, 659 
—Photograph of a Sail-Fish caught at 
Port Stephens, and a living Butter- 
Fish. 1911, 44—Blue-Hyes, living in 
both fresh and salt water, from 
Wamberal Lagoon. 1911, 156—Oyster- 
Blennies from Broken Bay. 1911, 605 
—An ovigerous Pycnogonid, from off 
Nobbys. 1911, 504—An aboriginal 
nulla-nulla; and examples of a seaweed 
known as Balloon-weed, Bubble-weed or 
Bladder-weed, detrimental to oysters. 
1911, 632—Embryos and fry of the 
Salmon Catfish. 1912, 48—Aboriginal 
remains from a Shell-deposit, Macleay 
River; Oyster-shells from a deposit at 
Nambucca River. 1912, 236—Bog-moss 
used for packing Trout-ova. 1912, 283 
—Photographs of a Southern Ribbon- 
Fish. 1912, 492—Oyster and Cockle 
Shells from a deposit at Macleay River. 
1912, 556—Tail-barb of a Sting-ray ex- 
tracted from another individual of the 
same species. 1913, 169—Photograph of 
a Leopard-Seal captured in Brisbane 
Water. 19138, 525—Californian Rain- 
bow-trout of the same age, differing in 
size. 1913, 603—Frog from the Kos- 
ciusko Tableland. 1913, 656—Nema- 
todes from the ovaries of a Jewfish. 
1914, 20—Amphiozus (Branchiostoma 
sp.). 1924, xxiii—Leaf of Moreton 
Bay fig from Cobar. 1925, xlv—Photo- 
graphs showing Kealakekua Bay and 
Captain Cook’s Monument. 1925, xl— 
Remarks on prevalence of camels in 
wild state north-west of Bourke. 1925, 
xlv—Remarks on widespread occur- 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 101 


rence of common pie melon. 1925, xlv 
—Seven distinct types of common 
golden carp. 1925, xlvi—Skull of green 
turtle. 1925, xxxviii. 


STEEL, T. Bombyx from Fiji overgrown 


by fungus. 1887, 174—Pond snail, 
Physa gibbosa. 1887, 196—Attention 
called to paper on immunity of some 
low forms of life from lead poisoning. 
1895, 472—Very large ship worm 
(Teredo) from piles in freshwater, 
Fiji. 1895, 519—Gecko (Gehyra voraz) 
from Fiji. 1895, 537—Nodule from Mac- 
donnell Ranges. 1895, 550, 618—Crusta- 
cean (Ibacus peronii) from Pyrmont. 
1895, 550—Growing sugar cane attacked 
by Termites. 1895, 550—Peripatus born 
in captivity. 1895, 618—Peripatus 
from Australia, Tasmania and New 
Zealand. 1896, 113—Fungus from Bun- 
danoon. 1892, 269—Note on Peripatus. 
1897, 124—Large specimen of Poly- 
porus mylittae from Bundanoon. 1897, 
253—Type of Dendrelaphis schlenckeri 
and series of lizards from New Guinea. 
1898, 408—Needles made of human 
bones from Fiji. 1899, 374—Cigar from 
Fiji. 1899, 697—Volcanic bombs from 
Auckland. 1900, 398—Living specimens 
of land planarians. 1900, 610—Large 
example of earthworm (Didymogaster 
sylvatica). 1900, 610—Part of humerus 
of Diprotodon australis. 1900, T60— 
Collection of interesting specimens 
from New Zealand. 1901, 514—Species 
of Peripatus. 1901, 738—Résumé of 
visit abroad. 1903, 314—Prehistoric 
so-called “vitrified fort’ from Scotland. 
1903, 564—Greenockite from Scotland. 
1903, 685—Sigillaria from Scottish Coal 
Measures. 1903, 685—Common pine 
case-moth (Vhyridopteryxr hubneri). 
1904, 129—Series of galls of Apiomorpha 
pedunculata. 1904, 460—Note on Zea 
mays. 1905, 175—Living examples of 
four land’ planarians from Victoria. 
1905, 223—Living specimens of land 
planarians. 1905, 350—String of copra. 
1905, 392—Stage in germination of seed 
of Loranthus. 1905, 487—Series of 
N.S.W. whitings. with notes. 1905, 574 
——Specimens of Ooperipatus oviparus 
and land  planarians. 1906, 428— 
Specimens of volcanic dust. 1906, 495 
—Attention called to working model of 
ocean currents. 1906, 495—Large speci- 
men of Saunders’ case-moth. 1907, 838 
—Small clay nest-building wasps from 
Brisbane. 1909, 117—Ants, dead in 
quantity. 1910, 310—Bacterial growth 
from a distillery pipe. 1910, 687— 
Specimens of a freshwater ship-worm, 
and of a piece of red-gum pile riddled 
with burrows, from Ba River, Fiji. 


STEPHEN, —. 


STEPHENS, T. 


1911, 504—Fleshy corolla-tubes of the 
Mohwa. 1912, 235—An abnormally 
coloured egg of a Muscovy Duck. 1912, 
390—Acorn with four cotyledons. 1912, 
492—-Snail-shells after manipulation 
by the common brown rat. 1913, 
107—Reunited, fractured femur of an 
ox. 1916, 217—An abnormal gizzard of 
a Muscovy duck. 1918, 361, 415—Pin 
embedded in liver of fowl. 1920, 318 
—Young Hyla coerulea with two bots, 
one on each shoulder. 1922, xxii—See 
also under Brazier, J.; MAIDEN, J. H. 
Fossil Tertiary leaves from 
Newstead. 1881, 581—Ethnological 
collection from Pleasant Island. 1902, 
343. 

Portion of aé_e plank 
destroyed by “dry-rot’. 1910, 311. 


STEPHENS, W. J. Trilobites from the Yass 


district. 1879, 409—Note on shale from 
the Hawkesbury sandstone. 1880, 182 
—Note on Japanese drawing of Octopus. 
1880, 183—Fossils from the Namoi and 
from Campbelltown. 1880, 300— 
Reference to quarry at Rushcutter’s 
Bay. 1881, 408—Fossil land shells. 
1882, 91—Specimens of Hucalyptus 
cordata from near Hobart. 1882, 303 
—Notes on rocks and fossils from 
Western Coalfield. 1882, 402, 560— 
Photograph and sketch of Devonian 
fossil from near Yass. 1883, 217— 
Pebble containing drop of water. 1883, 
219—Chrysalis of Danais secured to 
leaf. 1883, 219—Fossils from Sturt’s 
Stony Desert. 1883, 281—Petrified 
wood, Dendrites, gypsum, and _ shell 
breccia from north-western N.S.W. 18838, 
281—Fungus from Springwood. 1883, 
281—Opal from Paroo District. 1883, 
281—(For Rev. J. M. Curran) Fossil 
plants from  Ballinore. 1883, 297— 
Coccus infesting Casuarina. 1883, 297 
—(For Mr. J. AnpEerson) Fossil leaves 
and freshwater Molluscs (Unio) from 
Inverell. 1883, 297—Rocks found at 
Lake Macquarie. 1883, 388—Siliceous 
sinter from Cataract River. 1883, 388 
—Conglomerate and pebbles from 
Narran_ district. 1883, 389—Living 
example and photographs of Hatteria 
punctata from New Zealand. 1883, 396 
—Specimens of Pennatulidae from 
British Columbia. 1883, 397—Walchia 
milneana and Spirifer. 1884, 864— 
Pug or mixed clay and wash-dirt from 
Gulgong. 1885, 62—Germination of 
orange seeds within uninjured fruit. 
1885, 761—Geological specimens from 
Dubbo. 1885, 247—Glossopteris Brown- 
iana. 1885, 279—Boletus bovinus. 1886, 
477—Species of Lamprey. 1886, 506— 
Engraving of Ichthyodorulite. 1886, 


102 INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


506—(For Mr. Percy FairHruL) Abor- 
iginal grinding stones. 1886, 883— 
(For Mr. J. Srirrtinc) Volcanic ejecta 
from Taupo, N.Z. 1886, 1062—Drawing 
of Platyceps wilkinsonii, 1886, 1208— 
(For Dr. Ramsay) Shale from Gosford 
cutting, with fossils. 1887, 145—Note 
by Baron von Mueller re_ botanical 
discoveries on Mt. Bellenden-Ker. 1887, 
175—Archaeocyathus sp. from near 


Yass. 1887, 198—Siderite concretion. 
1887, 557—Stone axe from Lower 
Namoi. 1887, 557—(For Dr. Woo..s) 


Plants from Mt. Wilson, Cobar, Mudgee 
and the Lachlan. 1887, 1077—Fossils 
from County Bathurst. 1888, 336— 
Pleistocene bone breccia. 1888, 336 
—(For Mr. Norton) Internal cast of 
crinoid. 1888, 337—(For Dr. Woo.ts) 
Jussiaea repens, with note. 1888, 337 
—(For Dr. Wootits) Plants from the 
Lachlan, with notes. 1888, 338—Pouch 
of Dasyurus viverrinus containing 
young. 1888, 1259—(For Dr. Woo ts) 
Two species of Hucalyptus from Blue 
Mountains. 1888, 1316—Devonian 
fossils from Cudgegong. 1888, 1316— 
Fossil Crustacean from Lake Bathurst. 
1888, 1316—Voluta magnifica, obtained 
70 feet below sea level at Stockton pit. 
1889, 313—Determination of plant ex- 
hibited by Mr. Rohu (1889, p. 131) as 
Mezoneurum brachycarpum. 1889, 313 
—(For Mr. McCoorty) Albino variety of 
Dacelo gigas. 1889, 1052—(For Mr. 
McCoory) Head of Diemenia super- 
ciliosa with two poison fangs in right 
jaw. 1889, 1052—Parasitic Nematodes 
(Ascaris sp.) from brown snake. 1889, 
1100—See also under Macieay, W. 


STEPHENSON, L. Orchid (Drakea hunt- 
iana) from near Blackheath. 18938, 
45. 


STIRLING, J. See under STEPHENS, W. J. 


STOCKDALE, H. Paintings illustrating 
disposal of dead by aborigines, Alligator 
River. 1892, 344. 

Stokes, EH. S. Drawings and preparations 
of Fredericella sultana, Anabaena sp., 
and Peridinium sp. 1906, 362—Fila- 
mentous Alga from filter beds at West 
Maitland. 1907, 159—-Diatomaceous 
deposit (Amphora sp.). 1907, 159— 
Dried thalli of Chroococcus. 1907, 159 
—Caddis worms and their cases from 
water channels. 1909, 275. 

SULMAN, Miss F. Leaves of Waratah 
attacked by a leaf-mining larva. 1915, 
210. 


Sussmincu, C. A. Lepidodendron from 


Bermagui. 1905, 577—Eurydesma 
cordata from Hunter River district. 
WOOO, IW, 


TATE, R. Note calling attention to new 
marsupial from Alice Springs. 1888, 
1255—Note on nomenclature of Port 
Jackson Molluse (Cingulina brazieri). 
1901, 214—See also under Braziger, J. 

TAyLor, F. H. Photographs of Brazilian 
disease “Rabbit Myxoma”’ or blepharo- 
conjunctivitis. 1919, 820—Sheep mag- 
got-flies and fruit fly pests. 1920, 203. 

AvAsaroe, “I, Gr Fossil Blastoid from 
Clarencetown. 1905, 487—Stereogram 
of N.S.W. 1905, 577—Gastropods from 
Miocene beds of S.A. 1906, 61— 
Aegirine trachyte from near Goulburn. 
1906, 175—Archeocyathinae from S. 
Aust. 1906, 361—(For H. I. JensEN) 
Diatomaceous earth from Warrum- 
bungle Mts. 1906, 362—Photographs 
made by use of express enlarger from 
microsections. 1907, 393. 

TEITKINS, W. Extract from letter to Rev. 
J. Tenison-Woods in reference to his 
exploration of the Bunda Plateau, north 
of the Australian Bight. 1880, 280. 

Tuomas, H. C. Remarks on origin of 
kerosene shale. 1889, 634-—Petroleum 
shale coated with iron pyrites from 
Joadja Creek. 1890, 140. 

THORNTON, G. See under Lucas, A. H. S. 


TIDSWELL, F. Summary of knowledge of 
tick or Texas fever in cattle. 1899, 190. 


TILLYARD, R. J. Water colour drawings 
of Australian dragon-flies. 1904, 460— 
Set specimens of Lestes leda, illustrat- 
ing oviposition. 1905, 487—Statistics 
on numerical relations of the sexes in 
species of dragon-flies. 1905, 487—Two 
proliferous roses. 1906, 676—Dragon- 
flies of genera Rhyothemis and Neuro- 
themis. 1908, 629—Cast skin of dragon- 
fly, Hemicordulia australiae, with cast 
skin of a smaller species on its back. 


1908, 798—Four adults of Camacinia 
othello from Cooktown. 1909, 118— 
Dragonfly larva, after exposure to 


starvation and desiccation. 1910, 48 
—Photographs of a seedling of the W.A. 
Christmas-Tree. 1912, 137—A rare 
dragon-fly and its larval skin. 1912, 
590—An Ascalaphid, with the eggs, and 
a Panorpid. 1914, 88—Larvae of two 
rare Zygopterid Dragonflies. 1915, 416 
—Neuropterous larva (Psychopsis sp.). 
1915, 625—Larvae of rare ant-lions; 
hybrid Sweet-pea. 1916, 194—New 
Perlidae reared from larvae; larva of 
a new Buffalo-gnat. 1916, 632—Collec- 
tion of insects from, and lantern-slides 
illustrating the natural history of, 
Cradle Mt., N.W. Tasmania. - 1917, 201 
—Collection of Mecopterous insects 
(Panorpatae). 1917, 302—Wing of 
fossil insect from Coal-seam. 1918, 361 
—Sections of the Saccoid Caudal Gills 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 103 


of the larva of a Javanese Dragonfly. 
1918, 495—Canadian Lacewings and 
Caddisflies; a large Dragonfly picked up 
on the pavement. 1918, 612—Larvae and 
cocoons of Ithone fusca. 1919, 526-527 
—Cocoons of Thynnus variabilis. 1919, 
527—Pupae of Dipterous flies (Bomby- 
liidae). 1919, 527—Larvae of Apoda 
zylomeli. 1919, 527—Larva, sub-pupa 
and pupa of Hzeirus lateritius. 1919, 
720—Five fossil insect wings. 1921, 
423—Larvae, pupae and imagines of 


two new Blepharoceridae. 1921, 508. 
TREBECK, P. N. Large crab (Pseudo- 
Carcinus gigas). 1883, 297—Two 


samples of wool grown on the same 
sheep. 1884, 865—Two samples of wool 
grown on the same ram. 1884, 1015— 
Fungi from Fiji. 1885, 341—Tertiary 
limestone from Eucla. 1885, 341— 
Auriferous iron ore from Mt. Morgan. 
1886, 505—Attention drawn to cultiva- 
tion of pleuro-pneumonia virus for in- 
oculation. 1887, 414—Communication 
re efforts to establish better protection 
of native flora and fauna. 1889, 190 
—Hucalypt bark marked by insect 
burrows. 1889, 192—lLiving Vermi- 
cella annulata trom Annandale. 1889, 
389—Wool which had been improved 
by a German process. 1889, 1028— 
Dipterous galls from Mt. Wilson. 1891, 
125—Insects collected at North Sydney. 
1891, 249—Caterpillars destructive to 
vegetation. 1891, 578—Flying fish 
(Dactylopterus orientalis) from Port 
Jackson. 1892, 200—Photographs of 
Coccus and galls of a Brachyscelid. 
1892, 314—Sow-thistle infested with 
larvae of Phytomyza. 1892, 314—Leaf 
insect (Phyllum sp.) from Fiji. 1892, 
405—Orthopterous insect (Phibalo- 
soma) from Fiji. 18938, 126—Scorpion 
from Queensland. 1893, 126—Fresh- 
water prawn (Palaemon ornatus) from 
Fiji. 1893, 181—Fish (Solenognathus 
spinosissimus) from Middle Harbour. 
1897, 44—Rattle of Crotalus sp. from 
British Columbia. 1900, 115—Branch 
of Opuntia coccinellifera. 1900, 762 
—Borer (Phoracantha sp.) in Eucalypt 
timber. 1900, 762—Seedling peach 
foliage spotted with Uromyces. 1902, 
207. 


TROUGHTON, FE. LE G. Skul! of Bettongia 


cuniculus. 1921, 350—Yellow-footed 
Pouched Mouse. 1921, 850—Skins of 
rare native rat. 1922, xxiv—Skulls of 
white-necked Hair Seal. 1922, xxiv— 
Insectivorous bat (Nyctinomus aus- 
tralis). 1924, xxv—White-backed wren 
(Malurus  leuconotus). 1924, xxv— 
Mounted specimen of Caenolestes fuli- 
ginosa. 1925, xlvii—Skull of adult 


female aboriginal showing remarkable 
recovery from injury. 1925, xlv. 


TurRNER, A. J. A collection of Canadian 


Lepidoptera. 1918, 611. 


TuRNER, FE. Fruits and seeds of Sweet 


cassava (Manihot Aipi). 1891, 577— 
Fruits and seeds of Sterculia acu- 
minata. 1891, 578—Fruits of Hmex 
australis. 1891, 578—Telopea oreades 
from Fitzroy Falls. 1891, 703—Three 
grasses attacked by fungus. 1891, 703 
—Hraglossis Kennedyae from Broken 
Hill. 1893, 535—Richea Gunnii and 
Poa saxicola from near Mt. Kosciusko. 
1893, 535—Flowering specimen of Cali- 
fornian poppy (Romneya Coulteri). 
1894, 44—-Flowering specimen of Rhus 
typhina from Wagga. 1894, 44—Fruit- 
ing branch of Ailanthus glandulosa. 
1894, 44—Plants of Trachymene incisa. 
1894, 561—Specimens of Japanese elm, 
Mexican soldier bush and star anise in- 
fested with Loranthus. 1894, 561— 
Specimens of Morchella conica. 1894, 
583—Flowering and fruiting specimens 
of Adriana acerifolia, suspected of 
poisoning cattle. 1895, 341—Specimen 
of Kochia pyramidata, reported to have 
poisoned sheep. 1895, 409—Fruits of 
Pyrus domestica from Camden. 1896, 
29—Lepturus cylindricus from Hay. 
1896, 816—Two leguminous plants from 
W.A., supposed to be poisonous. 1896, 
816—Specimens of milk bush and hop 
plant. 1897, 124—Remarks re identi- 
fication of Hriachne obtusa from Rose 
Bay. 1897, 161—Notes on five interest- 
ing plants. 1897, 252—Collection of 
American grasses. 1897, 577—Dan- 
thonia pilosa with inflorescence affected 
by parasitic fungus. 1897, 686—In- 
digenous economic plants from the 
Liverpool Plains. 1898, 28—Three 
grasses with inflorescences affected 
with parasitic fungi. 1898, 75— 
Atripler angulata infested with species 
of Dodder. 1898, 75—Cassia mimosoides 
and Crotalaria incana from Clarence 
River. 1898, 76—Portulaca oleracea 
infested with Dodder. 1898, 107—Speci- 
mens and notes on Chloris truncata. 
1899, 285—Forage plants and grasses 
from New England. 1899, 374—Grass 
(Hragrostis nigra) with inflorescence 
infested with fungus. 1900, 195— 
Variegated form of Kennedya rubi- 
cunda. 1900, 115—Fruit of Cydonia 
chinensis. 1900, 322—Desmodium par- 
vifolium acclimatised in Fiji. 1900, 
476—Thirty-five plants suspected of 
causing bad flavour in Australian 
butter. 1900, 611—Homeria aurantiaca, 
Euphorbia eremophila and Acacia Bid- 
willi. 1900, 698—Symplocos thwaitesii 


104 


and Ouscuta australis. 1901, 145— 
Plantago coronopus trom Coogee Bay. 
1902, 592—Lobelia purpurascens, show- 
ing malformation. 1902, 592—Three 
suspected poisonous plants. 1902, 656 
—Series of Australian grasses from 
near Darling River. 1903, 3861— 
Western species of plants raised from 
seed and growing in Hyde Park. 1903, 
497—Ohenopodium rhadistichyum and 
Tecoma Hillii. 1903, 564—Yellow-rattle 
(Rhinanthus crista-gall), an  intro- 
duced plant. 1903, 8832—Two Huropean 
species of Medicago. . 1903, 832—Three 
plants from Minimbah, Upper Hunter 
River. 1903, 885—Observations on five 
species of plants. 1904, 129—Collection 
of plants from Soutn-western N.S.W. 
1904, 253—Collection of grasses from 
Northern Australia. 1994, 806—Collec- 
tion of lichens from New England. 
1905, 259—European grass (Triticum 
repens) from New England. 1905, 259 
—lList of lichens from New England. 
1905, 308—Species of Acacia from 
Dubbo district. 1905, 393—Collection 
of Australian grasses. 1906, 429— 
Flowering specimen of supposed hybrid 
between Sterculia diversifolia and S. 
acerifolia. 1907, 838—Botanical speci- 
mens from N.S.W. 1908, 288—Botan- 
ical specimens. 1908, 290—Botanical 
specimens from Collarenebri and near 
Sydney. 1908, 344—Hordewm aegiceros 
grown in Brisbane. 1908, 636—Speci- 
men from tree of Ficus rubiginosa, 
growing in Hyde Park. 1908, 800—A 
rare South African Protead, in flower; 
a variegated form of an indigenous 
cultivated plant; a Huropean melilot 
from the Hay District. 1910, 660—An 
introduced Mexican plant from the 
Narromine District. 1910, 27—An 
Indian grass becoming common; a fas- 
ciated Crucifer; a cultivated indigen- 
ous Crotalaria. 1910, 805—Chenopodi- 
aceous Plants from Brewarrina. 1910, 
48—Richea, a remarkable Epacrid from 
Tasmania. 1910, 690—Various plants. 
1911, 84—An unrecorded Indian grass 
from the Clarence River. 1911, 159—A 
rare grass from the Australian Alps. 
1911, 423—Grasses from North Aus- 
tralia. 1911, 424—The exotic “Blue 
Couch”’. 1911, 506—An acclimatised 
species of Hragrostis now established 
in N.W. Australia. 1911, 607—A grass 
(Panicum glabrum), with a note con- 
firming his determination. 1912, 48— 
Fruits of Owenia acidula. 1912, 137— 
Fruits of Nitraria Schoberi; Solanum 
petrophilum, a suspected poisonous 
plant; Grasses from New Caledonia. 
1912, 288—Grasses from the Northern 


glauca. 


TURNER, Rev. Dr. 


Wappy, P. 


Aware, IDE, TR 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


Territory; a grass from Cudgen, Tweed 
River; a Chenopod with hairy fruiting 
perianths causing fibre-balls. 1912, 393 
—Grasses and Cyperaceous plants from 
the Northern Territory. 1912, 495—A 
western grass from Blacktown. 1912, 
559—Grasses; fasciated growth of 
Cassia Candolleana. 1913, 107— 
Grasses; an abnormal growth of 
Atriplex campanulata. 19138, 169— 
Grasses. 19138, 398, 526—Grasses 
(Hragrostis spp.). 19138, 604—Specimen 
and a drawing of Strychnos_ psilo- 
sperma. 1913, 657—CGrasses. 1914, 8&7, 
323—Fruits of Quandong. 1914, 542, 
646—Grasses. iL9)1U5). 115—Sechium 
edule with variegated leaves. 1915, 209 
—Remarks on Grasses. 1915, 288— 
West Australian plants. 1915, 719— 
Various plants. 1916, 101, 190—Grasses 
from Queensland. 1916, 217—Fruits of 
Yellow Quandong. 1916, 492—Abnormal 
apple. 1916, 494—White-flowered variety 
of Dampiera. 1916, 769—Flowering 
Bamboo; Timothy-grass from the 
Adelong district; a poison-plant (Gas- 
trolobium), from W.A.; a poisonous 
Chilian Lobelia. 1917, 246—Star-grass 
from the Inverell district. 1917, 302— 
Fruits of Red Quandong; a specimen 
of an introduced Liliaceous plant 
(Triteleia) spreading in the Coolamon 
district; (for Mr. Clements) fasciated 
Red Lac-Sumach. 1917, 439, 440—Pink- 
flowering variety of Tecoma jasimin- 
oides. 1917, 511—An  acclimatised, 
Abyssinian grass. 1918, 234—An intro- 
duced, European Geranium. 1918, 361 


—A rare New South Wales plant 
(Trichinium) . 1918, 610—A_ terato- 
logical specimen of an _ introduced 


Plantago. 1918, 713—Gastrolobium 
grandifiorum. iLL). 198—Nicotiana 
1919, 198—Adriana acerifolia. 
1919, 198—Amarantus macrocarpus and 
Boerhaavia diffusa from Wootton 
Station, Upper Hunter. 1920, 179— 
Remarks on Stipa aristiglumis from 
Liverpool Plains and  Anisacantha 
muricata in Brewarrina District. 1920, 
179-180—Specimen of Lolium temu- 
lentum. 1920, 531—Hryngium  rost- 
ratum. 1921, 157—Myosurus minimus. 
1921, 157—Remarks on TYecoma Hillii. 
1921, 157—Huphorbia lathyris. 1922, 
Xxii. 


Letter from, respect- 
ing a custom prevaient among the 
Armidale blacks. 1885, 188. 


Account of flowering of 
Oenothera Lamarckiana. 1887, 144. 


Reptiles from northern 
district of N.S.W. 18938, 303—Very 


WaLkom, A. B. 


WaALKoM, A. J. 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 105 


young example of Hemisphaeriodon 
gerrardii, from Kurrajong. 1894, 187 
—(For Mr, Skuse) Larva of moth in- 
fested with Jsaria. 1894, 862—Two 
Molluscs (Potamides ebeninum and 
Arca trapezia) offered for sale at Fish 
Market. 1894, 562-—Golden perch 
attacked by fungus. 1894, 740—Mullet 
with small seaweed growing from head. 
1894, 740—Living waltzing mice from 
Japan. 1895, 341—Photographs of tree 
Kangaroos. 1895, 521—Peripatus from 
Colo Vale and other localities. 1895, 
549—Living young green tree snakes 
from Kempsey. 1896, 28—Female 
pouched mouse (Phascologale flavipes) 
with young and a note on nidification. 
1896, 349—Note on range of Platypus. 
1896, 500—Lizard (Nephrurus laevis) 
from Bathurst. 1896, 816—Dark variety 
of Sydney bush rat. 1897, 253—Shells 
of introduced Helix aspersa. 1897, 253 
—Typhlops aluensis from Fiji. 1897, 
685—New Zealand fish caught in Port 
Jackson. 1897, 685—Photographs of 
albatrosses. 1897, 686—Limestone 
polished by rock wallabies. 1897, 686 
—Remarks on Sydney bush rat. 1898, 
106—Notes on range of Crocodilus and 
Brachylophus. 1899, 2883—Fry of Rain- 
bow trout showing abnormalities. 1899, 
477—Living examples of Molge pyrro- 
gastra from China. 1904, 557—Report 
of Leopard Seal coming ashore at 
Manly. 1905, 308—Young examples of 
Paradise fish. 1905, 308—Living ex- 
amples of fighting fish (Betta pugnac). 
1905, 394—The first Part of the Records 
of the S. Aust. Museum. 1918, 236. 


WALKER, J. J. European beetle (Nacerdes 


melanura), not previously recorded 
from Australia. 1900, 760—Remarks on 
exhibit of Huschemon rafflesia. 1903, 
314—Remarks on stone similar to one 
exhibited by Mr. Baker, given to him 
at Tanna. New Hebrides. 1903, 362— 
Anaspides tasmanica from Mt. Welling- 
ton. 19038, 497—Attention called to 
description of a second member of 
EHuschemonidae. 1903, 497—Gempylodes 
tmetus from Otford. 1903, 831—Small 
beetle destructive to crops from Otford. 
1903, 831. 


Glendonites from the 
Lower Marine Series. 1912, 493—Seeds 
associated with Glossopteris. 1920, 531 
—Mesozoic Cycadeoid from Queensland. 
1921, 210—Osmiundites and ‘Taeniop- 
terid. 1923, xxxiii—Scale leaves of 
Glossopteris and associated sporangia. 
1924, xxxi. 


Species of Pentamerus 
from Molong. 1902, 370. 
H 


Warp, R. D. Sponge-bearing crab. 1877, 
30 


WaASTENEYS, H. See under Fiercnuer, J. J. 
WATERHOUSE, G. A. Pamphile augiades 


showing varieties. 1897, 253—Butter- 
fly known as Papilio erectheus. 1900, 


. 398—Particulars of movement to form 


Field Naturalists’ Club. 1900, 476— 
Xenica hobartia and xX. tasmanica. 
1900, 761—Liphyra brassolis, Casyapa 


beata and Mynes geoffroyi. 1901, 516 
—Six species of butterfkies. 1902, 343 
—Noteworthy Rhopalocera. 1902, 370 
—Australian Lycaenidae. 1903, 313— 


Euschemon rafflesia. 1903, 3183—Telesto 
monticolae. 19038, 313—Hypocysta 
metirius and H. pseudirius. 1903, 685— 
Attention drawn to migration of butter- 
flies (Belenois java). 19038, 944— 
Heteronympha banksii and new variety 
of Tisiphone abeona. 1904, 479—Aus- 
tralian species of Ogyris. 1906, 424— 
Pupa and insects of Troides priamus 
poseidi from Cape York. 1906, 674— 
A rare butterfly (Cyclopides croites). 
1912, 236—Butterfly (Huploea corinna) 
from E., N.E., and N. Australia. 1912, 
494—-A series of aberrant Rhopalocera. 
1912, 558—Series of Butterflies, repre- 
senting the five subspecies of Tisiphone 
abeona. 1913, 657—Five geographical 
races of a Butterfly (Tisiphone). 1914, 
396—Collection of butterflies from 
Gallipoli. 1915, 722—First and second . 
generations of crosses of Tisiphone 
abeona and T. rawnsleyi. 1920, 531— 
Heteronympha mirifica and H. para- 
delpha reared from larvae. 1920, 531 
—Five Butterflies reared from gd 
Tisiphone rawnsleyi mated with 2 T. 
abeona. 1920, 221—Heteronympha 
solandri reared from egg. 1920, 472 
—Argynnina hobartia cyrila. 1922, 
xxvii—Larvae of Philiris ilias inno- 
tatus. 1924, xxvii—Loranthus  lino- 
phyllus on Casuarina glauca. 1924, 
xxvii—Second generation hybrid of 
Tisiphone abeona x T. morrisi. 1924, 
XXvi. 


WATERHOUSE, G. A., and R. ‘TURNER. 


Attention called to new species of 
butterfly from Lord Howe Island. 
1904, 697. 


WATERHOUSE, Mrs. G. J. See under 


Henn, A. U. 


Warts, Rev. W. W. Notes on new mosses 


from N.S.W. 1899, 632—-Note on Rich- 
mond River hepaties. 1901, 215— 
Additional notes on mosses of N.S.W. 
1901, 473—Notes on N.S.W. hepatics. 
1901, 6383—Remarks on nomenclature 
of moss described as Barbula mnioides. 
1903, 497—List of- twenty-seven lichens 
mostly from Richmond River. 1903, 


106 INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


498—Collection of North American 
ferns. 1903, 499—Further notes on 
Australian hepatics. 1904, 558—Ferns 
(Ophioglossum, Platyzoma). 1914, 87, 
469—An abnormal form of the common 
Bracken Fern. 1915, 210—See also 
under Baxer, R. T.; WHITELEGGE, T. 

WEARNE, W. L. Effect of pinhole borer 
on timber. 1925, xli—Sapwood of Red 
Cedar damaged by powder post borer. 
1925, xii. 

WetcH, M. B. Nails in bark of Queens- 
land Kauri. 1923, xxxi—Wood of 
Hucalyptus saligna grown in “Trans- 
vaal. 1925, xxxviii. 

WELCH, W. Sinhalese water-clock. 1925, 
Xliv. 

Wuitr, H. L. A skull of the Native 
Bear, showing an extensive osseous 
growth. 1911, 156—Fossil reptilian 
vertebrae. 1914, 396. 

WHITELEGGE, T. Plumatella from Botany 
Swamps and Nitella from Randwick. 
1883, 281—Plumatella repens and a 
freshwater sponge from Moore Park. 
1883, 297—Living specimen of Frederi- 
cella. 1883, 416—Plumatella-like form. 
1883, 465—Fossil woods, ete. 1884, 178 
—Fossil plants from Hawkesbury 
Series. 1885, 62—Collection of mosses. 
1885, 248—Water insects with small 
Molluses attached. 1885, 760—KFresh- 
water Polyzoa. 1885, 760—Specimens 
of Cordylophora. 1885, 854—Remarks 
on large species of Nitella. 1886, 476— 
Living specimens of Amoeba and 
Clathrulina. 1886, 506—Hydroid zoo- 
phyte from Bondi. 1886, 578—Micro- 
scopic forms from Moore Park. 1886, 
854—Infusoria and  Rotifers from 
Waterloo Swamps. 1886, 881—Fora- 
minifera trom Port Jackson. 1886, 975, 
—Claudea bennettiana from Port Jack- 
son Heads. 1886, 1061—Note on Volvoz 
minor. 1886, 1122—Lemna oligorrhiza 
in flower. 1886, 1123—Examples of 
early stages of the Truffle. 1887, 251— 
Tubularia gracilis. 1887, 452—Larvae 
of Comatula from Port Jackson. 1887, 
452—Porina inversa from Port Jack- 
son. 1887, 680—Haliphysema ramulosa. 
1888, 151—Slides of Polyzoa. 1888, 151 
—New species of mosses. 1888, 336—- 
Mycelia of fungus. 1888, 892—W.Neis 
cordigera from Port Jackson. 1888, 
892—Phosphorescent fat. 1888, 892— 
Medusae from Mosman’s Bay. 1888, 
1255—Earthworm (Allolobophora tur- 
gida) with two tails.’ 1888, 1780— 
Voluta fusiformis containing rare her- 
mit crab (Clibanarius strigimanus). 
1889, 118—Hydroid Zoophytes from 
Maroubra Bay. 1889; 633—Flowering 
Sprengelia ponceletia, 1889,  654—- 


Herbarium specimens of species of 
Equisetum. 1891, 167—Peridinium and 
allied organisms. 1891, 167—Collection 
of mosses from Lord Howe Island. 
1892, 277—Physalid (Alophota sp.) 
from Coogee. 1892, 314—Rhegmatodes 
thalassina from Sydney Cove. -.13892, 
314—Rare Isopod (Amphoroidea aus- 
traliensis) from Maroubra Bay. 1896, 
503—Note on three N.S.W. ferns. i899, 
191—(For Rev. W. W. Watts) Aus- 
tralian mosses with notes on recently 
described species by Mr. Watts. 1899, 
374—Two rare orchids (Caladenia 
tessellata and Dendrobium kingianum). 
1899, 547—Living plant and dried 
fronds of Doodia linearis. 1899, 631— 
(For W. W. Warts) Note on recent 
collections of mosses. 1900, 322— 
Huspongia illawarrae. 1902, 74—Fresh 
specimens of Utricularia, of a retiform 
alga, and of an uncommon Hepatic. 
1911, 606—Slides illustrating the sexual 
generation of Psilotum. 1916, 102— 
See also under HEDLEY, C. 


WHITTELL, H. R. Collection of insects and 


birds’ eggs. 1881, 169—Specimens of 
Tacsonia exonensis. 1883, 397—Vege- 
table caterpillar. 1883, 417—Remarks 
on flowering specimen of Svwainsonia 
Greyana. 1884, 179. 


WILKINSON, C. 8S. Tooth of a Diprotodon. 


1880, 286—Species of Phasma from Fish 
River Caves. 1881, 408—Tertiary fossil 
insects from Vegetable Creek. 1883, 
398—Carboniferous coral from near 
Jervis Bay. 1883, 398—EHchinus from 
Lord Howe Island. 1883, 534—Paper 
Nautilus from Lord Howe Island. 1884, 
178—Portion of Diprotodon jaw from 
near Armidale. 1884, 254—Fossilifer- 
ous limestone from South Australia. 
1884, 865—Curious native shoe. 1884, 
865—Minerals from Barrier Ranges. 
1884, 946—Shell-like covering of 
Phrygaenea. 1884, 1169—Fossil bones 
from Lord Howe Island. 1885, 75— 
Oyster shells from shaft near New- 
castle. 1885, 75—Recent shells from 
coal pits and harbour works, Newcastle. 
1885, 245—Collection of grasses and 
plants from Wonominta Station. 1885, 
246—Remarks on report on Tasmanian 
fisheries. 1885, 554—Dolium - varie- 
gatum. 1885, 696—Seed pod of Cassia 
fistula. 1885, 696—Fossil turtle eggs 
from Lord Howe Island. 1886, 164— 
Trochus imperialis from New Zealand. 
1886, 164—Bones, scutes, etc. of 
Megalania. 1886, 505—Part of lower 
jaw of Thylacoleo carnifex. 1886, 505 
—Aphanaia gigantea and sandstone 
with Ostracod (?) markings. 1886, 854 
—Planorbis in sandstone from Cockatoo 


INDEX TO EXHIBITS. 


Island. 1886, 854—Volcanic ash from 
Tarawera, New Zealand. 1886, 854— 
Fossils from Gosford. 1887, 174—(For 
Mr. LockyEr) Limestone found attached 
to tree six feet above ground. 1887, 
250—Crystals containing fluid from 
Richmond River district. 1887, 250— 
Collection of egg agates from mound 
on aboriginal grave, Tweed River 
district. 1887, 250—See also under 
Davin, T. W. E.; Macteay, W.; OLLirFr, 
A. S. 
WILLIAMS, P. See under DEANE, H. 


WILLIAMS, P. 1. Cocoon of Lewin’s case 


moth. 1899, 283—Heteronympha para- 
delpha from Berrima. 1900, 60— 
Funeral stone from Wilcannia. 1901, 
515—See also under Deane, 4H.; 


EXTHERIDGE, R. 
Wixttiams, W. D. C. Collection of Zulu 


weapons. 1882, 303—Collection of arms 
and implements from the Soudan. 
1885, 448. 


Wixson, J. T. Note on dumb-bell shaped 
bone in Ornithorhynchus. 1894, 44. 


Wooprorp, C. M. Diurnal Lepidoptera 


from Solomon Group. 1887, 979— 
Birds from Solomon Group. 1887, 979. 
Woops, —. Pile showing ravages of 


marine borers. 1881, 170. 


Woops, J. EH. TENISON. Seeds of Hucalyp- 
tus. 1878, 20—Photographs of Brachi- 
opods. 1878, 40—Fungi of Australia. 
1879, 244—Shells from Western Aus- 
tralia and Cassis achatina from Bass 
Strait. 1880, 184—Nepenthes Kennedyi 
and N. Bernaysii and photograph of a 
new Lycopod from Queensland. 1880, 
192—Letter from W. Teitkins. 1880, 


107 


280—Summary of work on New Zealand 
Tertiary Radiata. 1880, 282—Aboriginal 
spear points of dolomite. 1880, 286— 
Bryozoa from New Caledonia. 1882, 
206—Fossils from Tivoli Mine, Ipswich 
and Cemetery Hill, West Maitland. 
1882, 347—Hydroid zoophyte with 
attached WHschara. 1882, 347—Fossil 
plants. 1883, 180—Stone axes and 
native ornaments. 1885, 62—See also 
under Macireay, W. 


Woops, T. A. TrniIson. Examples of 
photograph being converted into a 
negative. 1878, 305—Turbinaria crater 


attached to pearl oyster. 1879, 244— 
Specimens of Pituri and the extract 
from Duboisia myoporoides. 1879, 292 
—Note on Huktiminaria ducalis. 1879, 
310—Hydrophis sp. from Java. 1880, 
192—Drawing of impressions of red 
hands made by aborigines. 1882, 329 
—Stone tomahawk. 1882, 348—TIdol 
from Savu. 1882, 612, 674. 

WOoOOoLLs, Rev. W. Note on Panicum 
spectabile. 1882, 348—Specimens of 
Calotis scapigere and C. hispidula, with 
a note. 1890, 655—Dodonaea attenuata 
with both simple and pinnate leaves. 
1890, 897—Manna from Eucalyptus 
pulverulenta. 1891, 381—Lichens (Usnea 
articulata and Cladonia retipora). 1891, 
381—F lowering specimens of Capparis 
Mitcheli and C. lasiantha from the 
Namoi. 1892, 40—See also under 
STEPHENS, W. J. 

WooLtnoucH, W. G. Graptolites 
Shoalhaven River near Tallong. 
635. 

WooLtrycH, L. F. Snakes from near 
Parramatta. 1894, 708. 


from 
1908, 


iv. LIST OF OBITUARY NOTICES IN THE PROCEEDINGS. 


Allan, W., 1916, 5 

Bailey, F. M., 1916, 7 
Baird, S. F., 1887, 1090 
Beddome, C. E., 1899, 2 
Bell, F. J., 1925, v 
Bennett, G., 1893, 542 
Bennett, K. H., 1891, 707 
Betche, H., 1914, 3 
Blackburn, T., 1913, 7 
Boyer-Bower, T. H., 1886, 1210 
Bradley, H. H. B., 1919, 16 
Brodribb, W. A., 1886, 1210 
Brown, H. J., 1915, viii 
Busby, W., 1887, 1089 
Campbell, D. H., 1885, 856 
Campbell, W. R., 1907, 4 
Carne, J. H., 1923, iv 
Clark, C. D., 1901, 741 
Clements, F. M., 1921, § 
Collie, R., 1892, 668 

(Clop, di, (Gh Sales, 5 
Daintrey, H., 1887, 1089 
Dalley, W. B., 1888, 1782 
Deane, H., 1924, iv 

De Gray, T., see Walsingham 
De Toni, G. B., 1925, v 

De Vis, C. W., 1916, 6 
Dixon, J. R. L., 1924, v 
Dixson, C., 1895, 135 
Duncan, W. A., 1885, 855 
Dwyer, T. C., 1910, 3 
Etheridge, R., Junr., 1920, 5 
Ewan, J. F., 1888, 1784 
Forsyth, W., 1911, 10 

Fry, D. B., 1918, 9 

Garland, J. B., 1902, 684 
Garland, J. R., 1915, x 
Grant, A., 1907, 5 

Grant, F. E., 1907, 5 
Gunther, A. C. L. G., 1914, 5 
Hamblin, C. O., 1923, v 
Haswell, W. A., 1925, v 
Hay, J., 1909, 1 

Hayes, P., 1887, 1089 
Hutton, F. W., 1905, 606 
Kalchbrenner, C., 1886, 1210 
Kershaw, W., 1900, 2 

King, P. G., 1905, 3 

Labatt, H. R., 1887, 1090 
Langley, S. P., 1907, 2 
Lodder, Mary, 1911, 11 
Loven, S., 1895, 623 

Wiucasw eee LOLS. AO 


MacGillivray, P. H., 1895, 624 
MacLaurin, N., 1915, ix 
Maclay, N. N. M., 1888, 1783 
Macleay, W., 1891, 707 
Mann, Dr., 1890, 902 
Markey, J., 1887, 1089 
Masters, G., 1913, 2 

Wen, dis lel; isileG 7 

Mein, C. T., 1890, 902 
Merewether, H. C., 1893, 542 
Mitchell, D. S., 1908, 2 
Mitten, W., 1907, 3 
Morehead, R. A. A., 1885, 855 
Mueller, F. von, 1896, 823 
Murdoch, R., 1925, viii 
North, A. J., 1918, 10 
Norton, J., 1907, 6 

Olliff, A. S., 1895, 624 © 
Owen, R., 1892, 669 

Palmer, E. G. W., 1915, viii 
Parker, T. J., 1897, 813 
Petterd, W. F., 1911, 7 
Playfair, G. I., 1923, vi 
Ratiray, A., 11924, iv 
Rainbow, W. J., 1920, 5 
Ratte, F., 1890, 902 

Read, R. B., 1890, 902 
Renwick, A., 1909, 1 

Ross, W. J. C., 1915, ix 
Rossiter, R. C., 1902, 684 
Schuette, R., 1886, 1211 


‘Scortechini, B., 1886, 1211 


Shirley, J., 1923, vii 
Simson, A., 1919, 18 
Smith, H. A., 1917, 7 
Smith, H. G., 1925, viii 
Stackhouse, T., 1886, 1211 
Stephens, H., 1920, 4 
Stephens, T., 1914, 4 
Stephens, W. J., 1890, 900 
Tate, R., 1901, 741 
Trebeck, P. N., 1905, 2 
Turnbull, A. H., 1919, 18 
Walker, R. C., 1897, 812 
Walsingham, Baron, 1921, 8 
Weston, W. J., 1887, 1089 
Wilkinson, C. S., 1891, 706 
Wilson, J. B., 1895, 624 
Wilson, W., 1886, 1211 
Woods, F. T., 1887, 1089 
Woods, J. EH. T., 1889, 1301 
Woolls, W., 1892, 669 


i de 


VOLUMES 
(1875-1925). 


Ss ¥D NE Ys ! 
tA 
"PRINTED AND PUBLISHED FOR THE SOCIETY BY 


THE AUSTRALASIAN MEDICAL PUBLISHING CO., 
- Seamer Street, Glebe, Se 


ae and Paes 
SOLD BY THE SOCIETY. 


’ LIST OF OFFICERS AND COUNCIL, 1928-29.°. = 

3 rm ~ he ; 
President: 7s Mie eae te Se 
_ Assistant-Professor W. R. Browne, D. Se. oS ea 


Vice-Presidents: a ip en ae yee: Saas 


7 
pe ARE aed 
eee 


g H. J. Carter, B:A., F:E.S.., ; _ A. F. Basset Hull. ; eos ue Figs : 
A. G. Hamilton, ; ae Be ge 
: : : Hon.-'Treasurer: *E. Cheel~” Bets ee z 


Secretary: A. B. Walkom, ‘D.Sc. 


: : Council: : 2 
Cc. Anderson, M.A., D.Sc. - G. M. Goldfinch. | a go 
oe _ EB. C. Andrews, B.A, F.G.S. A. G. Hamilton. Pee MMe easy co 
bodes -- -w. R. Browne, D.Sc. oe A. F. Basset Hull.. sted ee 
Professor A. N. Burkitt M.B., B.Sc. A. H. 8. Lucas, M.A., B. : Se. pie ae 
BE ak Carter, BSAC ERS, I. M. Mackerras, MB., GhNES Be. Are Shee 
EE. Cheel. A. J. Nicholson, M.Se. SR aes 
Sir T. W. Edgéworth David, K.B.E., {Professor T. G. B. Osborn, D.Sc. Cia he SIR gee 
C.M.G., D.S.0O., B:A., D.Sc., F.R.S. A. B. Walkom, D.Sc. pee Dees E eae 
oy T. Storie Dixson, M.B., Ch.M. : -H.S. H. Wardlaw, D.Sc. — ata: 
Ss : WW. Froggatt, F.L.S. _ G. A. Waterhouse, D.Sc, B.E., F. ES, ‘ 


-Anditor: F. H. Rayment, F.C-P.A! 


\ 


aa ‘ *Blected 24th October, 1928, in place of G. a Waterhouse, D. Se. fal ID younot ee 
ee) : +BHlected 19th December, 1928, in place of the late R. H. Gunter oe By ee ow ed 


eo “NOTICE. = 


“Wirn the exception of Volumes I-VI of the Procempmnas—of which the Society’s 
stock was totally destroyed in the Garden Palace Fire—the Publications of the 
Linnean Society of N.S.W. may be obtained from the Society, Macleay House, 
16 College Street, Sydney, or from Dulau & ote 32 Old Bond Bite London, Oe 
at the following prices :— a: aa pee ee aes 


ae o FIRST SERIHS. ~ — eee ee aS 


Proceedings for 1882, Vol. VII.—Part 1, 7s. 6d.; Part 2, 10s.; - Part 3, 5a Part ye 10s. 
Proceedings for 1883, Vol. VIII.—Part 1, 10s.; Part 2, 5s.; Part 3, Ts.5 SPartea< Sey. caine 
x Proceedings for 1884, Vol. IX.—Part 1, 85.; Part-2, t2s.> Part (3,-64— 5s.; Part 4, £1 5s. ree 
p Proceedings for 1885, Vol. X.—Part 1, 12s.; Para 7s. 6d.; Part 3, 15s.; Part 4 Z 
: 17s, 6d. : i Oe, RN Se RG NS 2 ee Et 


SECOND SERIES. A es 


* ' Proceedings for 1886, Vol. i.—Part il 10s. 6d.; Part re 12s. he Part 3, 188.5 8 Part” oe 

12s. 6d. i é oa 

es Proceedings for 1887, Vol. II. —Part LtS.% Part 2, 8s.; Part 3, 12s.; Part’ a £1 7s. 

oe ¢ a> Proceedings for 1888, Vol. III.—Part 1, 15s.; ‘Part 2, £1 4s.; Part 3, £1; Part 4, 18s. ae 

_ Proceedings for 1889, Vol. IV.—Part 1, 11s.; Part 2, 16s.; Part 3, 19s.; ‘Part 4, 11s. 

i Proceedings for 1890, Vol. V.—Part 1, l1s.; Part 2, 9s.; Part 3, 9s.; Part 4, 9s. _ 3 

roe Proceedings for 1891, Vol. VI.—Part 1, 10s.; Part 2, 9s. 6d.; Part 3, 17s.; Part 4, — 
Z. 7s. 6d. : a wes ¥ ae ee : ee eee 

Has Proceedings for 1892, Vol. VIL—Part 1, 6s. 6d.; Part 2, 4s. 6d.; Part 3, 88.; Part 4, 8s. __ 

Proceedings for 1893, Vol. NIII.—Part 1, 5s.; Part 2, 11s.; Pact 8, 6s.; Part 4, 952 

Proceedings for 1894, Vol. IX: Se see: ile wae Part 2, ete ; Part 35 La 3 nea 4, 8a. 


, 98.5 ; Supplement, ‘2s. 6a.: art. 6s. 6d.; Part Sikes 6. 


10s.; Part 2, 8s. 6d.; Part 3, ake Part 4, 128. 6d. 
8s.; Part 2, 6s.; ie Part 8, 12s.; Part 4, 14s. ; 
12s. 6d.; Part 2, 12s.; Part 3, 10s.; Part 4, 10s. 6d. 
: SnESay Bane 2, 10s. 6d.; Part 3, 10s. 6d.; Part 4, 17s. 6d. 
, 10s:; Part 2, ol eart 3, 5s.; Part i 17s. 6d. 
HW pigs SEY A 7s. 6d.; Part 3, 7s. 6d.; Supplement, 3s.; 


Binds eePart. 2 ates. bth; Part 3, 148.;/Part, 4; lost 
gs | for 1904. part 1, 108.; Part 2, Ts, 6d.; Part 3, 9s.; Part 4, 10s: 
; for” 1905.—Part is with Supplement, lg : Part 2, 10s.; Part 3, 12s. 
rith ‘Supplement, 10s. 6d. 
rs for -1906.—Part ae “12s. 6d.; Part os 12s. 6d.; Part 3, 12s. -6d.; Part 4, 
ss for 1907. —Part 1,288.9 Part 2, 8s. 6d.; Part 3, 15s.; Part 4, 18s. 
for 1908.—Part oR 7s.; Part 2; 98.5 Part 8, 14s.; Pact 4, 12s. 6d. 

ss for 1909.— —Part. 1, pee | Part. 2, 17s.; Part 3, 14s.; Part 4, 16s. 6d. 

Vist Part 3, 18.5 : fea 4, 12s. 6d.. 
eer 1911-—Part. L ie ie Part 2, 9s. 6d.; Part. 3, 9s. 6d.; Part 4, 10s. 
for 1912.—Part_ 1, 8s. 6d.; Part 2, 25s.; Part 3, 12s. 6d.; Part 4, 15s. 

‘s for 1913.- ‘Part 1, 14s.; Part 2, [GSAT ORV Sea dees 63.; Part 4, 13s. 

‘s for 1914. Part -1, 4£2s:; Part 2, 17s.; Part 3, 25s.; Part 4, 19s. 
for LO LD: —Part 1,-2i8.; ; Part 2, 12s. 6d.; Part 3, 10s.; Part 4, 11s. 
for 1916.—Part 7 PMO: Beare 2, 12s. ; $ ‘Part, ae 15s.; A Part 4, 19s. 

S for 1917.—Part 1, 14s.; 3; Part 2, 9s.; Part 3, 12s. 6d.; Part 4, 16s. 6d. 

;s for 1918.—Part 5 lee 20s.; Part 72, 148); Part 3, 2is.; Part 4, 19s. 

s for 1919. —Part teats: 6d.: Part 2; 11s. 6d.; Part 3; 17s. 6d.; Part 4, 
for 1920.—Part 1, 10s. 9d.; Part 2, Ts. 6d.; ‘Part 8, 9s.; Part 4,. 11s. 
for. 1921 —Part d, 9s.; g Part 2, 8s.; Part 3, es 6d.; Part 4, 9s. 6d. 
for. 1922.—Part 1, — Sods, Part 2) Iss. 6d.; . Part 3, lis.; Part 4, 

ae 250 6a; Part 2, 128.; 3: Part 55 ea Part 4; 13s. 


s for 1924.—Part 1, 2s. Part 2, 18s, 64. ; Part 3, 12s. S6e Part 4, 


mes ee 1926.—Part i. 2. Part 2 128,; Part 3, 8s. 9d.; BERS 4, 14s. 


TO VOLUMES ets OF THE PROCEEDINGS [Issued “15th February, 19291. . pp. 108. 


ne a) ee fi = F 2 
ca Oo 4 


‘he “Macunax Memonzan VoLuME issued October 13th, 1893]. Royal 4to. ui and 308 


roe copie: S. only. Price £1 net. 


The T ANSACTIONS OF THE SSP aetoce rae SOCIETY OF Naw SourH WALES, 2 vols., oe 
=a eeeomplete in five ate 1863- Pie ee 70s. net, Parts 2-5 = coca Vol. 


_ Index to Subje 


“Index to Exhibi 
_ Index to Obituary Notices .. .. 


f ; ‘ media 


Authors of Papers 2. 
sof Papers... 
pms: AL, < 


ra 
ih 


MBL/ 


ii 


SS rate 


ey os 
— Se